This file is indexed.

/usr/share/libreoffice/help/gl/simpress.ht is in libreoffice-help-gl 1:3.5.7-0ubuntu13.

This file is owned by root:root, with mode 0o644.

The actual contents of the file can be viewed below.

   1
   2
   3
   4
   5
   6
   7
   8
   9
  10
  11
  12
  13
  14
  15
  16
  17
  18
  19
  20
  21
  22
  23
  24
  25
  26
  27
  28
  29
  30
  31
  32
  33
  34
  35
  36
  37
  38
  39
  40
  41
  42
  43
  44
  45
  46
  47
  48
  49
  50
  51
  52
  53
  54
  55
  56
  57
  58
  59
  60
  61
  62
  63
  64
  65
  66
  67
  68
  69
  70
  71
  72
  73
  74
  75
  76
  77
  78
  79
  80
  81
  82
  83
  84
  85
  86
  87
  88
  89
  90
  91
  92
  93
  94
  95
  96
  97
  98
  99
 100
 101
 102
 103
 104
 105
 106
 107
 108
 109
 110
 111
 112
 113
 114
 115
 116
 117
 118
 119
 120
 121
 122
 123
 124
 125
 126
 127
 128
 129
 130
 131
 132
 133
 134
 135
 136
 137
 138
 139
 140
 141
 142
 143
 144
 145
 146
 147
 148
 149
 150
 151
 152
 153
 154
 155
 156
 157
 158
 159
 160
 161
 162
 163
 164
 165
 166
 167
 168
 169
 170
 171
 172
 173
 174
 175
 176
 177
 178
 179
 180
 181
 182
 183
 184
 185
 186
 187
 188
 189
 190
 191
 192
 193
 194
 195
 196
 197
 198
 199
 200
 201
 202
 203
 204
 205
 206
 207
 208
 209
 210
 211
 212
 213
 214
 215
 216
 217
 218
 219
 220
 221
 222
 223
 224
 225
 226
 227
 228
 229
 230
 231
 232
 233
 234
 235
 236
 237
 238
 239
 240
 241
 242
 243
 244
 245
 246
 247
 248
 249
 250
 251
 252
 253
 254
 255
 256
 257
 258
 259
 260
 261
 262
 263
 264
 265
 266
 267
 268
 269
 270
 271
 272
 273
 274
 275
 276
 277
 278
 279
 280
 281
 282
 283
 284
 285
 286
 287
 288
 289
 290
 291
 292
 293
 294
 295
 296
 297
 298
 299
 300
 301
 302
 303
 304
 305
 306
 307
 308
 309
 310
 311
 312
 313
 314
 315
 316
 317
 318
 319
 320
 321
 322
 323
 324
 325
 326
 327
 328
 329
 330
 331
 332
 333
 334
 335
 336
 337
 338
 339
 340
 341
 342
 343
 344
 345
 346
 347
 348
 349
 350
 351
 352
 353
 354
 355
 356
 357
 358
 359
 360
 361
 362
 363
 364
 365
 366
 367
 368
 369
 370
 371
 372
 373
 374
 375
 376
 377
 378
 379
 380
 381
 382
 383
 384
 385
 386
 387
 388
 389
 390
 391
 392
 393
 394
 395
 396
 397
 398
 399
 400
 401
 402
 403
 404
 405
 406
 407
 408
 409
 410
 411
 412
 413
 414
 415
 416
 417
 418
 419
 420
 421
 422
 423
 424
 425
 426
 427
 428
 429
 430
 431
 432
 433
 434
 435
 436
 437
 438
 439
 440
 441
 442
 443
 444
 445
 446
 447
 448
 449
 450
 451
 452
 453
 454
 455
 456
 457
 458
 459
 460
 461
 462
 463
 464
 465
 466
 467
 468
 469
 470
 471
 472
 473
 474
 475
 476
 477
 478
 479
 480
 481
 482
 483
 484
 485
 486
 487
 488
 489
 490
 491
 492
 493
 494
 495
 496
 497
 498
 499
 500
 501
 502
 503
 504
 505
 506
 507
 508
 509
 510
 511
 512
 513
 514
 515
 516
 517
 518
 519
 520
 521
 522
 523
 524
 525
 526
 527
 528
 529
 530
 531
 532
 533
 534
 535
 536
 537
 538
 539
 540
 541
 542
 543
 544
 545
 546
 547
 548
 549
 550
 551
 552
 553
 554
 555
 556
 557
 558
 559
 560
 561
 562
 563
 564
 565
 566
 567
 568
 569
 570
 571
 572
 573
 574
 575
 576
 577
 578
 579
 580
 581
 582
 583
 584
 585
 586
 587
 588
 589
 590
 591
 592
 593
 594
 595
 596
 597
 598
 599
 600
 601
 602
 603
 604
 605
 606
 607
 608
 609
 610
 611
 612
 613
 614
 615
 616
 617
 618
 619
 620
 621
 622
 623
 624
 625
 626
 627
 628
 629
 630
 631
 632
 633
 634
 635
 636
 637
 638
 639
 640
 641
 642
 643
 644
 645
 646
 647
 648
 649
 650
 651
 652
 653
 654
 655
 656
 657
 658
 659
 660
 661
 662
 663
 664
 665
 666
 667
 668
 669
 670
 671
 672
 673
 674
 675
 676
 677
 678
 679
 680
 681
 682
 683
 684
 685
 686
 687
 688
 689
 690
 691
 692
 693
 694
 695
 696
 697
 698
 699
 700
 701
 702
 703
 704
 705
 706
 707
 708
 709
 710
 711
 712
 713
 714
 715
 716
 717
 718
 719
 720
 721
 722
 723
 724
 725
 726
 727
 728
 729
 730
 731
 732
 733
 734
 735
 736
 737
 738
 739
 740
 741
 742
 743
 744
 745
 746
 747
 748
 749
 750
 751
 752
 753
 754
 755
 756
 757
 758
 759
 760
 761
 762
 763
 764
 765
 766
 767
 768
 769
 770
 771
 772
 773
 774
 775
 776
 777
 778
 779
 780
 781
 782
 783
 784
 785
 786
 787
 788
 789
 790
 791
 792
 793
 794
 795
 796
 797
 798
 799
 800
 801
 802
 803
 804
 805
 806
 807
 808
 809
 810
 811
 812
 813
 814
 815
 816
 817
 818
 819
 820
 821
 822
 823
 824
 825
 826
 827
 828
 829
 830
 831
 832
 833
 834
 835
 836
 837
 838
 839
 840
 841
 842
 843
 844
 845
 846
 847
 848
 849
 850
 851
 852
 853
 854
 855
 856
 857
 858
 859
 860
 861
 862
 863
 864
 865
 866
 867
 868
 869
 870
 871
 872
 873
 874
 875
 876
 877
 878
 879
 880
 881
 882
 883
 884
 885
 886
 887
 888
 889
 890
 891
 892
 893
 894
 895
 896
 897
 898
 899
 900
 901
 902
 903
 904
 905
 906
 907
 908
 909
 910
 911
 912
 913
 914
 915
 916
 917
 918
 919
 920
 921
 922
 923
 924
 925
 926
 927
 928
 929
 930
 931
 932
 933
 934
 935
 936
 937
 938
 939
 940
 941
 942
 943
 944
 945
 946
 947
 948
 949
 950
 951
 952
 953
 954
 955
 956
 957
 958
 959
 960
 961
 962
 963
 964
 965
 966
 967
 968
 969
 970
 971
 972
 973
 974
 975
 976
 977
 978
 979
 980
 981
 982
 983
 984
 985
 986
 987
 988
 989
 990
 991
 992
 993
 994
 995
 996
 997
 998
 999
1000
1001
1002
1003
1004
1005
1006
1007
1008
1009
1010
1011
1012
1013
1014
1015
1016
1017
1018
1019
1020
1021
1022
1023
1024
1025
1026
1027
1028
1029
1030
1031
1032
1033
1034
1035
1036
1037
1038
1039
1040
1041
1042
1043
1044
1045
1046
1047
1048
1049
1050
1051
1052
1053
1054
1055
1056
1057
1058
1059
1060
1061
1062
1063
1064
1065
1066
1067
1068
1069
1070
1071
1072
1073
1074
1075
1076
1077
1078
1079
1080
1081
1082
1083
1084
1085
1086
1087
1088
1089
1090
1091
1092
1093
1094
1095
1096
1097
1098
1099
1100
1101
1102
1103
1104
1105
1106
1107
1108
1109
1110
1111
1112
1113
1114
1115
1116
1117
1118
1119
1120
1121
1122
1123
1124
1125
1126
1127
1128
1129
1130
1131
1132
1133
1134
1135
1136
1137
1138
1139
1140
1141
1142
1143
1144
1145
1146
1147
1148
1149
1150
1151
1152
1153
1154
1155
1156
1157
1158
1159
1160
1161
1162
1163
1164
1165
1166
1167
1168
1169
1170
1171
1172
1173
1174
1175
1176
1177
1178
1179
1180
1181
1182
1183
1184
1185
1186
1187
1188
1189
1190
1191
1192
1193
1194
1195
1196
1197
1198
1199
1200
1201
1202
1203
1204
1205
1206
1207
1208
1209
1210
1211
1212
1213
1214
1215
1216
1217
1218
1219
1220
1221
1222
1223
1224
1225
1226
1227
1228
1229
1230
1231
1232
1233
1234
1235
1236
1237
1238
1239
1240
1241
1242
1243
1244
1245
1246
1247
1248
1249
1250
1251
1252
1253
1254
1255
1256
1257
1258
1259
1260
1261
1262
1263
1264
1265
1266
1267
1268
1269
1270
1271
1272
1273
1274
1275
1276
1277
1278
1279
1280
1281
1282
1283
1284
1285
1286
1287
1288
1289
1290
1291
1292
1293
1294
1295
1296
1297
1298
1299
1300
1301
1302
1303
1304
1305
1306
1307
1308
1309
1310
1311
1312
1313
1314
1315
1316
1317
1318
1319
1320
1321
1322
1323
1324
1325
1326
1327
1328
1329
1330
1331
1332
1333
1334
1335
1336
1337
1338
1339
1340
1341
1342
1343
1344
1345
1346
1347
1348
1349
1350
1351
1352
1353
1354
1355
1356
1357
1358
1359
1360
1361
1362
1363
1364
1365
1366
1367
1368
1369
1370
1371
1372
1373
1374
1375
1376
1377
1378
1379
1380
1381
1382
1383
1384
1385
1386
1387
1388
1389
1390
1391
1392
1393
1394
1395
1396
1397
1398
1399
1400
1401
1402
1403
1404
1405
1406
1407
1408
1409
1410
1411
1412
1413
1414
1415
1416
1417
1418
1419
1420
1421
1422
1423
1424
1425
1426
1427
1428
1429
1430
1431
1432
1433
1434
1435
1436
1437
1438
1439
1440
1441
1442
1443
1444
1445
1446
1447
1448
1449
1450
1451
1452
1453
1454
1455
1456
1457
1458
1459
1460
1461
1462
1463
1464
1465
1466
1467
1468
1469
1470
1471
1472
1473
1474
1475
1476
1477
1478
1479
1480
1481
1482
1483
1484
1485
1486
1487
1488
1489
1490
1491
1492
1493
1494
1495
1496
1497
1498
1499
1500
1501
1502
1503
1504
1505
1506
1507
1508
1509
1510
1511
1512
1513
1514
1515
1516
1517
1518
1519
1520
1521
1522
1523
1524
1525
1526
1527
1528
1529
1530
1531
1532
1533
1534
1535
1536
1537
1538
1539
1540
1541
1542
1543
1544
1545
1546
1547
1548
1549
1550
1551
1552
1553
1554
1555
1556
1557
1558
1559
1560
1561
1562
1563
1564
1565
1566
1567
1568
1569
1570
1571
1572
1573
1574
1575
1576
1577
1578
1579
1580
1581
1582
1583
1584
1585
1586
1587
1588
1589
1590
1591
1592
1593
1594
1595
1596
1597
1598
1599
1600
1601
1602
1603
1604
1605
1606
1607
1608
1609
1610
1611
1612
1613
1614
1615
1616
1617
1618
1619
1620
1621
1622
1623
1624
1625
1626
1627
1628
1629
1630
1631
1632
1633
1634
1635
1636
1637
1638
1639
1640
1641
1642
1643
1644
1645
1646
1647
1648
1649
1650
1651
1652
1653
1654
1655
1656
1657
1658
1659
1660
1661
1662
1663
1664
1665
1666
1667
1668
1669
1670
1671
1672
1673
1674
1675
1676
1677
1678
1679
1680
1681
1682
1683
1684
1685
1686
1687
1688
1689
1690
1691
1692
1693
1694
1695
1696
1697
1698
1699
1700
1701
1702
1703
1704
1705
1706
1707
1708
1709
1710
1711
1712
1713
1714
1715
1716
1717
1718
1719
1720
1721
1722
1723
1724
1725
1726
1727
1728
1729
1730
1731
1732
1733
1734
1735
1736
1737
1738
1739
1740
1741
1742
1743
1744
1745
1746
1747
1748
1749
1750
1751
1752
1753
1754
1755
1756
1757
1758
1759
1760
1761
1762
1763
1764
1765
1766
1767
1768
1769
1770
1771
1772
1773
1774
1775
1776
1777
1778
1779
1780
1781
1782
1783
1784
1785
1786
1787
1788
1789
1790
1791
1792
1793
1794
1795
1796
1797
1798
1799
1800
1801
1802
1803
1804
1805
1806
1807
1808
1809
1810
1811
1812
1813
1814
1815
1816
1817
1818
1819
1820
1821
1822
1823
1824
1825
1826
1827
1828
1829
1830
1831
1832
1833
1834
1835
1836
1837
1838
1839
1840
1841
1842
1843
1844
1845
1846
1847
1848
1849
1850
1851
1852
1853
1854
1855
1856
1857
1858
1859
1860
1861
1862
1863
1864
1865
1866
1867
1868
1869
1870
1871
1872
1873
1874
1875
1876
1877
1878
1879
1880
1881
1882
1883
1884
1885
1886
1887
1888
1889
1890
1891
1892
1893
1894
1895
1896
1897
1898
1899
1900
1901
1902
1903
1904
1905
1906
1907
1908
1909
1910
1911
1912
1913
1914
1915
1916
1917
1918
1919
1920
1921
1922
1923
1924
1925
1926
1927
1928
1929
1930
1931
1932
1933
1934
1935
1936
1937
1938
1939
1940
1941
1942
1943
1944
1945
1946
1947
1948
1949
1950
1951
1952
1953
1954
1955
1956
1957
1958
1959
1960
1961
1962
1963
1964
1965
1966
1967
1968
1969
1970
1971
1972
1973
1974
1975
1976
1977
1978
1979
1980
1981
1982
1983
1984
1985
1986
1987
1988
1989
1990
1991
1992
1993
1994
1995
1996
1997
1998
1999
2000
2001
2002
2003
2004
2005
2006
2007
2008
2009
2010
2011
2012
2013
2014
2015
2016
2017
2018
2019
2020
2021
2022
2023
2024
2025
2026
2027
2028
2029
2030
2031
2032
2033
2034
2035
2036
2037
2038
2039
2040
2041
2042
2043
2044
2045
2046
2047
2048
2049
2050
2051
2052
2053
2054
2055
2056
2057
2058
2059
2060
2061
2062
2063
2064
2065
2066
2067
2068
2069
2070
2071
2072
2073
2074
2075
2076
2077
2078
2079
2080
2081
2082
2083
2084
2085
2086
2087
2088
2089
2090
2091
2092
2093
2094
2095
2096
2097
2098
2099
2100
2101
2102
2103
2104
2105
2106
2107
2108
2109
2110
2111
2112
2113
2114
2115
2116
2117
2118
2119
2120
2121
2122
2123
2124
2125
2126
2127
2128
2129
2130
2131
2132
2133
2134
2135
2136
2137
2138
2139
2140
2141
2142
2143
2144
2145
2146
2147
2148
2149
2150
2151
2152
2153
2154
2155
2156
2157
2158
2159
2160
2161
2162
2163
2164
2165
2166
2167
2168
2169
2170
2171
2172
2173
2174
2175
2176
2177
2178
2179
2180
2181
2182
2183
2184
2185
2186
2187
2188
2189
2190
2191
2192
2193
2194
2195
2196
2197
2198
2199
2200
2201
2202
2203
2204
2205
2206
2207
2208
2209
2210
2211
2212
2213
2214
2215
2216
2217
2218
2219
2220
2221
2222
2223
2224
2225
2226
2227
2228
2229
2230
2231
2232
2233
2234
2235
2236
2237
2238
2239
2240
2241
2242
2243
2244
2245
2246
2247
2248
2249
2250
2251
2252
2253
2254
2255
2256
2257
2258
2259
2260
2261
2262
2263
2264
2265
2266
2267
2268
2269
2270
2271
2272
2273
2274
2275
2276
2277
2278
2279
2280
2281
2282
2283
2284
2285
2286
2287
2288
2289
2290
2291
2292
2293
2294
2295
2296
2297
2298
2299
2300
2301
2302
2303
2304
2305
2306
2307
2308
2309
2310
2311
2312
2313
2314
2315
2316
2317
2318
2319
2320
2321
2322
2323
2324
2325
2326
2327
2328
2329
2330
2331
2332
2333
2334
2335
2336
2337
2338
2339
2340
2341
2342
2343
2344
2345
2346
2347
2348
2349
2350
2351
2352
2353
2354
2355
2356
2357
2358
2359
2360
2361
2362
2363
2364
2365
2366
2367
2368
2369
2370
2371
2372
2373
2374
2375
2376
2377
2378
2379
2380
2381
2382
2383
2384
2385
2386
2387
2388
2389
2390
2391
2392
2393
2394
2395
2396
2397
2398
2399
2400
2401
2402
2403
2404
2405
2406
2407
2408
2409
2410
2411
2412
2413
2414
2415
2416
2417
2418
2419
2420
2421
2422
2423
2424
2425
2426
2427
2428
2429
2430
2431
2432
2433
2434
2435
2436
2437
2438
2439
2440
2441
2442
2443
2444
2445
2446
2447
2448
2449
2450
2451
2452
2453
2454
2455
2456
2457
2458
2459
2460
2461
2462
2463
2464
2465
2466
2467
2468
2469
2470
2471
2472
2473
2474
2475
2476
2477
2478
2479
2480
2481
2482
2483
2484
2485
2486
2487
2488
2489
2490
2491
2492
2493
2494
2495
2496
2497
2498
2499
2500
2501
2502
2503
2504
2505
2506
2507
2508
2509
2510
2511
2512
2513
2514
2515
2516
2517
2518
2519
2520
2521
2522
2523
2524
2525
2526
2527
2528
2529
2530
2531
2532
2533
2534
2535
2536
2537
2538
2539
2540
2541
2542
2543
2544
2545
2546
2547
2548
2549
2550
2551
2552
2553
2554
2555
2556
2557
2558
2559
2560
2561
2562
2563
2564
2565
2566
2567
2568
2569
2570
2571
2572
2573
2574
2575
2576
2577
2578
2579
2580
2581
2582
2583
2584
2585
2586
2587
2588
2589
2590
2591
2592
2593
2594
2595
2596
2597
2598
2599
2600
2601
2602
2603
2604
2605
2606
2607
2608
2609
2610
2611
2612
2613
2614
2615
2616
2617
2618
2619
2620
2621
2622
2623
2624
2625
2626
2627
2628
2629
2630
2631
2632
2633
2634
2635
2636
2637
2638
2639
2640
2641
2642
2643
2644
2645
2646
2647
2648
2649
2650
2651
2652
2653
2654
2655
2656
2657
2658
2659
2660
2661
2662
2663
2664
2665
2666
2667
2668
2669
2670
2671
2672
2673
2674
2675
2676
2677
2678
2679
2680
2681
2682
2683
2684
2685
2686
2687
2688
2689
2690
2691
2692
2693
2694
2695
2696
2697
2698
2699
2700
2701
2702
2703
2704
2705
2706
2707
2708
2709
2710
2711
2712
2713
2714
2715
2716
2717
2718
2719
2720
2721
2722
2723
2724
2725
2726
2727
2728
2729
2730
2731
2732
2733
2734
2735
2736
2737
2738
2739
2740
2741
2742
2743
2744
2745
2746
2747
2748
2749
2750
2751
2752
2753
2754
2755
2756
2757
2758
2759
2760
2761
2762
2763
2764
2765
2766
2767
2768
2769
2770
2771
2772
2773
2774
2775
2776
2777
2778
2779
2780
2781
2782
2783
2784
2785
2786
2787
2788
2789
2790
2791
2792
2793
2794
2795
2796
2797
2798
2799
2800
2801
2802
2803
2804
2805
2806
2807
2808
2809
2810
2811
2812
2813
2814
2815
2816
2817
2818
2819
2820
2821
2822
2823
2824
2825
2826
2827
2828
2829
2830
2831
2832
2833
2834
2835
2836
2837
2838
2839
2840
2841
2842
2843
2844
2845
2846
2847
2848
2849
2850
2851
2852
2853
2854
2855
2856
2857
2858
2859
2860
2861
2862
2863
2864
2865
2866
2867
2868
2869
2870
2871
2872
2873
2874
2875
2876
2877
2878
2879
2880
2881
2882
2883
2884
2885
2886
2887
2888
2889
2890
2891
2892
2893
2894
2895
2896
2897
2898
2899
2900
2901
2902
2903
2904
2905
2906
2907
2908
2909
2910
2911
2912
2913
2914
2915
2916
2917
2918
2919
2920
2921
2922
2923
2924
2925
2926
2927
2928
2929
2930
2931
2932
2933
2934
2935
2936
2937
2938
2939
2940
2941
2942
2943
2944
2945
2946
2947
2948
2949
2950
2951
2952
2953
2954
2955
2956
2957
2958
2959
2960
2961
2962
2963
2964
2965
2966
2967
2968
2969
2970
2971
2972
2973
2974
2975
2976
2977
2978
2979
2980
2981
2982
2983
2984
2985
2986
2987
2988
2989
2990
2991
2992
2993
2994
2995
2996
2997
2998
2999
3000
3001
3002
3003
3004
3005
3006
3007
3008
3009
3010
3011
3012
3013
3014
3015
3016
3017
3018
3019
3020
3021
3022
3023
3024
3025
3026
3027
3028
3029
3030
3031
3032
3033
3034
3035
3036
3037
3038
3039
3040
3041
3042
3043
3044
3045
3046
3047
3048
3049
3050
3051
3052
3053
3054
3055
3056
3057
3058
3059
3060
3061
3062
3063
3064
3065
3066
3067
3068
3069
3070
3071
3072
3073
3074
3075
3076
3077
3078
3079
3080
3081
3082
3083
3084
3085
3086
3087
3088
3089
3090
3091
3092
3093
3094
3095
3096
3097
3098
3099
3100
3101
3102
3103
3104
3105
3106
3107
3108
3109
3110
3111
3112
3113
3114
3115
3116
3117
3118
3119
3120
3121
3122
3123
3124
3125
3126
3127
3128
3129
3130
3131
3132
3133
3134
3135
3136
3137
3138
3139
3140
3141
3142
3143
3144
3145
3146
3147
3148
3149
3150
3151
3152
3153
3154
3155
3156
3157
3158
3159
3160
3161
3162
3163
3164
3165
3166
3167
3168
3169
3170
3171
3172
3173
3174
3175
3176
3177
3178
3179
3180
3181
3182
3183
3184
3185
3186
3187
3188
3189
3190
3191
3192
3193
3194
3195
3196
3197
3198
3199
3200
3201
3202
3203
3204
3205
3206
3207
3208
3209
3210
3211
3212
3213
3214
3215
3216
3217
3218
3219
3220
3221
3222
3223
3224
3225
3226
3227
3228
3229
3230
3231
3232
3233
3234
3235
3236
3237
3238
3239
3240
3241
3242
3243
3244
3245
3246
3247
3248
3249
3250
3251
3252
3253
3254
3255
3256
3257
3258
3259
3260
3261
3262
3263
3264
3265
3266
3267
3268
3269
3270
3271
3272
3273
3274
3275
3276
3277
3278
3279
3280
3281
3282
3283
3284
3285
3286
3287
3288
3289
3290
3291
3292
3293
3294
3295
3296
3297
3298
3299
3300
3301
3302
3303
3304
3305
3306
3307
3308
3309
3310
3311
3312
3313
3314
3315
3316
3317
3318
3319
3320
3321
3322
3323
3324
3325
3326
3327
3328
3329
3330
3331
3332
3333
3334
3335
3336
3337
3338
3339
3340
3341
3342
3343
3344
3345
3346
3347
3348
3349
3350
3351
3352
3353
3354
3355
3356
3357
3358
3359
3360
3361
3362
3363
3364
3365
3366
3367
3368
3369
3370
3371
3372
3373
3374
3375
3376
3377
3378
3379
3380
3381
3382
3383
3384
3385
3386
3387
3388
3389
3390
3391
3392
3393
3394
3395
3396
3397
3398
3399
3400
3401
3402
3403
3404
3405
3406
3407
3408
3409
3410
3411
3412
3413
3414
3415
3416
3417
3418
3419
3420
3421
3422
3423
3424
3425
3426
3427
3428
3429
3430
3431
3432
3433
3434
3435
3436
3437
3438
3439
3440
3441
3442
3443
3444
3445
3446
3447
3448
3449
3450
3451
3452
3453
3454
3455
3456
3457
3458
3459
3460
3461
3462
3463
3464
3465
3466
3467
3468
3469
3470
3471
3472
3473
3474
3475
3476
3477
3478
3479
3480
3481
3482
3483
3484
3485
3486
3487
3488
3489
3490
3491
3492
3493
3494
3495
3496
3497
3498
3499
3500
3501
3502
3503
3504
3505
3506
3507
3508
3509
3510
3511
3512
3513
3514
3515
3516
3517
3518
3519
3520
3521
3522
3523
3524
3525
3526
3527
3528
3529
3530
3531
3532
3533
3534
3535
3536
3537
3538
3539
3540
3541
3542
3543
3544
3545
3546
3547
3548
3549
3550
3551
3552
3553
3554
3555
3556
3557
3558
3559
3560
3561
3562
3563
3564
3565
3566
3567
3568
3569
3570
3571
3572
3573
3574
3575
3576
3577
3578
3579
3580
3581
3582
3583
3584
3585
3586
3587
3588
3589
3590
3591
3592
3593
3594
3595
3596
3597
3598
3599
3600
3601
3602
3603
3604
3605
3606
3607
3608
3609
3610
3611
3612
3613
3614
3615
3616
3617
3618
3619
3620
3621
3622
3623
3624
3625
3626
3627
3628
3629
3630
3631
3632
3633
3634
3635
3636
3637
3638
3639
3640
3641
3642
3643
3644
3645
3646
3647
3648
3649
3650
3651
3652
3653
3654
3655
3656
3657
3658
3659
3660
3661
3662
3663
3664
3665
3666
3667
3668
3669
3670
3671
3672
3673
3674
3675
3676
3677
3678
3679
3680
3681
3682
3683
3684
3685
3686
3687
3688
3689
3690
3691
3692
3693
3694
3695
3696
3697
3698
3699
3700
3701
3702
3703
3704
3705
3706
3707
3708
3709
3710
3711
3712
3713
3714
3715
3716
3717
3718
3719
3720
3721
3722
3723
3724
3725
3726
3727
3728
3729
3730
3731
3732
3733
3734
3735
3736
3737
3738
3739
3740
3741
3742
3743
3744
3745
3746
3747
3748
3749
3750
3751
3752
3753
3754
3755
3756
3757
3758
3759
3760
3761
3762
3763
3764
3765
3766
3767
3768
3769
3770
3771
3772
3773
3774
3775
3776
3777
3778
3779
3780
3781
3782
3783
3784
3785
3786
3787
3788
3789
3790
3791
3792
3793
3794
3795
3796
3797
3798
3799
3800
3801
3802
3803
3804
3805
3806
3807
3808
3809
3810
3811
3812
3813
3814
3815
3816
3817
3818
3819
3820
3821
3822
3823
3824
3825
3826
3827
3828
3829
3830
3831
3832
3833
3834
3835
3836
3837
3838
3839
3840
3841
3842
3843
3844
3845
3846
3847
3848
3849
3850
3851
3852
3853
3854
3855
3856
3857
3858
3859
3860
3861
3862
3863
3864
3865
3866
3867
3868
3869
3870
3871
3872
3873
3874
3875
3876
3877
3878
3879
3880
3881
3882
3883
3884
3885
3886
3887
3888
3889
3890
3891
3892
3893
3894
3895
3896
3897
3898
3899
3900
3901
3902
3903
3904
3905
3906
3907
3908
3909
3910
3911
3912
3913
3914
3915
3916
3917
3918
3919
3920
3921
3922
3923
3924
3925
3926
3927
3928
3929
3930
3931
3932
3933
3934
3935
3936
3937
3938
3939
3940
3941
3942
3943
3944
3945
3946
3947
3948
3949
3950
3951
3952
3953
3954
3955
3956
3957
3958
3959
3960
3961
3962
3963
3964
3965
3966
3967
3968
3969
3970
3971
3972
3973
3974
3975
3976
3977
3978
3979
3980
3981
3982
3983
3984
3985
3986
3987
3988
3989
3990
3991
3992
3993
3994
3995
3996
3997
3998
3999
4000
4001
4002
4003
4004
4005
4006
4007
4008
4009
4010
4011
4012
4013
4014
4015
4016
4017
4018
4019
4020
4021
4022
4023
4024
4025
4026
4027
4028
4029
4030
4031
4032
4033
4034
4035
4036
4037
4038
4039
4040
4041
4042
4043
4044
4045
4046
4047
4048
4049
4050
4051
4052
4053
4054
4055
4056
4057
4058
4059
4060
4061
4062
4063
4064
4065
4066
4067
4068
4069
4070
4071
4072
4073
4074
4075
4076
4077
4078
4079
4080
4081
4082
4083
4084
4085
4086
4087
4088
4089
4090
4091
4092
4093
4094
4095
4096
4097
4098
4099
4100
4101
4102
4103
4104
4105
4106
4107
4108
4109
4110
4111
4112
4113
4114
4115
4116
4117
4118
4119
4120
4121
4122
4123
4124
4125
4126
4127
4128
4129
4130
4131
4132
4133
4134
4135
4136
4137
4138
4139
4140
4141
4142
4143
4144
4145
4146
4147
4148
4149
4150
4151
4152
4153
4154
4155
4156
4157
4158
4159
4160
4161
4162
4163
4164
4165
4166
4167
4168
4169
4170
4171
4172
4173
4174
4175
4176
4177
4178
4179
4180
4181
4182
4183
4184
4185
4186
4187
4188
4189
4190
4191
4192
4193
4194
4195
4196
4197
4198
4199
4200
4201
4202
4203
4204
4205
4206
4207
4208
4209
4210
4211
4212
4213
4214
4215
4216
4217
4218
4219
4220
4221
4222
4223
4224
4225
4226
4227
4228
4229
4230
4231
4232
4233
4234
4235
4236
4237
4238
4239
4240
4241
4242
4243
4244
4245
4246
4247
4248
4249
4250
4251
4252
4253
4254
4255
4256
4257
4258
4259
4260
4261
4262
4263
4264
4265
4266
4267
4268
4269
4270
4271
4272
4273
4274
4275
4276
4277
4278
4279
4280
4281
4282
4283
4284
4285
4286
4287
4288
4289
4290
4291
4292
4293
4294
4295
4296
4297
4298
4299
4300
4301
4302
4303
4304
4305
4306
4307
4308
4309
4310
4311
4312
4313
4314
4315
4316
4317
4318
4319
4320
4321
4322
4323
4324
4325
4326
4327
4328
4329
4330
4331
4332
4333
4334
4335
4336
4337
4338
4339
4340
4341
4342
4343
4344
4345
4346
4347
4348
4349
4350
4351
4352
4353
4354
4355
4356
4357
4358
4359
4360
4361
4362
4363
4364
4365
4366
4367
4368
4369
4370
4371
4372
4373
4374
4375
4376
4377
4378
4379
4380
4381
4382
4383
4384
4385
4386
4387
4388
4389
4390
4391
4392
4393
4394
4395
4396
4397
4398
4399
4400
4401
4402
4403
4404
4405
4406
4407
4408
4409
4410
4411
4412
4413
4414
4415
4416
4417
4418
4419
4420
4421
4422
4423
4424
4425
4426
4427
4428
4429
4430
4431
4432
4433
4434
4435
4436
4437
4438
4439
4440
4441
4442
4443
4444
4445
4446
4447
4448
4449
4450
4451
4452
4453
4454
4455
4456
4457
4458
4459
4460
4461
4462
4463
4464
4465
4466
4467
4468
4469
4470
4471
4472
4473
4474
4475
4476
4477
4478
4479
4480
4481
4482
4483
4484
4485
4486
4487
4488
4489
4490
4491
4492
4493
4494
4495
4496
4497
4498
4499
4500
4501
4502
4503
4504
4505
4506
4507
4508
4509
4510
4511
4512
4513
4514
4515
4516
4517
4518
4519
4520
4521
4522
4523
4524
4525
4526
4527
4528
4529
4530
4531
4532
4533
4534
4535
4536
4537
4538
4539
4540
4541
4542
4543
4544
4545
4546
4547
4548
4549
4550
4551
4552
4553
4554
4555
4556
4557
4558
4559
4560
4561
4562
4563
4564
4565
4566
4567
4568
4569
4570
4571
4572
4573
4574
4575
4576
4577
4578
4579
4580
4581
4582
4583
4584
4585
4586
4587
4588
4589
4590
4591
4592
4593
4594
4595
4596
4597
4598
4599
4600
4601
4602
4603
4604
4605
4606
4607
4608
4609
4610
4611
4612
4613
4614
4615
4616
4617
4618
4619
4620
4621
4622
4623
4624
4625
4626
4627
4628
4629
4630
4631
4632
4633
4634
4635
4636
4637
4638
4639
4640
4641
4642
4643
4644
4645
4646
4647
4648
4649
4650
4651
4652
4653
4654
4655
4656
4657
4658
4659
4660
4661
4662
4663
4664
4665
4666
4667
4668
4669
4670
4671
4672
4673
4674
4675
4676
4677
4678
4679
4680
4681
4682
4683
4684
4685
4686
4687
4688
4689
4690
4691
4692
4693
4694
4695
4696
4697
4698
4699
4700
4701
4702
4703
4704
4705
4706
4707
4708
4709
4710
4711
4712
4713
4714
4715
4716
4717
4718
4719
4720
4721
4722
4723
4724
4725
4726
4727
4728
4729
4730
4731
4732
4733
4734
4735
4736
4737
4738
4739
4740
4741
4742
4743
4744
4745
4746
4747
4748
4749
4750
4751
4752
4753
4754
4755
4756
4757
4758
4759
4760
4761
4762
4763
4764
4765
4766
4767
4768
4769
4770
4771
4772
4773
4774
4775
4776
4777
4778
4779
4780
4781
4782
4783
4784
4785
4786
4787
4788
4789
4790
4791
4792
4793
4794
4795
4796
4797
4798
4799
4800
4801
4802
4803
4804
4805
4806
4807
4808
4809
4810
4811
4812
4813
4814
4815
4816
4817
4818
4819
4820
4821
4822
4823
4824
4825
4826
4827
4828
4829
4830
4831
4832
4833
4834
4835
4836
4837
4838
4839
4840
4841
4842
4843
4844
4845
4846
4847
4848
4849
4850
4851
4852
4853
12 .uno%3ASaveGraphic a3 Abre unha caixa de diálogo que permite gardar como ficheiro a imaxe de mapa de bits seleccionada. O formato de ficheiro predefinido é o formato interno da imaxe.
16 .uno%3ACustomAnimation 3b Abre a xanela Animación personalizada no panel de tarefas.
10 .uno%3APageSetup 5d Define a orientación da páxina, as marxes da páxina, o fondo e outras opcións de deseño.
17 SD_HID_SD_NAVIGATOR_TLB 73 Lista as diapositivas que se poden usar. Prema dúas veces nunha diapositiva para convertela en diapositiva activa.
10 .uno%3ANavigator 71 Abre o navegador, co cal é posíbel saltar rapidamente a outras diapositivas ou moverse entre ficheiros abertos.
20 SD_HID_SD_NAVIGATOR_TBI_DRAGTYPE 54 Arrastre e solte diapositivas e obxectos nomeados para dentro da diapositiva activa.
1c SD_HID_SD_NAVIGATOR_TBI_PREV 32 Retroceder unha das diapositivas da presentación.
1c SD_HID_SD_NAVIGATOR_TBI_LAST 2e Salta á última diapositiva da presentación.
24 SD_HID_SD_NAVIGATOR_TBI_SHAPE_FILTER f6 In the submenu you can choose to display a list of all shapes or only the named shapes. Use drag-and-drop in the list to reorder the shapes. When you set the focus to a slide and press the Tab key, the next shape in the defined order is selected.
16 SD_HID_SD_NAVIGATOR_LB 2f Lista ficheiros dispoñíbeis de $[officename].
1c SD_HID_SD_NAVIGATOR_TBI_NEXT 2e Pasa á seguinte diapositiva da presentación.
1b SD_HID_SD_NAVIGATOR_TBI_PEN 75 Transforma o apuntador do rato nun bolígrafo que pode usar para escribir nas diapositivas durante as presentacións.
1d SD_HID_SD_NAVIGATOR_TBI_FIRST 2f Salta á primeira diapositiva da presentación.
13 SD_HID_SD_NAVIGATOR 71 Abre o navegador, co cal é posíbel saltar rapidamente a outras diapositivas ou moverse entre ficheiros abertos.
2c sd%3AMetricField%3ADLG_COPY%3AMTR_FLD_MOVE_Y c3 Enter the vertical distance between the centers of the selected object and the duplicate object. Positive values shift the duplicate object down and negative values shift the duplicate object up.
2c sd%3AMetricField%3ADLG_COPY%3AMTR_FLD_MOVE_X d6 Enter the horizontal distance between the centers of the selected object and the duplicate object. Positive values shift the duplicate object to the right and negative values shift the duplicate object to the left.
2e sd%3AImageButton%3ADLG_COPY%3ABTN_SET_VIEWDATA a7 Enters the width and the height values of the selected object in the X axis and the Y axis boxes respectively as well as the fill color of the object in the Start box.
12 .uno%3ACopyObjects 2e Makes one or more copies of a selected object.
2c sd%3AMetricField%3ADLG_COPY%3AMTR_FLD_HEIGHT 5b Enter the amount by which you want to enlarge or reduce the height of the duplicate object.
2d sd%3ANumericField%3ADLG_COPY%3ANUM_FLD_COPIES 2c Enter the number of copies you want to make.
28 sd%3AListBox%3ADLG_COPY%3ALB_START_COLOR 27 Choose a color for the selected object.
26 sd%3AListBox%3ADLG_COPY%3ALB_END_COLOR 76 Choose a color for the duplicate object. If you are making more than one copy, this color is applied to the last copy.
2b sd%3AMetricField%3ADLG_COPY%3AMTR_FLD_ANGLE ce Enter the angle (0 to 359 degrees) by which you want to rotate the duplicate object. Positive values rotate the duplicate object in a clockwise direction and negative values in a counterclockwise direction.
2b sd%3AMetricField%3ADLG_COPY%3AMTR_FLD_WIDTH 5a Enter the amount by which you want to enlarge or reduce the width of the duplicate object.
11 .uno%3ADeletePage 28 Elimina a diapositiva ou páxina activa.
11 .uno%3ARenamePage 1f Renomea a páxina seleccionada.
12 .uno%3ADeleteLayer 16 Elimina a capa activa.
28 sd%3AMetricField%3ADLG_MORPH%3AMTF_STEPS 4a Especifique o número de formas desexadas entre os obxectos seleccionados.
2a sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_MORPH%3ACBX_ATTRIBUTES 60 Aplica unha transición gradual á liña e propiedades de enchemento dos obxectos seleccionados.
2b sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_MORPH%3ACBX_ORIENTATION 3e Aplica unha transición suave entre os obxectos seleccionados.
f .uno%3AMorphing 52 Crea formas e distribúeas en incrementos uniformes entre dous obxectos de debuxo.
2d sd%3AListBox%3ADLG_FIELD_MODIFY%3ALB_LANGUAGE 1d Seleccione o idioma do campo.
2d sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_FIELD_MODIFY%3ARBT_VAR 1f Mostra o valor actual do campo.
2d sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_FIELD_MODIFY%3ARBT_FIX 34 Mostra o contido que tiña o campo cando se inseriu.
12 .uno%3AModifyField 28 Edita as propiedades dun campo inserido.
23 sd%3AModalDialog%3ADLG_FIELD_MODIFY 28 Edita as propiedades dun campo inserido.
2b sd%3AListBox%3ADLG_FIELD_MODIFY%3ALB_FORMAT 34 Seleccione un formato de presentación para o campo.
10 .uno%3AShowRuler 58 Mostra ou oculta as regras colocadas no bordo superior e esquerdo do espazo de traballo.
1b .uno%3ACommonTaskBarVisible 2a Ordes usadas normalmente con diapositivas.
19 .uno%3ANormalMultiPaneGUI 62 Pasa ao modo normal de visualización, que permite ao usuario crear e editar diapositivas propias.
12 SD_HID_SD_BTN_DRAW 62 Pasa ao modo normal de visualización, que permite ao usuario crear e editar diapositivas propias.
f .uno%3APageMenu 34 Opens a submenu with commands for the current slide.
12 .uno%3ADrawingMode 62 Pasa ao modo normal de visualización, que permite ao usuario crear e editar diapositivas propias.
1b .uno%3ADisplayMasterObjects 46 When enabled, the current slide shows the objects of the slide master.
1e .uno%3ADisplayMasterBackground 51 When enabled, the current slide shows the background picture of the slide master.
17 .uno%3ASelectBackground bb Opens a file dialog to select a picture. The picture will be scaled and inserted on the background of the current slide master. Use Format - Slide/Page - Background to remove the picture.
12 .uno%3AOutlineMode 71 Activa a visualización do esquema, que permite reordenar as diapositivas e editar os seus títulos e cabeceiras.
15 SD_HID_SD_BTN_OUTLINE 71 Activa a visualización do esquema, que permite reordenar as diapositivas e editar os seus títulos e cabeceiras.
13 SD_HID_SD_BTN_SLIDE 2f Exhibe versións en miniatura das diapositivas.
e .uno%3ADiaMode 2f Exhibe versións en miniatura das diapositivas.
13 SD_HID_SD_BTN_NOTES 58 Activa a visualización da páxina de notas, que permite engadir notas ás diapositivas.
10 .uno%3ANotesMode 58 Activa a visualización da páxina de notas, que permite engadir notas ás diapositivas.
12 .uno%3AHandoutMode 63 Switches to the handout master page, where you can scale several slides to fit on one printed page.
15 SD_HID_SD_BTN_HANDOUT 63 Switches to the handout master page, where you can scale several slides to fit on one printed page.
13 .uno%3APresentation 27 Inicia a presentación de diapositivas.
1a SD_HID_SD_BTN_PRESENTATION 27 Inicia a presentación de diapositivas.
18 SD_HID_SD_BTN_MASTERPAGE 8e Activa unha das visualizacións principais, en que pode engadir os elementos que quere que aparezan en todas as diapositivas da presentación.
11 .uno%3AMasterPage 8e Activa unha das visualizacións principais, en que pode engadir os elementos que quere que aparezan en todas as diapositivas da presentación.
17 .uno%3ADeleteMasterPage 57 Select a slide master and click this icon to remove the slide master from the document.
17 .uno%3ARenameMasterPage 45 Select a slide master and click this icon to rename the slide master.
16 .uno%3ACloseMasterPage 31 Lista todas as páxinas principais dispoñíbeis.
16 .uno%3ASlideMasterPage b3 Activa a visualización da diapositiva principal, en que pode engadir os elementos que quere que aparezan en todas aquelas diapositivas que utilizan a mesma diapositiva principal.
17 .uno%3AInsertMasterPage 7d Inserts a new slide master into the document. Double-click the new slide master on the Slides pane to apply it to all slides.
16 .uno%3ANotesMasterPage 4d Mostra a nota principal, onde pode definir o formatado predefinido das notas.
14 .uno%3AMasterLayouts 4c Add header, footer, date, and slide number placeholders to the slide master.
32 sd%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SD_DLG_MASTER_LAYOUT%3ACB_DATE 31 Adds a date/time placeholder to the slide master.
34 sd%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SD_DLG_MASTER_LAYOUT%3ACB_HEADER 38 Adds a header placeholder to the slide master for notes.
34 sd%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SD_DLG_MASTER_LAYOUT%3ACB_FOOTER 2e Adds a footer placeholder to the slide master.
39 sd%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SD_DLG_MASTER_LAYOUT%3ACB_PAGE_NUMBER 34 Adds a slide number placeholder to the slide master.
3b sd%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SD_TABPAGE_HEADERFOOTER%3ACB_NOTONTITLE 54 Does not display your specified information on the first slide of your presentation.
3f sd%3AListBox%3ARID_SD_TABPAGE_HEADERFOOTER%3ACB_DATETIME_FORMAT 58 Mostra a data e a hora creados pola diapositiva. Seleccione un formato de data na lista.
16 .uno%3AHeaderAndFooter 5b Adds or changes text in placeholders at the top and the bottom of slides and slide masters.
39 sd%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SD_TABPAGE_HEADERFOOTER%3ACB_DATETIME 26 Engade a data e a hora á diapositiva.
3d sd%3APushButton%3ARID_SD_TABPAGE_HEADERFOOTER%3ABT_APPLYTOALL 67 Applies the settings to all the slides in your presentation, including the corresponding slide masters.
39 sd%3AEdit%3ARID_SD_TABPAGE_HEADERFOOTER%3ATB_HEADER_FIXED 3c Engade na parte superior da diapositiva o texto introducido.
37 sd%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SD_TABPAGE_HEADERFOOTER%3ACB_FOOTER 5d Engade na parte inferior da diapositiva o texto introducido na caixa Texto de pé de páxina.
41 sd%3AListBox%3ARID_SD_TABPAGE_HEADERFOOTER%3ACB_DATETIME_LANGUAGE 32 Seleccione o idioma para o formato de data e hora.
37 sd%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SD_TABPAGE_HEADERFOOTER%3ACB_HEADER 58 Engade na parte superior da diapositiva o texto introducido na caixa Texto da cabeceira.
3b sd%3AEdit%3ARID_SD_TABPAGE_HEADERFOOTER%3ATB_DATETIME_FIXED 36 Engade a data e a hora introducidas na caixa de texto.
38 sd%3APushButton%3ARID_SD_TABPAGE_HEADERFOOTER%3ABT_APPLY 3e Aplica a configuración actual ás diapositivas seleccionadas.
39 sd%3AEdit%3ARID_SD_TABPAGE_HEADERFOOTER%3ATB_FOOTER_FIXED 3c Engade na parte inferior da diapositiva o texto introducido.
42 sd%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SD_TABPAGE_HEADERFOOTER%3ARB_DATETIME_FIXED 36 Engade a data e a hora introducidas na caixa de texto.
46 sd%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SD_TABPAGE_HEADERFOOTER%3ARB_DATETIME_AUTOMATIC 58 Mostra a data e a hora creados pola diapositiva. Seleccione un formato de data na lista.
3c sd%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SD_TABPAGE_HEADERFOOTER%3ACB_SLIDENUMBER 2e Engade o número da diapositiva ou da páxina.
17 .uno%3AInsertPageNumber 2e Engade o número da diapositiva ou da páxina.
18 .uno%3AInsertDateAndTime 26 Engade a data e a hora á diapositiva.
1d .uno%3AOutputQualityGrayscale 38 Mostra as diapositivas en tonalidades de branco e negro.
1e .uno%3AOutputQualityBlackWhite 40 Mostra as diapositivas en branco e negro puros, sen tonalidades.
19 .uno%3AOutputQualityColor 1e Mostra as diapositivas en cor.
11 .uno%3AInsertPage 3c Insire unha páxina a continuación da páxina seleccionada.
2e sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_INSERT_LAYER%3ACBX_VISIBLE 1a Mostrar ou ocultar a capa.
12 .uno%3AInsertLayer 5f Insire unha nova capa no documento. Só é posíbel utilizar esta orde en Draw, non en Impress.
27 sd%3AEdit%3ADLG_INSERT_LAYER%3AEDT_NAME 23 Introduza un nome para a nova capa.
2d sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_INSERT_LAYER%3ACBX_LOCKED 28 Impide a edición dos elementos da capa.
30 sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_INSERT_LAYER%3ACBX_PRINTABLE 35 When printing, print or ignore this particular layer.
2f sd%3AImageRadioButton%3ADLG_SNAPLINE%3ARB_POINT 15 Inserts a snap point.
2b sd%3AMetricField%3ADLG_SNAPLINE%3AMTR_FLD_X 67 Insira a cantidade de espazo que desexa entre o punto ou liña de axuste e o bordo esquerdo da páxina.
34 sd%3AImageRadioButton%3ADLG_SNAPLINE%3ARB_HORIZONTAL 27 Insire unha liña de axuste horizontal.
32 sd%3AImageRadioButton%3ADLG_SNAPLINE%3ARB_VERTICAL 25 Insire unha liña de axuste vertical.
13 .uno%3ACapturePoint 74 Insire un punto ou unha liña de axuste (tamén chamada "guía") coa cal se poden aliñar obxectos de xeito rápido.
2b sd%3AMetricField%3ADLG_SNAPLINE%3AMTR_FLD_Y 6a Introduza a cantidade de espazo que desexa entre o punto ou liña de axuste e o bordo superior da páxina.
11 .uno%3AInsertRows 95 Inserts a new row above the active cell. The number of rows inserted correspond to the number of rows selected. The existing rows are moved downward.
2b sd%3APushButton%3ADLG_SNAPLINE%3ABTN_DELETE 30 Elimina o punto ou liña de axuste seleccionada.
12 .uno%3ASetSnapItem 70 Define a posición do punto ou liña de axuste seleccionados en relación ao canto superior esquerdo da páxina.
15 .uno%3ADeleteSnapItem 30 Elimina o punto ou liña de axuste seleccionada.
14 .uno%3AInsertColumns ae Inserts a new column to the left of the active cell. The number of columns inserted correspond to the number of columns selected. The existing columns are moved to the right.
18 .uno%3AInsertSpreadsheet 33 Inserts a new table into the current slide or page.
12 .uno%3AInsertTable 33 Inserts a new table into the current slide or page.
15 .uno%3AImportFromFile 9c Insire un ficheiro na diapositiva activa. Pódense inserir ficheiros de $[officename] Draw ou Impress, ou texto dun documento HTML ou dun ficheiro de texto.
39 sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_INSERT_PAGES_OBJS%3ACBX_CHECK_MASTERS 37 As páxinas principais non usadas non se poden inserir.
30 sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_INSERT_PAGES_OBJS%3ACBX_LINK 6e Inserts a file or some file elements as a link that is automatically updated when the source file is modified.
14 .uno%3ADuplicatePage 3b Insire unha copia da diapositiva activa xusto despois dela.
11 .uno%3AExpandPage f7 Crea unha dispositiva nova a partir de cada punto de esquema de nivel superior (o texto que está un nivel por debaixo do título na xerarquía do esquema) na diapositiva seleccionada. O texto do esquema convértese en título da nova diapositiva.
12 .uno%3ASummaryPage b7 Crea unha nova diapositiva cunha lista con viñetas dos títulos das diapositivas que veñen despois da seleccionada. A diapositiva de resumo insírese despois da última diapositiva.
19 .uno%3AInsertDateFieldFix 56 Insire a data actual na diapositiva como campo fixo. Non se actualiza automaticamente.
19 .uno%3AInsertDateFieldVar 6e Insire a data actual na diapositiva como campo variábel. Actualízase automaticamente ao recargar o ficheiro.
19 .uno%3AInsertTimeFieldFix 56 Insire a hora actual na diapositiva como campo fixo. Non se actualiza automaticamente.
19 .uno%3AInsertTimeFieldVar 6e Insire a hora actual na diapositiva como campo variábel. Actualízase automaticamente ao recargar o ficheiro.
16 .uno%3AInsertPageField 40 Insire o número de páxina na diapositiva ou na páxina actual.
18 .uno%3AInsertAuthorField 5d Insire na diapositiva activa o nome e apelido listados nos datos de usuario de $[officename].
16 .uno%3AInsertFileField 4d Insire o nome no ficheiro activo. O nome só se mostra ao gardar o documento.
12 .uno%3ATableDialog 6a Specifies the properties of the selected table, for example, fonts, font effects, borders, and background.
15 SFX2_HID_TEMPLATE_FMT 27 Cree, edite, aplice e xestione estilos.
1a SFX2_HID_TEMPLDLG_WATERCAN e0 Aplica o estilo seleccionado a un obxecto da diapositiva. Prema na icona de lata de pintura e, a seguir, nun obxecto da diapositiva para aplicar o estilo. Prema novamente na icona de lata de pintura para abandonar este modo.
21 SFX2_HID_TEMPLDLG_UPDATEBYEXAMPLE 84 Actualiza o estilo seleccionado na xanela Estilos e formatado co mesmo formatado que ten o obxecto seleccionado no momento presente.
10 .uno%3AListStyle 35 Show styles used in %PRODUCTNAME Impress AutoLayouts.
10 .uno%3AParaStyle 46 Show styles for formatting graphical elements, including text objects.
1e SFX2_HID_TEMPLDLG_NEWBYEXAMPLE 4c Crea un novo estilo usando os atributos de formato dun obxecto seleccionado.
11 .uno%3ADeleteRows 2b Deletes the selected row(s) from the table.
2e sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_PRESLT%3ACBX_CHECK_MASTERS 4d Elimina do documento as diapositivas de fondo e os deseños de presentación.
19 .uno%3APresentationLayout e1 Mostra a caixa de diálogo Estilo de diapositiva, onde é posíbel seleccionar un esquema de deseño para a diapositiva actual. Todos os obxectos do estilo da diapositiva insírense detrás dos obxectos da diapositiva actual.
2c sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_PRESLT%3ACBX_MASTER_PAGE 5a Aplica o fondo do estilo de diapositiva seleccionado a todas as diapositivas do documento.
27 sd%3APushButton%3ADLG_PRESLT%3ABTN_LOAD 55 Displays the Load Slide Design dialog, where you can select additional slide designs.
2d sfx2%3AMultiLineEdit%3ADLG_NEW_FILE%3AED_DESC 1e Resumo do modelo seleccionado.
2a sfx2%3AMoreButton%3ADLG_NEW_FILE%3ABT_MORE 4e Mostra ou oculta a previsualización e as propiedades dun modelo seleccionado.
2b sfx2%3AListBox%3ADLG_NEW_FILE%3ALB_TEMPLATE 3b Mostra os modelos para a categoría de estilo seleccionada.
25 sfx2%3AEdit%3ADLG_NEW_FILE%3AED_THEMA 41 Mostra o asunto do modelo. Algúns modelos agrúpanse por asunto.
2c sfx2%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_NEW_FILE%3ABTN_PREVIEW 25 Activa a previsualización do modelo.
28 sfx2%3AEdit%3ADLG_NEW_FILE%3AED_KEYWORDS 26 Mostra as palabras chave para a busca.
29 sfx2%3AListBox%3ADLG_NEW_FILE%3ALB_REGION 3d Mostra as categorías dispoñíbeis de estilo de diapositiva.
25 sfx2%3AEdit%3ADLG_NEW_FILE%3AED_TITLE 1b Mostra o título do modelo.
14 .uno%3ADeleteColumns 2e Deletes the selected column(s) from the table.
11 .uno%3AModifyPage 3c Abre o panel de deseños de diapositivas no panel de tarefas
12 .uno%3ARenameLayer 16 Renomea a capa activa.
12 .uno%3AModifyLayer 2d Modifica as propiedades da capa seleccionada.
36 cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_MEASURE%3ATSB_AUTOPOSH 44 Determina a posición horizontal óptima para o texto de dimensión.
3f cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_MEASURE%3AMTR_FLD_HELPLINE_DIST ba Especifica a lonxitude da guía esquerda e dereita, a partir da liña de dimensión. Os valores positivos estenden as guías por enriba da liña de dimensión e os negativos por debaixo.
36 cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_MEASURE%3ATSB_AUTOPOSV 42 Determina a posición vertical óptima para o texto de dimensión.
3f cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_MEASURE%3AMTR_FLD_HELPLINE2_LEN ac Especifica a lonxitude da guía dereita a partir da liña de dimensión. Os valores positivos estenden a guía por debaixo da liña de dimensión e os negativos por enriba.
43 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_MEASURE%3AMTR_FLD_HELPLINE_OVERHANG c7 Especifica a lonxitude da guía esquerda e dereita a partir da liña base (distancia entre liñas = 0). Os valores positivos estenden as guías por enriba da liña de base e os negativos por debaixo.
37 cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_MEASURE%3ATSB_SHOW_UNIT 72 Mostra ou oculta as unidades de medida de dimensión. Tamén pode seleccionar unha unidade da lista para mostrala.
18 .uno%3AMeasureAttributes 5d Modifica a lonxitude, a medida e as propiedades de guía da liña de dimensión seleccionada.
2d cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_MEASURE%3ALB_UNIT 72 Mostra ou oculta as unidades de medida de dimensión. Tamén pode seleccionar unha unidade da lista para mostrala.
37 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_MEASURE%3AMTR_LINE_DIST 5f Especifica a distancia entre a liña de dimensión e a liña base (distancia entre liñas = 0).
3f cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_MEASURE%3AMTR_FLD_DECIMALPLACES 57 Especifica o número de decimais usados para a visualización das propiedades de liña.
36 cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_MEASURE%3ATSB_PARALLEL 53 Mostra o texto paralelo ou cun ángulo de 90 graos respecto á liña de dimensión.
1c CUI_HID_MEASURE_CTL_POSITION 5e Determina a posición do texto de dimensión en relación á liña de dimensión e ás guías.
3f cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_MEASURE%3AMTR_FLD_HELPLINE1_LEN b5 Especifica a lonxitude da guía esquerda a partir da liña de dimensión. Os valores positivos estenden a guía por debaixo da liña de dimensión e os valores negativos por enriba.
3c cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_MEASURE%3ATSB_BELOW_REF_EDGE 30 Reverte as propiedades definidas na área Liña.
11 .uno%3ANewRouting 3c Restabelece os valores predefinidos de oblicuidade de liña.
1a .uno%3AConnectorAttributes 25 Define as propiedades dos conectores.
3b cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CONNECTION%3AMTR_FLD_LINE_3 31 Introduza un valor de oblicuidade para a liña 3.
3b cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CONNECTION%3AMTR_FLD_LINE_2 31 Introduza un valor de oblicuidade para a liña 2.
3b cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CONNECTION%3AMTR_FLD_LINE_1 31 Introduza un valor de oblicuidade para a liña 1.
30 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CONNECTION%3ALB_TYPE 2b Lista os tipos de conectores dispoñíbeis.
3b cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CONNECTION%3AMTR_FLD_VERT_2 4f Introduza a cantidade de espazo vertical que quere que haxa na fin do conector.
3b cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CONNECTION%3AMTR_FLD_HORZ_2 51 Introduza a cantidade de espazo horizontal que quere que haxa na fin do conector.
3b cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CONNECTION%3AMTR_FLD_VERT_1 52 Introduza a cantidade de espazo vertical que quere que haxa no inicio do conector.
3b cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CONNECTION%3AMTR_FLD_HORZ_1 54 Introduza a cantidade de espazo horizontal que quere que haxa no inicio do conector.
13 .uno%3ABeforeObject 9d Altera a orde de amontoamento ao mover o obxecto seleccionado diante do obxecto especificado. Non cambia a localización na pantalla do obxecto seleccionado.
13 .uno%3ABehindObject a4 Modifica a orde de amontoamento ao mover o obxecto seleccionado detrás doutro obxecto especificado. Non cambia a localización do obxecto seleccionado na pantalla.
13 .uno%3AReverseOrder 3a Inverte a orde de amontoamento dos obxectos seleccionados.
12 .uno%3AHyphenation 46 Activa ou desactiva a opción de guionización para obxectos de texto.
2b SD_HID_SD_SLIDETRANSITIONPANE_PB_SLIDE_SHOW 46 Inicia a presentación de diapositivas a partir da diapositiva actual.
32 SD_HID_SD_SLIDETRANSITIONPANE_LB_SLIDE_TRANSITIONS 51 Seleccione un efecto de transición para aplicalo ás diapositivas seleccionadas.
25 SD_HID_SD_SLIDETRANSITIONPANE_PB_PLAY 48 Mostra a transición de diapositivas actual como unha previsualización.
2b SD_HID_SD_SLIDETRANSITIONPANE_CB_LOOP_SOUND 55 Seleccione esta opción para reproducir o son repetidamente ata o comezo do seguinte.
2d SD_HID_SD_SLIDETRANSITIONPANE_PB_APPLY_TO_ALL 6f Aplica a transición de diapositivas seleccionada a todas as diapositivas do documento de presentación actual.
33 SD_HID_SD_SLIDETRANSITIONPANE_MF_ADVANCE_AUTO_AFTER 9a Select to advance to the next slide after a number of seconds. Enter the seconds in the numerical field next to the spin button, or click the spin button.
a .uno%3ADia 5e Define o efecto especial que se reproduce ao mostrar unha diapositiva durante a presentación.
26 SD_HID_SD_SLIDETRANSITIONPANE_LB_SPEED 33 Define a velocidade da transición de diapositivas.
2d SD_HID_SD_SLIDETRANSITIONPANE_CB_AUTO_PREVIEW 63 Seleccione esta opción para ver as transicións de diapositivas de forma automática no documento.
f .uno%3ADiaSpeed 33 Define a velocidade da transición de diapositivas.
18 .uno%3ASlideChangeWindow 5e Define o efecto especial que se reproduce ao mostrar unha diapositiva durante a presentación.
2d SD_HID_SD_SLIDETRANSITIONPANE_RB_ADVANCE_AUTO 9a Select to advance to the next slide after a number of seconds. Enter the seconds in the numerical field next to the spin button, or click the spin button.
26 SD_HID_SD_SLIDETRANSITIONPANE_LB_SOUND 4b Lista os sons que poden reproducirse durante a transición de diapositivas.
31 SD_HID_SD_SLIDETRANSITIONPANE_RB_ADVANCE_ON_MOUSE 51 Seleccione esta opción para avanzar ata a seguinte diapositiva premendo no rato.
30 sd%3ARadioButton%3AFLT_WIN_ANIMATION%3ARBT_GROUP 9e Reúne imaxes nun único obxecto para poder movelas todas xuntas. Tamén é posíbel editar obxectos individuais premendo dúas veces no grupo da diapositiva.
32 sd%3AImageButton%3AFLT_WIN_ANIMATION%3ABTN_REVERSE 1e Plays the animation backwards.
35 sd%3AImageButton%3AFLT_WIN_ANIMATION%3ABTN_REMOVE_ALL 26 Elimina todas as imaxes da animación.
17 .uno%3AAnimationObjects 37 Crea unha animación predefinida na diapositiva actual.
38 sd%3AImageButton%3AFLT_WIN_ANIMATION%3ABTN_REMOVE_BITMAP 32 Elimina a imaxe actual da secuencia de animación.
2f sd%3AImageButton%3AFLT_WIN_ANIMATION%3ABTN_PLAY 17 Reproduce a animación.
39 sd%3AImageButton%3AFLT_WIN_ANIMATION%3ABTN_GET_ONE_OBJECT 39 Engade o(s) obxecto(s) seleccionado(s) como imaxe única.
36 sd%3APushButton%3AFLT_WIN_ANIMATION%3ABTN_CREATE_GROUP 23 Insire a animación na diapositiva.
2f sd%3AImageButton%3AFLT_WIN_ANIMATION%3ABTN_STOP 28 Interrompe a reprodución da animación.
30 sd%3AListBox%3AFLT_WIN_ANIMATION%3ALB_ADJUSTMENT 24 Aliña as imaxes da súa animación.
36 sd%3ANumericField%3AFLT_WIN_ANIMATION%3ANUM_FLD_BITMAP 37 Indica a posición da imaxe na secuencia de animación.
31 sd%3ARadioButton%3AFLT_WIN_ANIMATION%3ARBT_BITMAP 22 Combina imaxes nunha única imaxe.
30 sd%3AListBox%3AFLT_WIN_ANIMATION%3ALB_LOOP_COUNT 39 Define o número de veces que se executará a animación.
30 sd%3AImageButton%3AFLT_WIN_ANIMATION%3ABTN_FIRST 33 Salta á primeira imaxe na secuencia de animación.
3a sd%3AImageButton%3AFLT_WIN_ANIMATION%3ABTN_GET_ALL_OBJECTS 31 Engade unha imaxe para cada obxecto seleccionado.
2f sd%3ATimeField%3AFLT_WIN_ANIMATION%3ATIME_FIELD ba Introduza o número de segundos que vai durar a visualización da imaxe. A opción só estará dispoñíbel se seleccionou a opción Obxecto de mapa de bits no campo Grupo de animación.
2f sd%3AImageButton%3AFLT_WIN_ANIMATION%3ABTN_LAST 32 Salta á última imaxe da secuencia de animación.
2a SD_HID_SD_CUSTOMANIMATIONPANE_PB_MOVE_DOWN 6d Prema nun dos botóns para mover na lista o efecto de animación seleccionado cara a abaixo ou cara a arriba.
28 SD_HID_SD_CUSTOMANIMATIONPANE_PB_MOVE_UP 6d Prema nun dos botóns para mover na lista o efecto de animación seleccionado cara a abaixo ou cara a arriba.
2c SD_HID_SD_CUSTOMANIMATIONPANE_CB_AUTOPREVIEW 63 Seleccione esta opción para previsualizar efectos novos ou editados na diapositiva ao atribuílos.
2b SD_HID_SD_CUSTOMANIMATIONPANE_PB_SLIDE_SHOW 46 Inicia a presentación de diapositivas a partir da diapositiva actual.
13 .uno%3AEffectWindow 2c Atribúe efectos aos obxectos seleccionados.
16 .uno%3ACustomAnimation 2c Atribúe efectos aos obxectos seleccionados.
2e SD_HID_SD_CUSTOMANIMATIONPANE_PB_REMOVE_EFFECT 46 Elimina os efectos de animación seleccionados da lista de animación.
2b SD_HID_SD_CUSTOMANIMATIONPANE_PB_ADD_EFFECT 81 Abre a caixa de diálogo Animación personalizada para engadir outro efecto de animación ao obxecto seleccionado na diapositiva.
2e SD_HID_SD_CUSTOMANIMATIONPANE_PB_CHANGE_EFFECT 87 Abre a caixa de diálogo Animación personalizada para modificar o efecto de animación da entrada seleccionada na lista de animación.
25 SD_HID_SD_CUSTOMANIMATIONPANE_PB_PLAY 43 Reproduce o efecto de animación seleccionado na previsualización.
26 SD_HID_SD_CUSTOMANIMATIONPANE_CB_SPEED 4c Especifica a velocidade ou a duración do efecto de animación seleccionado.
26 SD_HID_SD_CUSTOMANIMATIONPANE_LB_START 43 Mostra a propiedade de inicio do efecto de animación seleccionado.
29 SD_HID_SD_CUSTOMANIMATIONPANE_LB_PROPERTY ab Selecciona as propiedades adicionais da animación. Prema no botón ... para abrir a caixa de diálogo Opcións de efecto, que permite seleccionar propiedades e aplicalas.
27 sd%3AEdit%3ATP_ANIMATION%3AEDT_BOOKMARK 3e Introduza o nome da diapositiva ou obxecto que quere procurar.
17 .uno%3AAnimationEffects 65 Define o comportamento do obxecto seleccionado ao premer nel durante a presentación de diapositivas.
27 sd%3AListBox%3ATP_ANIMATION%3ALB_ACTION 70 Especifica a acción que se activará ao premer no obxecto seleccionado durante a presentación de diapositivas.
29 sd%3APushButton%3ATP_ANIMATION%3ABTN_SEEK 2e Busca a diapositiva ou o obxecto especificado.
17 SD_HID_CTL_ACTION_DLG_1 3a Lista as diapositivas e os obxectos que poden ser destino.
27 sd%3AEdit%3ATP_ANIMATION%3AEDT_DOCUMENT 65 Introduza un camiño para o ficheiro que quere abrir, ou prema en Explorar para localizar o ficheiro.
26 sd%3AEdit%3ATP_ANIMATION%3AEDT_PROGRAM 5d Introduza un camiño para o programa que desexa iniciar ou prema en Explorar para localizalo.
17 SD_HID_CTL_ACTION_DLG_2 b7 Abre e mostra un ficheiro durante a presentación de diapositivas. Se selecciona un ficheiro $[officename] como documento de destino, pode especificar tamén a páxina que se abrirá.
24 sd%3AEdit%3ATP_ANIMATION%3AEDT_MACRO 5b Introduza un camiño para a macro que desexa executar ou prema en Explorar para localizala.
24 sd%3AEdit%3ATP_ANIMATION%3AEDT_SOUND 5e Introduza un camiño ao ficheiro de son que quere abrir, ou prema en Explorar para localizalo.
2b sd%3APushButton%3ATP_ANIMATION%3ABTN_SEARCH 24 Localice o ficheiro que quere abrir.
35 sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_START_PRESENTATION%3ACBX_AUTOLOGO 3b Mostra o logotipo de $[officename] na diapositiva de pausa.
39 sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_START_PRESENTATION%3ACBX_MOUSEPOINTER 43 Mostra o apuntador do rato durante a presentación de diapositivas.
34 sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_START_PRESENTATION%3ARBT_AUTO ce Reinicia a presentación de diapositivas despois do intervalo de pausa especificado. Móstrase unha diapositiva de pausa entre a diapositiva final e a inicial. Prema na tecla Esc para deter a presentación.
35 sd%3AListBox%3ADLG_START_PRESENTATION%3ALB_CUSTOMSHOW 8b Executa unha presentación de diapositivas na orde definida en Presentación de diapositivas - Presentación personalizada de diapositivas.
3e sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_START_PRESENTATION%3ACBX_ANIMATION_ALLOWED 4a Mostra todos os marcos dos ficheiros GIF animados durante a presentación.
3a sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_START_PRESENTATION%3ACBX_ALWAYS_ON_TOP 84 A xanela $[officename] mantense na parte superior durante a presentación. É a única xanela que se mostra diante da presentación.
36 sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_START_PRESENTATION%3ARBT_AT_DIA 2b Introduza o número da diapositiva inicial.
33 sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_START_PRESENTATION%3ACBX_MANUEL 49 Ao seleccionar esta caixa, as diapositivas nunca cambian automaticamente.
33 sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_START_PRESENTATION%3ARBT_ALL 2f Inclúe todas as diapositivas da presentación.
2f sd%3AListBox%3ADLG_START_PRESENTATION%3ALB_DIAS 2b Introduza o número da diapositiva inicial.
1b SD_HID_SD_SLIDESHOW_DISPLAY 68 Seleccione o monitor que se vai utilizar para o modo presentación de diapositivas en pantalla completa.
38 sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_START_PRESENTATION%3ACBX_CHANGE_PAGE 3e Avanza á seguinte diapositiva ao premer no fondo dunha delas.
30 sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_START_PRESENTATION%3ACBX_PEN 6f Transforma o apuntador do rato nun lapis que pode usarse para debuxar nas diapositivas durante a presentación.
38 sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_START_PRESENTATION%3ARBT_STANDARD 37 Aparece unha diapositiva que ocupa a pantalla completa.
3a sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_START_PRESENTATION%3ARBT_CUSTOMSHOW 8b Executa unha presentación de diapositivas na orde definida en Presentación de diapositivas - Presentación personalizada de diapositivas.
33 sd%3ATimeField%3ADLG_START_PRESENTATION%3ATMF_PAUSE b9 Introduza a duración da pausa antes de repetir a presentación de diapositivas. Se introduce cero, a presentación reiníciase inmediatamente sen mostrar ningunha diapositiva de pausa.
36 sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_START_PRESENTATION%3ACBX_NAVIGATOR 3b Mostra o Navegador durante a presentación de diapositivas.
36 sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_START_PRESENTATION%3ARBT_WINDOW 4f A presentación de diapositivas execútase na xanela do programa $[officename].
19 .uno%3APresentationDialog a1 Define a configuración para a presentación de diapositivas, incluído a diapositiva inicial, a maneira de avanzar das diapositivas, e as opcións do apuntador.
30 sd%3APushButton%3ADLG_CUSTOMSHOW%3ABTN_STARTSHOW 6c Runs the slide show. Ensure that Use Custom Slide Show is selected if you want to run a custom presentation.
2e sd%3AListBox%3ADLG_CUSTOMSHOW%3ALB_CUSTOMSHOWS 30 Lists the custom slide shows that are available.
17 .uno%3ACustomShowDialog bd Defines a custom slide show using slides within the current presentation. You can then pick slides to meet the needs of your audience. You can create as many custom slide shows as you want.
33 sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_CUSTOMSHOW%3ACBX_USE_CUSTOMSHOW 6a Runs the custom slide show you selected when you click Start. Otherwise, the entire presentation is shown.
2b sd%3APushButton%3ADLG_CUSTOMSHOW%3ABTN_EDIT 5b Add, remove or reorder slides as well as change the name of the selected custom slide show.
2b sd%3APushButton%3ADLG_CUSTOMSHOW%3ABTN_COPY 67 Creates a copy of the selected custom slide show. You can modify the name of the show by clicking Edit.
2a sd%3APushButton%3ADLG_CUSTOMSHOW%3ABTN_NEW 5b Add, remove or reorder slides as well as change the name of the selected custom slide show.
2c sd%3AEdit%3ADLG_DEFINE_CUSTOMSHOW%3AEDT_NAME 59 Mostra o nome da presentación personalizada . Se o desexa, pode introducir un nome novo.
34 sd%3APushButton%3ADLG_DEFINE_CUSTOMSHOW%3ABTN_REMOVE a1 Elimina unha diapositiva da lista Diapositivas seleccionadas. Para utilizar este botón, ten que escoller unha diapositiva na lista de Diapositvas seleccionadas.
20 SD_HID_DLG_DEFINE_CUSTOMSHOW_CTL a5 Lista todas as diapositivas nas presentacións personalizadas. Se o desexa, pode alterar a orde da lista, arrastrando as diapositivas cara a arriba ou cara a abaixo.
34 sd%3AMultiListBox%3ADLG_DEFINE_CUSTOMSHOW%3ALB_PAGES 48 Lista todas as diapositivas na orde en que aparecen no documento actual.
31 sd%3APushButton%3ADLG_DEFINE_CUSTOMSHOW%3ABTN_ADD b0 Engade unha diapositiva á parte inferior das Diapositivas seleccionadas. Para utilizar este botón, primeiro é necesario escoller unha diapositiva en Diapositivas existentes.
13 .uno%3AChangeBezier 37 Converte o obxecto seleccionado nunha curva de Bézier.
2f sd%3AMetricField%3ADLG_VECTORIZE%3AMT_FILLHOLES 45 Introduza o tamaño do rectángulo que se usará para encher o fondo.
2c sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_VECTORIZE%3ACB_FILLHOLES 45 Enche os espazos de cor que aparecen ao aplicar a redución de punto.
2d sd%3ANumericField%3ADLG_VECTORIZE%3ANM_LAYERS 8b Introduza o número de cores que se mostrará na imaxe convertida. $[officename] xera un polígono para cada ocorrencia dunha cor na imaxe.
2c sd%3AMetricField%3ADLG_VECTORIZE%3AMT_REDUCE 4e Elimina os polígonos de cor máis pequenos que o valor de píxel introducido.
14 .uno%3AChangePolygon 55 Converte o obxecto seleccionado nun polígono (un obxecto pechado por liñas rectas).
2d sd%3APushButton%3ADLG_VECTORIZE%3ABTN_PREVIEW 3e Previsualiza a imaxe convertida sen aplicar as modificacións.
14 .uno%3AConvertInto3D 40 Converte o obxecto seleccionado nun obxecto tridimensional (3D).
1d .uno%3AConvertInto3DLatheFast 5c Crea unha forma tridimensional xirando o obxecto seleccionado en torno do seu eixo vertical.
18 .uno%3AConvertIntoBitmap 64 Converte o obxecto seleccionado nun mapa de bits (unha grade de píxeles que representa unha imaxe).
1a .uno%3AConvertIntoMetaFile 88 Converte o obxecto seleccionado en Windows Metafile Format (WMF), que contén os datos gráficos tanto de mapa de bits como de vectores.
19 .uno%3Aconvert_to_contour 48 Converte o obxecto seleccionado nun polígono ou un grupo de polígonos.
e .uno%3ACombine 40 Combina dous ou máis obxectos seleccionados nunha única forma.
10 .uno%3ADismantle 34 Divide un obxecto combinado en obxectos individuais.
e .uno%3AConnect 5d Crea unha liña ou unha curva de Bézier que conecta liñas, curvas de Bézier e/ou obxectos.
c .uno%3ABreak 27 Separa liñas unidas coa orde Conectar.
c .uno%3AMerge 99 Engade a área dos obxectos seleccionados á área do obxecto situado máis abaixo na selección. Esta orde é máis apropiada para obxectos sobrepostos.
10 .uno%3ASubstract 54 Subtrae a área dos obxectos seleccionados da área do obxecto situado máis abaixo.
10 .uno%3AIntersect 44 Crea unha forma a partir da área en que os obxectos se sobrepoñen.
35 SD_LISTBOX_RID_TP_CUSTOMANIMATION_ENTRANCE_LB_EFFECTS 36 Seleccione un efecto e prema en Aceptar para aplicalo.
3a sd%3AComboBox%3ARID_TP_CUSTOMANIMATION_ENTRANCE%3ACB_SPEED 4c Especifica a velocidade ou a duración do efecto de animación seleccionado.
3d sd%3ACheckBox%3ARID_TP_CUSTOMANIMATION_ENTRANCE%3ACBX_PREVIEW 54 Seleccione esta opción para previsualizar na diapositiva efectos novos ou editados.
2e SD_HID_SD_CUSTOMANIMATIONPANE_PB_PROPERTY_MORE 5f Especifica propiedades adicionais do elemento seleccionado no panel Animacións personalizadas.
42 sd%3APushButton%3ARID_TP_CUSTOMANIMATION_EFFECT%3APB_SOUND_PREVIEW 29 Reproduce o ficheiro de son seleccionado.
40 sd%3AMetricField%3ARID_TP_CUSTOMANIMATION_EFFECT%3AMF_TEXT_DELAY 49 Especifica a porcentaxe de atraso entre animacións de palabras e letras.
3b sd%3AListBox%3ARID_TP_CUSTOMANIMATION_EFFECT%3ACLB_DIMCOLOR 20 Seleccione a cor de atenuación.
3e sd%3AListBox%3ARID_TP_CUSTOMANIMATION_EFFECT%3ALB_AFTER_EFFECT 71 Seleccione unha cor para mostrarse despois de terminar a animación ou seleccione outro efecto posterior na lista
3b sd%3AListBox%3ARID_TP_CUSTOMANIMATION_EFFECT%3ALB_TEXT_ANIM 35 Seleccione o modo de animación para o texto da forma
37 sd%3AListBox%3ARID_TP_CUSTOMANIMATION_EFFECT%3ALB_SOUND 45 Seleccione un son da galería ou escolla unha das entradas especiais.
3d sd%3ACheckBox%3ARID_TP_CUSTOMANIMATION_EFFECT%3ACB_SMOOTH_END 53 Enable this option to assign a gradually decreasing speed to the end of the effect.
3f sd%3ACheckBox%3ARID_TP_CUSTOMANIMATION_EFFECT%3ACB_SMOOTH_START 55 Enable this option to assign a gradually increasing speed to the start of the effect.
2f SD_HID_SD_CUSTOMANIMATIONPANE_PRESETPROPERTYBOX 22 Especifica a dirección do efecto.
39 sd%3ACheckbox%3ARID_TP_CUSTOMANIMATION_TEXT%3ACBX_REVERSE 25 Anima os parágrafos en orde inversa.
3e sd%3ACheckbox%3ARID_TP_CUSTOMANIMATION_TEXT%3ACBX_ANIMATE_FORM 40 Desmarque esta caixa para animar soamente o texto e non a forma.
3c sd%3ACheckbox%3ARID_TP_CUSTOMANIMATION_TEXT%3ACBX_GROUP_AUTO 80 Se a opción "Agrupar texto - Polos parágrafos de 1º nivel" está seleccionada, os parágrafos animaranse un despois do outro.
3e sd%3AMetricField%3ARID_TP_CUSTOMANIMATION_TEXT%3AMF_GROUP_AUTO 4f Introduza un atraso adicional en segundos para animar os parágrafos seguintes.
3a sd%3AListBox%3ARID_TP_CUSTOMANIMATION_TEXT%3ALB_GROUP_TEXT 2c Especifica como se animan varios parágrafos
3b sd%3AComboBox%3ARID_TP_CUSTOMANIMATION_DURATION%3ACB_REPEAT 37 Specifies whether and how to repeat the current effect.
3b sd%3AListBox%3ARID_TP_CUSTOMANIMATION_DURATION%3ALB_TRIGGER 33 Seleccione a forma polo seu nome na caixa de lista.
43 sd%3ARadioButton%3ARID_TP_CUSTOMANIMATION_DURATION%3ARB_INTERACTIVE 48 Especifica se animación pode comezar ao premer nunha forma específica.
45 sd%3ARadioButton%3ARID_TP_CUSTOMANIMATION_DURATION%3ARB_CLICKSEQUENCE 47 Especifica se a animación pode comezar coa secuencia normal de premas.
3c sd%3ACheckBox%3ARID_TP_CUSTOMANIMATION_DURATION%3ACBX_REWIND 61 Especifica se a forma animada debe ou non retornar ao seu estado inicial ao rematar a animación.
39 sd%3AListBox%3ARID_TP_CUSTOMANIMATION_DURATION%3ALB_START 36 Mostra a propiedade de inicio do efecto de animación.
43 sd%3AMetricField%3ARID_TP_CUSTOMANIMATION_DURATION%3AMF_START_DELAY 44 Especifica un atraso adicional de n segundos ata o inicio do efecto.
3d sd%3AComboBox%3ARID_TP_CUSTOMANIMATION_DURATION%3ACB_DURATION 21 Especifica a duración do efecto.
16 .uno%3ALeftPaneImpress 2b Activa e desactiva o panel de diapositivas.
13 .uno%3ALeftPaneDraw 2b Activa e desactiva o panel de diapositivas.
1f SD_HID_SD_TASK_PANE_PREVIEW_ALL 82 Prema co botón esquerdo para aplicar a páxina principal a todas as diapositivas. Prema co botón dereito para abrir un submenú.
23 SD_HID_SD_TASK_PANE_PREVIEW_CURRENT 82 Prema co botón esquerdo para aplicar a páxina principal a todas as diapositivas. Prema co botón dereito para abrir un submenú.
23 SD_HID_SD_TASK_PANE_PREVIEW_LAYOUTS 8a Prema para aplicar un estilo de diapositiva a todas as diapositivas seleccionadas. Prema co botón dereito do rato para abrir un submenú.
14 SC_HID_SC_DPLAY_DATA b9 Abre o separador Páxinas principais, onde pode aplicar unha páxina principal (fondo) a todas as diapositivas (prema co botón esquerdo) ou ás diapositivas seleccionadas (co dereito).
16 SD_HID_SD_TABLE_DESIGN 45 Opens the Table Design. Double-click a preview to insert a new table.
1f .uno%3ATaskPaneShowLargePreview 31 Lista as páxinas principais usadas recentemente.
24 .uno%3ATaskPaneApplyToSelectedSlides 55 Aplica a páxina principal ou o estilo de diapositiva ás diapositivas seleccionadas.
10 .uno%3ARightPane 3e Activa e desactiva o panel de tarefas de %PRODUCTNAME Impress.
19 SD_HID_SD_CURRENT_MASTERS 3c Lista as páxinas principais que están a usarse no momento.
1b SD_HID_SD_SLIDE_TRANSITIONS 78 Abre o separador Transición de diapositivas, que permite aplicar efectos de transición ás diapositivas seleccionadas.
22 SD_HID_SD_TASK_PANE_PREVIEW_RECENT 82 Prema co botón esquerdo para aplicar a páxina principal a todas as diapositivas. Prema co botón dereito para abrir un submenú.
12 .uno%3ATableDesign 45 Opens the Table Design. Double-click a preview to insert a new table.
1f .uno%3ATaskPaneShowSmallPreview 31 Lista as páxinas principais usadas recentemente.
1b SD_HID_SD_CUSTOM_ANIMATIONS 6c Abre o separadorAnimación personalizada, onde se aplican efectos aos obxectos seleccionados na diapositiva.
18 SD_HID_SD_RECENT_MASTERS 31 Lista as páxinas principais usadas recentemente.
1f .uno%3ATaskPaneApplyToAllSlides 33 Aplica a páxina principal a todas as diapositivas.
17 SD_HID_SD_SLIDE_DESIGNS 7a Abre o separador Deseños, onde é posíbel aplicar un estilo de diapositiva á diapositiva ou diapositivas seleccionadas.
15 SD_HID_SD_ALL_MASTERS 31 Lista todas as páxinas principais dispoñíbeis.
10 .uno%3AHideSlide 58 Oculta a diapositiva seleccionada para que non apareza na presentación de diapositivas.
12 .uno%3APagesPerRow 68 Introduza o número de diapositivas que quere que aparezan en cada fila do clasificador de diapositivas.
10 .uno%3ADiaEffect 61 Seleccione o efecto de transición que quere que apareza antes de mostrarse a diapositiva actual.
e .uno%3ADiaTime 56 Introduza o intervalo de tempo que tardará a presentación en cambiar de diapositiva.
16 .uno%3ARehearseTimings 52 Inicia a presentación de diapositivas cun cronómetro no canto inferior esquerdo.
f .uno%3APosition 47 Mostra a posición X e Y do cursor e o tamaño do obxecto seleccionado.
11 .uno%3APageStatus 50 Mostra o número da diapositiva actual seguido do número total de diapositivas.
12 .uno%3AZoomPanning 35 Move a diapositiva dentro da xanela de $[officename].
12 .uno%3AZoomObjects 4b Redimensiona a visualización para axustar o(s) obxecto(s) seleccionado(s).
f .uno%3AZoomNext 2f Undoes the action of the Previous Zoom command.
14 .uno%3AZoomPageWidth 76 Mostra a largura completa da diapositiva. É posíbel que non se vexan os extremos inferior e superior da diapositiva.
d .uno%3AZoomIn 2c Displays the slide at half its current size.
f .uno%3AZoomPlus 36 Mostra a diapositiva ao dobre de tamaño que o normal.
12 .uno%3AZoomToolBox 92 Reduce ou aumenta a visualización en pantalla do documento actual. Prema na frecha situada xunto á icona para abrir a barra de ferramentas Zoom.
13 .uno%3AZoomPrevious 49 Returns the display of the slide to the previous zoom factor you applied.
f .uno%3AZoomPage 2a Mostra a diapositiva completa na pantalla.
15 .uno%3AZoom100Percent 29 Mostra a diapositiva no seu tamaño real.
12 .uno%3AZoomOptimal 4d Redimensiona a visualización para incluír todos os obxectos da diapositiva.
d .uno%3AMirror 13b Voltea o(s) obxecto(s) seleccionado(s) arredor dunha liña de inversión, que pode arrastrar a calquera lugar da diapositiva. Arrastre unha agarradoira do(s) obxecto(s) sobre a liña de inversión para voltealo(s). Para modificar a orientación da liña de inversión, arrastre un dos seus extremos a un novo lugar.
12 .uno%3ACrookRotate b5 Distorsiona o obxecto seleccionado envolvéndoo con círculos imaxinarios e engadindo despois perspectiva. Arrastre unha das agarradoiras do obxecto seleccionado para distorsionalo.
19 .uno%3AConvertInto3DLathe 77 Converte o(s) obxecto(s) 2D seleccionado(s) en obxecto(s) 3D, xirando o(s) obxecto(s) arredor dunha liña de simetría.
13 .uno%3AAdvancedMode 52 Modifica a forma, a orientación ou o enchemento do(s) obxecto(s) seleccionado(s).
c .uno%3AShear 56 Permite arrastrar as agarradeiras do obxecto seleccionado para modificar a súa forma.
1a .uno%3AInteractiveGradient a4 Modifica o enchemento de gradación do obxecto seleccionado. Só é posíbel acceder a esta orde se aplicou a gradación ao obxecto seleccionado en Formato - Área.
11 .uno%3ACrookSlant 8f Distorsiona o obxecto seleccionado envolvéndoo en círculos imaxinarios. Arrastre unha agarradoira do obxecto seleccionado para distorsionalo.
1e .uno%3AInteractiveTransparence 40 Aplica unha gradación de transparencia ao obxecto seleccionado.
1a .uno%3AGlueVertAlignBottom 61 When the object is resized, the current gluepoint remains fixed to the bottom edge of the object.
1a .uno%3AGlueVertAlignCenter 65 When the object is resized, the current gluepoint remains fixed to the vertical center of the object.
16 .uno%3AGlueInsertPoint 31 Inserts a gluepoint where you click in an object.
12 .uno%3AGluePercent 52 Maintains the relative position of a selected gluepoint when you resize an object.
1d .uno%3AGlueEscapeDirectionTop 3d Connector attaches to the top edge of the selected gluepoint.
18 .uno%3AGlueHorzAlignLeft 65 Se o obxecto se redimensiona, o punto de pegado actual continúa fixado ao bordo esquerdo do obxecto.
20 .uno%3AGlueEscapeDirectionBottom 40 Connector attaches to the bottom edge of the selected gluepoint.
1f .uno%3AGlueEscapeDirectionRight 3f Connector attaches to the right edge of the selected gluepoint.
1e .uno%3AGlueEscapeDirectionLeft 3e Connector attaches to the left edge of the selected gluepoint.
17 .uno%3AGlueVertAlignTop 5e When the object is resized, the current gluepoint remains fixed to the top edge of the object.
19 .uno%3AGlueHorzAlignRight 60 When the object is resized, the current gluepoint remains fixed to the right edge of the object.
1a .uno%3AGlueHorzAlignCenter 5c When the object is resized, the current gluepoint remains fixed to the center of the object.
20 .uno%3AVerticalTextFitToSizeTool fd Debuxa un marco para texto orientado na vertical ao premer ou arrastrar no documento actual. O texto introducido é automaticamente redimensionado para encaixar nas dimensións do marco. (Active o soporte para textos asiáticos para activar esta icona).
12 .uno%3ATextToolbox 4c The Text toolbar contains some icons to enter different types of text boxes.
b .uno%3AText 96 Ábrese unha caixa de texto. Pode premer nela ou arrastrar no documento. Prema en calquera lugar do documento e, a seguir, introduza ou pegue o texto.
18 .uno%3ATextFitToSizeTool 99 Ábrese unha caixa de texto. Pode premer nela ou arrastrar no documento. O texto introducido axústase automaticamente ás dimensións da caixa de texto.
14 .uno%3ARect_Unfilled f9 Debuxa un rectángulo baleiro ao arrastrar o apuntador sobre o documento. Prema no lugar en que quere colocar un canto do rectángulo e arrastre ata conseguir o tamaño desexado. Para debuxar un cadrado, manteña premida a tecla Maiús ao arrastrar.
15 .uno%3ASquare_Rounded 10a Debuxa un cadrado arredondado e cheo ao arrastrar o apuntador polo documento. Prema onde quere colocar un canto do cadrado arredondado e arrastre ata conseguir o tamaño desexado. Para debuxar un rectángulo arredondado, manteña premida a tecla Maiús ao arrastrar.
1e .uno%3ASquare_Rounded_Unfilled 11e Debuxa un cadrado arredondado baleiro ao arrastrar o apuntador do rato no documento. Prema no lugar en que desexa colocar un dos cantos do cadrado arredondado e arrastre ata obter o tamaño desexado. Para debuxar un rectángulo arredondado, manteña premida a tecla Maiús ao arrastrar.
16 .uno%3ASquare_Unfilled f1 Debuxa un cadrado baleiro ao arrastrar o apuntador no documento. Prema no lugar en que quere colocar un dos cantos do cadrado e arrastre ata obter o tamaño desexado. Para debuxar un rectángulo, manteña premida a tecla Maiús ao arrastrar.
d .uno%3ASquare e9 Debuxa un cadrado cheo no lugar en que se arrastra o apuntador sobre o documento. Prema no lugar en que desexa coocar un dos cantos do cadrado e arrastre ata conseguir o tamaño desexado. Manteña premida a tecla Maiús ao arrastrar.
17 .uno%3ARectangleToolbox 7c A opción Personalizar a barra de ferramentas permite engadir a barra de ferramentas Debuxo, que contén a orde Rectángulos
13 .uno%3ARect_Rounded 106 Debuxa un rectángulo arredondado e cheo ao arrastrar no documento. Prema no lugar onde quere colocar un canto do rectángulo arredondado e arrastre ata conseguir o tamaño desexado. Para debuxar un cadrado arredondado, teña premida a tecla Maiús ao arrastrar.
1c .uno%3ARect_Rounded_Unfilled 131 Debuxa un rectángulo arredondado baleiro ao arrastrar o apuntador do rato no documento. Prema no lugar do documento onde quere colocar un dos cantos do rectángulo arredondado, e arrastre ata conseguir o tamaño desexado. Para debuxar un cadrado arredondado, manteña premida a tecla Maiús ao arrastrar.
10 .uno%3ACirclePie 1bc Debuxa unha forma chea, definida polo arco dun círculo e dúas liñas de raio no documento actual. Para debuxar un sector de círculo, arrastre un círculo ata conseguir o tamaño desexado e despois prema para definir a primeira liña de raio. Mova o apuntador ata o lugar en que quere colocar a segunda liña de raio e prema. Non é necesario premer no círculo. Para debuxar un sector elíptico, manteña premida a tecla Maiús ao arrastrar.
1a .uno%3AEllipseCut_Unfilled 1a8 Draws an empty shape that is defined by the arc of an oval and a diameter line in the current document. To draw an ellipse segment, drag an ellipse to the size you want, and then click to define the starting point of the diameter line. Move your pointer to where you want to place the endpoint of the diameter line and click. You do not need to click on the ellipse. To draw a circle segment, hold down Shift while you drag.
11 .uno%3AEllipseCut 1a8 Draws a filled shape that is defined by the arc of an oval and a diameter line in the current document. To draw an ellipse segment, drag an ellipse to the size you want, and then click to define the starting point of the diameter line. Move your pointer to where you want to place the endpoint of the diameter line and click. You do not need to click on the ellipse. To draw a circle segment, hold down Shift while you drag.
19 .uno%3ACirclePie_Unfilled 1c7 Debuxa no documento unha forma baleira, definida polo arco dun círculo e dúas liñas de raio no documento actual. Para debuxar un sector circular, arrastre un círculo ata conseguir o tamaño desexado e prema despois para definir a primeira liña de raio. Mova o apuntador ata o lugar en que quere colocar a segunda liña de raio e prema. Non é preciso premer no círculo. Para debuxar un sector elíptico, manteña premida a tecla Maiús ao arrastrar.
10 .uno%3ACircleArc 164 Draws an arc that is based on a circle in the current document. To draw an arc, drag a circle to the size you want, and then click to define the starting point of the arc. Move your pointer to where you want to place the endpoint and click. You do not need to click on the circle. To draw an arc that is based on an ellipse, hold down Shift while you drag.
16 .uno%3ACircle_Unfilled e6 Debuxa un círculo baleiro ao arrastrar o apuntador no documento actual. Prema no lugar onde quere debuxar o círculo e arrastre ata obter o tamaño desexado. Para debuxar unha elipse, manteña premida a tecla Maiús ao arrastrar.
19 .uno%3ACircleCut_Unfilled 1ba Debuxa no documento unha forma baleira, definida polo arco dun círculo e unha liña de diámetro. Para debuxar un segmento circular, arrastre un círculo ata conseguir o tamaño desexado e prema para definir o punto inicial da liña de diámetro. Mova o apuntador ata o lugar onde vai colocar a liña de diámetro e prema. Non é necesario premer no círculo. Para debuxar un segmento elíptico, manteña premida a tecla Maiús ao arrastrar.
13 .uno%3APie_Unfilled 1bd Debuxa no documento unha forma baleira, definida polo arco dunha forma oval e dúas liñas de raio. Para debuxar un sector elíptico, arrastre a forma oval ata conseguir o tamaño desexado e prema despois para definir a primeira liña de raio. Mova o apuntador ata o lugar en que desexa colocar a segunda liña de raio e prema. Non é preciso premer na forma oval. Para debuxar un segmento circular, manteña premida a tecla Maiús ao arrastrar.
15 .uno%3AEllipseToolbox 60 Using Customize Toolbar, you can add the Ellipse icon which opens the Circles and Ovals toolbar.
17 .uno%3AEllipse_Unfilled e8 Debuxa unha forma oval baleira ao arrastrar o apuntador no documento. Prema no lugar onde desexa arrastrar a forma oval e arrastre ata obter o tamaño desexado. Para debuxar un círculo, manteña premida a tecla Maiús ao arrastrar.
d .uno%3ACircle d2 Debuxa un círculo cheo ao arrastrar no documento. Prema no lugar onde quere debuxar o círculo arrastre ata conseguir o tamaño desexado. Para debuxar unha elipse, manteña premida a tecla Maiús ao arrastrar.
f .uno%3AFreeline 121 Debuxa unha liña de forma libre ao arrastrar o apuntador pola diapositiva. Ao soltar o botón do rato, $[officename] crea unha forma pechada cun segmento en liña recta desde a extremidade ata o punto inicial da liña. A forma comprendida entre as liñas énchese coa cor de área actual.
e .uno%3APolygon 1be Debuxa unha forma pechada e composta de segmentos de liña recta. Prema no lugar en que quere que comece o polígono e arrastre para debuxar un segmento de liña. Prema novamente para definir o final do segmento de liña e continúe premendo para definir os restantes segmentos de liña do polígono. Prema dúas veces para acabar de debuxar o polígono. Para limitar o polígono a ángulos de 45 graos, manteña premida a tecla Maiús ao premer.
17 .uno%3APolygon_Diagonal 1e9 Debuxa unha forma pechada que consiste en segmentos de liña recta limitados por ángulos de 45 graos. Prema onde queira iniciar o polígono e arrastre o apuntador para debuxar un segmento de liña. Prema novamente para definir o final do segmento de liña e continúe premendo para definir os restantes segmentos do polígono. Prema dúas veces para acabar de debuxar o polígono. Para debuxar un polígono non limitado por ángulos de 45 graos, manteña premida a tecla Maiús ao premer.
11 .uno%3ABezierFill 14b Debuxa unha forma pechada e con enchemento, baseada nunha curva de Bézier. Prema no lugar en que quere que comece a liña, arrastre, libere, mova o apuntador ata o lugar en que vai rematar a liña, e prema. Mova o apuntador e prema novamente para engadir un segmento de liña recta á curva. Prema dúas veces para pechar a forma.
1e .uno%3APolygon_Diagonal_Unfill 14b Draws a line composed of a series of straight line segments, that are constrained by angles of 45 degree. Drag to draw a line segment, click to define the endpoint of the line segment, and then drag to draw a new line segment. Double-click to finish drawing the line. To create a closed shape, hold down OptionAlt and double-click.
12 .uno%3ALineToolbox 7c A icona Curva da barra Debuxo abre a barra de ferramentas Liñas, que permite engadir liñas e formas á diapositiva actual.
e .uno%3AShell3D b9 Deseña un obxecto cóncavo baseado nun círculo ao arrastrar o apuntador na diapositiva. Para debuxar unha cunca baseada nunha forma oval, manteña premida a tecla Maiús ao arrastrar.
c .uno%3ATorus bd Debuxa un obxecto con forma de anel e baseado nun círculo ao arrastrar co rato na diapositiva. Para debuxar un torus baseado nunha forma oval, manteña premida a tecla Maiús ao arrastrar.
b .uno%3ACone b1 Debuxa un cono baseado nun círculo ao arrastrar o apuntador do rato na diapositiva. Para debuxar un cono baseado nunha forma oval, manteña premida a tecla Maiús ao arrastrar.
f .uno%3ACylinder ba Debuxa un cilindro baseado nun círculo ao arrastrar co apuntador do rato na diapositiva. Para debuxar un cilindro baseado nunha forma oval, manteña premida a tecla Maiús ao arrastrar.
17 .uno%3AObjects3DToolbox 6a Opens the 3D Objects toolbar. The objects are three dimensional, with depth, illumination, and reflection.
e .uno%3ACyramid 1b1 Debuxa unha pirámide de base cadrada ao arrastrar o rato na diapositiva. Para debuxar unha pirámide de base rectangular, manteña premida a tecla Maiús ao arrastrar. Para definir un polígono diferente na base da pirámide, abra a caixa de diálogo Efectos 3D e prema no separador Xeometría. Na área Segmentos, introduza o número de lados para o polígono na caixa Horizontal e, a seguir, prema na marca de verificación verde.
11 .uno%3AHalfSphere 94 Debuxa a metade dunha esfera ao arrastrar co rato na diapositiva. Para debuxar a metade dun esferoide, manteña premida a tecla Maiús ao arrastrar.
d .uno%3ASphere 92 Debuxa unha esfera chea ao arrastrar co apuntador na diapositiva. Para debuxar unha forma esférica, manteña premida a tecla Maiús ao arrastrar.
b .uno%3ACube 91 Debuxa un cubo cheo no lugar da diapositiva en que arrastra co rato. Para debuxar un rectángulo 3D, manteña premida a tecla Maiús ao arrastrar
1f .uno%3AConnectorCurveArrowStart 9b Draws a curved line connector with an arrow at the starting point. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
1e .uno%3AConnectorLineArrowStart 9d Draws a straight line connector with an arrow at the starting point. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
1b .uno%3AConnectorLineCircles 93 Draws a straight line connector with circles at both ends. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
1e .uno%3AConnectorLinesCircleEnd 11a Draws a connector that ends with a circle and bends near a gluepoint. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release. To adjust the length of the line segment between a bend point and a gluepoint, click the connector and drag the bend point.
14 .uno%3AConnectorLine 79 Draws a straight line connector. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
1c .uno%3AConnectorCurveCircles 91 Draws a curved line connector with circles at both ends. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
1d .uno%3AConnectorCurveArrowEnd 95 Draws a curved line connector with an arrow at the endpoint. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
18 .uno%3AConnectorArrowEnd af Draws a connector with one or more 90-degree angle bends and an arrow at the endpoint. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
20 .uno%3AConnectorCurveCircleStart 9b Draws a curved line connector with a circle at the starting point. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
15 .uno%3AConnectorCurve 77 Draws a curved line connector. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
1a .uno%3AConnectorLineArrows 92 Draws a straight line connector with arrows at both ends. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
1e .uno%3AConnectorCurveCircleEnd 95 Draws a curved line connector with a circle at the endpoint. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
1f .uno%3AConnectorLinesArrowStart 11c Draws a connector that starts with an arrow and bends near a gluepoint. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release. To adjust the length of the line segment between a bend point and a gluepoint, click the connector and drag the bend point.
1c .uno%3AConnectorLinesCircles 120 Draws a connector that bends near a gluepoint and has circles at both ends. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release. To adjust the length of the line segment between a bend point and a gluepoint, click the connector and drag the bend point.
15 .uno%3AConnectorLines 103 Draws a connector that bends near a gluepoint. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release. To adjust the length of the line segment between a bend point and a gluepoint, click the connector and drag the bend point.
20 .uno%3AConnectorLinesCircleStart 11c Draws a connector that starts with a circle and bends near a gluepoint. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release. To adjust the length of the line segment between a bend point and a gluepoint, click the connector and drag the bend point.
1b .uno%3AConnectorCurveArrows 90 Draws a curved line connector with arrows at both ends. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
1d .uno%3AConnectorLinesArrowEnd 11a Draws a connector that ends with an arrow and bends near a gluepoint. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release. To adjust the length of the line segment between a bend point and a gluepoint, click the connector and drag the bend point.
17 .uno%3AConnectorToolbox f8 Abra a barra de ferramentas Conectores, onde pode engadir conectores aos obxectos da diapositiva. Os conectores son liñas que unen obxectos e continúan anexada aos obxectos ao movelos. Se copia un obxecto cun conector, o conector tamén se copia.
16 .uno%3AConnectorArrows aa Draws a connector with one or more 90-degree angle bends and arrows at both ends. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
1f .uno%3AConnectorLineCircleStart 9d Draws a straight line connector with a circle at the starting point. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
17 .uno%3AConnectorCircles ab Draws a connector with one or more 90-degree angle bends and circles at both ends. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
1d .uno%3AConnectorLineCircleEnd 97 Draws a straight line connector with a circle at the endpoint. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
1b .uno%3AConnectorLinesArrows 11f Draws a connector that bends near a gluepoint and has arrows at both ends. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release. To adjust the length of the line segment between a bend point and a gluepoint, click the connector and drag the bend point.
1a .uno%3AConnectorArrowStart b5 Draws a connector with one or more 90-degree angle bends and an arrow at the starting point. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
1b .uno%3AConnectorCircleStart b5 Draws a connector with one or more 90-degree angle bends and a circle at the starting point. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
1c .uno%3AConnectorLineArrowEnd 97 Draws a straight line connector with an arrow at the endpoint. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
10 .uno%3AConnector 92 Draws a connector with one or more 90-degree angle bends. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
19 .uno%3AConnectorCircleEnd af Draws a connector with one or more 90-degree angle bends and a circle at the endpoint. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
14 .uno%3AInsertToolbox 80 Abra a barra de ferramentas Inserir, onde pode engadir obxectos, incluídas gráficas, follas de cálculo e imaxes ao documento.
14 .uno%3AArrowsToolbox 90 Abra a barra de ferramentas Frechas, que permite engadir liñas rectas, liñas con frechas, e liñas de dimensión á diapositiva ou á páxina.
15 .uno%3ALineArrowStart a5 Debuxa unha liña recta cunha frecha no inicio ao arrastrar co apuntador no documento. Para limitar a liña a 45 graos, manteña premida a tecla Maiús ao arrastrar.
16 .uno%3ALineArrowSquare bd Debuxa unha liña recta que comeza por unha frecha e remata cun cadrado ao arrastrar o apuntador no documento. Para limitar a liña a 45 graos, manteña premida a tecla Maiús ao arrastrar.
13 .uno%3ALineArrowEnd ab Debuxa no documento unha liña recta, rematada en frecha, ao arrastrar co apuntador do rato. Para limitar a liña a 45 graos, manteña premida a tecla Maiús ao arrastrar.
14 .uno%3ALine_Diagonal 3a Debuxa unha liña recta limitada por ángulos de 45 graos.
16 .uno%3ALineArrowCircle ac Ao arrastrar no documento debuxa unha liña recta cunha frecha no inicio e un círculo no fin. Para limitar a liña a 45 graos, manteña premida a tecla Maiús ao arrastar.
16 .uno%3ALineCircleArrow 95 Debuxa unha liña recta que comeza nun círculo e remata nunha frecha. Para limitar a liña a 45 graos, manteña premida a tecla Maiús ao arrastrar.
16 .uno%3ALineSquareArrow ba Debuxa unha liña recta que comeza cun cadrado e remata cunha frecha ao arrastrar o apuntador no documento. Para limitar a liña a 45 graos, manteña premida a tecla Maiús ao arrastrar.
11 .uno%3ALineArrows 9b Draws a straight line with arrows at both ends where you drag in the current document. To constrain the line to 45 degrees, hold down Shift while you drag.
12 .uno%3AMeasureLine 43 Debuxa unha liña que mostra a lonxitude existente entre as guías.
19 .uno%3AOutlineCollapseAll fd Oculta todos os títulos, excepto os das diapositivas, na presentación de diapositivas actual. Os títulos ocultos aparecen indicados por unha liña negra diante do título da diapositiva. Para mostrar todos os títulos, prema na icona Todos os niveis.
17 .uno%3AOutlineExpandAll d1 Mostra os títulos ocultos nas diapositivas da presentación actual. Para ocultar todos os títulos na presentación de diapositivas actual, excepto os títulos das diapositivas, prema na icona Primeiro nivel.
16 .uno%3AOutlineCollapse c1 Oculta os subtítulos dun título seleccionado. Os subtítulos ocultos indícanse cunha liña negra diante do título. Para mostrar os títulos de menor nivel, prema na icona Mostrar subpuntos.
14 .uno%3AOutlineExpand 8f Mostra os subtítulos ocultos dun título seleccionado. Para ocultar os subtítulos dun título seleccionado, prema na icona Ocultar subpuntos.
14 .uno%3AOutlineFormat e2 Mostra ou oculta o formatado de caracteres dos títulos de diapositivas. Para modificar o formatado dos caracteres dun título, abra a xanela Estilos e formatado, prema co botón dereito do rato nun estilo, e escollaModificar.
10 .uno%3AColorView 32 Mostra as diapositivas soamente en branco e negro.
13 .uno%3AGlueEditMode 93 Insira ou modifique as propiedades dun punto de pegado. Os puntos de pegado son puntos de conexión personalizados aos que pode anexar un conector.
1a .uno%3AClickChangeRotation 73 Modifica o comportamento do rato, mostrando as agarradoiras de rotación ao premer nun obxecto e volver premer nel.
14 .uno%3AAnimationMode ba Plays a preview of an animation effect that is assigned to an object, when you click the object in the slide. To select an object for editing, hold down the OptionAlt key when you click.
11 .uno%3AActionMode b5 Runs a preview of the interaction that is assigned to an object, when you click the object in the slide. To select an object for editing, hold down the OptionAlt key when you click.
17 .uno%3AHelplinesVisible 81 Mostra ou oculta as guías para poder aliñar obxectos na diapositiva. Para eliminar unha guía, arrástrea afora da diapositiva.
1a .uno%3ADoubleClickTextEdit 79 Modifica o comportamento do rato, de forma que sexa posíbel premer dúas veces nun obxecto para engadir ou editar texto.
12 .uno%3ASolidCreate 8e If this icon on the Options bar is activated, objects are shown with their attributes, but with 50% transparency, while you move or draw them.
15 .uno%3ALeaveAllGroups 38 Sae de todos os grupos e volve á visualización normal.
e .uno%3ARowMenu 2d Choose commands for the selected or all rows.
11 .uno%3AInsertRows c5 If currently no cell is selected, a new row will be inserted at the bottom of the table. If currently cells are selected, as many new rows as the selection has will be inserted below the selection.
10 .uno%3ASplitCell 52 The selected cell is split into several cells. You see the Split Cells dialog box.
15 .uno%3ADistributeRows 6c Distributes the height of the selected or all rows to the same size. The height of the table is not changed.
33 cui%3ANumericField%3ARID_SVX_NEWTABLE_DLG%3ANF_ROWS 2b Enter the number of rows for the new table.
11 .uno%3ADeleteRows 32 All rows of the current selection will be deleted.
15 .uno%3ACellVertCenter 3f The cell contents are aligned vertically centered in the cells.
14 .uno%3ADeleteColumns 35 All columns of the current selection will be deleted.
36 cui%3ANumericField%3ARID_SVX_NEWTABLE_DLG%3ANF_COLUMNS 2e Enter the number of columns for the new table.
12 .uno%3ASelectTable 1a Selects the current table.
11 .uno%3AColumnMenu 30 Choose commands for the selected or all columns.
18 .uno%3ADistributeColumns 6d Distributes the width of the selected or all columns to the same size. The width of the table is not changed.
13 .uno%3AEntireColumn 9c If currently no cell is selected, all columns will be selected. If currently cells are selected, all columns containing the selected cells will be selected.
15 .uno%3ACellVertBottom 39 The cell contents are aligned at the bottom of the cells.
12 .uno%3ACellVertTop 34 The cell contents are align at the top of the cells.
10 .uno%3AEntireRow 96 If currently no cell is selected, all rows will be selected. If currently cells are selected, all rows containing the selected cells will be selected.
11 .uno%3AMergeCells 2c All selected cells are merged into one cell.
f .uno%3ACellMenu 55 Define the vertical alignment of selected or all cell contents. Split or merge cells.
15 .uno%3AAlignObjetMenu 29 Align the table within the page or slide.
14 .uno%3AInsertColumns d4 If currently no cell is selected, a new column will be inserted at the right border of the table. If currently cells are selected, as many new columns as the selection has will be inserted right of the selection.
f .uno%3AFileMenu 5b Estas orde aplícanselle ao documento actual, abra un documento novo ou peche o aplicativo.
f .uno%3AEditMenu 45 Este menú contén ordes para editar os contidos do documento actual.
f .uno%3AViewMenu 51 Este menú contén ordes para controlar a presentación en pantalla do documento.
11 .uno%3AInsertMenu 9c Este menú contén as ordes que se usan para inserir elementos novos no documento, por exemplo gráficos, obxectos, caracteres especiais e outros ficheiros.
11 .uno%3AFormatMenu 40 Contén ordes para formatar o deseño e o contido de documentos.
10 .uno%3AToolsMenu ca Contén ferramentas de corrección, unha galería de obxectos de arte que pode engadir ao seu documento, así como ferramentas para configuración de menús e configuración de preferencias do programa.
11 .uno%3AWindowList 39 Conten ordes para manexar e mostrar xanelas de documento.
11 .uno%3AModifyMenu 37 Contén ordes para modificar obxectos no seu documento.
14 .uno%3ASlideShowMenu 3c Contén ordes e opcións para reproducir unha presentación.
d .uno%3AShrink 38 Reduce o tamaño do tipo de letra do texto seleccionado.
b .uno%3AGrow 39 Aumenta o tamaño do tipo de letra do texto seleccionado.
31 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_COLOR%3ABTN_DELETE 3c Elimina os elementos seleccionados despois da confirmación.
1e WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_CANCEL 52 Premendo en Cancelar péchase a caixa de diálogo sen gardar ningunha alteración.
2c starmath%3APushButton%3ARID_SYMBOLDIALOG%3A2 4e Aplica os valores modificados ou seleccionados sen pechar a caixa de diálogo.
1c SFX2_HID_TABDLG_STANDARD_BTN 49 Restabelece na caixa de diálogo os valores de instalación predefinidos.
37 sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_SPEC_FILTER%3ARB_COPY_AREA 116 Prema na icona Reducirpara reducir a caixa de diálogo ao tamaño do campo de entrada, para que sexa máis fácil marcar a referencia desexada na folla. As iconas converteranse automaticamente na icona Maximizar. Prema na caixa de diálogo para restaurar o seu tamaño orixinal.
2f sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_TABOP%3ARB_ROWCELL 116 Prema na icona Reducirpara reducir a caixa de diálogo ao tamaño do campo de entrada, para que sexa máis fácil marcar a referencia desexada na folla. As iconas converteranse automaticamente na icona Maximizar. Prema na caixa de diálogo para restaurar o seu tamaño orixinal.
32 sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_FILTER%3ARB_COPY_AREA 116 Prema na icona Reducirpara reducir a caixa de diálogo ao tamaño do campo de entrada, para que sexa máis fácil marcar a referencia desexada na folla. As iconas converteranse automaticamente na icona Maximizar. Prema na caixa de diálogo para restaurar o seu tamaño orixinal.
2d sd%3APushButton%3ADLG_CUSTOMSHOW%3ABTN_REMOVE 44 Elimina os elementos seleccionados sen solicitar unha confirmación.
21 WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_0_CMDCANCEL 52 Premendo en Cancelar péchase a caixa de diálogo sen gardar ningunha alteración.
2c sd%3APushButton%3ADLG_COPY%3ABTN_SET_DEFAULT 49 Restabelece na caixa de diálogo os valores de instalación predefinidos.
31 sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_AREAS%3ARB_REPEATCOL 116 Prema na icona Reducirpara reducir a caixa de diálogo ao tamaño do campo de entrada, para que sexa máis fácil marcar a referencia desexada na folla. As iconas converteranse automaticamente na icona Maximizar. Prema na caixa de diálogo para restaurar o seu tamaño orixinal.
34 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_OFADLG_OPTIONS_TREE%3APB_BACK 35 Restabelece os valores predefinidos de $[officename].
1b DBACCESS_HID_DBWIZ_PREVIOUS 5e Observe a selección realizada na caixa de diálogo anterior. Non se alterou a configuración.
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_0_CMDPREV 5e Observe a selección realizada na caixa de diálogo anterior. Non se alterou a configuración.
39 sc%3APushButton%3ARID_SCDLG_COLROWNAMERANGES%3ABTN_REMOVE 3c Elimina os elementos seleccionados despois da confirmación.
33 basctl%3APushButton%3ARID_TP_MODULS%3ARID_PB_DELETE 3c Elimina os elementos seleccionados despois da confirmación.
30 sc%3APushButton%3ARID_SCDLG_DBNAMES%3ABTN_REMOVE 3c Elimina os elementos seleccionados despois da confirmación.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_LISTWIZARD_NEXT 9e Click the Next button, and the wizard uses the current dialog settings and proceeds to the next step. If you are on the last step, this button becomes Create.
17 DBACCESS_HID_DBWIZ_NEXT 9e Click the Next button, and the wizard uses the current dialog settings and proceeds to the next step. If you are on the last step, this button becomes Create.
31 sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_AREAS%3ARB_PRINTAREA 116 Prema na icona Reducirpara reducir a caixa de diálogo ao tamaño do campo de entrada, para que sexa máis fácil marcar a referencia desexada na folla. As iconas converteranse automaticamente na icona Maximizar. Prema na caixa de diálogo para restaurar o seu tamaño orixinal.
37 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_LINEEND_DEF%3ABTN_DELETE 3c Elimina os elementos seleccionados despois da confirmación.
2e sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_NAMES%3ARB_ASSIGN 116 Prema na icona Reducirpara reducir a caixa de diálogo ao tamaño do campo de entrada, para que sexa máis fácil marcar a referencia desexada na folla. As iconas converteranse automaticamente na icona Maximizar. Prema na caixa de diálogo para restaurar o seu tamaño orixinal.
1e WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_CREATE 26 Aplica os cambios e pecha o asistente.
3d cui%3APushButton%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_EXCEPT%3APB_DELABBREV 44 Elimina os elementos seleccionados sen solicitar unha confirmación.
1c WIZARDS_HID_FAXWIZARD_CANCEL 52 Premendo en Cancelar péchase a caixa de diálogo sen gardar ningunha alteración.
1c WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_NEXT 9e Click the Next button, and the wizard uses the current dialog settings and proceeds to the next step. If you are on the last step, this button becomes Create.
1b CUI_HID_MEASURE_CTL_PREVIEW 33 Mostra unha previsualización da selección actual.
2e sc%3APushButton%3ARID_SCDLG_NAMES%3ABTN_REMOVE 3c Elimina os elementos seleccionados despois da confirmación.
31 sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_AREAS%3ARB_REPEATROW 116 Prema na icona Reducirpara reducir a caixa de diálogo ao tamaño do campo de entrada, para que sexa máis fácil marcar a referencia desexada na folla. As iconas converteranse automaticamente na icona Maximizar. Prema na caixa de diálogo para restaurar o seu tamaño orixinal.
34 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_LINE_DEF%3ABTN_DELETE 3c Elimina os elementos seleccionados despois da confirmación.
34 sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_CONDFORMAT%3ARB_COND3_2 116 Prema na icona Reducirpara reducir a caixa de diálogo ao tamaño do campo de entrada, para que sexa máis fácil marcar a referencia desexada na folla. As iconas converteranse automaticamente na icona Maximizar. Prema na caixa de diálogo para restaurar o seu tamaño orixinal.
2a sw%3APushButton%3ADLG_BIB_BASE%3APB_DELETE 44 Elimina os elementos seleccionados sen solicitar unha confirmación.
2b sw%3APushButton%3ATP_STD_FONT%3APB_STANDARD 49 Restabelece na caixa de diálogo os valores de instalación predefinidos.
11 WIZARDS_HID0_NEXT 9e Click the Next button, and the wizard uses the current dialog settings and proceeds to the next step. If you are on the last step, this button becomes Create.
1c WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDNEXT 9e Click the Next button, and the wizard uses the current dialog settings and proceeds to the next step. If you are on the last step, this button becomes Create.
34 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRADIENT%3ABTN_DELETE 3c Elimina os elementos seleccionados despois da confirmación.
34 sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_CONDFORMAT%3ARB_COND2_1 116 Prema na icona Reducirpara reducir a caixa de diálogo ao tamaño do campo de entrada, para que sexa máis fácil marcar a referencia desexada na folla. As iconas converteranse automaticamente na icona Maximizar. Prema na caixa de diálogo para restaurar o seu tamaño orixinal.
34 sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_SOLVER%3ARB_FORMULACELL 116 Prema na icona Reducirpara reducir a caixa de diálogo ao tamaño do campo de entrada, para que sexa máis fácil marcar a referencia desexada na folla. As iconas converteranse automaticamente na icona Maximizar. Prema na caixa de diálogo para restaurar o seu tamaño orixinal.
1e WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDCANCEL 52 Premendo en Cancelar péchase a caixa de diálogo sen gardar ningunha alteración.
1c WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDPREV 5e Observe a selección realizada na caixa de diálogo anterior. Non se alterou a configuración.
1f EXTENSIONS_HID_GROUPWIZARD_NEXT 9e Click the Next button, and the wizard uses the current dialog settings and proceeds to the next step. If you are on the last step, this button becomes Create.
33 sc%3APushButton%3ARID_SCDLG_AUTOFORMAT%3ABTN_REMOVE 3c Elimina os elementos seleccionados despois da confirmación.
3b sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_SPEC_FILTER%3ARB_CRITERIA_AREA 116 Prema na icona Reducirpara reducir a caixa de diálogo ao tamaño do campo de entrada, para que sexa máis fácil marcar a referencia desexada na folla. As iconas converteranse automaticamente na icona Maximizar. Prema na caixa de diálogo para restaurar o seu tamaño orixinal.
15 SW_HID_MD_GLOS_DELETE 3c Elimina os elementos seleccionados despois da confirmación.
1b WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDPREV 5e Observe a selección realizada na caixa de diálogo anterior. Non se alterou a configuración.
19 SFX2_HID_TABDLG_RESET_BTN c2 Desfai as alteracións realizadas no separador, restabelecendo a configuración existente antes de abrir a caixa de diálogo. Non se solicitará confirmación cando se peche a caixa de diálogo.
34 sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_CONDFORMAT%3ARB_COND1_2 116 Prema na icona Reducirpara reducir a caixa de diálogo ao tamaño do campo de entrada, para que sexa máis fácil marcar a referencia desexada na folla. As iconas converteranse automaticamente na icona Maximizar. Prema na caixa de diálogo para restaurar o seu tamaño orixinal.
43 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_REPLACE%3APB_DELETE_REPLACE 44 Elimina os elementos seleccionados sen solicitar unha confirmación.
37 sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_CONSOLIDATE%3ARB_DEST_AREA 116 Prema na icona Reducirpara reducir a caixa de diálogo ao tamaño do campo de entrada, para que sexa máis fácil marcar a referencia desexada na folla. As iconas converteranse automaticamente na icona Maximizar. Prema na caixa de diálogo para restaurar o seu tamaño orixinal.
41 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_EXCEPT%3APB_DELDOUBLECAPS 44 Elimina os elementos seleccionados sen solicitar unha confirmación.
2f sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_TABOP%3ARB_COLCELL 116 Prema na icona Reducirpara reducir a caixa de diálogo ao tamaño do campo de entrada, para que sexa máis fácil marcar a referencia desexada na folla. As iconas converteranse automaticamente na icona Maximizar. Prema na caixa de diálogo para restaurar o seu tamaño orixinal.
31 basctl%3APushButton%3ARID_TP_LIBS%3ARID_PB_DELETE 3c Elimina os elementos seleccionados despois da confirmación.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_LISTWIZARD_PREVIOUS 5e Observe a selección realizada na caixa de diálogo anterior. Non se alterou a configuración.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_LISTWIZARD_CANCEL 52 Premendo en Cancelar péchase a caixa de diálogo sen gardar ningunha alteración.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_GROUPWIZARD_PREVIOUS 5e Observe a selección realizada na caixa de diálogo anterior. Non se alterou a configuración.
32 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TABULATOR%3ABTN_DEL 3c Elimina os elementos seleccionados despois da confirmación.
13 WIZARDS_HID0_CANCEL 52 Premendo en Cancelar péchase a caixa de diálogo sen gardar ningunha alteración.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_GROUPWIZARD_CANCEL 52 Premendo en Cancelar péchase a caixa de diálogo sen gardar ningunha alteración.
34 sc%3APushButton%3ARID_SCDLG_CONSOLIDATE%3ABTN_REMOVE 44 Elimina os elementos seleccionados sen solicitar unha confirmación.
17 SVX_HID_GALLERY_PREVIEW 33 Mostra unha previsualización da selección actual.
34 sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_TABOP%3ARB_FORMULARANGE 116 Prema na icona Reducirpara reducir a caixa de diálogo ao tamaño do campo de entrada, para que sexa máis fácil marcar a referencia desexada na folla. As iconas converteranse automaticamente na icona Maximizar. Prema na caixa de diálogo para restaurar o seu tamaño orixinal.
31 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HATCH%3ABTN_DELETE 3c Elimina os elementos seleccionados despois da confirmación.
21 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_0_CMDCANCEL 52 Premendo en Cancelar péchase a caixa de diálogo sen gardar ningunha alteración.
1c WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_BACK 5e Observe a selección realizada na caixa de diálogo anterior. Non se alterou a configuración.
30 sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_SOLVER%3ARB_VARCELL 116 Prema na icona Reducirpara reducir a caixa de diálogo ao tamaño do campo de entrada, para que sexa máis fácil marcar a referencia desexada na folla. As iconas converteranse automaticamente na icona Maximizar. Prema na caixa de diálogo para restaurar o seu tamaño orixinal.
30 sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_DBNAMES%3ARB_DBAREA 116 Prema na icona Reducirpara reducir a caixa de diálogo ao tamaño do campo de entrada, para que sexa máis fácil marcar a referencia desexada na folla. As iconas converteranse automaticamente na icona Maximizar. Prema na caixa de diálogo para restaurar o seu tamaño orixinal.
32 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_BITMAP%3ABTN_DELETE 3c Elimina os elementos seleccionados despois da confirmación.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDCANCEL 52 Premendo en Cancelar péchase a caixa de diálogo sen gardar ningunha alteración.
37 sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_COLROWNAMERANGES%3ARB_DATA 116 Prema na icona Reducirpara reducir a caixa de diálogo ao tamaño do campo de entrada, para que sexa máis fácil marcar a referencia desexada na folla. As iconas converteranse automaticamente na icona Maximizar. Prema na caixa de diálogo para restaurar o seu tamaño orixinal.
33 sc%3APushButton%3ARID_SCPAGE_USERLISTS%3ABTN_REMOVE 3c Elimina os elementos seleccionados despois da confirmación.
34 sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_CONDFORMAT%3ARB_COND1_1 116 Prema na icona Reducirpara reducir a caixa de diálogo ao tamaño do campo de entrada, para que sexa máis fácil marcar a referencia desexada na folla. As iconas converteranse automaticamente na icona Maximizar. Prema na caixa de diálogo para restaurar o seu tamaño orixinal.
37 sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_CONSOLIDATE%3ARB_DATA_AREA 116 Prema na icona Reducirpara reducir a caixa de diálogo ao tamaño do campo de entrada, para que sexa máis fácil marcar a referencia desexada na folla. As iconas converteranse automaticamente na icona Maximizar. Prema na caixa de diálogo para restaurar o seu tamaño orixinal.
37 sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_COLROWNAMERANGES%3ARB_AREA 116 Prema na icona Reducirpara reducir a caixa de diálogo ao tamaño do campo de entrada, para que sexa máis fácil marcar a referencia desexada na folla. As iconas converteranse automaticamente na icona Maximizar. Prema na caixa de diálogo para restaurar o seu tamaño orixinal.
1e WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDFINISH 26 Aplica os cambios e pecha o asistente.
36 sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_PIVOT_LAYOUT%3ARB_OUTAREA 116 Prema na icona Reducirpara reducir a caixa de diálogo ao tamaño do campo de entrada, para que sexa máis fácil marcar a referencia desexada na folla. As iconas converteranse automaticamente na icona Maximizar. Prema na caixa de diálogo para restaurar o seu tamaño orixinal.
34 sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_CONDFORMAT%3ARB_COND2_2 116 Prema na icona Reducirpara reducir a caixa de diálogo ao tamaño do campo de entrada, para que sexa máis fácil marcar a referencia desexada na folla. As iconas converteranse automaticamente na icona Maximizar. Prema na caixa de diálogo para restaurar o seu tamaño orixinal.
34 sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_CONDFORMAT%3ARB_COND3_1 116 Prema na icona Reducirpara reducir a caixa de diálogo ao tamaño do campo de entrada, para que sexa máis fácil marcar a referencia desexada na folla. As iconas converteranse automaticamente na icona Maximizar. Prema na caixa de diálogo para restaurar o seu tamaño orixinal.
31 basctl%3APushButton%3ARID_TP_DLGS%3ARID_PB_DELETE 3c Elimina os elementos seleccionados despois da confirmación.
11 WIZARDS_HID0_PREV 5e Observe a selección realizada na caixa de diálogo anterior. Non se alterou a configuración.
3b cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_MULTIPATH%3ABTN_DEL_MULTIPATH 44 Elimina os elementos seleccionados sen solicitar unha confirmación.
1b WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDNEXT 9e Click the Next button, and the wizard uses the current dialog settings and proceeds to the next step. If you are on the last step, this button becomes Create.
1d SVX_HID_GALLERY_MN_BACKGROUND 27 Insire a imaxe seleccionada como fondo.
19 SID_EXPLORERCONTENT_PASTE 3c Insire no documento o elemento que moveu para o portapapeis.
1a SID_EXPLORERCONTENT_RENAME 30 Habilita un obxecto seleccionado para renomealo.
1f SID_EXPLORERCONTENT_OPEN_OBJECT 45 Use a orde Abrir para abrir o obxecto seleccionado nunha nova tarefa.
1f SID_EXPLORERCONTENT_OPEN_FOLDER 45 Use a orde Abrir para abrir o obxecto seleccionado nunha nova tarefa.
18 SID_EXPLORERCONTENT_COPY 2d Copia no portapapeis o elemento seleccionado.
19 SVX_HID_GALLERY_ACTUALIZE 40 Actualiza a visualización da xanela ou do obxecto seleccionado.
18 SID_EXPLORERCONTENT_OPEN 45 Use a orde Abrir para abrir o obxecto seleccionado nunha nova tarefa.
1b SID_EXPLORERCONTENT_DESTROY b3 Elimina a selección actual. Se hai varios obxectos seleccionados, elimínanse todos. A maioría das veces, aparece unha solicitude de confirmación antes de eliminar os obxectos.
1c SFX2_HID_DID_SAVE_PACKED_XML 4d $[officename] carga e garda os ficheiros no formato OpenDocument por defecto.
11 .uno%3AActiveHelp 58 Activa a visualización dunha descrición breve de menús e iconas no apuntador do rato.
e .uno%3AHelpTip 5d Activa a visualización dos nomes de iconas no apuntador do rato e noutros contidos da Axuda.
13 .uno%3AHelperDialog 9d Allows you to activate the automatic Help Agent. You can also activate the Help Agent through $[officename] - General - Help Agent in the Options dialog box.
2f svtools%3AListBox%3ADLG_EXPORT%3ALB_COLOR_DEPTH 41 Select the color depth from 8 bit grayscale or 24 bit true color.
34 svtools%3ANumericField%3ADLG_EXPORT%3ANF_COMPRESSION da Sets the compression and quality for the export. Choose from a low quality with minimal file size, up to a high quality and big file size. A high compression means a low quality, a low compression means a high quality.
33 svtools%3ANumericField%3ADLG_EXPORT%3ANF_RESOLUTION 4b Enter the image resolution. Select the measurement units from the list box.
2e svtools%3AListBox%3ADLG_EXPORT%3ALB_RESOLUTION 4b Enter the image resolution. Select the measurement units from the list box.
2d svtools%3AMetricField%3ADLG_EXPORT%3AMF_SIZEX 14 Specifies the width.
3c svtools%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_EXPORT%3ARB_EPS_COMPRESSION_NONE 32 Specifies that you do not wish to use compression.
2f svtools%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_EXPORT%3ACB_INTERLACED 40 Specifies whether the graphic is to be saved in interlaced mode.
36 svtools%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_EXPORT%3ACB_SAVE_TRANSPARENCY ba Specifies whether to save the background of the picture as transparent. Only objects will be visible in the GIF image. Use the Color Replacer to set the transparent color in the picture.
2e svtools%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_EXPORT%3ARB_BINARY 52 Exports the file in binary format. The resulting file is smaller than a text file.
32 svtools%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_EXPORT%3ARB_EPS_LEVEL2 73 Select the Level 2 option if your output device supports colored bitmaps, palette graphics and compressed graphics.
39 svtools%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_EXPORT%3ARB_EPS_COLOR_FORMAT1 1a Exports the file in color.
29 svtools%3AListBox%3ADLG_EXPORT%3ALB_SIZEX 20 Specifies the measurement units.
2d svtools%3AMetricField%3ADLG_EXPORT%3AMF_SIZEY 15 Specifies the height.
3b svtools%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_EXPORT%3ARB_EPS_COMPRESSION_LZW 66 LZW compression is the compression of a file into a smaller file using a table-based lookup algorithm.
35 svtools%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_EXPORT%3ACB_EPS_PREVIEW_EPSI b6 Specifies whether a monochrome preview graphic in EPSI format is exported together with the PostScript file. This format only contains printable characters from the 7-bit ASCII code.
2c svtools%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_EXPORT%3ARB_TEXT 57 Exports the file in ASCII text format. The resulting file is larger than a binary file.
35 svtools%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_EXPORT%3ACB_EPS_PREVIEW_TIFF 6a Specifies whether a preview image is exported in the TIFF format together with the actual PostScript file.
31 svtools%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_EXPORT%3ACB_RLE_ENCODING 36 Applies RLE (Run Length Encoding) to the BMP graphics.
39 svtools%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_EXPORT%3ARB_EPS_COLOR_FORMAT2 24 Exports the file in grayscale tones.
32 svtools%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_EXPORT%3ARB_EPS_LEVEL1 8c Compression is not available at this level. Select the Level 1 option if your PostScript printer does not offer the capabilities of Level 2.
2c sc%3AListBox%3ARID_SCDLG_IMPORTOPT%3ALB_FONT 41 Select the character set from the options used for import/export.
31 sc%3AComboBox%3ARID_SCDLG_IMPORTOPT%3AED_FIELDSEP 48 Escolla ou introduza o delimitador de campo, que separa campos de datos.
33 sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_IMPORTOPT%3ACB_FIXEDWIDTH 34 Exporta todos os campos de datos cunha largura fixa.
32 sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_IMPORTOPT%3ACB_SAVESHOWN bc Enabled by default, data will be saved as displayed, including applied number formats. If this checkbox is not marked, raw data content will be saved, as in older versions of the software.
31 sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_IMPORTOPT%3ACB_QUOTEALL c0 Exports all text cells with leading and trailing quote characters as set in the Text delimiter box. If not checked, only those text cells get quoted that contain the Field delimiter character.
30 sc%3AComboBox%3ARID_SCDLG_IMPORTOPT%3AED_TEXTSEP 52 Escolla ou introduza o delimitador de texto, que inclúe todos os campos de datos.
2e sc%3AListBox%3ARID_SCDLG_IMPORTOPT%3ADDLB_FONT 4c Especifica o conxunto de caracteres utilizados para a exportación de texto.
2b sc%3AListBox%3ARID_SCDLG_ASCII%3ALB_CHARSET 44 Especifica o conxunto de caracteres utilizado no ficheiro importado.
2b sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_ASCII%3ACB_ASONCE 47 Combina delimitadores consecutivos e elimina campos de datos en branco.
33 sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_ASCII%3ACB_QUOTED_AS_TEXT b2 When this option is enabled, fields or cells whose values are quoted in their entirety (the first and last characters of the value equal the text delimiter) are imported as text.
29 sc%3AListBox%3ARID_SCDLG_ASCII%3ALB_TYPE1 77 Escolla unha columna na xanela de visualización e seleccione o tipo de datos a que desexa aplicar os datos importados.
2b sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_ASCII%3ACKB_COMMA 32 Separa en columnas os datos delimitados por comas.
2e sc%3AListBox%3ARID_SCDLG_ASCII%3ALB_CUSTOMLANG 2f Determines how the number strings are imported.
2c sc%3AComboBox%3ARID_SCDLG_ASCII%3ACB_TEXTSEP 5c Select a character to delimit text data. You can can also enter a character in the text box.
2b sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_ASCII%3ACKB_SPACE 34 Separa en columnas os datos delimitados por espazos.
2d sc%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SCDLG_ASCII%3ARB_FIXED 4a Separa en columnas os datos de largura fixa (igual número de caracteres).
2f sc%3ANumericField%3ARID_SCDLG_ASCII%3ANF_AT_ROW 36 Especifica a liña onde desexa iniciar a importación.
2b sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_ASCII%3ACKB_OTHER 8f Separa datos en columnas, empregando o separador personalizado especificado. Nota: O separador personalizado tamén debe facer parte dos datos.
3a sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_ASCII%3ACB_DETECT_SPECIAL_NUMBER 9e When this option is enabled, Calc will automatically detect all number formats, including special number formats such as dates, time, and scientific notation.
31 sc%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SCDLG_ASCII%3ARB_SEPARATED 2b Seleccione o separador utilizado nos datos.
29 sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_ASCII%3ACKB_TAB 38 Separa en columnas os datos delimitados por tabuladores.
22 sc%3AModalDialog%3ARID_SCDLG_ASCII 3b Configura as opcións de importación de datos delimitados.
2f sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_ASCII%3ACKB_SEMICOLON 39 Separa en columnas os datos delimitados por punto e coma.
26 sc%3AEdit%3ARID_SCDLG_ASCII%3AED_OTHER 8f Separa datos en columnas, empregando o separador personalizado especificado. Nota: O separador personalizado tamén debe facer parte dos datos.
31 sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PRINT_WARNINGS%3ARBT_SCALE 3f Specifies whether to distribute the printout on multiple pages.
25 sd%3AModalDialog%3ADLG_PRINT_WARNINGS 64 The Warning Print Options dialog appears when the page setup does not match the defined print range.
2f sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PRINT_WARNINGS%3ARBT_CUT 72 Specifies that anything extending beyond the maximum print range will be cut off and not included in the printing.
32 sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PRINT_WARNINGS%3ARBT_POSTER 3f Specifies whether to distribute the printout on multiple pages.
2b sw%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_ASCII_FILTER%3ARB_LF 45 Aplica unha "quebra de liña con sangría" como quebra de parágrafo.
2d sw%3AListBox%3ADLG_ASCII_FILTER%3ALB_LANGUAGE 76 Especifica o idioma do texto, se aínda non foi definido. Esta configuración só está dispoñíbel cando se importa.
29 sw%3AListBox%3ADLG_ASCII_FILTER%3ALB_FONT bc Configurando un tipo de letra predefinido está a especificar que o texto debe mostrarse nun tipo de letra específico. Os tipos de letra predefinidos só se poden seleccionar ao importar.
2d sw%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_ASCII_FILTER%3ARB_CRLF 62 Aplica un "retorno de carro" e unha "quebra de liña con sangría". Esta é a opción predefinida.
2c sw%3AListBox%3ADLG_ASCII_FILTER%3ALB_CHARSET 59 Especifica o conxunto de caracteres do ficheiro para a súa exportación ou importación.
2b sw%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_ASCII_FILTER%3ARB_CR 37 Aplica un "retorno de carro" como quebra de parágrafo.
1b SVX_HID_GALLERY_MN_ADD_LINK 32 Insire o gráfico seleccionado como unha ligazón.
16 SVX_HID_GALLERY_MN_ADD 55 Insire unha copia do obxecto gráfico seleccionado, directamente dentro do documento.
19 SVX_HID_GALLERY_MN_DELETE 38 Elimina o gráfico selecionado despois da confirmación.
1a SVX_HID_GALLERY_MN_ADDMENU 41 Define como é inserido un obxecto gráfico dentro dun documento.
15 SVX_HID_GALLERY_TITLE 3a Atribúe un título a un obxecto seleccionado da Galería.
1a SVX_HID_GALLERY_MN_PREVIEW 39 A orde Previsualización  mostra o gráfico seleccionado.
1d SW_HID_MN_READONLY_GRAPHICOFF 3e Define todos os gráficos para seren invisíbeis no documento.
1e SW_HID_MN_READONLY_LOADGRAPHIC 5e Se desactivou a visualización de imaxes, escolla a ordeCargar imaxes para as facer visíbeis.
1b SW_HID_MN_READONLY_COPYLINK 42 Copia no portapapeis a ligazón situada baixo o apuntador do rato.
21 SW_HID_MN_READONLY_SAVEBACKGROUND 29 Permite gardar o fondo dunha páxina web.
1e SW_HID_MN_READONLY_SAVEGRAPHIC 47 Abre unha caixa de diálogo en que se pode gardar a imaxe seleccionada.
1c SW_HID_MN_READONLY_PLUGINOFF 23 Desactiva as extensións inseridas.
1e SW_HID_MN_READONLY_COPYGRAPHIC 2d Copia unha imaxe seleccionada no portapapeis.
22 CUI_HID_GALLERY_PROPERTIES_GENERAL 16 Mostra o nome do tema.
10 .uno%3AAddDirect 25 Creates a new $[officename] document.
19 private%3Afactory%2Fscalc 38 Creates a new spreadsheet document ($[officename] Calc).
28 private%3Afactory%2Fsimpress%3Fslot=6686 64 Creates a new presentation document ($[officename] Impress). The Presentation Wizard dialog appears.
21 private%3Afactory%2Fswriter%2Fweb 1c Creates a new HTML document.
28 private%3Afactory%2Fswriter%3Fslot=21052 93 Opens the Business Cards dialog where you can set the options for your business cards, and then creates a new text document ($[officename] Writer).
28 private%3Afactory%2Fswriter%3Fslot=21051 92 Opens the Labels dialog where you can set the options for your labels, and then creates a new text document for the labels ($[officename] Writer).
2c private%3Afactory%2Fswriter%2FGlobalDocument 1e Creates a new master document.
28 private%3Afactory%2Fswriter%3Fslot=21053 1e Creates a new XForms document.
1b private%3Afactory%2Fswriter 33 Creates a new text document ($[officename] Writer).
2b private%3Afactory%2Fsdatabase%3FInteractive 34 Opens the Database Wizard to create a database file.
19 private%3Afactory%2Fsdraw 34 Creates a new drawing document ($[officename] Draw).
1b SFX2_HID_TBXCONTROL_FILENEW 52 Creates a new $[officename] document. Click the arrow to select the document type.
2f service%3Acom.sun.star.sdb.DatabaseWizardDialog 34 Opens the Database Wizard to create a database file.
d .uno%3ANewDoc 57 If you want to create a document from a template, choose New - Templates and Documents.
19 private%3Afactory%2Fsmath 34 Creates a new formula document ($[officename] Math).
b slot%3A5500 4d Creates a new document using an existing template or opens a sample document.
1e SVT_HID_TEMPLATEDLG_TB_DOCINFO 3e Displays the properties for the selected template or document.
1e SVT_HID_TEMPLATEDLG_TB_PREVIEW 38 Allows you to preview the selected template or document.
1c SVT_HID_TEMPLATEDLG_TB_PRINT 29 Prints the selected template or document.
1b SVT_HID_TEMPLATEDLG_TB_PREV 28 Moves up one folder level, if available.
1c SVT_HID_TEMPLATEDLG_FILEVIEW c7 Lists the available templates or documents for the selected category. Select a template or document and, then click Open. To preview the document, click the Preview button above the box on the right.
3d svtools%3APushButton%3ADLG_DOCTEMPLATE%3ABTN_DOCTEMPLATE_EDIT 28 Opens the selected template for editing.
1c SVT_HID_TEMPLATEDLG_ICONCTRL ad Categories are shown in the box on the left side of the Templates and Documents dialog. Click a category to display the files associated with that category in the Title box.
3f svtools%3APushButton%3ADLG_DOCTEMPLATE%3ABTN_DOCTEMPLATE_MANAGE 3b Adds, removes, or rearranges templates or sample documents.
1b SVT_HID_TEMPLATEDLG_TB_BACK 30 Moves back to the previous window in the dialog.
13 .uno%3AInsertLabels 43 Allows you to create labels. Labels are created in a text document.
13 SW_HID_LABEL_INSERT 23 Creates a new document for editing.
24 sw%3AListBox%3ATP_LAB_LAB%3ABOX_TYPE eb Select the size format that you want to use. The available formats depend on the brand on what you selected in the Brand list. If you want to use a custom label format, select [User], and then click the Format tab to define the format.
2d sw%3AMultiLineEdit%3ATP_LAB_LAB%3AEDT_WRITING 5a Enter the text that you want to appear on the label. You can also insert a database field.
25 sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_LAB_LAB%3ABOX_ADDR 66 Creates a label with your return address. Text that is currently in the Label text box is overwritten.
27 sw%3AListBox%3ATP_LAB_LAB%3ALB_DATABASE 4b Select the database that you want to use as the data source for your label.
24 sw%3AListBox%3ATP_LAB_LAB%3ABOX_MAKE 2f Select the brand of paper that you want to use.
26 sw%3AListBox%3ATP_LAB_LAB%3ALB_DBFIELD 86 Select the database field that you want, and then click the arrow to the left of this box to insert the field into the Label text box.
29 sw%3ARadioButton%3ATP_LAB_LAB%3ABTN_SHEET 23 Prints labels on individual sheets.
28 sw%3ARadioButton%3ATP_LAB_LAB%3ABTN_CONT 22 Prints labels on continuous paper.
2a sw%3AImageButton%3ATP_LAB_LAB%3ABTN_INSERT 86 Select the database field that you want, and then click the arrow to the left of this box to insert the field into the Label text box.
e SW_HID_LAB_LAB 3f Specify the label text and choose the paper size for the label.
24 sw%3AListBox%3ATP_LAB_LAB%3ALB_TABLE 55 Select the database table containing the field(s) that you want to use in your label.
28 sw%3AMetricField%3ATP_LAB_FMT%3AFLD_LEFT a3 Displays the distance from the left edge of the page to the left edge of the first label or business card. If you are defining a custom format, enter a value here.
28 sw%3AComboBox%3ADLG_SAVE_LABEL%3ACB_MAKE 22 Enter or select the desired brand.
26 sw%3APushButton%3ATP_LAB_FMT%3APB_SAVE 30 Saves the current label or business card format.
29 sw%3AMetricField%3ATP_LAB_FMT%3AFLD_WIDTH 6f Displays the width for the label or the business card. If you are defining a custom format, enter a value here.
24 sw%3AEdit%3ADLG_SAVE_LABEL%3AED_TYPE 1d Enter or select a label type.
e SW_HID_LAB_FMT 1d Set paper formatting options.
29 sw%3AMetricField%3ATP_LAB_FMT%3AFLD_UPPER 98 Displays distance from the top edge of the page to the top of the first label or business card. If you are defining a custom format, enter a value here.
29 sw%3AMetricField%3ATP_LAB_FMT%3AFLD_VDIST c8 Displays the distance between the upper edge of a label or a business card and the upper edge of the label or the business card directly below. If you are defining a custom format, enter a value here.
2a sw%3AMetricField%3ATP_LAB_FMT%3AFLD_HEIGHT 6c Displays the height for the label or business card. If you are defining a custom format, enter a value here.
2c sw%3ANumericField%3ATP_LAB_FMT%3AFLD_COLUMNS 59 Enter the number of labels or business cards that you want to span the width of the page.
29 sw%3AMetricField%3ATP_LAB_FMT%3AFLD_HDIST 8b Displays the distance between the left edges of adjacent labels or business cards. If you are defining a custom format, enter a value here.
29 sw%3ANumericField%3ATP_LAB_FMT%3AFLD_ROWS 5a Enter the number of labels or business cards that you want to span the height of the page.
28 sw%3ANumericField%3ATP_LAB_PRT%3AFLD_COL 59 Enter the number of labels or business cards that you want to have in a row on your page.
28 sw%3ANumericField%3ATP_LAB_PRT%3AFLD_ROW 58 Enter the number of rows of labels or business cards that you want to have on your page.
2a sw%3ARadioButton%3ATP_LAB_PRT%3ABTN_SINGLE 32 Prints a single label or  business card on a page.
28 sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_LAB_PRT%3ACB_SYNCHRON af Allows you to edit a single label or business card and updates the contents of the remaining labels or business cards on the page when you click the Synchronize Labels button.
29 sw%3APushButton%3ADLG_SYNC_BTN%3ABTN_SYNC 71 Copies the contents of the top left label or business card to the remaining labels or business cards on the page.
28 sw%3ARadioButton%3ATP_LAB_PRT%3ABTN_PAGE 31 Creates a full page of  labels or business cards.
2b sw%3APushButton%3ATP_LAB_PRT%3ABTN_PRTSETUP 1f Opens the Printer Setup dialog.
e SW_HID_LAB_PRT 6f Sets additional options for your labels or business cards, including text synchronization and printer settings.
19 .uno%3AInsertBusinessCard 2a Design and create your own business cards.
1d SW_HID_BUSINESS_FMT_PAGE_CONT 2a Prints business cards on continuous paper.
1e SW_HID_BUSINESS_FMT_PAGE_SHEET 2b Prints business cards on individual sheets.
1d SW_HID_BUSINESS_FMT_PAGE_TYPE dd Select the size format that you want to use. The available formats depend on what you selected in the Brand list. If you want to use a custom size format, select [User], and then click the Format tab to define the format.
1e SW_HID_BUSINESS_FMT_PAGE_BRAND 2f Select the brand of paper that you want to use.
1c SW_HID_BUSINESS_CARD_CONTENT 67 Select a business card category in AutoText - Section box, and then click a layout in the Content list.
35 sw%3AListBox%3ATP_VISITING_CARDS%3ALB_AUTO_TEXT_GROUP 4d Select a business card category, and then click a layout in the Content list.
2b sw%3AEdit%3ATP_PRIVATE_DATA%3AED_PROFESSION 23 Enter the title of your profession.
2b sw%3AEdit%3ATP_PRIVATE_DATA%3AED_SHORTCUT_2 4b Enter the initials of the person, whom you want to use as a second contact.
27 sw%3AEdit%3ATP_PRIVATE_DATA%3AED_MOBILE 23 Enter your mobile telephone number.
27 sw%3AEdit%3ATP_PRIVATE_DATA%3AED_NAME_2 4c Enter the last name of the person, whom you want to use as a second contact.
26 sw%3AEdit%3ATP_PRIVATE_DATA%3AED_PHONE 21 Enter your home telephone number.
26 sw%3AEdit%3ATP_PRIVATE_DATA%3AED_STATE 30 Enter the name of the country in which you live.
2c sw%3AEdit%3ATP_PRIVATE_DATA%3AED_FIRSTNAME_2 4d Enter the first name of the person, whom you want to use as a second contact.
24 sw%3AEdit%3ATP_PRIVATE_DATA%3AED_WWW 2c Enter the address of your internet homepage.
25 sw%3AEdit%3ATP_BUSINESS_DATA%3AED_WWW 36 Enter the address of your company's internet homepage.
28 sw%3AEdit%3ATP_BUSINESS_DATA%3AED_MOBILE 23 Enter your mobile telephone number.
28 sw%3AEdit%3ATP_BUSINESS_DATA%3AED_SLOGAN 21 Enter the slogan of your company.
2a sw%3AEdit%3ATP_BUSINESS_DATA%3AED_COMP_EXT 21 Enter additional company details.
27 sw%3AEdit%3ATP_BUSINESS_DATA%3AED_PHONE 25 Enter your business telephone number.
27 sw%3AEdit%3ATP_BUSINESS_DATA%3AED_STATE 3d Enter the name of the country where your business is located.
49 fpicker%3AImageButton%3ADLG_SVT_EXPLORERFILE%3ABTN_EXPLORERFILE_NEWFOLDER 18 Creates a new directory.
34 svtools%3APushButton%3ADLG_SVT_QUERYDELETE%3ABTN_ALL 23 Click to delete all selected files.
1b SFX2_HID_FILEDLG_INSERT_BTN 4b Inserts the selected file into the current document at the cursor position.
18 SVT_HID_FILEOPEN_VERSION 5e If there are multiple versions of the selected file, select the version that you want to open.
19 SVT_HID_FILEOPEN_READONLY 21 Opens the file in read-only mode.
47 fpicker%3AMenuButton%3ADLG_SVT_EXPLORERFILE%3ABTN_EXPLORERFILE_STANDARD 31 Displays the files in the default user directory.
1c SVT_HID_FILEVIEW_MENU_RENAME 3f To rename a file, right-click the file, and then choose Rename.
41 fpicker%3AMenuButton%3ADLG_SVT_EXPLORERFILE%3ABTN_EXPLORERFILE_UP 61 Move up one directory in the directory hierarchy. Long-click to see the higher level directories.
20 SFX2_HID_FILEDLG_FOLDER_FILENAME 7a Enter a file name or a path for the file. You can also enter a URL that starts with the protocol name ftp, http, or https.
43 fpicker%3AListBox%3ADLG_SVT_EXPLORERFILE%3ALB_EXPLORERFILE_FILETYPE 7b Select the file type that you want to open, or select All Files (*) to display a list of all of the files in the directory.
34 svtools%3APushButton%3ADLG_SVT_QUERYDELETE%3ABTN_YES 3c Click to delete the file with the name shown in this dialog.
23 FPICKER_HID_FILEDLG_AUTOCOMPLETEBOX 7a Enter a file name or a path for the file. You can also enter a URL that starts with the protocol name ftp, http, or https.
b .uno%3AOpen 1c Abre ou importa un ficheiro.
1c SVT_HID_FILEVIEW_MENU_DELETE 3f To delete a file, right-click the file, and then choose Delete.
19 SFX2_HID_FILEDLG_STANDARD 44 Displays the files and directories in the directory that you are in.
33 svtools%3APushButton%3ADLG_SVT_QUERYDELETE%3ABTN_NO 48 Click to cancel deletion of the file with the name shown in this dialog.
18 SVT_HID_EXPLORERDLG_FILE 1c Abre ou importa un ficheiro.
19 SFX2_HID_FILEDLG_PATH_BTN 1b Selects the indicated path.
1e SFX2_HID_FILEDLG_PATH_FILENAME 27 Enter or select the path from the list.
2e uui%3AListBox%3ADLG_FILTER_SELECT%3ALB_FILTERS 3c Select the import filter for the file that you want to open.
f .uno%3ACloseDoc 38 Closes the current document without exiting the program.
b .uno%3ASave 1b Saves the current document.
19 SVT_HID_FILESAVE_FILETYPE 3c Select the file format for the document that you are saving.
21 SVT_HID_FILESAVE_DEFAULTDIRECTORY 31 Displays the files in the default user directory.
17 SVT_HID_FILESAVE_DOSAVE f Saves the file.
18 SVT_HID_FILESAVE_FILEURL 42 Enter a file name or a path for the file. You can also enter a URL
1a SVT_HID_FILESAVE_SELECTION 9a Exports only the selected graphic objects in %PRODUCTNAME Draw and Impress to another format. If this box is not checked, the entire document is exported.
18 SVT_HID_FILESAVE_LEVELUP 61 Move up one directory in the directory hierarchy. Long-click to see the higher level directories.
20 SVT_HID_FILESAVE_CUSTOMIZEFILTER 4e Allows you to set the spreadsheet saving options for some types of data files.
21 SVT_HID_FILESAVE_SAVEWITHPASSWORD 57 Protects the file with a password that must be entered before a user can open the file.
d .uno%3ASaveAs 5f Saves the current document in a different location, or with a different file name or file type.
d SID_SAVEASDOC 5f Saves the current document in a different location, or with a different file name or file type.
17 SVT_HID_FILESAVE_DIALOG 5f Saves the current document in a different location, or with a different file name or file type.
20 SVT_HID_FILESAVE_CREATEDIRECTORY 18 Creates a new directory.
19 SVT_HID_FILESAVE_FILEVIEW 44 Displays the files and directories in the directory that you are in.
f .uno%3AExportTo 5b Saves the current document with a different name and format to a location that you specify.
1c .uno%3ASetDocumentProperties 78 Displays the properties for the current file, including statistics such as word count and the date the file was created.
27 sfx2%3AEdit%3ATP_DOCINFODESC%3AED_THEMA 61 Enter a subject for the document. You can use a subject to group documents with similar contents.
27 sfx2%3AEdit%3ATP_DOCINFODESC%3AED_TITLE 1f Enter a title for the document.
2a sfx2%3AEdit%3ATP_DOCINFODESC%3AED_KEYWORDS ad Enter the words that you want to use to index the content of your document. Keywords must be separated by commas. A keyword can contain white space characters or semicolons.
32 sfx2%3AMultiLineEdit%3ATP_DOCINFODESC%3AED_COMMENT 2d Enter comments to help identify the document.
14 SFX2_HID_DOCINFODESC 34 Contains descriptive information about the document.
2e sfx2%3APushButton%3ATP_DOCINFODOC%3ABTN_DELETE a3 Resets the editing time to zero, the creation date to the current date and time, and the version number to 1. The modification and printing dates are also deleted.
2a sfx2%3AEdit%3ATP_DOCINFODOC%3AED_FILE_NAME 17 Displays the file name.
31 sfx2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_DOCINFODOC%3ACB_USE_USERDATA 92 Saves the user's full name with the file. You can edit the name by choosing %PRODUCTNAME - PreferencesTools - Options - $[officename] - User Data.
13 SFX2_HID_DOCINFODOC 32 Contains basic information about the current file.
31 sfx2%3APushButton%3ATP_CUSTOMPROPERTIES%3ABTN_ADD 2e Click to add a new row to the Properties list.
1e SFX2_HID_CTRL_CUSTOMPROPERTIES ae Enter your custom contents. You can change the name, type, and contents of each row. You can add or remove rows. The items will be exported as metadata to other file formats.
27 sfx2%3AEdit%3ATP_DOCINFOUSER%3AED_INFO1 ae Enter your custom contents. You can change the name, type, and contents of each row. You can add or remove rows. The items will be exported as metadata to other file formats.
14 SFX2_HID_DOCINFOUSER 40 Allows you to assign custom information fields to your document.
27 sfx2%3AEdit%3ATP_DOCINFOUSER%3AED_INFO4 ae Enter your custom contents. You can change the name, type, and contents of each row. You can add or remove rows. The items will be exported as metadata to other file formats.
27 sfx2%3AEdit%3ATP_DOCINFOUSER%3AED_INFO3 ae Enter your custom contents. You can change the name, type, and contents of each row. You can add or remove rows. The items will be exported as metadata to other file formats.
27 sfx2%3AEdit%3ATP_DOCINFOUSER%3AED_INFO2 ae Enter your custom contents. You can change the name, type, and contents of each row. You can add or remove rows. The items will be exported as metadata to other file formats.
f SW_HID_DOC_STAT 29 Displays statistics for the current file.
1e sc%3ATabPage%3ARID_SCPAGE_STAT 29 Displays statistics for the current file.
16 SFX2_HID_DOCINFORELOAD 37 Sets the refresh and redirect options for an HTML page.
32 sfx2%3ANumericField%3ATP_DOCINFORELOAD%3AED_RELOAD 40 Enter the number of seconds to wait before the page is reloaded.
33 sfx2%3APushButton%3ATP_DOCINFORELOAD%3APB_BROWSEURL 3b Locate the file that you want to open, and then click Open.
37 sfx2%3ARadioButton%3ATP_DOCINFORELOAD%3ARB_NOAUTOUPDATE 24 User must refresh the page manually.
38 sfx2%3ARadioButton%3ATP_DOCINFORELOAD%3ARB_FORWARDUPDATE 5c Loads a page that you specify after the number of seconds that you enter in the seconds box.
27 sfx2%3AEdit%3ATP_DOCINFORELOAD%3AED_URL 38 Enter the URL address of the file that you want to open.
33 sfx2%3ANumericField%3ATP_DOCINFORELOAD%3AED_FORWARD 57 Enter the number of seconds to wait before redirecting the browser to a different file.
2d sfx2%3AComboBox%3ATP_DOCINFORELOAD%3ACB_FRAME 6f If the current HTML page uses frames, select the name of the target frame where you want the file to be loaded.
37 sfx2%3ARadioButton%3ATP_DOCINFORELOAD%3ARB_RELOADUPDATE 87 Reloads the HTML page after the number of seconds that you enter in the seconds box. To observe the result, open the page in a browser.
28 HID_SECURITYTAB_CONFIRM_PASSWORD_TO_OPEN 16 Re-enter the password.
2a HID_SECURITYTAB_CONFIRM_PASSWORD_TO_MODIFY 16 Re-enter the password.
1f SFX2_HID_SECURITYTAB_PROTECTION d7 Protects the change recording state with a password. If change recording is protected for the current document, the button is named Unprotect. Click Unprotect and type the correct password to disable the protection.
22 HID_SECURITYTAB_PASSWORD_TO_MODIFY 2e Type a password. A password is case sensitive.
30 HID_DLG_PASSWORD_TO_OPEN_MODIFY_PASSWORD_TO_OPEN 2e Type a password. A password is case sensitive.
3a HID_DLG_PASSWORD_TO_OPEN_MODIFY_CONFIRM_PASSWORD_TO_MODIFY 16 Re-enter the password.
23 SFX2_HID_SECURITYTAB_RECORD_CHANGES 50 Select to enable recording changes. This is the same as Edit - Changes - Record.
38 HID_DLG_PASSWORD_TO_OPEN_MODIFY_CONFIRM_PASSWORD_TO_OPEN 16 Re-enter the password.
2d HID_DLG_PASSWORD_TO_OPEN_MODIFY_FILE_READONLY 42 Select to allow this document to be opened in read-only mode only.
20 HID_SECURITYTAB_PASSWORD_TO_OPEN 2e Type a password. A password is case sensitive.
32 HID_DLG_PASSWORD_TO_OPEN_MODIFY_PASSWORD_TO_MODIFY 2e Type a password. A password is case sensitive.
27 SFX2_HID_SECURITYTAB_OPEN_FILE_READONLY 42 Select to allow this document to be opened in read-only mode only.
13 .uno%3ATemplateMenu 5a Lets you organize and edit your templates, as well as save the current file as a template.
17 SFX2_HID_ORGANIZE_PRINT 47 Prints the name and properties of the styles that are used in the file.
1f SFX2_HID_ORGANIZE_PRINTER_SETUP 3f Changes the printer and its settings for the selected document.
2b sfx2%3AMenuButton%3ADLG_ORGANIZE%3ABTN_EDIT 48 Contains commands for managing and editing your templates and documents.
18 SFX2_HID_ORGANIZE_DELETE 1e Deletes the current selection.
1b SFX2_HID_ORGANIZE_COPY_FROM 96 Imports an additional template. To import a template, select a template folder in the list, click the Command button, and then select Import template.
2c sfx2%3APushButton%3ADLG_ORGANIZE%3ABTN_FILES 4d Locate a file that you want to add to the document list, and then click Open.
19 SFX2_HID_ORGANIZE_COPY_TO 1e Exports the selected template.
2b sfx2%3AListBox%3ADLG_ORGANIZE%3ALB_LEFT_TYP 5a Select Templates or Documents to change the contents that are displayed in the list above.
1b SFX2_HID_CTL_ORGANIZER_LEFT 9d Displays the available template categories or opened $[officename] files. To change the contents of the list, select Templates or Documents in the box below.
15 SFX2_HID_ORGANIZE_NEW 20 Creates a new template category.
2c sfx2%3AListBox%3ADLG_ORGANIZE%3ALB_RIGHT_TYP 5a Select Templates or Documents to change the contents that are displayed in the list above.
21 SFX2_HID_ORGANIZE_STDTEMPLATE_DEL 5c Select a $[officename] document type to reset the default template to the original template.
16 SFX2_HID_ORGANIZE_EDIT 28 Opens the selected template for editing.
1c SFX2_HID_CTL_ORGANIZER_RIGHT 9d Displays the available template categories or opened $[officename] files. To change the contents of the list, select Templates or Documents in the box below.
10 .uno%3AOrganizer 63 Opens the Template Management dialog where you can organize templates and define default templates.
36 sfx2%3APushButton%3ADLG_ORGANIZE%3ABTN_ADDRESSTEMPLATE 4d Locate a file that you want to add to the document list, and then click Open.
18 SFX2_HID_ORGANIZE_RESCAN 22 Updates the contents of the lists.
21 SFX2_HID_ORGANIZE_STDTEMPLATE_ADD 71 Uses the selected template as the default template when you create a new $[officename] document of the same type.
22 SVT_HID_ADDRTEMPL_FIELD_ASSIGNMENT 4e Select the field in the data table that corresponds to the address book entry.
35 svtools%3AComboBox%3ADLG_ADDRESSBOOKSOURCE%3ACB_TABLE 2c Select the data table for your address book.
49 svtools%3APushButton%3ADLG_ADDRESSBOOKSOURCE%3APB_ADMINISTATE_DATASOURCES 36 Add a new data source to the Address Book Source list.
3a svtools%3AComboBox%3ADLG_ADDRESSBOOKSOURCE%3ACB_DATASOURCE 2d Select the data source for your address book.
18 .uno%3AAddressBookSource 45 Edit the field assignments and the data source for your address book.
2e sfx2%3APushButton%3ADLG_DOC_TEMPLATE%3ABT_EDIT 28 Opens the selected template for editing.
28 sfx2%3AEdit%3ADLG_DOC_TEMPLATE%3AED_NAME 1e Enter a name for the template.
15 .uno%3ASaveAsTemplate 29 Saves the current document as a template.
2e sfx2%3AListBox%3ADLG_DOC_TEMPLATE%3ALB_SECTION 34 Select a category in which to save the new template.
32 sfx2%3APushButton%3ADLG_DOC_TEMPLATE%3ABT_ORGANIZE 54 Opens the Template Management dialog where you can organize or create new templates.
32 sfx2%3AListBox%3ADLG_DOC_TEMPLATE%3ALB_STYLESHEETS 28 Lists the available template categories.
13 .uno%3AOpenTemplate 3b Opens a dialog where you can select a template for editing.
32 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3AJobPage%3AProperties 6a Opens the printer properties dialog. The printer properties vary according to the printer that you select.
35 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3ASlidesPerPage%3AListBox 29 Select how many slides to print per page.
38 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3AIsPrintDateTime%3ACheckBox 35 Specifies whether to print the current date and time.
33 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3AJobPage%3APrinterList f9 The list box shows the installed printers. Click the printer to use for the current print job. Click the Printer details button to see some information about the selected printer. Click the Properties button to change some of the printer properties.
36 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3AIsPrintHidden%3ACheckBox 3f Specifies whether to print the pages that are currently hidden.
32 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3AOptPage%3ASingleJobs 68 Check to not rely on the printer to create collated copies but create a print job for each copy instead.
3c .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintContent%3ARadioButton%3A2 46 Prints only the selected area(s) or object(s) in the current document.
3a .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3ASlidesPerPageOrder%3AListBox 32 Specify how to arrange slides on the printed page.
3c .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintContent%3ARadioButton%3A1 42 Prints only the pages or slides that you specify in the Pages box.
3b .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APageOptions%3ARadioButton%3A1 44 Specifies that you do not want to further scale pages when printing.
2f .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3ANUpPage%3ARowsBox 16 Select number of rows.
20 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3AOK 83 Prints the current document, selection, or the pages that you specify. You can also set the print options for the current document.
3c .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintProspectInclude%3AListBox 2a Select which pages of a brochure to print.
30 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3ANUpPage%3AOrderBox 2e Select order in which pages are to be printed.
37 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3AQuality%3ARadioButton%3A2 2d Specifies to print colors as black and white.
2e .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3AJobPage%3ACopies 32 Enter the number of copies that you want to print.
35 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3ANUpPage%3APageMarginBox 3e Select margin between individual pages on each sheet of paper.
3b .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintFormat%3ARadioButton%3A0 3b Prints the formula without adjusting the current font size.
35 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3ANUpPage%3APagesPerSheet 28 Print multiple pages per sheet of paper.
2f .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3ABorder%3ACheckBox 3a Applies a thin border to the formula area in the printout.
3c .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintPageBackground%3ACheckBox 7b Specifies whether to print colors and objects that are inserted to the background of the page (Format - Page - Background).
38 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintBlackFonts%3ACheckBox 30 Specifies whether to always print text in black.
3c .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintPaperFromSetup%3ACheckBox 86 For printers with multiple trays this option specifies whether the paper tray used is specified by the system settings of the printer.
3d .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintTextPlaceholder%3ACheckBox 78 Enable this option to print text placeholders. Disable this option to leave the text placeholders blank in the printout.
36 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintProspect%3ACheckBox 44 Select the Brochure option to print the document in brochure format.
34 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3AIsPrintName%3ACheckBox 37 Specifies whether to print the page name of a document.
38 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintHiddenText%3ACheckBox 3a Enable this option to print text that is marked as hidden.
3b .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APageOptions%3ARadioButton%3A3 a8 Specifies that pages are to be printed in tiled format. If the pages or slides are smaller than the paper, several pages or slides will be printed on one page of paper.
c HID_PRINTDLG 83 Prints the current document, selection, or the pages that you specify. You can also set the print options for the current document.
2f .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3AJobPage%3ACollate 32 Preserves the page order of the original document.
38 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintEmptyPages%3ACheckBox 182 If this option is enabled automatically inserted blank pages are printed. This is best if you are printing double-sided. For example, in a book, a "chapter" paragraph style has been set to always start with an odd numbered page. If the previous chapter ends on an odd page, %PRODUCTNAME inserts an even numbered blank page. This option controls whether to print that even numbered page.
32 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3ANUpPage%3AColumnsBox 19 Select number of columns.
3c .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3AIsIncludeEmptyPages%3ACheckBox 52 If checked empty pages that have no cell contents or draw objects are not printed.
40 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintPicturesAndObjects%3ACheckBox 5d Specifies whether the graphics and drawings or OLE objects of your text document are printed.
31 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3ANUpPage%3ABorderBox 28 Check to draw a border around each page.
3b .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APageOptions%3ARadioButton%3A0 2c Specify how to scale slides in the printout.
36 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintControls%3ACheckBox 4b Specifies whether the form control fields of the text document are printed.
38 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3ANUpPage%3APagesPerSheetBox 32 Select how many pages to print per sheet of paper.
37 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3AQuality%3ARadioButton%3A1 27 Specifies to print colors as grayscale.
2e .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APageRange%3AEdit c3 To print a range of pages, use a format like 3-6. To print single pages, use a format like 7;9;11. You can print a combination of page ranges and single pages, by using a format like 3-6;8;10;12.
3b .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintFormat%3ARadioButton%3A1 3c Adjusts the formula to the page format used in the printout.
31 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3ATitleRow%3ACheckBox 53 Specifies whether you want the name of the document to be included in the printout.
36 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3ANUpPage%3AOrientationBox 24 Select the orientation of the paper.
37 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3AQuality%3ARadioButton%3A0 26 Specifies to print in original colors.
c .uno%3APrint 83 Prints the current document, selection, or the pages that you specify. You can also set the print options for the current document.
3b .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APageOptions%3ARadioButton%3A2 83 Specifies whether to scale down objects that are beyond the margins of the current printer so they fit on the paper in the printer.
3b .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintAnnotationMode%3AListBox 29 Specify where to print comments (if any).
3c .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintContent%3ARadioButton%3A0 1b Prints the entire document.
31 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3AOptPage%3AToReverse 26 Check to print pages in reverse order.
37 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintScale%3ANumericField 4a Reduces or enlarges the size of the printed formula by a specified factor.
3d .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintAnnotationMode%3AFixedText 29 Specify where to print comments (if any).
34 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3AFormulaText%3ACheckBox 5f Specifies whether to include the contents of the Commands window at the bottom of the printout.
3b .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintFormat%3ARadioButton%3A2 4a Reduces or enlarges the size of the printed formula by a specified factor.
38 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintProspectRTL%3AListBox 5e For brochure printing, you can select a left-to-right order of pages or a right-to-left order.
36 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3ANUpPage%3ASheetMarginBox 37 Select margin between the printed pages and paper edge.
2e .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3AOptPage%3AToFile 29 Prints to a file instead of to a printer.
3b .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintLeftRightPages%3AListBox 2d Specify which pages to include in the output.
32 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3AJobPage%3ADetailsBtn 37 Show/Hide detailed information of the selected printer.
37 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APageContentType%3AListBox 35 Select which parts of the document should be printed.
32 svtools%3AModalDialog%3ADLG_SVT_PRNDLG_PRNSETUPDLG 34 Select the default printer for the current document.
13 .uno%3APrinterSetup 34 Select the default printer for the current document.
39 svtools%3AListBox%3ADLG_SVT_PRNDLG_PRNSETUPDLG%3ALB_NAMES 7a Lists the installed printers on your operating system. To change the default printer, select a printer name from the list.
42 svtools%3APushButton%3ADLG_SVT_PRNDLG_PRNSETUPDLG%3ABTN_PROPERTIES 4f Changes the printer settings of your operating system for the current document.
16 .uno%3ASendMailDocAsMS 80 Opens a new window in your default e-mail program with the current document as an attachment. The Microsoft file format is used.
11 .uno%3ASendToMenu 3f Sends a copy of the current document to different applications.
17 .uno%3ASendMailDocAsOOo 83 Opens a new window in your default e-mail program with the current document as an attachment. The OpenDocument file format is used.
f .uno%3ASendMail 7e Opens a new window in your default e-mail program with the current document as an attachment. The current file format is used.
28 SW_HID_SEND_MASTER_CTRL_CONTROL_FILEVIEW 74 Select the paragraph style or outline level that you want to use to separate the source document into sub-documents.
13 .uno%3ANewGlobalDoc b1 Creates a master document from the current Writer document. A new sub-document is created at each occurrence of a chosen paragraph style or outline level in the source document.
28 SW_HID_SEND_MASTER_CTRL_LISTBOX_TEMPLATE 74 Select the paragraph style or outline level that you want to use to separate the source document into sub-documents.
19 SVT_HID_FILESAVE_TEMPLATE 74 Select the paragraph style or outline level that you want to use to separate the source document into sub-documents.
24 SW_HID_SEND_MASTER_CTRL_EDIT_FILEURL 74 Select the paragraph style or outline level that you want to use to separate the source document into sub-documents.
b .uno%3AQuit 47 Closes all $[officename] programs and prompts you to save your changes.
e .uno%3ASaveAll 2b Saves all modified $[officename] documents.
14 .uno%3AVersionDialog 89 Saves and organizes multiple versions of the current document in the same file. You can also open, delete, and compare previous versions.
2c sfx2%3APushButton%3ADLG_VERSIONS%3APB_DELETE 1d Deletes the selected version.
21 sfx2%3AModalDialog%3ADLG_VERSIONS 85 Lists the existing versions of the current document, the date and the time they were created, the author and the associated comments.
2a sfx2%3APushButton%3ADLG_VERSIONS%3APB_OPEN 31 Opens the selected version in a read-only window.
2d sfx2%3APushButton%3ADLG_VERSIONS%3APB_COMPARE 33 Compare the changes that were made in each version.
31 sfx2%3AMultiLineEdit%3ADLG_COMMENTS%3AME_VERSIONS 7d Enter a comment here when you are saving a new version. If you clicked Show to open this dialog, you cannot edit the comment.
2f sfx2%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_VERSIONS%3ACB_SAVEONCLOSE 77 If you have made changes to your document, $[officename] automatically saves a new version when you close the document.
2a sfx2%3APushButton%3ADLG_VERSIONS%3APB_SAVE a8 Saves the current state of the document as a new version. If you want, you can also enter comments in the Insert Version Comment dialog before you save the new version.
2a sfx2%3APushButton%3ADLG_VERSIONS%3APB_VIEW 35 Displays the entire comment for the selected version.
15 .uno%3ARecentFileList 51 Lists the most recently opened files. To open a file in the list, click its name.
14 SVX_HID_IMAPDLG_UNDO a1 Reverses the last command or the last entry you typed. To select the command that you want to reverse, click the arrow next to the Undo icon on the Standard bar.
b .uno%3AUndo a1 Reverses the last command or the last entry you typed. To select the command that you want to reverse, click the arrow next to the Undo icon on the Standard bar.
b .uno%3ARedo 9a Reverses the action of the last Undo command. To select the Undo step that you want to reverse, click the arrow next to the Redo icon on the Standard bar.
14 SVX_HID_IMAPDLG_REDO 9a Reverses the action of the last Undo command. To select the Undo step that you want to reverse, click the arrow next to the Redo icon on the Standard bar.
d .uno%3ARepeat 47 Repeats the last command. This command is available in Writer and Calc.
13 .uno%3ARepeatAction 47 Repeats the last command. This command is available in Writer and Calc.
a .uno%3ACut 32 Removes and copies the selection to the clipboard.
b .uno%3ACopy 26 Copies the selection to the clipboard.
c .uno%3APaste 6f Inserts the contents of the clipboard at the location of the cursor, and replaces any selected text or objects.
17 SC_HID_SC_REPLCELLSWARN 6f Inserts the contents of the clipboard at the location of the cursor, and replaces any selected text or objects.
15 .uno%3AInsertContents 0 
30 sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_INSNOTES 0 
32 sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_INSOBJECTS 0 
32 sc%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_MV_DOWN 0 
31 sc%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_OP_DIV 0 
30 sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_INSATTRS 0 
33 sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_INSDATETIME 0 
32 sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_INSSTRINGS 0 
32 sc%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_MV_NONE 0 
13 .uno%3APasteSpecial 5d Inserts the contents of the clipboard into the current file in a format that you can specify.
32 sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_SKIP_EMPTY 0 
11 CUI_HID_PASTE_DLG 2e Displays the source of the clipboard contents.
31 sc%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_OP_ADD 0 
15 .uno%3APasteClipboard 5d Inserts the contents of the clipboard into the current file in a format that you can specify.
30 cui%3AListBox%3AMD_PASTE_OBJECT%3ALB_INSERT_LIST 42 Select a format for the clipboard contents that you want to paste.
33 sc%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_MV_RIGHT 0 
31 sc%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_OP_MUL 0 
32 sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_INSNUMBERS 0 
32 sc%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_OP_NOOP 0 
31 sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_TRANSPOSE 0 
31 sc%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_OP_SUB 0 
2c sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_LINK 0 
33 sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_INSFORMULAS 0 
2e sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_INSALL 0 
10 .uno%3ASelectAll 46 Selects the entire content of the current file, frame, or text object.
d .uno%3ASelect 46 Selects the entire content of the current file, frame, or text object.
2e svx%3AComboBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3AED_SEARCH 56 Enter the text that you want to search for, or select a previous search from the list.
34 svx%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3ALB_CALC_SEARCHIN 9b Searches for the characters that you specify in formulas and in fixed (not calculated) values. For example, you could look for formulas that contain 'SUM'.
2e svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3ACB_REGEXP 2b Allows you to use wildcards in your search.
34 svx%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3ARB_CALC_ROWS 2c Searches from left to right across the rows.
2f svx%3AMoreButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3ABTN_MORE 60 Shows more or fewer search options. Click this button again to hide the extended search options.
39 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCHFORM%3ACB_HALFFULLFORMS 40 Distinguishes between half-width and full-width character forms.
32 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3ACB_ALL_SHEETS 43 Searches through all of the sheets in the current spreadsheet file.
31 svx%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3ABTN_SEARCH 63 Finds and selects the next occurrence of the text or format that you searching for in the document.
35 svx%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3ABTN_SEARCH_ALL 89 Finds and selects all instances of the text or the format that you are searching for in the document (only in Writer and Calc documents).
f .uno%3AFindText 50 Type the text to search in the current document. Press Enter to search the text.
17 .uno%3ASearchProperties 41 Searches for or replaces text or formats in the current document.
11 .uno%3ADownSearch 3a Click to search the next occurrence in downward direction.
39 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCHFORM%3ACB_SOUNDSLIKECJK a2 Lets you specify the search options for similar notation used in Japanese text. Select this checkbox, and then click the ... button to specify the search options.
36 svx%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3ABTN_REPLACE_ALL 4f Replaces all of the occurrences of the text or format that you want to replace.
41 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3ACB_JAP_MATCH_FULL_HALF_WIDTH 40 Distinguishes between half-width and full-width character forms.
2d SVX%3ALISTBOX%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3ALB_SEARCH 56 Enter the text that you want to search for, or select a previous search from the list.
40 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCHFORM%3APB_SOUNDSLIKESETTINGS 43 Sets the search options for similar notation used in Japanese text.
32 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3ACB_SELECTIONS 29 Searches only the selected text or cells.
31 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3ACB_BACKWARDS 5d Search starts at the current cursor position and goes backwards to the beginning of the file.
13 .uno%3ASearchDialog 41 Searches for or replaces text or formats in the current document.
2f svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3ACB_LAYOUTS cf Searches for text formatted with the style that you specify. Select this checkbox, and then select a style from the Search for list. To specify a replacement style, select a style from the Replace with list.
2f svx%3AComboBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3AED_REPLACE 57 Enter the replacement text, or select a recent replacement text or style from the list.
37 svx%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3ARB_CALC_COLUMNS 30 Searches from top to bottom through the columns.
33 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3ACB_WHOLE_WORDS 48 Searches for whole words or cells that are identical to the search text.
32 svx%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3ABTN_REPLACE 66 Replaces the selected text or format that you searched for, and then searches for the next occurrence.
33 svx%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3ABTN_NOFORMAT 7b Click in the Search for or the Replace with box, and then click this button to remove the search criteria based on formats.
37 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3ACB_JAP_SOUNDS_LIKE a2 Lets you specify the search options for similar notation used in Japanese text. Select this checkbox, and then click the ... button to specify the search options.
28 svx_ComboBox_RID_SVXDLG_SEARCH_ED_SEARCH 56 Enter the text that you want to search for, or select a previous search from the list.
f .uno%3AUpSearch 38 Click to search the next occurrence in upward direction.
2e svx%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3ALB_REPLACE 57 Enter the replacement text, or select a recent replacement text or style from the list.
32 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3ACB_MATCH_CASE 39 Distinguishes between uppercase and lowercase characters.
35 svx%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3APB_JAP_OPTIONS 43 Sets the search options for similar notation used in Japanese text.
3b cui%3ANumericField%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCHSIMILARITY%3ANF_OTHER 48 Enter the number of characters in the search term that can be exchanged.
3d cui%3ANumericField%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCHSIMILARITY%3ANF_SHORTER 53 Enter the number of characters by which a word can be shorter than the search term.
37 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCHSIMILARITY%3ACB_RELAX 53 Searches for a term that matches any combination of the similarity search settings.
34 svx%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3APB_SIMILARITY 2a Set the options for the similarity search.
1d CUI_HID_SEARCH_APPROXSETTINGS 89 Find terms that are similar to the Search for text. Select this checkbox, and then click the ... button to define the similarity options.
3c cui%3ANumericField%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCHSIMILARITY%3ANF_LONGER 6e Enter the maximum number of characters by which a word can exceed the number of characters in the search term.
15 CUI_HID_SEARCH_APPROX 89 Find terms that are similar to the Search for text. Select this checkbox, and then click the ... button to define the similarity options.
32 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3ACB_SIMILARITY 89 Find terms that are similar to the Search for text. Select this checkbox, and then click the ... button to define the similarity options.
1b CUI_HID_SEARCHATTR_CTL_ATTR 32 Select the attributes that you want to search for.
12 CUI_HID_SEARCHATTR 32 Select the attributes that you want to search for.
34 svx%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3ABTN_ATTRIBUTE 122 Choose the text attributes that you want to search for. For example, if you search for the Font attribute, all instances of text that do not use the default font are found. All text that has a directly coded font attribute, and all text where a style switches the font attribute, are found.
31 svx%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3ABTN_FORMAT 69 Finds specific text formatting features, such as font types, font effects, and text flow characteristics.
11 SW_HID_NAVI_TBX18 b8 Edit the contents of the component selected in the Navigator list. If the selection is a file, the file is opened for editing. If the selection is an index, the index dialog is opened.
1c SW_HID_GLBLTREE_INS_NEW_FILE 27 Creates and inserts a new sub-document.
16 SW_HID_GLBLTREE_UPDATE 36 Click and choose the contents that you want to update.
16 SW_HID_GLBLTREEUPD_ALL 15 Updates all contents.
11 SW_HID_NAVI_TBX19 36 Click and choose the contents that you want to update.
18 SW_HID_GLBLTREE_INS_TEXT 90 Inserts a new paragraph in the master document where you can enter text. You cannot insert text next to an existing text entry in the Navigator.
19 SW_HID_GLBLTREE_EDIT_LINK 32 Changes the link properties for the selected file.
17 SW_HID_GLBLTREE_INS_IDX 29 Insire un índice no documento principal.
18 SW_HID_GLBLTREE_UPD_LINK 12 Updates all links.
13 SW_HID_GLBLTREE_DEL 2e Deletes the selection from the Navigator list.
11 SW_HID_NAVI_TBX20 45 Inserts a file, an index, or a new document into the master document.
11 SW_HID_NAVI_TBX21 a7 Saves a copy of the contents of the linked files in the master document. This ensures that the current contents are available when the linked files cannot be accessed.
17 SW_HID_GLBLTREE_UPD_IDX 14 Updates all indexes.
11 SW_HID_NAVI_TBX23 3c Moves the selection down one position in the Navigator list.
1e SW_HID_NAVIGATOR_GLOB_TREELIST b8 The Navigator lists the main components of the master document. If you rest the mouse pointer over a name of a sub-document in the list, the full path of the sub-document is displayed.
11 SW_HID_NAVI_TBX22 3a Moves the selection up one position in the Navigator list.
18 SW_HID_GLBLTREE_INS_FILE 3c Inserts one or more existing files into the master document.
14 SW_HID_GLBLTREE_EDIT b8 Edit the contents of the component selected in the Navigator list. If the selection is a file, the file is opened for editing. If the selection is an index, the index dialog is opened.
16 SW_HID_GLBLTREE_INSERT 45 Inserts a file, an index, or a new document into the master document.
17 SW_HID_GLBLTREE_UPD_SEL 26 Updates the contents of the selection.
36 cui%3APushButton%3AMD_UPDATE_BASELINKS%3APB_UPDATE_NOW 7a Updates the selected link so that the most recently saved version of the linked file is displayed in the current document.
33 cui%3ARadioButton%3AMD_UPDATE_BASELINKS%3ARB_MANUAL 37 Only updates the link when you click the Update button.
12 .uno%3AManageLinks c6 Lets you edit the properties of each link in the current document, including the path to the source file. This command is not available if the current document does not contain links to other files.
36 cui%3APushButton%3AMD_UPDATE_BASELINKS%3APB_BREAK_LINK 99 Breaks the link between the source file and the current document. The most recently updated contents of the source file are kept in the current document.
36 cui%3ARadioButton%3AMD_UPDATE_BASELINKS%3ARB_AUTOMATIC d1 Automatically updates the contents of the link when you open the file. Any changes made in the source file are then displayed in the file containing the link. Linked graphic files can only be updated manually.
10 .uno%3AEditLinks c6 Lets you edit the properties of each link in the current document, including the path to the source file. This command is not available if the current document does not contain links to other files.
11 .uno%3ALinkDialog c6 Lets you edit the properties of each link in the current document, including the path to the source file. This command is not available if the current document does not contain links to other files.
15 CUI_HID_LINKDLG_TABLB 68 Double-click a link in the list to open a file dialog where you can select another object for this link.
39 cui%3APushButton%3AMD_UPDATE_BASELINKS%3APB_CHANGE_SOURCE 2d Change the source file for the selected link.
14 .uno%3APlugInsActive 124 Allows you to edit plug-ins in your file. Choose this command to enable or disable this feature. When enabled, a check mark appears beside this command, and you find commands to edit the plug-in in its context menu. When disabled, you find commands to control the plug-in in its context menu.
13 .uno%3AOriginalSize 28 Resizes the object to the original size.
12 .uno%3AObjectMenue 60 Lets you edit a selected object in your file that you inserted with the Insert - Object command.
33 cui%3AEdit%3AMD_INSERT_OBJECT_IFRAME%3AED_FRAMENAME 7b Enter a name for the floating frame. The name cannot contain spaces, special characters, or begin with an underscore ( _ ).
3d cui%3ARadioButton%3AMD_INSERT_OBJECT_IFRAME%3ARB_FRMBORDER_ON 2a Displays the border of the floating frame.
3e cui%3ARadioButton%3AMD_INSERT_OBJECT_IFRAME%3ARB_FRMBORDER_OFF 27 Hides the border of the floating frame.
41 cui%3ACheckBox%3AMD_INSERT_OBJECT_IFRAME%3ACB_MARGINHEIGHTDEFAULT 1c Applies the default spacing.
3c cui%3ARadioButton%3AMD_INSERT_OBJECT_IFRAME%3ARB_SCROLLINGON 2e Displays the scrollbar for the floating frame.
3d cui%3ARadioButton%3AMD_INSERT_OBJECT_IFRAME%3ARB_SCROLLINGOFF 2b Hides the scrollbar for the floating frame.
3e cui%3ANumericField%3AMD_INSERT_OBJECT_IFRAME%3ANM_MARGINHEIGHT dc Enter the amount of vertical space that you want to leave between the top and bottom edges of the floating frame and the contents of the frame. Both documents inside and outside the floating frame must be HTML documents.
3e cui%3ARadioButton%3AMD_INSERT_OBJECT_IFRAME%3ARB_SCROLLINGAUTO 59 Mark this option if the currently active floating frame can have a scrollbar when needed.
38 cui%3APushButton%3AMD_INSERT_OBJECT_IFRAME%3ABT_FILEOPEN 5d Locate the file that you want to display in the selected floating frame, and then click Open.
3d cui%3ANumericField%3AMD_INSERT_OBJECT_IFRAME%3ANM_MARGINWIDTH e2 Enter the amount of horizontal space that you want to leave between the right and the left edges of the floating frame and the contents of the frame. Both documents inside and outside the floating frame must be HTML documents.
2d cui%3AEdit%3AMD_INSERT_OBJECT_IFRAME%3AED_URL a7 Enter the path and the name of the file that you want to display in the floating frame. You can also click the ... button and locate the file that you want to display.
2a svx%3AComboBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_IMAP%3ACBB_URL 55 Enter the URL for the file that you want to open when you click the selected hotspot.
15 SVX_HID_IMAPDLG_APPLY 33 Applies the changes that you made to the image map.
18 SVX_HID_IMAPDLG_PROPERTY 3c Allows you to define the properties of the selected hotspot.
14 SVX_HID_IMAPDLG_OPEN 5b Loads an existing image map in the MAP-CERN, MAP-NCSA or SIP StarView ImageMap file format.
16 SVX_HID_IMAPDLG_CIRCLE b3 Draws an elliptical hotspot where you drag in the graphic. After, you can enter the Address and the Text for the hotspot, and then select the Frame where you want the URL to open.
16 SVX_HID_IMAPDLG_SELECT 2f Selects a hotspot in the image map for editing.
27 svx%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXDLG_IMAP%3AEDT_TEXT 59 Enter the text that you want to display when the mouse rests on the hotspot in a browser.
1a SVX_HID_IMAPDLG_POLYDELETE 22 Deletes the selected anchor point.
15 SVX_HID_IMAPDLG_MACRO 53 Lets you assign a macro that runs when you click the selected hotspot in a browser.
1a SVX_HID_IMAPDLG_POLYINSERT 43 Adds an anchor point where you click on the outline of the hotspot.
18 SVX_HID_IMAPDLG_GRAPHWND 0 
14 SVX_HID_IMAPDLG_RECT b3 Draws a rectangular hotspot where you drag in the graphic. After, you can enter the Address and the Text for the hotspot, and then select the Frame where you want the URL to open.
16 SVX_HID_IMAPDLG_ACTIVE 5e Disables or enables the hyperlink for the selected hotspot. A disabled hotspot is transparent.
18 SVX_HID_IMAPDLG_POLYEDIT 4f Lets you change the shape of the selected hotspot by editing the anchor points.
15 .uno%3AImageMapDialog 93 Allows you to attach URLs to specific areas, called hotspots, on a graphic or a group of graphics. An image map is a group of one or more hotspots.
16 SVX_HID_IMAPDLG_SAVEAS 53 Saves the image map in the MAP-CERN, MAP-NCSA or SIP StarView ImageMap file format.
18 SVX_HID_IMAPDLG_POLYMOVE 43 Lets you move the individual anchor points of the selected hotspot.
14 SVX_HID_IMAPDLG_POLY 1bb Draws a polygonal hotspot in the graphic. Click this icon, drag in the graphic, and then click to define one side of the polygon. Move to where you want to place the end of the next side, and then click. Repeat until you have drawn all of the sides of the polygon. When you are finished, double-click to close the polygon. After, you can enter the Address and the Text for the hotspot, and then select the Frame where you want the URL to open.
18 SVX_HID_IMAPDLG_FREEPOLY 122 Draws a hotspot that is based on a freeform polygon. Click this icon and move to where you want to draw the hotspot. Drag a freeform line and release to close the shape. After, you can enter the Address and the Text for the hotspot, and then select the Frame where you want the URL to open.
29 SVX%3AEDIT%3ARID_SVXDLG_IMAPURL%3AEDT_URL 55 Enter the URL for the file that you want to open when you click the selected hotspot.
34 SVX_MULTILINEEDIT_RID_SVXDLG_IMAPURL_EDT_DESCRIPTION 24 Enter a description for the hotspot.
26 SVX%3AMODALDIALOG%3ARID_SVXDLG_IMAPURL 2e Lists the properties for the selected hotspot.
2a SVX%3AEDIT%3ARID_SVXDLG_IMAPURL%3AEDT_NAME 1b Enter a name for the image.
31 SVX%3ACOMBOBOX%3ARID_SVXDLG_IMAPURL%3ACBB_TARGETS a0 Enter the name of the target frame that you want to open the URL in. You can also select a standard frame name that is recognized by all browsers from the list.
34 SVX%3AEDIT%3ARID_SVXDLG_IMAPURL%3AEDT_URLDESCRIPTION 59 Enter the text that you want to display when the mouse rests on the hotspot in a browser.
12 .uno%3AChangesMenu 48 Lists the commands that are available for tracking changes in your file.
16 .uno%3ATraceChangeMode 4b Tracks each change that is made in the current document by author and date.
13 .uno%3ATrackChanges 4b Tracks each change that is made in the current document by author and date.
1d .uno%3AProtectTraceChangeMode 87 Prevents a user from deactivating the record changes feature, or from accepting or rejecting changes unless the user enters a password.
12 SC_HID_CHG_PROTECT 87 Prevents a user from deactivating the record changes feature, or from accepting or rejecting changes unless the user enters a password.
12 .uno%3AShowChanges 20 Shows or hides recorded changes.
19 .uno%3AShowTrackedChanges 20 Shows or hides recorded changes.
14 .uno%3ACommentChange 28 Enter a comment for the recorded change.
1c .uno%3ACommentChangeTracking 28 Enter a comment for the recorded change.
16 CUI_HID_REDLINING_EDIT 28 Enter a comment for the recorded change.
1b .uno%3AAcceptTrackedChanges 22 Accept or reject recorded changes.
14 .uno%3AAcceptChanges 22 Accept or reject recorded changes.
15 SC_HID_SC_SORT_ACTION 31 Lists the changes that were made in the document.
20 SVX_HID_REDLINING_VIEW_PB_ACCEPT 59 Accepts the selected change and removes the highlighting from the change in the document.
13 SW_HID_SORT_COMMENT 4a Sorts the list according to the comments that are attached to the changes.
23 SVX_HID_REDLINING_VIEW_PB_ACCEPTALL 4a Accepts all of the changes and removes the highlighting from the document.
23 SVX_HID_REDLINING_VIEW_PB_REJECTALL 4a Rejects all of the changes and removes the highlighting from the document.
1e SVX_HID_REDLINING_VIEW_DG_VIEW b0 Lists the changes that were recorded in the document. When you select an entry in the list, the change is highlighted in the document. To sort the list, click a column heading.
13 SC_HID_SC_SORT_DATE 31 Lists the date and time that the change was made.
19 .uno%3ARejectTracedChange 59 Rejects the selected change and removes the highlighting from the change in the document.
20 SVX_HID_REDLINING_VIEW_PB_REJECT 59 Rejects the selected change and removes the highlighting from the change in the document.
10 SW_HID_SORT_DATE 2e Sorts the list according to the date and time.
15 SC_HID_SC_SORT_AUTHOR 23 Lists the user who made the change.
1e SVX_HID_REDLINING_VIEW_PB_UNDO 29 Edit the comment for the selected change.
13 SW_HID_EDIT_COMMENT 29 Edit the comment for the selected change.
19 .uno%3AAcceptTracedChange 59 Accepts the selected change and removes the highlighting from the change in the document.
1b SVX_HID_REDLINING_VIEW_PAGE 24 Accept or reject individual changes.
16 SC_HID_SC_SORT_COMMENT 33 Lists the comments that are attached to the change.
12 SW_HID_SORT_AUTHOR 27 Sorts the list according to the Author.
12 SW_HID_SORT_ACTION 2f Sorts the list according to the type of change.
14 SC_HID_SORT_POSITION 82 Sorts the list in a descending order according to the position of the changes in the document. This is the default sorting method.
19 SC_HID_SC_CHANGES_COMMENT 29 Edit the comment for the selected change.
20 SVX_HID_REDLINING_FILTER_DF_DATE 50 Filters the list of changes according to the date and the time that you specify.
21 SVX_HID_REDLINING_FILTER_LB_AUTOR 5e Filters the list of changes according to the name of the author that you select from the list.
21 SVX_HID_REDLINING_FILTER_CB_AUTOR 5e Filters the list of changes according to the name of the author that you select from the list.
3a sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_HIGHLIGHT_CHANGES%3ARB_ASSIGN 4f Filters the comments of the changes according to the keyword(s) that you enter.
20 SVX_HID_REDLINING_FILTER_TF_DATE 50 Filters the list of changes according to the date and the time that you specify.
22 SVX_HID_REDLINING_FILTER_LB_ACTION 4f Filters the comments of the changes according to the keyword(s) that you enter.
20 SVX_HID_REDLINING_FILTER_LB_DATE 50 Filters the list of changes according to the date and the time that you specify.
21 SVX_HID_REDLINING_FILTER_IB_CLOCK 3e Enters the current date and time into the corresponding boxes.
22 SVX_HID_REDLINING_FILTER_CB_ACTION 4f Filters the comments of the changes according to the keyword(s) that you enter.
20 SVX_HID_REDLINING_FILTER_BTN_REF 3b Select the range of cells that you want to use as a filter.
22 SVX_HID_REDLINING_FILTER_IB_CLOCK2 3e Enters the current date and time into the corresponding boxes.
23 SVX_HID_REDLINING_FILTER_CB_COMMENT 4f Filters the comments of the changes according to the keyword(s) that you enter.
21 SVX_HID_REDLINING_FILTER_DF_DATE2 50 Filters the list of changes according to the date and the time that you specify.
23 SVX_HID_REDLINING_FILTER_ED_COMMENT 4f Filters the comments of the changes according to the keyword(s) that you enter.
21 SVX_HID_REDLINING_FILTER_ED_RANGE 3b Select the range of cells that you want to use as a filter.
21 SVX_HID_REDLINING_FILTER_CB_RANGE 3b Select the range of cells that you want to use as a filter.
20 SVX_HID_REDLINING_FILTER_CB_DATE 50 Filters the list of changes according to the date and the time that you specify.
21 SVX_HID_REDLINING_FILTER_TF_DATE2 50 Filters the list of changes according to the date and the time that you specify.
32 sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_SIMPLEREF%3ARB_ASSIGN 4f Filters the comments of the changes according to the keyword(s) that you enter.
15 .uno%3AMergeDocuments 92 Imports changes made to copies of the same document into the original document. Changes made to footnotes, headers, frames and fields are ignored.
17 .uno%3ACompareDocuments 3e Compares the current document with a document that you select.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_IDENTIFIER_POS 6a Enter a short name for the record. The short name appears in the Identifier column in the list of records.
19 .uno%3ABib%2FremoveFilter 47 To display all of the records in a table, click the Remove Filter icon.
1b EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_YEAR_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
13 .uno%3ABib%2Fsource 73 Lists the available tables in the current database. Click a name in the list to display the records for that table.
15 SVX_HID_FM_DELETEROWS 1c Deletes the selected record.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_EDITION_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
17 SVX_HID_GRID_TRAVEL_NEW 2c Inserts a new record into the current table.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_EDITOR_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
18 SVX_HID_GRID_TRAVEL_LAST 23 Go to the last record in the table.
1a EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_URL_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
18 SVX_HID_GRID_TRAVEL_NEXT 23 Go to the next record in the table.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_TITLE_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_NUMBER_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_SCHOOL_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_CHAPTER_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
16 .uno%3ABib%2Fsdbsource 35 Select the data source for the bibliography database.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_VOLUME_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_REPORTTYPE_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
14 .uno%3ABib%2FMapping bd Lets you map the column headings to data fields from a different data source. To define a different data source for your bibliography, click the Data Source button on the record Object Bar.
19 .uno%3ABib%2FInsertRecord 2c Inserts a new record into the current table.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_PUBLISHER_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_BOOKTITLE_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_PAGES_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_MAPPINGDLG bd Lets you map the column headings to data fields from a different data source. To define a different data source for your bibliography, click the Data Source button on the record Object Bar.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_JOURNAL_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
24 EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_AUTHORITYTYPE_POS a5 Select the type of record that you want to create. $[officename] inserts a number in the Type column of the record that corresponds to the type that you select here.
1c .uno%3ABibliographyComponent 48 Insert, delete, edit, and organize records in the bibliography database.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_INSTITUTION_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_MONTH_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_SERIES_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
19 .uno%3ABib%2FDeleteRecord 1b Deletes the current record.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_HOWPUBLISHED_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
1b EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_NOTE_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
19 SVX_HID_GRID_TRAVEL_FIRST 24 Go to the first record in the table.
1c SVX_HID_GRID_TRAVEL_ABSOLUTE 4d Type the number of the record that you want to display, and then press Enter.
1b .uno%3ABib%2FstandardFilter 4b Use the Standard Filter to refine and to combine AutoFilter search options.
24 EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_ORGANIZATIONS_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
17 .uno%3ABib%2FautoFilter 96 Long-click to select the data field that you want to search using the term that you entered in the Search Key box. You can only search one data field.
12 .uno%3ABib%2Fquery 17e Type the information that you want to search for, and then press Enter. To change the filter options for the search, long-click the AutoFilter icon, and then select a different data field. You can use wildcards such as % or * for any number of characters, and _ or ? for one character in your search. To display all of the records in the table, clear this box, and then press Enter.
18 SVX_HID_GRID_TRAVEL_PREV 27 Go to the previous record in the table.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_ANNOTE_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_AUTHOR_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_ADDRESS_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
19 EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_DB_TBX 48 Insert, delete, edit, and organize records in the bibliography database.
1b EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_ISBN_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
2a SVX_RADIOBUTTON_RID_SVXDLG_ZOOM_BTN_SINGLE 56 The single page view layout displays pages beneath each other, but never side by side.
2d SVX_RADIOBUTTON_RID_SVXDLG_ZOOM_BTN_AUTOMATIC 59 The automatic view layout displays pages side by side, as many as the zoom factor allows.
34 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_ZOOM%3ABTN_PAGE_WIDTH 6a Displays the complete width of the document page. The top and bottom edges of the page may not be visible.
18 SVX_HID_MNU_ZOOM_OPTIMAL 45 Resizes the display to fit the width of the text in the document at .
b .uno%3AZoom 37 Reduces or enlarges the screen display of %PRODUCTNAME.
34 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_ZOOM%3ABTN_WHOLE_PAGE 28 Displays the entire page on your screen.
25 SVX_CHECKBOX_RID_SVXDLG_ZOOM_CHK_BOOK 83 In book mode view layout you see two pages side by side as in an open book. The first page is a right page with an odd page number.
14 SVX_HID_MNU_ZOOM_150 3e Displays the document at one and a half times its actual size.
2a SVX_METRICFIELD_RID_SVXDLG_ZOOM_ED_COLUMNS 6c In columns view layout you see pages in a given number of columns side by side. Enter the number of columns.
28 SVX_RADIOBUTTON_RID_SVXDLG_ZOOM_BTN_USER 5f Enter the zoom factor at which you want to display the document. Enter a percentage in the box.
13 SVX_HID_MNU_ZOOM_75 30 Displays the document at 75% of its actual size.
2e cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_ZOOM%3ABTN_USER 5f Enter the zoom factor at which you want to display the document. Enter a percentage in the box.
14 SVX_HID_MNU_ZOOM_200 33 Displays the document at two times its actual size.
31 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_ZOOM%3ABTN_OPTIMAL 45 Resizes the display to fit the width of the text in the document at .
14 SVX_HID_MNU_ZOOM_100 29 Displays the document at its actual size.
13 SVX_HID_MNU_ZOOM_50 31 Displays the document at half of its actual size.
1b SVX_HID_MNU_ZOOM_WHOLE_PAGE 28 Displays the entire page on your screen.
27 SVX_METRICFIELD_RID_SVXDLG_ZOOM_ED_USER 5f Enter the zoom factor at which you want to display the document. Enter a percentage in the box.
b SID_VIEW050 31 Displays the document at half of its actual size.
1b SVX_HID_MNU_ZOOM_PAGE_WIDTH 6a Displays the complete width of the document page. The top and bottom edges of the page may not be visible.
2b SVX_RADIOBUTTON_RID_SVXDLG_ZOOM_BTN_COLUMNS 6c In columns view layout you see pages in a given number of columns side by side. Enter the number of columns.
b SID_VIEW200 33 Displays the document at two times its actual size.
2d cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXDLG_ZOOM%3AED_USER 5f Enter the zoom factor at which you want to display the document. Enter a percentage in the box.
2d cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_ZOOM%3ABTN_100 29 Displays the document at its actual size.
e .uno%3AView100 29 Displays the document at its actual size.
19 .uno%3AFunctionBarVisible 20 Shows or hides the Standard Bar.
1a .uno%3AShowImeStatusWindow 3b Shows or hides the Input Method Engine (IME) status window.
15 .uno%3AToolBarVisible 1d Shows or hides the Tools bar.
17 .uno%3AStatusBarVisible 3f Shows or hides the Status Bar at the bottom edge of the window.
15 .uno%3ATaskBarVisible 3f Shows or hides the Status Bar at the bottom edge of the window.
1a SFX2_HID_FULLSCREENTOOLBOX 7d In Writer and Calc, you can also use the shortcut keys CommandCtrl+Shift+J to switch between the normal and full screen mode.
11 .uno%3AFullScreen 7b Shows or hides the menus and toolbars in Writer or Calc. To exit the full screen mode, click the Full Screen On/Off button.
13 .uno%3AColorControl 8b Show or hides the Color Bar. To modify or change the color table that is displayed, choose Format - Area, and then click on the Colors tab.
18 SVX_HID_COLOR_CTL_COLORS 145 Click the color that you want to use. To change the fill color of an object in the current file, select the object and then click a color. To change the line color of the selected object, right-click a color. To change the color of text in a text object, double-click the text-object, select the text, and then click a color.
18 .uno%3AAvailableToolbars 2a Opens a submenu to show and hide toolbars.
18 .cmd%3ARestoreVisibility aa Choose View - Toolbars - Reset to reset the toolbars to their default context sensitive behavior. Now some toolbars will be shown automatically, dependent on the context.
15 .uno%3ADeleteAllNotes 2c Delete all comments in the current document.
17 .uno%3AInsertAnnotation 12 Inserts a comment.
17 .uno%3ADeleteAnnotation 1b Delete the current comment.
16 .uno%3AShowAnnotations 49 Use View - Comments to show or hide all comments (not available in Calc).
22 .uno%3ADeleteAllAnnotationByAuthor 3b Delete all comments by this author in the current document.
13 .uno%3ADeleteAuthor 3b Delete all comments by this author in the current document.
11 .uno%3ADeleteNote 1b Delete the current comment.
1a .uno%3ADeleteAllAnnotation 2c Delete all comments in the current document.
b .uno%3AScan 2b Inserts a scanned image into your document.
12 .uno%3ATwainSelect 29 Selects the scanner that you want to use.
14 .uno%3ATwainTransfer 82 Scans an image, and then inserts the result into the document. The scanning dialog is provided by the manufacturer of the scanner.
32 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_CHARMAP%3ABTN_DELETE 4b Clears the current selection of special characters that you want to insert.
d .uno%3ABullet 34 Inserts special characters from the installed fonts.
1b CUI_HID_CHARMAP_CTL_SHOWSET 4a Click the special character(s) that you want to insert, and then click OK.
13 .uno%3AInsertSymbol 34 Inserts special characters from the installed fonts.
2c cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_CHARMAP%3ALB_FONT 4c Select a font to display the special characters that are associated with it.
2e cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_CHARMAP%3ALB_SUBSET 2f Select a Unicode category for the current font.
1a SVT_HID_FILEDLG_PREVIEW_CB 30 Displays a preview of the selected graphic file.
1f SVT_HID_FILEOPEN_IMAGE_TEMPLATE 27 Select the frame style for the graphic.
15 HID_IMPGRF_CB_PREVIEW 30 Displays a preview of the selected graphic file.
17 SVT_HID_FILEDLG_LINK_CB 2c Inserts the selected graphic file as a link.
1d SVX_HID_OFA_HYPERLINK_URL_TXT 2c Inserts the selected graphic file as a link.
14 .uno%3AInsertGraphic 2c Inserts a picture into the current document.
11 .uno%3AObjectMenu 62 Inserts an object into your document. For movies and sounds, use Insert - Movie and Sound instead.
13 .uno%3AInsertObject 6c Inserts an OLE object into the current document. The OLE object is inserted as a link or an embedded object.
13 .uno%3AInsertPlugin 2c Inserts a plug-in into the current document.
12 .uno%3AInsertSound 2f Inserts a sound file into the current document.
12 .uno%3AInsertVideo 2f Inserts a video file into the current document.
1b .uno%3AInsertObjectStarMath 2c Inserts a formula into the current document.
11 .uno%3AInsertMath 2c Inserts a formula into the current document.
20 .uno%3AInsertObjectFloatingFrame 87 Inserts a floating frame into the current document. Floating frames are used in HTML documents to display the contents of another file.
11 .uno%3ADataImport 6a Lists the databases that are registered in %PRODUCTNAME and lets you manage the contents of the databases.
1c .uno%3AViewDataSourceBrowser 6a Lists the databases that are registered in %PRODUCTNAME and lets you manage the contents of the databases.
12 .uno%3AGraphicMenu 38 Select the source for a picture that you want to insert.
11 .uno%3ASetDefault 50 Removes direct formatting and formatting by character styles from the selection.
16 .uno%3AResetAttributes 50 Removes direct formatting and formatting by character styles from the selection.
1d .uno%3AStandardTextAttributes 50 Removes direct formatting and formatting by character styles from the selection.
11 .uno%3AFontDialog 45 Changes the font and the font formatting for the selected characters.
19 CUI_HID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_NAME 3b Specify the formatting and the font that you want to apply.
36 cui%3AMetricBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_NAME%3ALB_EAST_SIZE 6c Enter or select the font size that you want to apply. For scalable fonts, you can also enter decimal values.
35 cui%3AComboBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_NAME%3ALB_WEST_NAME 59 Enter the name of an installed font that you want to use, or select a font from the list.
3a cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_NAME%3ALB_WEST_LANG_NOCJK 9c Sets the language that the spellchecker uses for the selected text or the text that you type. Available language modules have a check mark in front of them.
36 cui%3AComboBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_NAME%3ALB_WEST_STYLE 2d Select the formatting that you want to apply.
35 cui%3AMetricBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_NAME%3ALB_CTL_SIZE 6c Enter or select the font size that you want to apply. For scalable fonts, you can also enter decimal values.
36 cui%3AMetricBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_NAME%3ALB_WEST_SIZE 6c Enter or select the font size that you want to apply. For scalable fonts, you can also enter decimal values.
36 cui%3AComboBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_NAME%3ALB_EAST_STYLE 2d Select the formatting that you want to apply.
34 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_NAME%3ALB_WEST_LANG 9c Sets the language that the spellchecker uses for the selected text or the text that you type. Available language modules have a check mark in front of them.
34 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_NAME%3ALB_EAST_LANG 9c Sets the language that the spellchecker uses for the selected text or the text that you type. Available language modules have a check mark in front of them.
33 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_NAME%3ALB_CTL_LANG 9c Sets the language that the spellchecker uses for the selected text or the text that you type. Available language modules have a check mark in front of them.
3c cui%3AMetricBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_NAME%3ALB_WEST_SIZE_NOCJK 6c Enter or select the font size that you want to apply. For scalable fonts, you can also enter decimal values.
3c cui%3AComboBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_NAME%3ALB_WEST_STYLE_NOCJK 2d Select the formatting that you want to apply.
35 cui%3AComboBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_NAME%3ALB_CTL_STYLE 2d Select the formatting that you want to apply.
35 cui%3AComboBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_NAME%3ALB_EAST_NAME 59 Enter the name of an installed font that you want to use, or select a font from the list.
3b cui%3AComboBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_NAME%3ALB_WEST_NAME_NOCJK 59 Enter the name of an installed font that you want to use, or select a font from the list.
34 cui%3AComboBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_NAME%3ALB_CTL_NAME 59 Enter the name of an installed font that you want to use, or select a font from the list.
3d cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_EFFECTS%3ALB_UNDERLINE_COLOR 25 Select the color for the underlining.
36 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_EFFECTS%3ALB_EFFECTS2 e1 Select a relief effect to apply to the selected text. The embossed relief makes the characters appear as if they are raised above the page. The engraved relief makes the characters appear as if they are pressed into the page.
3e cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_EFFECTS%3ACB_INDIVIDUALWORDS 3d Applies the selected effect only to words and ignores spaces.
37 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_EFFECTS%3ALB_STRIKEOUT 33 Select a strikethrough style for the selected text.
37 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_EFFECTS%3ALB_UNDERLINE 7d Select the underlining style that you want to apply. To apply the underlining to words only, select the Individual Words box.
c .uno%3AColor cf Click to apply the current font color to the selected characters. You can also click here, and then drag a selection to change the text color. Click the arrow next to the icon to open the Font color toolbar.
36 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_EFFECTS%3ALB_POSITION 2c Specify where to display the emphasis marks.
34 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_EFFECTS%3ALB_RELIEF e1 Select a relief effect to apply to the selected text. The embossed relief makes the characters appear as if they are raised above the page. The engraved relief makes the characters appear as if they are pressed into the page.
1c CUI_HID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_EFFECTS 2e Specify the font effects that you want to use.
36 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_EFFECTS%3ALB_EMPHASIS 53 Select a character to display over or below the entire length of the selected text.
f .uno%3AOverline 81 Overlines or removes overlining from the selected text. If the cursor is not in a word, the new text that you enter is overlined.
37 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_EFFECTS%3ALB_FONTCOLOR 96 Sets the color for the selected text. If you select Automatic, the text color is set to black for light backgrounds and to white for dark backgrounds.
31 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_NAME%3ALB_COLOR2 96 Sets the color for the selected text. If you select Automatic, the text color is set to black for light backgrounds and to white for dark backgrounds.
3c cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_EFFECTS%3ALB_OVERLINE_COLOR 24 Select the color for the overlining.
10 .uno%3AFontColor cf Click to apply the current font color to the selected characters. You can also click here, and then drag a selection to change the text color. Click the arrow next to the icon to open the Font color toolbar.
38 cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_EFFECTS%3ACB_SHADOW 4b Adds a shadow that casts below and to the right of the selected characters.
39 cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_EFFECTS%3ACB_OUTLINE 5b Displays the outline of the selected characters. This effect does not work with every font.
36 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_EFFECTS%3ALB_OVERLINE 7b Select the overlining style that you want to apply. To apply the overlining to words only, select the Individual Words box.
36 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUMBERFORMAT%3ALB_LANGUAGE 100 Specifies the language setting for the selected fields. With the language set to Automatic, $[officename] automatically applies the number formats associated with the system default language. Select any language to fix the settings for the selected fields.
3d cui%3ANumericField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUMBERFORMAT%3AED_LEADZEROES 4c Enter the maximum number of zeroes to display in front of the decimal point.
31 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUMBERFORMAT%3AED_FORMAT 5c Displays the number format code for the selected format. You can also enter a custom format.
36 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUMBERFORMAT%3ABTN_NEGRED 32 Changes the font color of negative numbers to red.
1d CUI_HID_NUMBERFORMAT_TBI_INFO 2d Adds a comment to the selected number format.
1e CUI_HID_NUMBERFORMAT_LB_FORMAT 49 Select how you want the contents of the selected cell(s) to be displayed.
36 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUMBERFORMAT%3ALB_CATEGORY 56 Select a category from the list, and then select a formatting style in the Format box.
1c CUI_HID_NUMBERFORMAT_TBI_ADD 4a Adds the number format code that you entered to the user-defined category.
38 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUMBERFORMAT%3ABTN_THOUSAND 6c Inserts a separator between thousands. The type of separator that is used depends on your language settings.
32 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUMBERFORMAT%3AED_COMMENT 50 Enter a comment for the selected number format, and then click outside this box.
3b cui%3ANumericField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUMBERFORMAT%3AED_DECIMALS 3c Enter the number of decimal places that you want to display.
3b cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUMBERFORMAT%3ACB_SOURCEFORMAT 4b Uses the same number format as the cells containing the data for the chart.
1f CUI_HID_NUMBERFORMAT_TBI_REMOVE 23 Deletes the selected number format.
1e .uno%3ATableNumberFormatDialog 38 Specify the formatting options for the selected cell(s).
14 CUI_HID_NUMBERFORMAT 38 Specify the formatting options for the selected cell(s).
36 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUMBERFORMAT%3ALB_CURRENCY 71 Select a currency, and then scroll to the top of the Format list to view the formatting options for the currency.
28 sw%3APushButton%3ATP_CHAR_URL%3APB_EVENT 3c Specify an event that triggers when you click the hyperlink.
f SW_HID_CHAR_URL 38 Assigns a new hyperlink or edits the selected hyperlink.
27 sw%3AListBox%3ATP_CHAR_URL%3ALB_VISITED bf Select a formatting style to use for visited links from the list. To add or modify a style in this list, close this dialog, and click the Styles and Formatting icon on the Formatting toolbar.
21 sw%3AEdit%3ATP_CHAR_URL%3AED_NAME 1f Enter a name for the hyperlink.
20 sw%3AEdit%3ATP_CHAR_URL%3AED_URL 4c Enter a URL for the file that you want to open when you click the hyperlink.
2b sw%3AListBox%3ATP_CHAR_URL%3ALB_NOT_VISITED c1 Select a formatting style to use for unvisited links from the list. To add or modify a style in this list, close this dialog, and click the Styles and Formatting icon on the Formatting toolbar.
21 sw%3AEdit%3ATP_CHAR_URL%3AED_TEXT 3a Enter the text that you want to display for the hyperlink.
19 .uno%3AInsertHyperlinkDlg 38 Assigns a new hyperlink or edits the selected hyperlink.
27 sw%3AComboBox%3ATP_CHAR_URL%3ALB_TARGET 71 Enter the name of the frame that you want the linked file to open in, or select a predefined frame from the list.
26 sw%3APushButton%3ATP_CHAR_URL%3APB_URL 3e Locate the file that you want to link to, and then click Open.
3c cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_POSITION%3ARB_NORMALPOS 2c Removes superscript or subscript formatting.
3a cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_POSITION%3ARB_HIGHPOS 52 Reduces the font size of the selected text and raises the text above the baseline.
10 .uno%3ASubScript 52 Reduces the font size of the selected text and lowers the text below the baseline.
3b cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_POSITION%3ACB_PAIRKERNING 4c Automatically adjust the character spacing for specific letter combinations.
3b cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_POSITION%3AED_KERNING2 65 Enter the amount by which you want to expand or condense the character spacing for the selected text.
39 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_POSITION%3ARB_LOWPOS 52 Reduces the font size of the selected text and lowers the text below the baseline.
3e cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_POSITION%3AMF_SCALE_WIDTH 66 Enter the percentage of the font width by which to horizontally stretch or compress the selected text.
12 .uno%3ASuperScript 52 Reduces the font size of the selected text and raises the text above the baseline.
37 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_POSITION%3ALB_KERNING2 b2 Specifies the spacing between the characters of the selected text. For expanded or condensed spacing, enter the amount that you want to expand or condense the text in the by box.
3b cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_POSITION%3AED_FONTSIZE 50 Enter the amount by which you want to reduce the font size of the selected text.
3a cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_POSITION%3AED_HIGHLOW 9e Enter the amount by which you want to raise or to lower the selected text in relation to the baseline. One hundred percent is equal to the height of the font.
1d CUI_HID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_POSITION 44 Specify the position, scaling, rotation, and spacing for characters.
37 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_POSITION%3ACB_HIGHLOW 6a Automatically sets the amount by which the selected text is raised or lowered in relation to the baseline.
3b cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_TWOLINES%3AED_STARTBRACKET 85 Select the character to define the start of the double-lined area. If you want to choose a custom character, select Other Characters.
39 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_TWOLINES%3AED_ENDBRACKET 83 Select the character to define the end of the double-lined area. If you want to choose a custom character, select Other Characters.
38 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CHAR_TWOLINES%3ACB_TWOLINES 5a Allows you to write in double lines in the area that you selected in the current document.
3c cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_PARA_ASIAN%3ACB_AS_HANG_PUNC 88 Prevents commas and periods from breaking the line. Instead, these characters are added to the end of the line, even in the page margin.
3c cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_PARA_ASIAN%3ACB_AS_FORBIDDEN 89 Prevents the characters in the list from starting or ending a line. The characters are relocated to either the previous or the next line.
3f cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_PARA_ASIAN%3ACB_AS_SCRIPT_SPACE 3c Inserts a space between Asian, Latin and complex characters.
10 .uno%3AEditStyle 4c Modifies the format of the current paragraph, such as indents and alignment.
16 .uno%3AParagraphDialog 4c Modifies the format of the current paragraph, such as indents and alignment.
42 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_STD_PARAGRAPH%3AED_LINEDISTPERCENT 2c Enter the value to use for the line spacing.
3d cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_STD_PARAGRAPH%3AED_LEFTINDENT 184 Enter the amount of space that you want to indent the paragraph from the page margin. If you want the paragraph to extend into the page margin, enter a negative number. In Left-to-Right languages, the left edge of the paragraph is indented with respect to the left page margin. In Right-to-Left languages, the right edge of the paragraph is indented with respect to the right page margin.
1c CUI_HID_FORMAT_PARAGRAPH_STD 3d Sets the indenting and the spacing options for the paragraph.
3d cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_STD_PARAGRAPH%3AED_BOTTOMDIST 51 Enter the amount of space that you want to leave below the selected paragraph(s).
3e cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_STD_PARAGRAPH%3AED_RIGHTINDENT 184 Enter the amount of space that you want to indent the paragraph from the page margin. If you want the paragraph to extend into the page margin, enter a negative number. In Left-to-Right languages, the right edge of the paragraph is indented with respect to the right page margin. In Right-to-Left languages, the left edge of the paragraph is indented with respect to the left page margin.
3a cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_STD_PARAGRAPH%3AED_TOPDIST 51 Enter the amount of space that you want to leave above the selected paragraph(s).
41 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_STD_PARAGRAPH%3AED_LINEDISTMETRIC 2c Enter the value to use for the line spacing.
34 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_STD_PARAGRAPH%3ACB_AUTO 51 Enter the amount of space that you want to leave above the selected paragraph(s).
3e cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_STD_PARAGRAPH%3AED_FLINEINDENT 12a Indents the first line of a paragraph by the amount that you enter. To create a hanging indent enter a positive value for "Before text" and a negative value for "First line". To indent the first line of a paragraph that uses numbering or bullets, choose "Format - Bullets and Numbering - Position".
37 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_STD_PARAGRAPH%3ALB_LINEDIST 4a Specify the amount of space to leave between lines of text in a paragraph.
33 cui%3AMetricBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TABULATOR%3AED_TABPOS fa Select a tab stop type, enter a new measurement, and then click New. If you want, you can also specify the measurement units to use for the tab (cm for centimeter, or " for inches). Existing tabs to the left of the first tab that you set are removed.
36 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TABULATOR%3AED_FILLCHAR_OTHER 56 Allows you to specify a character to fill the empty space to the left of the tab stop.
35 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TABULATOR%3ABTN_DELALL 80 Removes all of the tab stops that you defined under Position. Sets Left tab stops at regular intervals as the default tab stops.
3d cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TABULATOR%3ABTN_TABTYPE_RIGHT 63 Aligns the right edge of the text to the tab stop and extends the text to the left of the tab stop.
32 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TABULATOR%3ABTN_NEW 3c Adds the tab stop that you defined to the current paragraph.
41 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TABULATOR%3ABTN_FILLCHAR_DASHLINE 3e Fills the empty space to the left of the tab stop with dashes.
3c cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TABULATOR%3ABTN_TABTYPE_LEFT 53 Aligns the left edge of the text to the tab stop and extends the text to the right.
3f cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TABULATOR%3ABTN_TABTYPE_DECIMAL 63 Aligns the decimal point of a number to the center of the tab stop and text to the left of the tab.
37 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TABULATOR%3AED_TABTYPE_DECCHAR 4e Enter a character that you want the decimal tab to use as a decimal separator.
3e cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TABULATOR%3ABTN_FILLCHAR_OTHER 56 Allows you to specify a character to fill the empty space to the left of the tab stop.
3e cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TABULATOR%3ABTN_TABTYPE_CENTER 2e Aligns the center of the text to the tab stop.
11 CUI_HID_TABULATOR 2e Set the position of a tab stop in a paragraph.
3b cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TABULATOR%3ABTN_FILLCHAR_NO 5c Inserts no fill characters, or removes existing fill characters to the left of the tab stop.
3f cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TABULATOR%3ABTN_FILLCHAR_POINTS 3c Fills the empty space to the left of the tab stop with dots.
43 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TABULATOR%3ABTN_FILLCHAR_UNDERSCORE 41 Draws a line to fill the empty space to the left of the tab stop.
31 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_BORDER%3ALB_LINECOLOR 46 Select the line color that you want to use for the selected border(s).
32 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_BORDER%3AMF_BOTTOM 65 Enter the distance that you want to have between the bottom border and the contents of the selection.
1a CUI_HID_BORDER_CTL_PRESETS 2a Select a predefined border style to apply.
2d cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_BORDER%3ACB_SYNC 5f Applies the same spacing to contents setting to all four borders when you enter a new distance.
36 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_BORDER%3AED_SHADOWSIZE 1e Enter the width of the shadow.
30 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_BORDER%3AMF_LEFT 63 Enter the distance that you want to have between the left border and the contents of the selection.
1a CUI_HID_BORDER_CTL_SHADOWS 2e Click a shadow style for the selected borders.
31 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_BORDER%3AMF_RIGHT 64 Enter the distance that you want to have between the right border and the contents of the selection.
33 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_BORDER%3ALB_SHADOWCOLOR 1e Select a color for the shadow.
31 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_BORDER%3ALB_LINESTYLE 6b Click the border style that you want to apply. The style is applied to the borders selected in the preview.
2f cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_BORDER%3AMF_TOP 62 Enter the distance that you want to have between the top border and the contents of the selection.
e CUI_HID_BORDER 43 Sets the border options for the selected objects in Writer or Calc.
34 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_BACKGROUND%3ALB_SELECTOR 35 Select the type of background that you want to apply.
34 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_BACKGROUND%3ALB_PARA_BOX 38 Links to or embeds the graphic file in the current file.
22 CUI_HID_BACKGROUND_CTL_BGDCOLORSET 62 Click the color that you want to use as a background. To remove a background color, click No Fill.
39 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_BACKGROUND%3ABTN_POSITION 43 Select this option, and then click a location in the position grid.
35 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_BACKGROUND%3ABTN_PREVIEW 34 Displays or hides a preview of the selected graphic.
18 SVX_HID_POPUP_COLOR_CTRL 71 Click a color. Click No Fill to remove a background or highlighting color. Click Automatic to reset a font color.
33 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_BACKGROUND%3ALB_TBL_BOX 38 Links to or embeds the graphic file in the current file.
1f CUI_HID_BACKGROUND_CTL_POSITION 43 Select this option, and then click a location in the position grid.
12 CUI_HID_BACKGROUND 24 Set the background color or graphic.
32 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_BACKGROUND%3ABTN_LINK 38 Links to or embeds the graphic file in the current file.
36 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_BACKGROUND%3ABTN_BROWSE 52 Locate the graphic file that you want to use as a background, and then click Open.
39 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_BACKGROUND%3AMF_COL_TRANS 38 Links to or embeds the graphic file in the current file.
35 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_BACKGROUND%3ABTN_AREA 4b Stretches the graphic to fill the entire background of the selected object.
35 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_BACKGROUND%3ABTN_TILE 53 Repeats the graphic so that it covers the entire background of the selected object.
41 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ALIGN_PARAGRAPH%3ABTN_CENTERALIGN 32 Centers the contents of the paragraph on the page.
3f cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ALIGN_PARAGRAPH%3ABTN_LEFTALIGN 2d Aligns the paragraph to the left page margin.
2b sw%3AListBox%3ATP_COLUMN%3ALB_TEXTDIRECTION 99 Specify the text direction for a paragraph that uses complex text layout (CTL). This feature is only available if complex text layout support is enabled.
1e CUI_HID_FORMAT_PARAGRAPH_ALIGN 44 Sets the alignment of the paragraph relative to the margins of page.
42 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ALIGN_PARAGRAPH%3ABTN_JUSTIFYALIGN 3f Aligns the paragraph to the left and to the right page margins.
33 sw%3AListBox%3ATP_FORMAT_TABLE%3ALB_TEXTORIENTATION 99 Specify the text direction for a paragraph that uses complex text layout (CTL). This feature is only available if complex text layout support is enabled.
3e cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ALIGN_PARAGRAPH%3ALB_TEXTDIRECTION 99 Specify the text direction for a paragraph that uses complex text layout (CTL). This feature is only available if complex text layout support is enabled.
40 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ALIGN_PARAGRAPH%3ABTN_RIGHTALIGN 2e Aligns the paragraph to the right page margin.
38 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ALIGN_PARAGRAPH%3ACB_EXPAND 99 Specify the text direction for a paragraph that uses complex text layout (CTL). This feature is only available if complex text layout support is enabled.
39 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ALIGN_PARAGRAPH%3ALB_LASTLINE 99 Specify the text direction for a paragraph that uses complex text layout (CTL). This feature is only available if complex text layout support is enabled.
33 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRFCROP%3APB_ORGSIZE 32 Returns the selected graphic to its original size.
33 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRFCROP%3AMF_HEIGHT 28 Enter a height for the selected graphic.
37 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRFCROP%3AMF_HEIGHTZOOM 39 Enter the height of the selected graphic as a percentage.
31 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRFCROP%3AMF_LEFT 161 If the Keep Scale option is selected, enter a positive amount to trim the left edge of the graphic, or a negative amount to add white space to the left of the graphic. If the Keep image size option is selected, enter a positive amount to increase the horizontal scale of the graphic, or a negative amount to decrease the horizontal scale of the graphic.
32 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRFCROP%3AMF_WIDTH 27 Enter a width for the selected graphic.
36 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRFCROP%3ARB_ZOOMCONST 68 Maintains the original scale of the graphic when you crop, so that only the size of the graphic changes.
36 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRFCROP%3ARB_SIZECONST 123 Maintains the original size of the graphic when you crop, so that only the scale of the graphic changes. To reduce the scale of the graphic, select this option and enter negative values in the cropping boxes. To increase the scale of the graphic, enter positive values in the cropping boxes.
36 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRFCROP%3AMF_WIDTHZOOM 39 Enter the width for the selected graphic as a percentage.
32 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRFCROP%3AMF_RIGHT 163 If the Keep Scale option is selected, enter a positive amount to trim the right edge of the graphic, or a negative amount to add white space to the right of the graphic. If the Keep image size option is selected, enter a positive amount to increase the horizontal scale of the graphic, or a negative amount to decrease the horizontal scale of the graphic.
33 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRFCROP%3AMF_BOTTOM 151 If the Keep Scale option is selected, enter a positive amount to trim the bottom of the graphic, or a negative amount to add white space below the graphic. If the Keep image size option is selected, enter a positive amount to increase the vertical scale of the graphic, or a negative amount to decrease the vertical scale of the graphic.
30 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRFCROP%3AMF_TOP 14e If the Keep Scale option is selected, enter a positive amount to trim the top of the graphic, or a negative amount to add white space above the graphic. If the Keep image size option is selected, enter a positive amount to increase the vertical scale of the graphic, or a negative amount to decrease the vertical scale of the graphic.
2b sfx2%3AListBox%3ATP_MANAGE_STYLES%3ALB_NEXT 102 Select an existing style that you want to follow the current style in your document. For paragraph styles, the next style is applied to the paragraph that is created when you press Enter. For page styles, the next style is applied when a new page is created.
31 sfx2%3AMultiLineEdit%3ATP_MANAGE_STYLES%3AED_DESC 3c Describes the relevant formatting used in the current style.
16 SFX2_HID_MANAGE_STYLES 27 Set the options for the selected style.
28 sfx2%3AEdit%3ATP_MANAGE_STYLES%3AED_NAME a7 Displays the name of the selected style. If you are creating or modifying a custom style, enter a name for the style. You cannot change the name of a predefined style.
2b sfx2%3AListBox%3ATP_MANAGE_STYLES%3ALB_BASE 69 Select an existing style that you want to base the new style on, or select none to define your own style.
2c sfx2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_MANAGE_STYLES%3ACB_AUTO b0 Updates the style when you apply direct formatting to a paragraph using this style in your document. The formatting of all paragraphs using this style is automatically updated.
2d sfx2%3AListBox%3ATP_MANAGE_STYLES%3ALB_REGION 7f Displays the category for the current style. If you are creating or modifying a new style, select 'Custom Style' from the list.
36 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_PAGE%3AED_PAPER_HEIGHT 61 Displays the height of the selected paper format. To define a custom format, enter a height here.
2c cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_PAGE%3ACB_ADAPT 86 Resizes the drawing objects so that they fit on the paper format that you select. The arrangement of the drawing objects is preserved.
2f cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_PAGE%3ALB_TEXT_FLOW 40 Select the text direction that you want to use in your document.
37 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_PAGE%3AED_BOTTOM_MARGIN 5c Enter the amount of space to leave between the lower edge of the page and the document text.
30 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_PAGE%3ALB_PAPER_TRAY ea Select the paper source for your printer. If you want, you can assign different paper trays to different page styles. For example, assign a different tray to the First Page style and load the tray with your company's letterhead paper.
35 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_PAGE%3AED_LEFT_MARGIN e7 Enter the amount of space to leave between the left edge of the page and the document text. If you are using the Mirrored page layout, enter the amount of space to leave between the inner text margin and the inner edge of the page.
13 CUI_HID_FORMAT_PAGE 73 Allows you to define page layouts for single and multiple-page documents, as well as a numbering and paper formats.
30 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_PAGE%3ALB_PAPER_SIZE 81 Select a predefined paper size, or create a custom format by entering the dimensions for the paper in the Height and Width boxes.
33 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_PAGE%3ARB_LANDSCAPE 4e Displays and prints the current document with the paper oriented horizontally.
2b cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_PAGE%3ACB_HORZ 33 Centers the cells horizontally on the printed page.
2f cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_PAGE%3ACB_REGISTER 43 Aligns the text on the selected Page Style to a vertical page grid.
2e cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_PAGE%3ALB_REGISTER dd Select the Paragraph Style that you want to use as a reference for lining up the text on the selected Page style. The height of the font that is specified in the reference style sets the spacing of the vertical page grid.
2b cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_PAGE%3ACB_VERT 31 Centers the cells vertically on the printed page.
34 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_PAGE%3AED_TOP_MARGIN 5c Enter the amount of space to leave between the upper edge of the page and the document text.
36 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_PAGE%3AED_RIGHT_MARGIN e8 Enter the amount of space to leave between the right edge of the page and the document text. If you are using the Mirrored page layout, enter the amount of space to leave between the outer text margin and the outer edge of the page.
32 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_PAGE%3ARB_PORTRAIT 4c Displays and prints the current document with the paper oriented vertically.
33 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_PAGE%3ALB_NUMBER_FORMAT 51 Select the page numbering format that you want to use for the current page style.
2c cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_PAGE%3ALB_LAYOUT 60 Specify whether the current style should show odd pages, even pages, or both odd and even pages.
35 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_PAGE%3AED_PAPER_WIDTH 5f Displays the width of the selected paper format. To define a custom format, enter a width here.
2f svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HEADER%3ACB_SHARED 2a Even and odd pages share the same content.
33 svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HEADER%3AED_RMARGIN 67 Enter the amount of space to leave between the right edge of the page and the right edge of the header.
15 SC_HID_SC_HEADER_EDIT 18 Add or edit header text.
33 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HEADER%3ACB_HEIGHT_DYN 51 Automatically adjusts the height of the header to fit the content that you enter.
15 SVX_HID_FORMAT_HEADER 78 Adds a header to the current page style. A header is an area in the top page margin, where you can add text or graphics.
32 svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HEADER%3AED_HEIGHT 2e Enter the height that you want for the header.
2f svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HEADER%3ACB_TURNON 28 Adds a header to the current page style.
33 svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HEADER%3AED_LMARGIN 65 Enter the amount of space to leave between the left edge of the page and the left edge of the header.
30 svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HEADER%3AED_DIST 80 Enter the amount of space that you want to maintain between the bottom edge of the header and the top edge of the document text.
33 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HEADER%3ACB_DYNSPACING 76 Overrides the Spacing setting, and allows the header to expand into the area between the header and the document text.
32 svx%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HEADER%3ABTN_EXTRAS 4d Defines a border, a background color, or a background pattern for the header.
2f svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_FOOTER%3ACB_SHARED 2a Even and odd pages share the same content.
2f svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_FOOTER%3ACB_TURNON 28 Adds a footer to the current page style.
33 svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_FOOTER%3AED_RMARGIN 67 Enter the amount of space to leave between the right edge of the page and the right edge of the footer.
30 svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_FOOTER%3AED_DIST 80 Enter the amount of space that you want to maintain between the bottom edge of the document text and the top edge of the footer.
33 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_FOOTER%3ACB_HEIGHT_DYN 4c Automatically adjusts the height of the footer to fit the content you enter.
32 svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_FOOTER%3AED_HEIGHT 29 Enter the height you want for the footer.
33 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_FOOTER%3ACB_DYNSPACING 71 Overrides the Spacing setting and allows the footer to expand into the area between the footer and document text.
33 svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_FOOTER%3AED_LMARGIN 65 Enter the amount of space to leave between the left edge of the page and the left edge of the footer.
15 SC_HID_SC_FOOTER_EDIT 18 Add or edit footer text.
32 svx%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_FOOTER%3ABTN_EXTRAS 4d Defines a border, a background color, or a background pattern for the footer.
15 SVX_HID_FORMAT_FOOTER 7b Adds a footer to the current page style. A footer is an area in the bottom page margin, where you can add text or graphics.
1c .uno%3AChangeCaseToFullWidth 3f Changes the selected Asian characters to full width characters.
1d .uno%3AChangeCaseToToggleCase 30 Toggles case of all selected western characters.
1a SID_TRANSLITERATE_SENTENCE 56 Changes the first letter of the selected western characters to an uppercase character.
1c SID_TRANSLITERATE_CAPITALIZE 67 Changes the first character of every word of the selected western characters to an uppercase character.
18 .uno%3AChangeCaseToUpper 40 Changes the selected western characters to uppercase characters.
1c .uno%3AChangeCaseToTitleCase 67 Changes the first character of every word of the selected western characters to an uppercase character.
1c .uno%3AChangeCaseToHalfWidth 3f Changes the selected Asian characters to half-width characters.
18 .uno%3ATransliterateMenu 88 Changes the case of characters in the selection. If the cursor is within a word and no text is selected, then the word is the selection.
18 .uno%3AChangeCaseToLower 40 Changes the selected western characters to lowercase characters.
1f .uno%3AChangeCaseToSentenceCase 56 Changes the first letter of the selected western characters to an uppercase character.
18 SID_TRANSLITERATE_TOGGLE 30 Toggles case of all selected western characters.
1b .uno%3AChangeCaseToKatakana 3d Changes the selected Asian characters to Katakana characters.
1b .uno%3AChangeCaseToHiragana 3d Changes the selected Asian characters to Hiragana characters.
29 svx%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXDLG_RUBY%3AED_RIGHT_3 4f Enter the text that you want to use as a pronunciation guide for the base text.
2d svx%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_RUBY%3ALB_POSITION 2d Select where you want to place the ruby text.
29 svx%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXDLG_RUBY%3AED_RIGHT_4 4f Enter the text that you want to use as a pronunciation guide for the base text.
28 svx%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXDLG_RUBY%3AED_LEFT_2 82 Displays the base text that you selected in the current file. If you want, you can modify the base text by entering new text here.
2f svx%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_RUBY%3APB_STYLIST 60 Opens the Styles and Formatting window where you can select a character style for the ruby text.
2f svx%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_RUBY%3ALB_CHAR_STYLE 2b Select a character style for the ruby text.
29 svx%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXDLG_RUBY%3AED_RIGHT_1 4f Enter the text that you want to use as a pronunciation guide for the base text.
28 svx%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXDLG_RUBY%3AED_LEFT_1 82 Displays the base text that you selected in the current file. If you want, you can modify the base text by entering new text here.
11 .uno%3ARubyDialog 54 Allows you to add comments above Asian characters to serve as a pronunciation guide.
28 svx%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXDLG_RUBY%3AED_LEFT_3 82 Displays the base text that you selected in the current file. If you want, you can modify the base text by entering new text here.
28 svx%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXDLG_RUBY%3AED_LEFT_4 82 Displays the base text that you selected in the current file. If you want, you can modify the base text by entering new text here.
29 svx%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXDLG_RUBY%3AED_RIGHT_2 4f Enter the text that you want to use as a pronunciation guide for the base text.
2b svx%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_RUBY%3ALB_ADJUST 32 Select the horizontal alignment for the Ruby text.
15 .uno%3AAlignFrameMenu 34 Aligns selected objects with respect to one another.
10 .uno%3AAlignLeft a1 Aligns the left edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the left edge of the object is aligned to the left page margin.
16 .uno%3AObjectAlignLeft a1 Aligns the left edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the left edge of the object is aligned to the left page margin.
1c .uno%3AAlignHorizontalCenter a7 Horizontally centers the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the center of the object is aligned to the horizontal center of the page.
12 .uno%3AAlignCenter a7 Horizontally centers the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the center of the object is aligned to the horizontal center of the page.
11 .uno%3AAlignRight a4 Aligns the right edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Impress or Draw, the right edge of the object is aligned to the right page margin.
17 .uno%3AObjectAlignRight a4 Aligns the right edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Impress or Draw, the right edge of the object is aligned to the right page margin.
e .uno%3AAlignUp ab Vertically aligns the top edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the top edge of the object is aligned to the upper page margin.
f .uno%3AAlignTop ab Vertically aligns the top edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the top edge of the object is aligned to the upper page margin.
12 .uno%3AAlignMiddle a3 Vertically centers the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the center of the object is aligned to the vertical center of the page.
1a .uno%3AAlignVerticalCenter a3 Vertically centers the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the center of the object is aligned to the vertical center of the page.
12 .uno%3AAlignBottom b1 Vertically aligns the bottom edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the bottom edge of the object is aligned to the lower page margin.
10 .uno%3AAlignDown b1 Vertically aligns the bottom edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the bottom edge of the object is aligned to the lower page margin.
f .uno%3ALeftPara 39 Aligns the selected paragraph(s) to the left page margin.
10 .uno%3ARightPara 3a Aligns the selected paragraph(s) to the right page margin.
11 .uno%3ACenterPara 2e Centers the selected paragraph(s) on the page.
12 .uno%3AJustifyPara cd Aligns the selected paragraph(s) to the left and the right page margins. If you want, you can also specify the alignment options for the last line of a paragraph by choosing Format - Paragraph - Alignment.
11 .uno%3AMergeCells 45 Combines the contents of the selected table cells into a single cell.
10 .uno%3ASplitCell 65 Splits the cell or group of cells horizontally or vertically into the number of cells that you enter.
12 .uno%3ACellVertTop 3c Aligns the contents of the cell to the top edge of the cell.
15 .uno%3ACellVertCenter 44 Centers the contents of the cell between top and bottom of the cell.
15 .uno%3ACellVertBottom 3f Aligns the contents of the cell to the bottom edge of the cell.
b .uno%3ABold 9c Makes the selected text bold. If the cursor is in a word, the entire word is made bold. If the selection or word is already bold, the formatting is removed.
d .uno%3AItalic a2 Makes the selected text italic. If the cursor is in a word, the entire word is made italic. If the selection or word is already italic, the formatting is removed.
16 .uno%3AUnderlineDouble 2c Underlines the selected text with two lines.
10 .uno%3AUnderline 39 Underlines or removes underlining from the selected text.
10 .uno%3AStrikeout 57 Draws a line through the selected text, or if the cursor is in a word, the entire word.
f .uno%3AShadowed 56 Adds a shadow to the selected text, or if the cursor is in a word, to the entire word.
15 .uno%3ADistributeRows 60 Adjusts the height of the selected rows to match the height of the tallest row in the selection.
11 .uno%3ASpacePara1 52 Applies single line spacing to the current paragraph. This is the default setting.
12 .uno%3ASpacePara15 45 Sets the line spacing of the current paragraph to one and half lines.
11 .uno%3ASpacePara2 3c Sets the line spacing of the current paragraph to two lines.
18 .uno%3ADistributeColumns 63 Adjusts the width of the selected columns to match the width of the widest column in the selection.
18 .uno%3AStyleNewByExample 1f Enter a name for the new Style.
33 sfx2%3AComboBox%3ADLG_NEW_STYLE_BY_EXAMPLE%3ALB_COL 1f Enter a name for the new Style.
29 sw%3AEdit%3ADLG_SWDLG_STRINPUT%3AED_INPUT 37 Enter a name for the new AutoFormat, and then click OK.
13 .uno%3ARenameObject 60 Assigns a name to the selected object, so that you can quickly find the object in the Navigator.
32 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXDLG_OBJECT_NAME%3ANTD_EDT_NAME 50 Enter a name for the selected object. The name will be visible in the Navigator.
1e SW_HID_FORMAT_NAME_OBJECT_NAME 50 Enter a name for the selected object. The name will be visible in the Navigator.
1b SD_HID_SD_NAMEDIALOG_OBJECT 50 Enter a name for the selected object. The name will be visible in the Navigator.
10 .uno%3ANameGroup 60 Assigns a name to the selected object, so that you can quickly find the object in the Navigator.
39 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXDLG_OBJECT_TITLE_DESC%3ANTD_EDT_TITLE 7c Enter a title text. This short name is visible as an alternative tag in HTML format. Accessibility tools can read this text.
1d .uno%3AObjectTitleDescription 9c Assigns a title and a description to the selected object. These are accessible for accessibility tools and as alternative tags when you export the document.
41 cui%3AMultiLineEdit%3ARID_SVXDLG_OBJECT_TITLE_DESC%3ANTD_EDT_DESC e3 Enter a description text. The long description text can be entered to describe a complex object or group of objects to users with screen reader software. The description is visible as an alternative tag for accessibility tools.
11 .uno%3AFormatLine 32 Sets the formatting options for the selected line.
11 .uno%3AXLineColor 1c Select a color for the line.
11 .uno%3AXLineStyle 2b Select the line style that you want to use.
33 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_LINE%3ACB_SYMBOL_RATIO 53 Maintains the proportions of the symbol when you enter a new height or width value.
2f cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_LINE%3ALB_END_STYLE 41 Select the arrowhead that you want to apply to the selected line.
31 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_LINE%3ALB_START_STYLE 41 Select the arrowhead that you want to apply to the selected line.
11 CUI_HID_LINE_LINE 93 Set the formatting options for the selected line or the line that you want to draw. You can also add arrowheads to a line, or change chart symbols.
2b cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_LINE%3ALB_COLOR 1c Select a color for the line.
36 cui%3AMenuButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_LINE%3AMB_SYMBOL_BITMAP 3b Select the symbol style that you want to use in your chart.
36 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_LINE%3AMF_SYMBOL_WIDTH 1d Enter a width for the symbol.
3b cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_LINE%3AMTR_LINE_TRANSPARENT 71 Enter the transparency of the line, where 100% corresponds to completely transparent and 0% to completely opaque.
37 cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_LINE%3ATSB_CENTER_START 4e Places the center of the arrowhead(s) on the endpoint(s) of the selected line.
33 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_LINE%3ACBX_SYNCHRONIZE 8a Automatically updates both arrowhead settings when you enter a different width, select a different arrowhead style,or center an arrowhead.
37 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_LINE%3AMF_SYMBOL_HEIGHT 1e Enter a height for the symbol.
35 cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_LINE%3ATSB_CENTER_END 4e Places the center of the arrowhead(s) on the endpoint(s) of the selected line.
39 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_LINE%3AMTR_FLD_LINE_WIDTH 99 Select the width for the line. You can append a measurement unit. A zero line width results in a hairline with a width of one pixel of the output medium.
30 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_LINE%3ALB_LINE_STYLE 2b Select the line style that you want to use.
10 .uno%3ALineWidth 99 Select the width for the line. You can append a measurement unit. A zero line width results in a hairline with a width of one pixel of the output medium.
3a cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_LINE%3AMTR_FLD_START_WIDTH 20 Enter a width for the arrowhead.
38 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_LINE%3AMTR_FLD_END_WIDTH 20 Enter a width for the arrowhead.
3b cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_LINE_DEF%3AMTR_FLD_LENGTH_2 1d Enter the length of the dash.
34 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_LINE_DEF%3ABTN_MODIFY 8a Updates the selected line style using the current settings. To change the name of the selected line style, enter a new name when prompted.
29 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXDLG_NAME%3AEDT_STRING d Enter a name.
3b cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_LINE_DEF%3AMTR_FLD_LENGTH_1 1d Enter the length of the dash.
34 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_LINE_DEF%3ALB_LINESTYLES 31 Select the style of line that you want to create.
35 cui%3ANumericField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_LINE_DEF%3ANUM_FLD_2 50 Enter the number of times that you want a dot or a dash to appear in a sequence.
31 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_LINE_DEF%3ABTN_ADD 34 Creates a new line style using the current settings.
35 cui%3ANumericField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_LINE_DEF%3ANUM_FLD_1 50 Enter the number of times that you want a dot or a dash to appear in a sequence.
10 CUI_HID_LINE_DEF 2c Edit or create dashed or dotted line styles.
33 cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_LINE_DEF%3ABTN_SAVE 4b Saves the current list of line styles, so that you can load it again later.
3b cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_LINE_DEF%3AMTR_FLD_DISTANCE 48 Enter the amount of space that you want to leave between dots or dashes.
37 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_LINE_DEF%3ACBX_SYNCHRONIZE 45 Automatically adjusts the entries relative to the length of the line.
30 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_LINE_DEF%3ALB_TYPE_1 38 Select the combination of dashes and dots that you want.
33 cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_LINE_DEF%3ABTN_LOAD 1e Imports a list of line styles.
30 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_LINE_DEF%3ALB_TYPE_2 38 Select the combination of dashes and dots that you want.
36 cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_LINEEND_DEF%3ABTN_SAVE 46 Saves the current list of arrow styles, so that you can load it later.
2f cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_LINEEND_DEF%3AEDT_NAME 2e Displays the name of the selected arrow style.
13 CUI_HID_LINE_ENDDEF 1c Edit or create arrow styles.
36 cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_LINEEND_DEF%3ABTN_LOAD 1f Imports a list of arrow styles.
34 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_LINEEND_DEF%3ABTN_ADD 5d To define a custom arrow style, select a drawing object in the document, and then click here.
37 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_LINEEND_DEF%3ABTN_MODIFY 2d Changes the name of the selected arrow style.
35 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_LINEEND_DEF%3ALB_LINEENDS 39 Choose a predefined arrow style symbol from the list box.
11 .uno%3AFormatArea 38 Sets the fill properties of the selected drawing object.
2e cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_AREA%3ALB_GRADIENT 3d Click the fill that you want to apply to the selected object.
36 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_AREA%3ALB_HATCHBCKGRDCOLOR 57 Click the color that you want to use as a background for the selected hatching pattern.
2b cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_AREA%3ALB_COLOR 3d Click the fill that you want to apply to the selected object.
2e cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_AREA%3ARBT_ROW 63 Horizontally offsets the original bitmap relative to the bitmap tiles by the amount that you enter.
34 cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_AREA%3ATSB_STEPCOUNT 5d Automatically determines the number of steps for blending the two end colors of the gradient.
11 CUI_HID_AREA_AREA 35 Set the fill options for the selected drawing object.
2f cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_AREA%3ATSB_TILE 2d Tiles the bitmap to fill the selected object.
35 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_AREA%3AMTR_FLD_Y_SIZE 1e Enter a height for the bitmap.
10 .uno%3AFillStyle 4e Select the type of fill that you want to apply to the selected drawing object.
35 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_AREA%3AMTR_FLD_OFFSET 33 Enter the percentage to offset the rows or columns.
33 cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_AREA%3ATSB_ORIGINAL 8d Retains the original size of the bitmap when filling the selected object. To resize the bitmap, clear this checkbox, and then click Relative.
30 cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_AREA%3ATSB_SCALE fd Rescales the bitmap relative to the size of the selected object by the percentage values that you enter in the Width and Height boxes . Clear this checkbox to resize the selected object with the measurements that you enter in the Width and Height boxes.
31 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_AREA%3ARBT_COLUMN 61 Vertically offsets the original bitmap relative to the bitmap tiles by the amount that you enter.
32 cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_AREA%3ATSB_STRETCH 5a Stretches the bitmap to fill the selected object. To use this feature, clear the Tile box.
2e cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_AREA%3ALB_HATCHING 3d Click the fill that you want to apply to the selected object.
39 cui%3ANumericField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_AREA%3ANUM_FLD_STEPCOUNT 4a Enter the number of steps for blending the two end colors of the gradient.
37 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_AREA%3AMTR_FLD_X_OFFSET 32 Enter the horizontal offset for tiling the bitmap.
35 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_AREA%3AMTR_FLD_X_SIZE 1d Enter a width for the bitmap.
32 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_AREA%3ACB_HATCHBCKGRD 6d Applies a background color to the hatching pattern. Select this checkbox, and then click a color in the list.
37 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_AREA%3AMTR_FLD_Y_OFFSET 30 Enter the vertical offset for tiling the bitmap.
2c cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_AREA%3ALB_BITMAP 3d Click the fill that you want to apply to the selected object.
15 CUI_HID_AREA_GRADIENT 42 Set the properties of a gradient, or save and load gradient lists.
39 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRADIENT%3AMTR_COLOR_FROM 72 Enter the intensity for the color in the From box, where 0% corresponds to black, and 100 % to the selected color.
33 cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRADIENT%3ABTN_LOAD 23 Load a different list of gradients.
34 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRADIENT%3AMTR_ANGLE 31 Enter a rotation angle for the selected gradient.
31 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRADIENT%3ABTN_ADD 6f Adds a custom gradient to the current list. Specify the properties of your gradient, and then click this button
34 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRADIENT%3ALB_COLOR_FROM 37 Select a color for the beginning point of the gradient.
38 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRADIENT%3ALB_GRADIENT_TYPES 2b Select the gradient that you want to apply.
32 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRADIENT%3ALB_COLOR_TO 30 Select a color for the endpoint of the gradient.
33 cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRADIENT%3ABTN_SAVE 43 Saves the current list of gradients, so that you can load it later.
37 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRADIENT%3AMTR_CENTER_X cc Enter the horizontal offset for the gradient, where 0% corresponds to the current horizontal location of the endpoint color in the gradient. The endpoint color is the color that is selected in the To box.
37 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRADIENT%3AMTR_CENTER_Y c8 Enter the vertical offset for the gradient, where 0% corresponds to the current vertical location of the endpoint color in the gradient. The endpoint color is the color that is selected in the To box.
37 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRADIENT%3AMTR_COLOR_TO 70 Enter the intensity for the color in the To box, where 0% corresponds to black, and 100 % to the selected color.
35 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRADIENT%3AMTR_BORDER 9c Enter the amount by which you want to adjust the area of the endpoint color on the gradient. The endpoint color is the color that is selected in the To box.
33 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRADIENT%3ALB_GRADIENTS 3d Select the type of gradient that you want to apply or create.
34 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRADIENT%3ABTN_MODIFY 80 Applies the current gradient properties to the selected gradient. If you want, you can save the gradient under a different name.
30 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HATCH%3ALB_LINE_TYPE 34 Select the type of hatch lines that you want to use.
2e cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HATCH%3ABTN_ADD 80 Adds a custom hatching pattern to the current list. Specify the properties of your hatching pattern, and then click this button.
35 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HATCH%3AMTR_FLD_ANGLE 54 Enter the rotation angle for the hatch lines, or click a position in the angle grid.
12 CUI_HID_AREA_HATCH 4a Set the properties of a hatching pattern, or save and load hatching lists.
30 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HATCH%3ALB_HATCHINGS 6c Lists the available hatching patterns. Click the hatching pattern that you want to apply, and then click OK.
30 cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HATCH%3ABTN_SAVE 4b Saves the current list of hatching patterns, so that you can load it later.
30 cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HATCH%3ABTN_LOAD 2c Loads a different list of hatching patterns.
14 CUI_HID_TPHATCH_CTRL 4e Click a position in the grid to define the rotation angle for the hatch lines.
31 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HATCH%3ABTN_MODIFY 87 Applies the current hatching properties to the selected hatching pattern. If you want, you can save the pattern under a different name.
38 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HATCH%3AMTR_FLD_DISTANCE 48 Enter the amount of space that you want to have between the hatch lines.
31 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HATCH%3ALB_LINE_COLOR 24 Select the color of the hatch lines.
32 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_BITMAP%3ABTN_MODIFY 97 Replaces a bitmap that you created in the Pattern Editor with the current bitmap pattern. If you want, you can save the pattern under a different name.
31 cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_BITMAP%3ABTN_LOAD 22 Loads a different list of bitmaps.
38 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_BITMAP%3ALB_BACKGROUND_COLOR 32 Select a background color for your bitmap pattern.
31 cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_BITMAP%3ABTN_SAVE 41 Saves the current list of bitmaps, so that you can load it later.
2d cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_BITMAP%3ALB_COLOR 54 Select a foreground color, and then click in the grid to add a pixel to the pattern.
13 CUI_HID_AREA_BITMAP 95 Select a bitmap that you want to use as a fill pattern, or create your own pixel pattern. You can also import bitmaps, and save or load bitmap lists.
32 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_BITMAP%3ABTN_IMPORT 80 Locate the bitmap that you want to import, and then click Open. The bitmap is added to the end of the list of available bitmaps.
2f cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_BITMAP%3ALB_BITMAPS 5b Select a bitmap in the list, and then click OK to apply the pattern to the selected object.
2f cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_BITMAP%3ABTN_ADD 49 Adds a bitmap that you created in the Pattern Editor to the current list.
15 CUI_HID_TPSHADOW_CTRL 28 Click where you want to cast the shadow.
11 .uno%3AFillShadow c9 Adds a shadow to the selected object. If the object already has a shadow, the shadow is removed. If you click this icon when no object is selected, the shadow is added to the next object that you draw.
34 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_SHADOW%3ALB_SHADOW_COLOR 1e Select a color for the shadow.
39 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_SHADOW%3AMTR_FLD_DISTANCE 52 Enter the distance that you want the shadow to be offset from the selected object.
3f cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_SHADOW%3AMTR_SHADOW_TRANSPARENT 64 Enter a percentage from 0% (opaque) to 100% (transparent) to specify the transparency of the shadow.
38 cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_SHADOW%3ATSB_SHOW_SHADOW 2d Adds a shadow to the selected drawing object.
13 CUI_HID_AREA_SHADOW 55 Add a shadow to the selected drawing object, and define the properties of the shadow.
40 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TRANSPARENCE%3AMTR_TRGR_CENTER_X 2d Enter the horizontal offset for the gradient.
41 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TRANSPARENCE%3AMTR_TRGR_END_VALUE 74 Enter a transparency value for the endpoint of the gradient, where 0% is fully opaque and 100% is fully transparent.
3d cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TRANSPARENCE%3AMTR_TRGR_ANGLE 28 Enter a rotation angle for the gradient.
3f cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TRANSPARENCE%3ARBT_TRANS_LINEAR 8c Turns on color transparency. Select this option, and then enter a number in the box, where 0% is fully opaque and 100% is fully transparent.
3c cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TRANSPARENCE%3ARBT_TRANS_OFF 1d Turns off color transparency.
43 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TRANSPARENCE%3AMTR_TRGR_START_VALUE 7b Enter a transparency value for the beginning point of the gradient, where 0% is fully opaque and 100% is fully transparent.
41 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TRANSPARENCE%3ALB_TRGR_GRADIENT_TYPES 40 Select the type of transparency gradient that you want to apply.
3e cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TRANSPARENCE%3AMTR_TRANSPARENT 6e Adjusts the transparency of the current fill color. Enter a number between 0% (opaque) and 100% (transparent).
41 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TRANSPARENCE%3ARBT_TRANS_GRADIENT 74 Applies a transparency gradient to the current fill color. Select this option, and then set the gradient properties.
3e cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TRANSPARENCE%3AMTR_TRGR_BORDER 6b Enter the amount by which you want to adjust the transparent area of the gradient. The default value is 0%.
40 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TRANSPARENCE%3AMTR_TRGR_CENTER_Y 2b Enter the vertical offset for the gradient.
15 .uno%3ATextAttributes 59 Sets the layout and anchoring properties for text in the selected drawing or text object.
15 CUI_HID_PAGE_TEXTATTR 59 Sets the layout and anchoring properties for text in the selected drawing or text object.
3e cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TEXTATTR%3ATSB_AUTOGROW_HEIGHT 63 Expands the height of the object to the height of the text, if the object is smaller than the text.
36 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TEXTATTR%3AMTR_FLD_TOP 77 Enter the amount of space to leave between the top edge of the drawing or text object and the upper border of the text.
1d CUI_HID_TEXTATTR_CTL_POSITION 36 Click where you want to place the anchor for the text.
39 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TEXTATTR%3AMTR_FLD_BOTTOM 7a Enter the amount of space to leave between the bottom edge of the drawing or text object and the lower border of the text.
3a cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TEXTATTR%3ATSB_FIT_TO_SIZE 46 Resizes the text to fit the entire area of the drawing or text object.
3c cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TEXTATTR%3ATSB_WORDWRAP_TEXT 59 Wraps the text that you add after double-clicking a custom shape to fit inside the shape.
38 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TEXTATTR%3AMTR_FLD_RIGHT 79 Enter the amount of space to leave between the right edge of the drawing or text object and the right border of the text.
3c cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TEXTATTR%3ATSB_AUTOGROW_SIZE 56 Resizes a custom shape to fit the text that you enter after double-clicking the shape.
37 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TEXTATTR%3AMTR_FLD_LEFT 77 Enter the amount of space to leave between the left edge of the drawing or text object and the left border of the text.
3d cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TEXTATTR%3ATSB_AUTOGROW_WIDTH 61 Expands the width of the object to the width of the text, if the object is smaller than the text.
36 cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TEXTATTR%3ATSB_CONTOUR 54 Adapts the text flow so that it matches the contours of the selected drawing object.
39 cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TEXTATTR%3ATSB_FULL_WIDTH 48 Anchors the text to the full width of the drawing object or text object.
16 .uno%3ATransformDialog 37 Resizes, moves, rotates, or slants the selected object.
35 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_POSITION_SIZE%3ALB_ANCHOR 0 
3d cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_POSITION_SIZE%3AMTR_FLD_POS_X 6f Enter the horizontal distance that you want to move the object relative to the base point selected in the grid.
42 cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_POSITION_SIZE%3ATSB_AUTOGROW_WIDTH 39 Resizes the text to fit the width of the selected object.
3d cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_POSITION_SIZE%3AMTR_FLD_WIDTH 26 Enter a width for the selected object.
13 CUI_HID_TPSIZE_CTRL 7d Click a base point in the grid, and then enter the new size dimensions for the selected object in the Width and Height boxes.
36 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_POSITION_SIZE%3ACBX_SCALE 3a Maintains proportions when you resize the selected object.
35 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_POSITION_SIZE%3ALB_ORIENT 0 
3e cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_POSITION_SIZE%3ATSB_POSPROTECT 44 Prevents changes to the position or the size of the selected object.
17 CUI_HID_TPPOSITION_CTRL f2 Click a base point in the grid, and then enter the amount that you want to shift the object relative to the base point that you selected in the Position Y and Position X boxes. The base points correspond to the selection handles on an object.
3e cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_POSITION_SIZE%3AMTR_FLD_HEIGHT 27 Enter a height for the selected object.
3f cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_POSITION_SIZE%3ATSB_SIZEPROTECT 26 Prevents you from resizing the object.
3d cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_POSITION_SIZE%3AMTR_FLD_POS_Y 6d Enter the vertical distance that you want to move the object relative to the base point selected in the grid.
43 cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_POSITION_SIZE%3ATSB_AUTOGROW_HEIGHT 3a Resizes the text to fit the height of the selected object.
35 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ANGLE%3AMTR_FLD_ANGLE 48 Enter the number of degrees that you want to rotate the selected object.
18 CUI_HID_TPROTATION_CTRL2 3f Click to specify the rotation angle in multiples of 45 degrees.
18 CUI_HID_TPROTATION_CTRL1 2e Click where you want to place the pivot point.
13 CUI_HID_TRANS_ANGLE 1c Rotates the selected object.
35 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ANGLE%3AMTR_FLD_POS_Y 4d Enter the vertical distance from the top edge of the page to the pivot point.
35 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ANGLE%3AMTR_FLD_POS_X 50 Enter the horizontal distance from the left edge of the page to the pivot point.
35 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_SLANT%3AMTR_FLD_ANGLE 22 Enter the angle of the slant axis.
36 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_SLANT%3AMTR_FLD_RADIUS 49 Enter the radius of the circle that you want to use to round the corners.
13 CUI_HID_TRANS_SLANT 4a Slants the selected object, or rounds the corners of a rectangular object.
30 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CAPTION%3ACB_LAENGE 3d Click here to display a single-angled line in an optimal way.
2f cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CAPTION%3ALB_ANSATZ 56 Select where you want to extend the callout line from, in relation to the callout box.
2f cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CAPTION%3ALB_WINKEL 47 Click the Callout style that you want to apply to the selected callout.
33 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CAPTION%3AMF_ANSATZ 56 Select where you want to extend the callout line from, in relation to the callout box.
33 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CAPTION%3ALB_ANSATZ_REL 56 Select where you want to extend the callout line from, in relation to the callout box.
33 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CAPTION%3AMF_LAENGE 73 Enter the length of the callout line segment that extends from the callout box to the inflection point of the line.
34 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CAPTION%3AMF_ABSTAND 6a Enter the amount of space that you want to leave between the end of the callout line, and the callout box.
18 CUI_HID_CAPTION_CTL_TYPE 47 Click the Callout style that you want to apply to the selected callout.
f .uno%3AFlipMenu 36 Flips the selected object horizontally, or vertically.
1b .uno%3AObjectMirrorVertical 3b Flips the selected object(s) vertically from top to bottom.
11 .uno%3AMirrorVert 3b Flips the selected object(s) vertically from top to bottom.
1d .uno%3AObjectMirrorHorizontal 3d Flips the selected object(s) horizontally from left to right.
11 .uno%3AMirrorHorz 3d Flips the selected object(s) horizontally from left to right.
15 .uno%3AObjectPosition 35 Changes the stacking order of the selected object(s).
12 .uno%3AArrangeMenu 35 Changes the stacking order of the selected object(s).
17 .uno%3AArrangeFrameMenu 35 Changes the stacking order of the selected object(s).
13 .uno%3ABringToFront 64 Moves the selected object to the top of the stacking order, so that it is in front of other objects.
e .uno%3AForward 5a Moves the selected object up one level, so that it is closer to top of the stacking order.
17 .uno%3AObjectForwardOne 5a Moves the selected object up one level, so that it is closer to top of the stacking order.
f .uno%3ABackward 63 Moves the selected object down one level, so that it is closer to the bottom of the stacking order.
14 .uno%3AObjectBackOne 63 Moves the selected object down one level, so that it is closer to the bottom of the stacking order.
11 .uno%3ASendToBack 66 Moves the selected object to the bottom of the stacking order, so that it is behind the other objects.
1c .uno%3ASetObjectToForeground 2b Moves the selected object in front of text.
1c .uno%3ASetObjectToBackground 26 Moves the selected object behind text.
11 .uno%3AAnchorMenu 33 Sets the anchoring options for the selected object.
16 .uno%3ASetAnchorToPage 2e Anchors the selected item to the current page.
16 .uno%3ASetAnchorToPara 33 Anchors the selected item to the current paragraph.
16 .uno%3ASetAnchorToCell 24 Anchors the selected item to a cell.
17 .uno%3ASetAnchorToFrame 33 Anchors the selected item to the surrounding frame.
16 .uno%3ASetAnchorAsChar c0 Anchors the selected item as a character in the current text. If the height of the selected item is greater than the current font size, the height of the line containing the item is increased.
16 .uno%3ASetAnchorToChar c0 Anchors the selected item as a character in the current text. If the height of the selected item is greater than the current font size, the height of the line containing the item is increased.
1d .uno%3AToggleObjectBezierMode 39 Lets you change the shape of the selected drawing object.
1f SVX_HID_FONTWORK_TBI_SHADOW_OFF 38 Removes the shadow effects that you applied to the text.
21 SVX_HID_FONTWORK_TBI_STYLE_ROTATE 4c Uses the top or the bottom edge of the selected object as the text baseline.
24 SVX_HID_FONTWORK_TBI_ADJUST_AUTOSIZE 38 Resizes the text to fit the length of the text baseline.
20 SVX_HID_FONTWORK_TBI_ADJUST_LEFT 35 Aligns the text to the left end of the text baseline.
f .uno%3AFontWork 66 Edits Fontwork effects of the selected object that has been created with the previous Fontwork dialog.
3a svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXDLG_FONTWORK%3AMTR_FLD_SHADOW_X 55 Enter the horizontal distance between the text characters and the edge of the shadow.
21 SVX_HID_FONTWORK_TBI_STYLE_SLANTX 36 Horizontally slants the characters in the text object.
36 svx%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_FONTWORK%3ACLB_SHADOW_COLOR 23 Select a color for the text shadow.
1c SVX_HID_FONTWORK_TBI_OUTLINE 44 Shows or hides the borders of the individual characters in the text.
22 SVX_HID_FONTWORK_TBI_ADJUST_CENTER 26 Centers the text on the text baseline.
3a svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXDLG_FONTWORK%3AMTR_FLD_DISTANCE 75 Enter the amount of space that you want to leave between the text baseline and the base of the individual characters.
3b svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXDLG_FONTWORK%3AMTR_FLD_TEXTSTART 6d Enter the amount of space to leave between the beginning of the text baseline, and the beginning of the text.
1e SVX_HID_FONTWORK_TBI_STYLE_OFF 1c Removes baseline formatting.
3a svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXDLG_FONTWORK%3AMTR_FLD_SHADOW_Y 53 Enter the vertical distance between the text characters and the edge of the shadow.
21 SVX_HID_FONTWORK_TBI_SHADOW_SLANT a2 Adds a slant shadow to the text in the selected object. Click this button, and then enter the dimensions of the shadow in the Distance X and the Distance Y boxes.
21 SVX_HID_FONTWORK_TBI_ADJUST_RIGHT 36 Aligns the text to the right end of the text baseline.
22 SVX_HID_FONTWORK_TBI_SHADOW_NORMAL 9c Adds a shadow to the text in the selected object. Click this button, and then enter the dimensions of the shadow in the Distance X and the Distance Y boxes.
1a SVX_HID_FONTWORK_CTL_FORMS 42 Click the shape of the baseline that you want to use for the text.
21 SVX_HID_FONTWORK_TBI_STYLE_SLANTY 34 Vertically slants the characters in the text object.
1d SVX_HID_FONTWORK_TBI_SHOWFORM 46 Shows or hides the text baseline, or the edges of the selected object.
22 SVX_HID_FONTWORK_TBI_ADJUST_MIRROR 9c Reverses the text flow direction, and flips the text horizontally or vertically. To use this command, you must first apply a different baseline to the text.
22 SVX_HID_FONTWORK_TBI_STYLE_UPRIGHT 97 Uses the top or the bottom edge of the selected object as the text baseline and preserves the original vertical alignment of the individual characters.
10 .uno%3AGroupMenu 61 Groups keep together selected objects, so that they can be moved or formatted as a single object.
12 .uno%3AFormatGroup 4a Groups the selected objects, so that they can be moved as a single object.
14 .uno%3AFormatUngroup 38 Breaks apart the selected group into individual objects.
11 .uno%3AEnterGroup a1 Opens the selected group, so that you can edit the individual objects. If the selected group contains nested group, you can repeat this command on the subgroups.
11 .uno%3ALeaveGroup 54 Exits the group, so that you can no longer edit the individual objects in the group.
3f cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TEXTANIMATION%3ATSB_STOP_INSIDE 31 Text remains visible after the effect is applied.
3b cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TEXTANIMATION%3ATSB_ENDLESS 9a Plays the animation effect continuously. To specify the number of times to play the effect, clear this checkbox, and enter a number in the Continuous box.
35 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TEXTANIMATION%3ALB_EFFECT 8f Select the animation effect that you want to apply to the text in the selected drawing object. To remove an animation effect, select No Effect.
39 cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TEXTANIMATION%3ABTN_RIGHT 20 Scrolls text from left to right.
40 cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TEXTANIMATION%3ATSB_START_INSIDE 49 Text is visible and inside the drawing object when the effect is applied.
38 cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TEXTANIMATION%3ABTN_DOWN 20 Scrolls text from top to bottom.
39 cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TEXTANIMATION%3ATSB_PIXEL 23 Measures increment value in pixels.
38 cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TEXTANIMATION%3ABTN_LEFT 20 Scrolls text from right to left.
36 cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TEXTANIMATION%3ABTN_UP 20 Scrolls text from bottom to top.
3d cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TEXTANIMATION%3AMTR_FLD_DELAY 3d Enter the amount of time to wait before repeating the effect.
3e cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TEXTANIMATION%3AMTR_FLD_AMOUNT 3b Enter the number of increments by which to scroll the text.
38 cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TEXTANIMATION%3ATSB_AUTO c5 $[officename] automatically determines the amount of time to wait before repeating the effect. To manually assign the delay period, clear this checkbox, and then enter a value in the Automatic box.
29 cui%3ATabPage%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TEXTANIMATION 44 Adds an animation effect to the text in the selected drawing object.
3e cui%3ANumericField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_TEXTANIMATION%3ANUM_FLD_COUNT 47 Enter the number of times that you want the animation effect to repeat.
1e DBACCESS_HID_BROWSER_ROWHEIGHT 3c Changes the height of the current row, or the selected rows.
2e sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_ROW_MAN%3ABTN_DEFVAL c1 Adjusts the row height to the size based on the default template. Existing contents may be shown vertically cropped. The height no longer increases automatically when you enter larger contents.
2f sc%3AMetricField%3ARID_SCDLG_ROW_MAN%3AED_VALUE 2a Enter the row height that you want to use.
31 dbaccess%3AMetricField%3ADLG_ROWHEIGHT%3AMF_VALUE 2a Enter the row height that you want to use.
10 .uno%3ARowHeight 3c Changes the height of the current row, or the selected rows.
31 dbaccess%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_ROWHEIGHT%3ACB_STANDARD c1 Adjusts the row height to the size based on the default template. Existing contents may be shown vertically cropped. The height no longer increases automatically when you enter larger contents.
30 dbaccess%3AMetricField%3ADLG_COLWIDTH%3AMF_VALUE 2c Enter the column width that you want to use.
12 .uno%3AColumnWidth 41 Changes the width of the current column, or the selected columns.
2f sc%3AMetricField%3ARID_SCDLG_COL_MAN%3AED_VALUE 2c Enter the column width that you want to use.
30 dbaccess%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_COLWIDTH%3ACB_STANDARD 41 Automatically adjusts the column width based on the current font.
2e sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_COL_MAN%3ABTN_DEFVAL 41 Automatically adjusts the column width based on the current font.
20 DBACCESS_HID_BROWSER_COLUMNWIDTH 41 Changes the width of the current column, or the selected columns.
11 CUI_HID_ALIGNMENT 57 Sets the alignment options for the contents of the current cell, or the selected cells.
3e cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ALIGNMENT%3ABTN_ASIAN_VERTICAL 133 Aligns Asian characters one below the other in the selected cell(s). If the cell contains more than one line of text, the lines are converted to text columns that are arranged from right to left. Western characters in the converted text are rotated 90 degrees to the right. Asian characters are not rotated.
37 cui%3ANumericField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ALIGNMENT%3ANF_DEGREES a2 Enter the rotation angle for the text in the selected cell(s). A positive number rotates the text to the left and a negative number rotates the text to the right.
33 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ALIGNMENT%3ALB_VERALIGN 51 Select the vertical alignment option that you want to apply to the cell contents.
36 cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ALIGNMENT%3ABTN_SHRINK aa Reduces the apparent size of the font so that the contents of the cell fit into the current cell width. You cannot apply this command to a cell that contains line breaks.
33 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ALIGNMENT%3ALB_HORALIGN 53 Select the horizontal alignment option that you want to apply to the cell contents.
34 cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ALIGNMENT%3ABTN_HYPH 3c Enables word hyphenation for text wrapping to the next line.
1a CUI_HID_ALIGNMENT_CTR_DIAL 2e Click in the dial to set the text orientation.
35 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ALIGNMENT%3AED_INDENT 44 Indents from the left edge of the cell by the amount that you enter.
34 cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ALIGNMENT%3ABTN_WRAP 66 Wraps text onto another line at the cell border. The number of lines depends on the width of the cell.
21 CUI_HID_ALIGNMENT_CTR_BORDER_LOCK 3b Specify the cell edge from which to write the rotated text.
3a cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ALIGNMENT%3ABTN_TXTSTACKED 17 Aligns text vertically.
18 SVX_HID_GRID_TRAVEL_PREV 27 Go to the previous record in the table.
18 SVX_HID_GRID_TRAVEL_LAST 23 Go to the last record in the table.
18 SVX_HID_GRID_TRAVEL_NEXT 23 Go to the next record in the table.
1b DBACCESS_HID_CTL_TABBROWSER 87 Select database records. Drag-and-drop rows or cells to the document to insert contents. Drag-and-drop column headers to insert fields.
1c SVX_HID_GRID_TRAVEL_ABSOLUTE 4d Type the number of the record that you want to display, and then press Enter.
1c SVX_HID_GRID_NUMBEROFRECORDS b7 Displays the number of records. For example, "Record 7 of 9(2)" indicates that two records (2) are selected in a table containing 9 records, and that the cursor is in record number 7.
19 SVX_HID_GRID_TRAVEL_FIRST 24 Go to the first record in the table.
17 SVX_HID_GRID_TRAVEL_NEW 2c Inserts a new record into the current table.
20 DBACCESS_HID_BROWSER_TABLEFORMAT 1c Formats the selected row(s).
21 DBACCESS_HID_BROWSER_COLUMNFORMAT 1f Formats the selected column(s).
f .uno%3AWindow3D 41 Specifies the properties of 3D object(s) in the current document.
33 svx%3ANumericField%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ANUM_VERTICAL 4f Enter the number of vertical segments to use in the selected 3D rotation object
2d svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_GEO 108 Adjusts the shape of the selected 3D object. You can only modify the shape of a 3D object that was created by converting a 2D object. To convert a 2D object to 3D, select the object, right-click, and then choose Convert - To 3D, or Convert - To 3D Rotation Object.
35 svx%3ANumericField%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ANUM_HORIZONTAL 52 Enter the number of horizontal segments to use in the selected 3D rotation object.
38 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_NORMALS_INVERT 19 Inverts the light source.
33 svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3AMTR_END_ANGLE 45 Enter the angle in degrees to rotate the selected 3D rotation object.
3a svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3AMTR_PERCENT_DIAGONAL 52 Enter the amount by which you want to round the corners of the selected 3D object.
36 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_NORMALS_FLAT 23 Renders the 3D surface as polygons.
38 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_NORMALS_SPHERE 1c Renders a smooth 3D surface.
3c svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_TWO_SIDED_LIGHTING 8f Lights the object from the outside and the inside. To use an ambient light source, click this button, and then click the Invert Normals button.
36 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_DOUBLE_SIDED 60 Closes the shape of a 3D object that was created by extruding a freeform line (Convert - To 3D).
35 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_NORMALS_OBJ 80 Renders the 3D surface according to the shape of the object. For example, a circular shape is rendered with a spherical surface.
33 svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3AMTR_BACKSCALE 67 Enter the amount by which to increase or decrease the area of the front side of the selected 3D object.
2f svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3AMTR_DEPTH 67 Enter the extrusion depth for the selected 3D object. This option is not valid for 3D rotation objects.
38 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_REPRESENTATION 3f Sets the shading and shadow options for the selected 3D object.
36 svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3AMTR_FOCAL_LENGTH 81 Enter the focal length of the camera, where a small value corresponds to a "fisheye" lens, and a large value to a telephoto lens.
2f svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3AMTR_SLANT 3b Enter an angle from 0 to 90 degrees for casting the shadow.
33 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_SHADOW_3D 35 Adds or removes a shadow from the selected 3D object.
32 svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3AMTR_DISTANCE 55 Enter the distance to leave between the camera and the center of the selected object.
2e svx%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ALB_SHADEMODE 135 Select the shading method that you want to use. Flat shading assigns a single color to a single polygon on the surface of the object. Gouraud shading blends colors across the polygons. Phong shading averages the color of each pixel based on the pixels that surround it, and requires the most processing power.
35 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_LIGHT_COLOR 25 Select a color for the ambient light.
31 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_LIGHT_2 d0 Click twice to turn the light source on, and then select a color for the light from the list. If you want, you can also set the color of the surrounding light, by selecting a color from the Ambient light box.
31 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_LIGHT_4 d0 Click twice to turn the light source on, and then select a color for the light from the list. If you want, you can also set the color of the surrounding light, by selecting a color from the Ambient light box.
2f svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_LIGHT 33 Define the light source for the selected 3D object.
31 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_LIGHT_1 d0 Click twice to turn the light source on, and then select a color for the light from the list. If you want, you can also set the color of the surrounding light, by selecting a color from the Ambient light box.
31 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_LIGHT_6 d0 Click twice to turn the light source on, and then select a color for the light from the list. If you want, you can also set the color of the surrounding light, by selecting a color from the Ambient light box.
31 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_LIGHT_7 d0 Click twice to turn the light source on, and then select a color for the light from the list. If you want, you can also set the color of the surrounding light, by selecting a color from the Ambient light box.
31 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_LIGHT_3 d0 Click twice to turn the light source on, and then select a color for the light from the list. If you want, you can also set the color of the surrounding light, by selecting a color from the Ambient light box.
2c svx%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ALB_LIGHT_1 2c Select a color for the current light source.
31 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_LIGHT_8 d0 Click twice to turn the light source on, and then select a color for the light from the list. If you want, you can also set the color of the surrounding light, by selecting a color from the Ambient light box.
31 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_LIGHT_5 d0 Click twice to turn the light source on, and then select a color for the light from the list. If you want, you can also set the color of the surrounding light, by selecting a color from the Ambient light box.
31 svx%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ALB_AMBIENTLIGHT 25 Select a color for the ambient light.
33 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_TEX_COLOR 1e Converts the texture to color.
31 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_TEXTURE 135 Sets the properties of the surface texture for the selected 3D object. This feature is only available after you apply a surface textures to the selected object. To quickly apply a surface texture, open the Gallery, hold down Shift+Ctrl (Mac: Shift+Command), and then drag an image onto the selected 3D object.
38 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_TEX_PARALLEL_X 34 Applies the texture parallel to the horizontal axis.
36 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_TEX_OBJECT_X 4c Automatically adjusts the texture based on the shape and size of the object.
35 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_TEX_REPLACE 24 Applies the texture without shading.
38 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_TEX_PARALLEL_Y 32 Applies the texture parallel to the vertical axis.
36 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_TEX_CIRCLE_X 41 Wraps the horizontal axis of the texture pattern around a sphere.
36 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_TEX_OBJECT_Y 4c Automatically adjusts the texture based on the shape and size of the object.
34 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_TEX_FILTER 37 Blurs the texture slightly to remove unwanted speckles.
36 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_TEX_CIRCLE_Y 3f Wraps the vertical axis of the texture pattern around a sphere.
37 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_TEX_LUMINANCE 28 Converts the texture to black and white.
36 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_TEX_MODULATE 79 Applies the texture with shading. To define the shading options for the texture, click the Shading button in this dialog.
38 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_SPECULAR_COLOR 2b Enter the intensity of the specular effect.
32 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_MATERIAL 2f Changes the coloring of the selected 3D object.
31 svx%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ALB_MAT_SPECULAR 35 Select the color that you want the object to reflect.
38 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_EMISSION_COLOR 35 Select the color that you want the object to reflect.
31 svx%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ALB_MAT_EMISSION 2a Select the color to illuminate the object.
40 svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3AMTR_MAT_SPECULAR_INTENSITY 2b Enter the intensity of the specular effect.
33 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_MAT_COLOR 2a Select the color to illuminate the object.
2e svx%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ALB_MAT_COLOR 36 Select the color that you want to apply to the object.
32 svx%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ALB_MAT_FAVORITES 59 Select a predefined color scheme, or select User-defined to define a custom color scheme.
3d cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_DISTRIBUTE%3ABTN_VER_DISTANCE 64 Distributes the selected objects vertically, so that the objects are evenly spaced from one another.
39 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_DISTRIBUTE%3ABTN_HOR_LEFT 6b Distributes the selected objects, so that the left edges of the objects are evenly spaced from one another.
38 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_DISTRIBUTE%3ABTN_VER_TOP 6a Distributes the selected objects, so that the top edges of the objects are evenly spaced from one another.
1a .uno%3ADistributeSelection 9d Distributes three or more selected objects evenly along the horizontal axis or the vertical axis. You can also evenly distribute the spacing between objects.
3b cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_DISTRIBUTE%3ABTN_VER_BOTTOM 6d Distributes the selected objects, so that the bottom edges of the objects are evenly spaced from one another.
3a cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_DISTRIBUTE%3ABTN_HOR_RIGHT 6c Distributes the selected objects, so that the right edges of the objects are evenly spaced from one another.
39 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_DISTRIBUTE%3ABTN_VER_NONE 2b Does not distribute the objects vertically.
3b cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_DISTRIBUTE%3ABTN_VER_CENTER 71 Distributes the selected objects, so that the vertical centers of the objects are evenly spaced from one another.
3b cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_DISTRIBUTE%3ABTN_HOR_CENTER 73 Distributes the selected objects, so that the horizontal centers of the objects are evenly spaced from one another.
39 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_DISTRIBUTE%3ABTN_HOR_NONE 2d Does not distribute the objects horizontally.
3d cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_DISTRIBUTE%3ABTN_HOR_DISTANCE 66 Distributes the selected objects horizontally, so that the objects are evenly spaced from one another.
1f CUI_HID_SPLDLG_BUTTON_CHANGEALL 49 Replaces all occurrences of the unknown word with the current suggestion.
20 CUI_HID_SPLDLG_BUTTON_IGNORERULE 74 While performing a grammar check, click Ignore Rule to ignore the rule that is currently flagged as a grammar error.
33 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_SPELLCHECK%3ALB_LANGUAGE 34 Specifies the language to use to check the spelling.
39 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_SPELLCHECK%3ACB_CHECK_GRAMMAR 58 Enable Check grammar to work first on all spellcheck errors, then on all grammar errors.
32 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_SPELLCHECK%3APB_UNDO 74 Click to undo the last change in the current sentence. Click again to undo the previous change in the same sentence.
37 cui%3AMenuButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_SPELLCHECK%3AMB_ADDTODICT 33 Adds the unknown word to a user-defined dictionary.
35 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_SPELLCHECK%3ALB_SUGGESTION 80 Lists suggested words to replace the misspelled word. Select the word that you want to use, and then click Change or Change All.
1f .uno%3ASpellingAndGrammarDialog 9a Checks the document or the current selection for spelling errors. If a grammar checking extension is installed, the dialog also checks for grammar errors.
1c CUI_HID_SPLDLG_BUTTON_CHANGE 8a Replaces the unknown word with the current suggestion. If you changed more than just the misspelled word, the entire sentence is replaced.
38 cui%3AMultiLineEdit%3ARID_SVXDLG_SPELLCHECK%3AED_NEWWORD 91 Displays the sentence with the misspelled word highlighted. Edit the word or the sentence, or click one of the suggestions in the text box below.
f .uno%3ASpelling 9a Checks the document or the current selection for spelling errors. If a grammar checking extension is installed, the dialog also checks for grammar errors.
35 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_SPELLCHECK%3APB_OPTIONS 6c Opens a dialog, where you can select the user-defined dictionaries, and set the rules for the spellchecking.
1f CUI_HID_SPLDLG_BUTTON_IGNOREALL 63 Skips all occurrences of the unknown word in the entire document and continues with the spellcheck.
36 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_SPELLCHECK%3APB_AUTOCORR 6c Opens a dialog, where you can select the user-defined dictionaries, and set the rules for the spellchecking.
1c CUI_HID_SPLDLG_BUTTON_IGNORE 39 Skips the unknown word and continues with the spellcheck.
17 .uno%3AMoreDictionaries 3d Opens the default browser on the dictionaries extension page.
13 .uno%3ALanguageMenu 40 Opens a submenu where you can choose language specific commands.
18 .uno%3AChineseConversion 8a Converts the selected Chinese text from one Chinese writing system to the other. If no text is selected, the entire document is converted.
35 svx%3AMenuButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_THESAURUS%3AMB_LANGUAGE 24 Select a language for the thesaurus.
16 .uno%3AThesaurusDialog 51 Opens a dialog box to replace the current word with a synonym, or a related term.
2b svx%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXDLG_THESAURUS%3AED_REPL af The word or words in the "Replace with" text box will replace the original word in the document when you click the Replace button. You can also type text directly in this box.
33 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_THESAURUS%3ABTN_LEFT 3d Recalls the previous contents of the "Current word" text box.
10 .uno%3AThesaurus 51 Opens a dialog box to replace the current word with a synonym, or a related term.
2f svx%3AComboBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_THESAURUS%3ACB_WORD b6 Displays the current word, or the related term that you selected by double-clicking a line in the Alternatives list. You can also type text directly in this box to look up your text.
1c CUI_HID_CT_THES_ALTERNATIVES c8 Click an entry in the Alternatives list to copy the related term to the "Replace with" text box. Double-click an entry to copy the related term to the "Current word" text box and to look up that term.
30 svx%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_BMPMASK%3ABTN_EXEC 74 Replaces the selected source colors in the current image with the colors that you specify in the Replace with boxes.
1b SVX_HID_BMPMASK_TBI_PIPETTE 8d Select one of the four source color boxes. Move the mouse pointer over the selected image, and then click the color that you want to replace.
2d svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXDLG_BMPMASK%3ASP_3 d3 Set the tolerance for replacing a source color in the source image. To replace colors that are similar to the color that you selected, enter a low value. To replace a wider range of colors, enter a higher value.
29 svx%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_BMPMASK%3ALB_1 96 Lists the available replacement colors. To modify the current list of colors, deselect the image, choose Format - Area, and then click the Colors tab.
1b SVX_HID_BMPMASK_CTL_PIPETTE a5 Displays the color in the selected image that directly underlies the current mouse pointer position. This features only works if the Color Replacer tool is selected.
2d svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXDLG_BMPMASK%3ASP_4 d3 Set the tolerance for replacing a source color in the source image. To replace colors that are similar to the color that you selected, enter a low value. To replace a wider range of colors, enter a higher value.
1a SVX_HID_BMPMASK_CTL_QCOL_1 af Displays the color in the selected image that you want to replace. To set the source color, click here, click the Color Replacer, and then click a color in the selected image.
2d svx%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_BMPMASK%3ALB_TRANS 47 Select the color to replace the transparent areas in the current image.
2b svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_BMPMASK%3ACBX_4 71 Select this checkbox to replace the current Source color with the color that you specify in the Replace with box.
2b svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_BMPMASK%3ACBX_3 71 Select this checkbox to replace the current Source color with the color that you specify in the Replace with box.
2d svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXDLG_BMPMASK%3ASP_2 d3 Set the tolerance for replacing a source color in the source image. To replace colors that are similar to the color that you selected, enter a low value. To replace a wider range of colors, enter a higher value.
2b svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_BMPMASK%3ACBX_2 71 Select this checkbox to replace the current Source color with the color that you specify in the Replace with box.
2b svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_BMPMASK%3ACBX_1 71 Select this checkbox to replace the current Source color with the color that you specify in the Replace with box.
e .uno%3ABmpMask 5f Opens the Color Replacer dialog, where you can replace colors in bitmap and meta file graphics.
2f svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_BMPMASK%3ACBX_TRANS 4f Replaces transparent areas in the current image with the color that you select.
29 svx%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_BMPMASK%3ALB_3 96 Lists the available replacement colors. To modify the current list of colors, deselect the image, choose Format - Area, and then click the Colors tab.
29 svx%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_BMPMASK%3ALB_4 96 Lists the available replacement colors. To modify the current list of colors, deselect the image, choose Format - Area, and then click the Colors tab.
2d svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXDLG_BMPMASK%3ASP_1 d3 Set the tolerance for replacing a source color in the source image. To replace colors that are similar to the color that you selected, enter a low value. To replace a wider range of colors, enter a higher value.
29 svx%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_BMPMASK%3ALB_2 96 Lists the available replacement colors. To modify the current list of colors, deselect the image, choose Format - Area, and then click the Colors tab.
15 .uno%3AAutoCorrectDlg 3e Sets the options for automatically replacing text as you type.
36 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOFMT_APPLY%3APB_EDIT 29 Modifies the selected AutoCorrect option.
20 CUI_HID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_OPTIONS 56 Select the options for automatically correcting errors as you type, and then click OK.
1c CUI_HID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_CLB 56 Select the options for automatically correcting errors as you type, and then click OK.
1e CUI_HID_OFAPAGE_AUTOFORMAT_CLB 56 Select the options for automatically correcting errors as you type, and then click OK.
1f CUI_HID_OFAPAGE_AUTOFMT_OPTIONS 56 Select the options for automatically correcting errors as you type, and then click OK.
20 CUI_HID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_REPLACE 6e Edits the replacement table for automatically correcting or replacing words or abbreviations in your document.
1f CUI_HID_OFACTL_AUTOCORR_REPLACE 12f Lists the entries for automatically replacing words or abbreviations while you type. To add an entry, enter text in the Replace and With boxes, and then click New. To edit an entry, select it, change the text in the With box, and then click Replace. To delete an entry, select it, and then click Delete.
34 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_REPLACE%3AED_SHORT 47 Enter the word or abbreviation that you want to replace while you type.
40 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_REPLACE%3APB_NEW_REPLACE 33 Adds or replaces an entry in the replacement table.
36 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_REPLACE%3AED_REPLACE f3 Enter the replacement text, graphic, frame, or OLE object that you want to replace the text in the Replace box. If you have selected text, a graphic, a frame, or an OLE object in your document, the relevant information is already entered here.
3c cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_REPLACE%3ACB_TEXT_ONLY 85 Saves the entry in the With box without formatting. When the replacement is made, the text uses the same format as the document text.
41 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_EXCEPT%3APB_NEWDOUBLECAPS 31 Adds the current entry to the list of exceptions.
34 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_EXCEPT%3AED_ABBREV d3 Type an abbreviation followed by a period, and then click New. This prevents $[officename] from automatically capitalizing the first letter of the word that comes after the period at the end of the abbreviation.
3d cui%3APushButton%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_EXCEPT%3APB_NEWABBREV 31 Adds the current entry to the list of exceptions.
1f CUI_HID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_EXCEPT 6d Specify the abbreviations or letter combinations that you do not want $[officename] to correct automatically.
3c cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_EXCEPT%3ACB_AUTOABBREV 12e Automatically adds abbreviations or words that start with two capital letters to the corresponding list of exceptions. This feature only works if the Correct TWo INitial CApitals option or the Capitalize first letter of every sentence option are selected in the [T] column onOptions tab of this dialog.
39 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_EXCEPT%3AED_DOUBLE_CAPS ce Type the word or abbreviation that starts with two capital letters that you do not want $[officename] to change to one initial capital. For example, enter PC to prevent $[officename] from changing PC to Pc.
3a cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_EXCEPT%3ACB_AUTOCAPS 12e Automatically adds abbreviations or words that start with two capital letters to the corresponding list of exceptions. This feature only works if the Correct TWo INitial CApitals option or the Capitalize first letter of every sentence option are selected in the [T] column onOptions tab of this dialog.
3c cui%3AListBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_EXCEPT%3ALB_DOUBLE_CAPS b3 Lists the words or abbreviations that start with two initial capitals that are not automatically corrected. All words which start with two capital letters are listed in the field.
37 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_EXCEPT%3ALB_ABBREV 3d Lists the abbreviations that are not automatically corrected.
19 CUI_HID_AUTOCORR_LANGUAGE 4f Select the language for which you want to create or edit the replacement rules.
3a cui%3APushButton%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_QUOTE%3APB_DBL_STD 32 Resets the quotation marks to the default symbols.
39 cui%3ACheckbox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_QUOTE%3ACB_SGL_TYPO 78 Automatically replaces the default system symbol for single quotation marks with the special character that you specify.
3d cui%3APushButton%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_QUOTE%3APB_STARTQUOTE 9e Select the special character that will automatically replace the current opening quotation mark in your document when you choose Format - AutoCorrect - Apply.
3a cui%3APushButton%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_QUOTE%3APB_SGL_STD 32 Resets the quotation marks to the default symbols.
41 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_QUOTE%3APB_SGL_STARTQUOTE 9e Select the special character that will automatically replace the current opening quotation mark in your document when you choose Format - AutoCorrect - Apply.
1c CUI_HID_OFAPAGE_QUOTE_SW_CLB 5a Select to apply the replacements while you type [T], or when you modify existing text [M].
3b cui%3APushButton%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_QUOTE%3APB_ENDQUOTE 9e Select the special character that will automatically replace the current closing quotation mark in your document when you choose Format - AutoCorrect - Apply.
3f cui%3APushButton%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_QUOTE%3APB_SGL_ENDQUOTE 9e Select the special character that will automatically replace the current closing quotation mark in your document when you choose Format - AutoCorrect - Apply.
35 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCORR_QUOTE%3ACB_TYPO 78 Automatically replaces the default system symbol for single quotation marks with the special character that you specify.
1a SW_HID_LINGU_WORD_LANGUAGE 63 Changes the language settings for the highlighted word, if the word is found in another dictionary.
15 SW_HID_LINGU_ADD_WORD 37 Adds the highlighted word to a user-defined dictionary.
19 SW_HID_LINGU_SPELLING_DLG 1c Opens the Spellcheck dialog.
22 EDITENG_HID_EDITENG_SPELLER_IGNORE 46 Ignores all instances of the highlighted word in the current document.
23 EDITENG_HID_EDITENG_SPELLER_ADDWORD 37 Adds the highlighted word to a user-defined dictionary.
1a SW_HID_LINGU_PARA_LANGUAGE 7e Changes the language setting for the paragraph that contains the highlighted word, if the word is found in another dictionary.
27 EDITENG_HID_EDITENG_SPELLER_AUTOCORRECT 9f To always replace the highlighted word, click a word in the list. The word pair is stored in the replacement table under Tools - AutoCorrect Options - Replace.
14 SW_HID_LINGU_REPLACE 66 Click the word to replace the highlighted word. Use the AutoCorrect submenu for permanent replacement.
15 SW_HID_LINGU_AUTOCORR 9f To always replace the highlighted word, click a word in the list. The word pair is stored in the replacement table under Tools - AutoCorrect Options - Replace.
21 EDITENG_HID_EDITENG_SPELLER_START 1c Opens the Spellcheck dialog.
18 SW_HID_LINGU_IGNORE_WORD 46 Ignores all instances of the highlighted word in the current document.
43 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCOMPLETE_OPTIONS%3ACB_APPEND_SPACE 49 If you do not add punctuation after the word, $[officename] adds a space.
3c cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCOMPLETE_OPTIONS%3ACB_ACTIV 92 Stores frequently used words, and automatically completes a word after you type three letters that match the first three letters of a stored word.
42 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCOMPLETE_OPTIONS%3ACB_REMOVE_LIST f7 When enabled, the list gets cleared when closing the current document. When disabled, makes the current Word Completion list available to other documents after you close the current document. The list remains available until you exit %PRODUCTNAME.
46 cui%3ANumericField%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCOMPLETE_OPTIONS%3ANF_MAX_ENTRIES 55 Enter the maximum number of words that you want to store in the Word Completion list.
42 cui%3AMultiListBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCOMPLETE_OPTIONS%3ALB_ENTRIES ed Lists the collected words. The list is valid until you close the current document. To make the list available to other documents in the current session, disable "When closing a document, remove the words collected from it from the list".
3d cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCOMPLETE_OPTIONS%3ACB_AS_TIP 2a Displays the completed word as a Help Tip.
46 cui%3ANumericField%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCOMPLETE_OPTIONS%3ANF_MIN_WORDLEN 5c Enter the minimum word length for a word to become eligible for the word completion feature.
3e cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCOMPLETE_OPTIONS%3ACB_COLLECT 87 Adds the frequently used words to a list. To remove a word from the Word Completion list, select the word, and then click Delete Entry.
40 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCOMPLETE_OPTIONS%3APB_ENTRIES 41 Removes the selected word or words from the Word Completion list.
41 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCOMPLETE_OPTIONS%3ADCB_EXPAND_KEY 4c Select the key that you want to use to accept the automatic word completion.
38 SVX_PUSHBUTTON_RID_OFAPAGE_SMARTTAG_OPTIONS_PB_SMARTTAGS 78 To configure a Smart Tag, select the name of the Smart Tag, then click Properties. Not all Smart Tags can be configured.
36 SVX_CHECKBOX_RID_OFAPAGE_SMARTTAG_OPTIONS_CB_SMARTTAGS 43 Enables Smart Tags to be evaluated and shown in your text document.
14 .uno%3AOutlineBullet 69 Adds numbering or bullets to the current paragraph, and lets you edit format of the numbering or bullets.
20 .uno%3ABulletsAndNumberingDialog 69 Adds numbering or bullets to the current paragraph, and lets you edit format of the numbering or bullets.
17 CUI_HID_VALUESET_BULLET 2c Click the bullet style that you want to use.
1a CUI_HID_VALUESET_SINGLENUM 2f Click the numbering style that you want to use.
14 CUI_HID_VALUESET_NUM 2d Click the outline style that you want to use.
31 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_PICK_BMP%3ACB_LINKED 6c If enabled, the graphics are inserted as links. If not enabled, the graphics are embedded into the document.
17 CUI_HID_VALUESET_NUMBMP 33 Click the graphics that you want to use as bullets.
30 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUM_OPTIONS%3AED_PREFIX 4c Enter a character or the text to display in front of the number in the list.
33 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUM_OPTIONS%3ACB_RATIO 2e Maintains the size proportions of the graphic.
36 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUM_OPTIONS%3APB_BULLET 4a Opens the Special Characters dialog, where you can select a bullet symbol.
36 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUM_OPTIONS%3ALB_BUL_COLOR 2f Select a color for the current numbering style.
37 cui%3ANumericField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUM_OPTIONS%3AED_START 32 Enter a new starting number for the current level.
33 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUM_OPTIONS%3ALB_ORIENT 2c Select the alignment option for the graphic.
34 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUM_OPTIONS%3ALB_CHARFMT 32 Enter a new starting number for the current level.
3b cui%3ANumericField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUM_OPTIONS%3ANF_ALL_LEVEL 32 Enter a new starting number for the current level.
36 cui%3AMenuButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUM_OPTIONS%3AMB_BITMAP 50 Select the graphic, or locate the graphic file that you want to use as a bullet.
36 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUM_OPTIONS%3AMF_WIDTH 1e Enter a width for the graphic.
37 cui%3AMultiListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUM_OPTIONS%3ALB_LEVEL 47 Select the level(s) that you want to define the formatting options for.
3d cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUM_OPTIONS%3AMF_BUL_REL_SIZE 7b Enter the amount by which you want to resize the bullet character with respect to the font height of the current paragraph.
37 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUM_OPTIONS%3AMF_HEIGHT 1f Enter a height for the graphic.
30 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUM_OPTIONS%3AED_SUFFIX a0 Enter a character or the text to display behind the number in the list. If you want to create a numbered list that uses the style "1.)", enter ".)" in this box.
30 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUM_OPTIONS%3ALB_FMT 31 Select a numbering style for the selected levels.
2f sw%3AMetricField%3ATP_NUM_POSITION%3AMF_NUMDIST 3f Resets the indent and the spacing values to the default values.
38 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUM_POSITION%3AMF_INDENT 6f Enter the amount of space to leave between the left edge of the numbering symbol and the left edge of the text.
33 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUM_POSITION%3ALB_ALIGN 125 Set the alignment of the numbering symbols. Select "Left" to align the numbering symbol to start directly at the "Aligned at" position. Select "Right" to align the symbol to end directly before the "Aligned at" position. Select "Centered" to center the symbol around the "Aligned at" position.
2e sw%3AMultiListBox%3ATP_NUM_POSITION%3ALB_LEVEL 2c Select the level(s) that you want to modify.
3b cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUM_POSITION%3AMF_INDENT_AT 7c Enter the distance from the left page margin to the start of all lines in the numbered paragraph that follow the first line.
37 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUM_POSITION%3ACB_RELATIVE 4f Indents the current level relative to the previous level in the list hierarchy.
39 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUM_POSITION%3AMF_NUMDIST 3f Resets the indent and the spacing values to the default values.
3c cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUM_POSITION%3AMF_BORDERDIST f1 Enter the amount of space to leave between the left page margin (or the left edge of the text object) and the left edge of the numbering symbol. If the current paragraph style uses an indent, the amount you enter here is added to the indent.
2e sw%3AMetricField%3ATP_NUM_POSITION%3AMF_INDENT 6f Enter the amount of space to leave between the left edge of the numbering symbol and the left edge of the text.
32 sw%3AMetricField%3ATP_NUM_POSITION%3AMF_BORDERDIST f1 Enter the amount of space to leave between the left page margin (or the left edge of the text object) and the left edge of the numbering symbol. If the current paragraph style uses an indent, the amount you enter here is added to the indent.
2d sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_NUM_POSITION%3ACB_RELATIVE 4f Indents the current level relative to the previous level in the list hierarchy.
38 cui%3AMultiListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUM_POSITION%3ALB_LEVEL 2c Select the level(s) that you want to modify.
3c cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUM_POSITION%3AMF_ALIGNED_AT 5b Enter the distance from the left page margin at which the numbering symbol will be aligned.
2f sw%3APushButton%3ATP_NUM_POSITION%3APB_STANDARD 3f Resets the indent and the spacing values to the default values.
35 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUM_POSITION%3ALB_ALIGN_2 125 Set the alignment of the numbering symbols. Select "Left" to align the numbering symbol to start directly at the "Aligned at" position. Select "Right" to align the symbol to end directly before the "Aligned at" position. Select "Centered" to center the symbol around the "Aligned at" position.
39 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUM_POSITION%3AMF_LISTTAB 6e If you select a tab stop to follow the numbering, you can enter a non-negative value as the tab stop position.
3f cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUM_POSITION%3ALB_LABEL_FOLLOWED_BY 53 Select the element that will follow the numbering: a tab stop, a space, or nothing.
29 sw%3AListBox%3ATP_NUM_POSITION%3ALB_ALIGN 125 Set the alignment of the numbering symbols. Select "Left" to align the numbering symbol to start directly at the "Aligned at" position. Select "Right" to align the symbol to end directly before the "Aligned at" position. Select "Centered" to center the symbol around the "Aligned at" position.
39 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_NUM_POSITION%3APB_STANDARD 3f Resets the indent and the spacing values to the default values.
33 basctl%3APushButton%3ARID_TP_MODULS%3ARID_PB_NEWDLG 2a Opens the editor and creates a new dialog.
18 BASCTL_HID_BASICIDE_LIBS c4 Mostra as bibliotecas e módulos nos cales pode abrir ou gardar as súas macros. Para gardar unha macro cun documento específico, abra o documento e, a continuación, abra esta caixa de diálogo.
34 basctl%3APushButton%3ARID_MACROCHOOSER%3ARID_PB_EDIT 59 Starts the $[officename] Basic editor and opens the selected macro or dialog for editing.
12 .uno%3AMacroDialog 22 Opens a dialog to organize macros.
33 basctl%3AEdit%3ARID_MACROCHOOSER%3ARID_ED_MACRONAME 69 Mostra o nome da macro seleccionada. Para crear ou modificar o nome dunha macro, introduza aquí un nome.
31 basctl%3APushButton%3ARID_TP_MODULS%3ARID_PB_EDIT 44 Abre a macro ou caixa de diálogo seleccionada para a súa edición.
31 basctl%3APushButton%3ARID_TP_LIBS%3ARID_PB_NEWLIB 15 Crea unha biblioteca.
36 basctl%3APushButton%3ARID_MACROCHOOSER%3ARID_PB_NEWMOD 29 Saves the recorded macro in a new module.
33 basctl%3APushButton%3ARID_TP_LIBS%3ARID_PB_PASSWORD 37 Assigns or edits the password for the selected library.
2f basctl%3APushButton%3ARID_TP_LIBS%3ARID_PB_EDIT 4e Abre o editor de $[officename] Basic para modificar a biblioteca seleccionada.
33 basctl%3APushButton%3ARID_MACROCHOOSER%3ARID_PB_RUN 20 Executa ou garda a macro actual.
2f basctl%3APushButton%3ARID_TP_DLGS%3ARID_PB_EDIT 59 Starts the $[officename] Basic editor and opens the selected macro or dialog for editing.
2e basctl%3AListBox%3ARID_TP_LIBS%3ARID_LB_BASICS 60 Select the application or the document containing the macro libraries that you want to organize.
31 basctl%3APushButton%3ARID_TP_DLGS%3ARID_PB_NEWDLG 2a Opens the editor and creates a new dialog.
33 basctl%3APushButton%3ARID_MACROCHOOSER%3ARID_PB_ORG 9e Abre a caixa de diálogo Organizador de diálogos, onde pode engadir, editar ou eliminar calquera módulo, caixa de diálogo ou biblioteca de macro existente.
36 basctl%3APushButton%3ARID_MACROCHOOSER%3ARID_PB_ASSIGN 6e Opens the Customize dialog, where you can assign the selected macro to a menu command, a toolbar, or an event.
36 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_DLG_SCRIPTORGANIZER%3ASF_PB_DEL 2a Prompts you to delete the selected script.
2f basctl%3AEdit%3ARID_DLG_NEWLIB%3ARID_ED_LIBNAME 2b Enter a name for the new library or module.
39 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_DLG_SCRIPTORGANIZER%3ASF_PB_CREATE 15 Creates a new script.
1d BASCTL_HID_BASICIDE_LIBS_TREE 56 Lists the existing macro libraries for the current application and any open documents.
39 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_DLG_SCRIPTORGANIZER%3ASF_PB_RENAME 44 Opens a dialog where you can change the name of the selected script.
31 basctl%3APushButton%3ARID_TP_LIBS%3ARID_PB_APPEND 73 Localice a biblioteca de $[officename] Basic que desexa engadir á lista actual e, a continuación, prema en Abrir.
36 basctl%3APushButton%3ARID_MACROCHOOSER%3ARID_PB_NEWLIB 2a Saves the recorded macro in a new library.
37 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_DLG_SCRIPTORGANIZER%3ASF_PB_EDIT 3a Opens the default script editor for your operating system.
33 basctl%3APushButton%3ARID_MACROCHOOSER%3ARID_PB_DEL 2f Crea unha nova macro ou elimina a seleccionada.
12 CUI_HID_SCRIPTSBOX 83 Select a macro or script from "user", "share", or an open document. To view the available macros or scripts, double-click an entry.
33 basctl%3APushButton%3ARID_TP_MODULS%3ARID_PB_NEWMOD 2a Opens the editor and creates a new module.
20 BASCTL_HID_BASICIDE_MODULES_TREE 31 Mostra as macros e caixas de diálogo existentes.
36 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_DLG_SCRIPTORGANIZER%3ASF_PB_RUN 41 To run a script, select a script in the list, and then click Run.
1a BASCTL_HID_BASICIDE_MACROS 52 Lists the macros that are contained in the module selected in the Macro from list.
15 .uno%3AMacroSignature 6e Adds and removes digital signatures to and from your macros. You can also use the dialog to view certificates.
f .uno%3ARunMacro 2b Opens a dialog where you can start a macro.
27 .uno%3AMacroOrganizer%3FTabId%3Ashort=1 32 Opens the Dialogs tab page of the Macro Organizer.
14 .uno%3AMacroRecorder 14 Records a new macro.
14 .uno%3AStopRecording 18 Stops recording a macro.
33 svx%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXDLG_PASSWORD%3AED_REPEAT_PASSWD 32 Reenter the new password for the selected library.
10 SVX_HID_PASSWORD 32 Protexe cun contrasinal a biblioteca seleccionada.
30 svx%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXDLG_PASSWORD%3AED_OLD_PASSWD 3a Introduza o contrasinal actual da biblioteca seleccionada.
30 svx%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXDLG_PASSWORD%3AED_NEW_PASSWD 3d Introduza un novo contrasinal para a biblioteca seleccionada.
44 .uno%3AScriptOrganizer%3FScriptOrganizer.Language%3Astring=BeanShell 2e Opens a dialog where you can organize scripts.
16 .uno%3AScriptOrganizer 50 Opens a submenu with links to dialogs where you can organize macros and scripts.
45 .uno%3AScriptOrganizer%3FScriptOrganizer.Language%3Astring=JavaScript 2e Opens a dialog where you can organize scripts.
20 BASCTL_HID_BASICIDE_LIBSDLG_TREE 6d Enter a name or the path to the library that you want to append. You can also select a library from the list.
2e basctl%3ACheckBox%3ARID_DLG_LIBS%3ARID_CB_REPL 40 Substitúe unha biblioteca do mesmo nome pola biblioteca actual.
2d basctl%3ACheckBox%3ARID_DLG_LIBS%3ARID_CB_REF 7e Engade a biblioteca seleccionada como ficheiro só de lectura. A biblioteca cárgase de novo cada vez que inicia %PRODUCTNAME.
16 .uno%3AConfigureDialog 59 Customizes $[officename] menus, shortcut keys, toolbars, and macro assignments to events.
12 .uno%3ALoadToolBox 59 Customizes $[officename] menus, shortcut keys, toolbars, and macro assignments to events.
37 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_MENUS%3ABTN_ADD_COMMANDS 7d Opens the Add Commands dialog. Select any command, then click Add or drag-and-drop the command into the Customize dialog box.
31 cui%3AMenuButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_MENUS%3ABTN_CHANGE 29 Opens a submenu with additional commands.
2e cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_MENUS%3ABTN_NEW 71 Opens the New Menu dialog where you can enter the name of a new menu as well as select the location for the menu.
1b CUI_HID_SELECTOR_CATEGORIES 5e Select any command, then click Add or drag-and-drop the command into the Customize dialog box.
35 cui%3AImageButton%3AMD_MENU_ORGANISER%3ABTN_MENU_DOWN 2a Moves the selected item down one position.
33 cui%3AImageButton%3AMD_MENU_ORGANISER%3ABTN_MENU_UP 28 Moves the selected item up one position.
37 cui%3AMenuButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_MENUS%3ABTN_CHANGE_ENTRY 2f Opens a menu that contains additional commands.
19 CUI_HID_SELECTOR_COMMANDS 5e Select any command, then click Add or drag-and-drop the command into the Customize dialog box.
2c cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_MENUS%3ALB_MENUS 32 Select the menu and submenu that you want to edit.
2d cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_MENUS%3ALB_SAVEIN 47 Select the application or open document where you want to add the menu.
2f cui%3AEdit%3AMD_MENU_ORGANISER%3AEDIT_MENU_NAME 76 Enter a name for the menu. To specify a letter in the name as an accelerator key, enter a tilde (~) before the letter.
1f CUI_HID_SVX_CONFIG_MENU_LISTBOX 6e Moves the selected menu entry up one position or down one position in the menu when you click an arrow button.
34 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_KEYBOARD%3ARB_MODULE 41 Displays shortcut keys for the current $[officename] application.
32 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_KEYBOARD%3ABTN_SAVE 4c Saves the current shortcut key configuration, so that you can load it later.
38 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_KEYBOARD%3ABTN_ACC_CHANGE 6c Assigns the key combination selected in the Shortcut keys list to the command selected in the Function list.
33 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_KEYBOARD%3ABTN_RESET 32 Resets modified values back to the default values.
32 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_KEYBOARD%3ABTN_LOAD 4b Replaces the shortcut key configuration with one that was previously saved.
38 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_KEYBOARD%3ABTN_ACC_REMOVE 44 Elimina os elementos seleccionados sen solicitar unha confirmación.
22 CUI_HID_CONFIGFUNCTION_ACC_LISTBOX dd Select a function that you want to assign a shortcut key to, click a key combination in the Shortcut keys list, and then click Modify. If the selected function already has a shortcut key, it is displayed in the Keys list.
34 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_KEYBOARD%3ARB_OFFICE 49 Displays shortcut keys that are common to all $[officename] applications.
1b CUI_HID_ACCELCONFIG_LISTBOX be Lists the shortcut keys and the associated commands. To assign or modify the shortcut key for the command selected in the Function list, click a shortcut in this list, and then click Modify.
14 CUI_HID_CONFIG_ACCEL 5d Assigns or edits the shortcut keys for $[officename] commands, or $[officename] Basic macros.
1f CUI_HID_CONFIGGROUP_ACC_LISTBOX 63 Lists the available function categories. To assign shortcuts to Styles, open the "Styles" category.
13 CUI_HID_SVX_SAVE_IN 49 Select the location where to load the configuration and where to save it.
1f CUI_HID_SVX_MODIFY_TOOLBAR_ITEM 21 The Modify button opens a submenu
2e cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_MENUS%3ABTN_UP 27 Moves the selected item up in the list.
1a CUI_HID_SVX_MODIFY_TOOLBAR 22 The Toolbar button opens a submenu
17 CUI_HID_SVX_NEW_TOOLBAR 6c Opens the Name dialog, where you enter the name of a new toolbar and select the location of the new toolbar.
30 cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_MENUS%3ABTN_DOWN 29 Moves the selected item down in the list.
1c CUI_HID_SVX_NEW_TOOLBAR_ITEM 79 Opens the Add Commands dialog. Select any command, then click Add or drag-and-drop the command into the Customize dialog.
2f cui%3APushButton%3AMD_ICONSELECTOR%3ABTN_DELETE 58 Click to remove the selected icon from the list. Only user-defined icons can be removed.
2f cui%3APushButton%3AMD_ICONSELECTOR%3ABTN_IMPORT 99 Adds new icons to the list of icons. You see a file open dialog that imports the selected icon or icons into the internal icon directory of %PRODUCTNAME.
12 .uno%3ATableEvents 6d Assigns macros to program events. The assigned macro runs automatically every time the selected event occurs.
31 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_EVENTS%3APB_ASSIGN 41 Opens the Macro Selector to assign a macro to the selected event.
31 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_EVENTS%3APB_DELETE 34 Deletes the macro assignment for the selected event.
36 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_MACROASSIGN%3APB_ASSIGN 41 Opens the Macro Selector to assign a macro to the selected event.
1a CUI_HID_SVX_MACRO_LB_EVENT b1 The big list box lists the events and the assigned macros. After you selected the location in the Save In list box, select an event in the big list box. Then click Assign Macro.
36 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_MACROASSIGN%3APB_DELETE 34 Deletes the macro assignment for the selected event.
2e cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_EVENTS%3ALB_SAVEIN 59 Select first where to save the event binding, in the current document or in %PRODUCTNAME.
25 FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_SETTINGS_DIALOG 27 Displays the help page for this dialog.
1a FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_SAVE 56 Displays a Save as dialog to save the selected file as an XSLT filter package (*.jar).
1a FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_TEST 32 Opens a dialog with the name of the selected file.
1c FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_DELETE 44 Deletes the selected file after you confirm the dialog that follows.
1c .uno%3AOpenXMLFilterSettings 7d Opens the XML Filter Settings dialog, where you can create, edit, delete, and test filters to import and to export XML files.
1b FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_CLOSE 12 Closes the dialog.
1a FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_OPEN 4d Displays an Open dialog to open a filter from an XSLT filter package (*.jar).
1a FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_EDIT 32 Opens a dialog with the name of the selected file.
19 FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_NEW 2d Opens a dialog with the name of a new filter.
1a FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_LIST 3a Select one or more filters, then click one of the buttons.
23 FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_TABPAGE_BASIC 34 Enter or edit general information for an XML filter.
1f FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_EXTENSION 99 Enter the file extension to use when you open a file without specifying a filter. $[officename] uses the file extension to determine which filter to use.
1a FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_NAME 5a Enter the name that you want to display in the list box of the XML Filter Settings dialog.
21 FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_DESCRIPTION 1b Enter a comment (optional).
21 FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_APPLICATION 3c Select the application that you want to use with the filter.
24 FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_INTERFACE_NAME 4d Enter the name that you want to display in the File type box in file dialogs.
1d FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_DOCTYPE 22 Enter the DOCTYPE of the XML file.
28 FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_IMPORT_XSLT_BROWSE 1e Opens a file selection dialog.
28 FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_EXPORT_XSLT_BROWSE 1e Opens a file selection dialog.
21 FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_IMPORT_XSLT 6b If this is an import filter, enter the file name of the XSLT stylesheet that you want to use for importing.
19 FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_DTD 6e If you want, enter the public or system identifier of the DTD (Document Type Definition) that you want to use.
25 FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_IMPORT_TEMPLATE 7b Enter the name of the template that you want to use for importing. In the template, styles are defined to display XML tags.
21 FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_EXPORT_XSLT 6b If this is an export filter, enter the file name of the XSLT stylesheet that you want to use for exporting.
2c FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_IMPORT_TEMPLATE_BROWSE 1e Opens a file selection dialog.
20 FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_DTD_BROWSE 1e Opens a file selection dialog.
2b FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_TEST_IMPORT_XSLT_FILE 5a Displays the file name of the XSLT filter that you entered on the Transformation tab page.
28 FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_TEST_IMPORT_RECENT 3c Re-opens the document that was last opened with this dialog.
29 FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_TEST_EXPORT_CURRENT d9 The front-most open file that matches the XML filter criteria will be used to test the filter. The current XML export filter transforms the file and the resulting XML code is displayed in the XML Filter output window.
28 FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_TEST_EXPORT_BROWSE 93 Locate the file that you want to apply the XML export filter to. The XML code of the transformed file is displayed in the XML Filter output window.
2d FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_TEST_IMPORT_RECENT_FILE 3c Re-opens the document that was last opened with this dialog.
2f FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_TEST_IMPORT_TEMPLATE_FILE 57 Displays the file name of the template that you entered on the Transformation tab page.
30 FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_TEST_IMPORT_DISPLAY_SOURCE 8f Opens the XML Filter output window, where the XML source of the selected document is displayed. The document is used to test the import filter.
2b FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_TEST_EXPORT_XSLT_FILE 5a Displays the file name of the XSLT filter that you entered on the Transformation tab page.
28 FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_TEST_IMPORT_BROWSE 5f Opens a file selection dialog. The selected file is opened using the current XML import filter.
23 FILTER_HID_XML_SOURCE_FILE_VALIDATE 37 Validates the contents of the XML Filter output window.
23 FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_OUTPUT_WINDOW 28 Lists the test results of an XML filter.
29 FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_TEST_VALIDATE_OUPUT 28 Lists the test results of an XML filter.
22 CUI_HID_HANGULDLG_BUTTON_IGNOREALL 81 No changes will be made to the current selection, and every time the same selection is detected it will be skipped automatically.
1f CUI_HID_HANGULDLG_BUTTON_IGNORE 6d No changes will be made to the current selection. The next word or character will be selected for conversion.
43 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA%3ACB_REPLACE_BY_CHARACTER 68 Check to move character-by-character through the selected text. If not checked, full words are replaced.
1f CUI_HID_HANGULDLG_BUTTON_CHANGE 5d Replaces the selection with the suggested characters or word according to the format options.
43 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA%3ARB_SIMPLE_CONVERSION 41 The original characters are replaced by the suggested characters.
48 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA%3ARB_HANJA_HANGUL_BRACKETED 43 The Hangul part will be displayed in brackets after the Hanja part.
20 CUI_HID_HANGULDLG_BUTTON_OPTIONS 26 Opens the Hangul/Hanja Options dialog.
44 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA%3ARB_HANJA_HANGUL_ABOVE 44 The Hangul part will be displayed as ruby text above the Hanja part.
44 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA%3ARB_HANJA_HANGUL_BELOW 44 The Hangul part will be displayed as ruby text below the Hanja part.
22 CUI_HID_HANGULDLG_SUGGESTIONS_GRID 36 Displays all available replacements in the dictionary.
1e CUI_HID_HANGULDLG_BUTTON_CLOSE 12 Closes the dialog.
44 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA%3ARB_HANGUL_HANJA_ABOVE 44 The Hanja part will be displayed as ruby text above the Hangul part.
22 CUI_HID_HANGULDLG_SUGGESTIONS_LIST 36 Displays all available replacements in the dictionary.
39 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA%3ACB_HANJA_ONLY 33 Check to convert only Hanja. Do not convert Hangul.
3a cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA%3ACB_HANGUL_ONLY 33 Check to convert only Hangul. Do not convert Hanja.
1d CUI_HID_HANGULDLG_SUGGESTIONS 36 Displays all available replacements in the dictionary.
22 CUI_HID_HANGULDLG_BUTTON_CHANGEALL aa Replaces the selection with the suggested characters or word according to the format options. Every time the same selection is detected it will be replaced automatically.
48 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA%3ARB_HANGUL_HANJA_BRACKETED 43 The Hanja part will be displayed in brackets after the Hangul part.
1c .uno%3AHangulHanjaConversion 4f Converts the selected Korean text from Hangul to Hanja or from Hanja to Hangul.
35 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA%3APB_FIND 57 Finds your Hangul input in the dictionary and replaces it with the corresponding Hanja.
44 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA%3ARB_HANGUL_HANJA_BELOW 44 The Hanja part will be displayed as ruby text below the Hangul part.
18 CUI_HID_SPELLDLG_SETWORD 1f Displays the current selection.
1e CUI_HID_HANGULDLG_EDIT_NEWWORD 3e Displays the first replacement suggestion from the dictionary.
3f cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_OPT%3APB_HHO_DELETE 2d Deletes the selected user-defined dictionary.
3d cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_OPT%3APB_HHO_EDIT 57 Opens the Edit Custom Dictionary dialog where you can edit any user-defined dictionary.
3c cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_OPT%3APB_HHO_NEW 4b Opens the New dictionary dialog box, where you can create a new dictionary.
3d cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_OPT%3ACB_IGNOREPOST 56 Ignores positional characters at the end of Korean words when you search a dictionary.
44 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_OPT%3ACB_SHOWRECENTLYFIRST 60 Shows the replacement suggestion that you selected the last time as the first entry on the list.
20 CUI_HID_HANGULHANJA_OPT_DICTS_LB ae Lists all user-defined dictionaries. Select the check box next to the dictionary that you want to use. Clear the check box next to the dictionary that you do not want to use.
44 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_OPT%3ACB_AUTOREPLACEUNIQUE 4b Automatically replaces words that only have one suggested word replacement.
3b cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_NEWDICT%3AED_DICTNAME 20 Enter a name for the dictionary.
40 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_EDIT%3APB_HHE_DELETE 1b Deletes the selected entry.
31 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_EDIT%3AED_4 95 Type a suggested replacement for the entry that is selected in the Original text box. The replacement word can contain a maximum of eight characters.
31 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_EDIT%3AED_3 95 Type a suggested replacement for the entry that is selected in the Original text box. The replacement word can contain a maximum of eight characters.
31 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_EDIT%3AED_2 95 Type a suggested replacement for the entry that is selected in the Original text box. The replacement word can contain a maximum of eight characters.
31 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_EDIT%3AED_1 95 Type a suggested replacement for the entry that is selected in the Original text box. The replacement word can contain a maximum of eight characters.
37 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_EDIT%3ALB_BOOK 39 Select the user-defined dictionary that you want to edit.
3d cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_EDIT%3APB_HHE_NEW 3a Adds the current replacement definition to the dictionary.
3c cui%3AComboBox%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_EDIT%3ALB_ORIGINAL 79 Select the entry in the current dictionary that you want to edit. If you want, you can also type a new entry in this box.
12 .uno%3ASpellDialog 19 Checks spelling manually.
10 .uno%3ANewWindow 44 Opens a new window that displays the contents of the current window.
33 padmin%3APushButton%3ARID_PADIALOG%3ARID_PA_BTN_STD 24 Opens the Select Certificate dialog.
3e xmlsecurity%3APushButton%3ARID_XMLSECDLG_DIGSIG%3ABTN_VIEWCERT 22 Opens the View Certificate dialog.
33 padmin%3APushButton%3ARID_PADIALOG%3ARID_PA_BTN_DEL 2a Removes the selected source from the list.
29 XMLSECURITY_HID_XMLSEC_CTRL_SIGNATURESDLG 36 Lists the digital signatures for the current document.
31 sfx2%3APushButton%3ATP_DOCINFODOC%3ABTN_SIGNATURE 70 Adds and removes digital signatures to and from your document. You can also use the dialog to view certificates.
10 .uno%3ASignature 70 Adds and removes digital signatures to and from your document. You can also use the dialog to view certificates.
46 desktop%3AMultiLineEdit%3ARID_DLG_UPDATE%3ARID_DLG_UPDATE_DESCRIPTIONS 95 While checking for updates, you see a progress indicator. Wait for some messages to show up in the dialog, or click Cancel to abort the update check.
21 DESKTOP_HID_DEPLOYMENT_GUI_UPDATE ec Click the Check for Updates button in the Extension Manager to check for online updates for all installed extensions. To check for online updates for only the selected extension, right-click to open the context menu, then choose Update.
28 DESKTOP_HID_DEPLOYMENT_GUI_UPDATEINSTALL ec Click the Check for Updates button in the Extension Manager to check for online updates for all installed extensions. To check for online updates for only the selected extension, right-click to open the context menu, then choose Update.
38 desktop%3ACheckBox%3ARID_DLG_UPDATE%3ARID_DLG_UPDATE_ALL 8c By default, only the downloadable extensions are shown in the dialog. Mark Show all Updates to see also other extensions and error messages.
39 desktop%3APushButton%3ARID_DLG_UPDATE%3ARID_DLG_UPDATE_OK 54 When you click the Install button the Download and Installation dialog is displayed.
13 .uno%3AInsertZWNBSP 94 Inserts an invisible space within a word that will keep the word together at the end of a line. Available when complex text layout (CTL) is enabled.
17 .uno%3AInsertHardHyphen 4d Inserts a hyphen that will keep bordering characters together on line breaks.
1d .uno%3AInsertNonBreakingSpace 4c Inserts a space that will keep bordering characters together on line breaks.
10 .uno%3AInsertRLM 92 Inserts a text direction mark that affects the text direction of any text following the mark. Available when complex text layout (CTL) is enabled.
10 .uno%3AInsertLRM 92 Inserts a text direction mark that affects the text direction of any text following the mark. Available when complex text layout (CTL) is enabled.
19 .uno%3AFormattingMarkMenu 51 Opens a submenu to insert special formatting marks. Enable CTL for more commands.
11 .uno%3AInsertZWSP a9 Inserts an invisible space within a word that will insert a line break once it becomes the last character in a line. Available when complex text layout (CTL) is enabled.
17 .uno%3AInsertSoftHyphen 80 Inserts an invisible hyphen within a word that will appear and create a line break once it becomes the last character in a line.
18 SVX_HID_GALLERY_LISTVIEW 55 Displays the contents of the Gallery as small icons, with title and path information.
18 SVX_HID_GALLERY_NEWTHEME 56 Adds a new theme to the Gallery and lets you choose the files to include in the theme.
16 SVX_HID_GALLERY_WINDOW 52 To insert a Gallery object, select the object, and then drag it into the document.
e .uno%3AGallery 59 Opens the Gallery, where you can select graphics and sounds to insert into your document.
19 SVX_HID_GALLERY_THEMELIST 3c Click a theme to view the objects associated with the theme.
18 SVX_HID_GALLERY_ICONVIEW 2e Displays the contents of the Gallery as icons.
41 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXTABPAGE_GALLERYTHEME_FILES%3ABTN_SEARCH 52 Locate the directory containing the files that you want to add, and then click OK.
3f cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXTABPAGE_GALLERYTHEME_FILES%3ABTN_TAKE 2f Adds the selected file(s) to the current theme.
40 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXTABPAGE_GALLERYTHEME_FILES%3ACBX_PREVIEW 31 Displays or hides a preview of the selected file.
42 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXTABPAGE_GALLERYTHEME_FILES%3ABTN_TAKEALL 37 Adds all of the files in the list to the current theme.
42 cui%3AMultiListBox%3ARID_SVXTABPAGE_GALLERYTHEME_FILES%3ALBX_FOUND 8b Lists the available files. Select the file(s) that you want to add, and then click Add. To add all of the files in the list, click Add All.
41 cui%3AComboBox%3ARID_SVXTABPAGE_GALLERYTHEME_FILES%3ACBB_FILETYPE 2d Select the type of file that you want to add.
f .uno%3AGridMenu 26 Sets the display properties of a grid.
14 .uno%3ASnapLinesMenu 2d Specifies the display options for snap lines.
14 .uno%3AAVMediaPlayer 82 Opens the Media Player window where you can preview movie and sound files as well as insert these files into the current document.
14 .uno%3AInsertAVMedia 31 Inserts a video or sound file into your document.
3b cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ONLINEUPDATE%3APB_CHANGEPATH 2f Click to select a folder to download the files.
36 desktop%3ACheckBox%3ATP_UPDATE_CHECK%3ACB_UPDATE_CHECK 34 You can check for updates manually or automatically.
3b cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ONLINEUPDATE%3ACB_AUTODOWNLOAD 90 Mark to enable the automatic check for updates. Choose %PRODUCTNAME - Online Update in the Options dialog box to disable or enable this feature.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_CHECK_FOR_UPD_DLG f2 Checks for available updates to your version of %PRODUCTNAME. If a newer version is available, you can choose to download the update. After downloading, if you have write permissions for the installation directory, you can install the update.
26 EXTENSIONS_HID_CHECK_FOR_UPD_DOWNLOAD2 9c Downloads and saves the update files to the desktop or a folder of your choice. Select the folder in %PRODUCTNAME - Online Update in the Options dialog box.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_CHECK_FOR_UPD_CANCEL 3b Aborts the download and deletes the partly downloaded file.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_CHECK_FOR_UPD_RESUME 1c Continues a paused download.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_CHECK_FOR_UPD_PAUSE 40 Pauses the download. Later click Resume to continue downloading.
21 SFX2_HID_DLG_CHECKFORONLINEUPDATE f2 Checks for available updates to your version of %PRODUCTNAME. If a newer version is available, you can choose to download the update. After downloading, if you have write permissions for the installation directory, you can install the update.
24 EXTENSIONS_HID_CHECK_FOR_UPD_INSTALL 1f Installs the downloaded update.
25 EXTENSIONS_HID_CHECK_FOR_UPD_DOWNLOAD 9c Downloads and saves the update files to the desktop or a folder of your choice. Select the folder in %PRODUCTNAME - Online Update in the Options dialog box.
2d DESKTOP_HID_EXTENSION_MANAGER_LISTBOX_DISABLE 20 Enable or disable the extension.
1b DESKTOP_HID_PACKAGE_MANAGER 5c The Extension Manager adds, removes, disables, enables, and updates %PRODUCTNAME extensions.
2d DESKTOP_HID_EXTENSION_MANAGER_LISTBOX_OPTIONS 57 Select an installed extension, then click to open the Options dialog for the extension.
2c DESKTOP_HID_EXTENSION_MANAGER_LISTBOX_REMOVE 44 Select the extension that you want to remove, and then click Remove.
39 service%3Acom.sun.star.deployment.ui.PackageManagerDialog 5c The Extension Manager adds, removes, disables, enables, and updates %PRODUCTNAME extensions.
36 desktop%3AMultiLineEdit%3ARID_DLG_LICENSE%3AML_LICENSE 87 Read the license. Click the Scroll Down button to scroll down if necessary. Click Accept to continue the installation of the extension.
27 DESKTOP_HID_PACKAGE_MANAGER_TREELISTBOX 7b Select the extension that you want to remove, enable, or disable. For some extensions, you can also open an Options dialog.
25 DESKTOP_HID_PACKAGE_MANAGER_MENU_ITEM 5c The Extension Manager adds, removes, disables, enables, and updates %PRODUCTNAME extensions.
38 desktop%3APushButton%3ARID_DLG_LICENSE%3APB_LICENSE_DOWN 87 Read the license. Click the Scroll Down button to scroll down if necessary. Click Accept to continue the installation of the extension.
36 uui%3AEdit%3ADLG_UUI_PASSWORD_CRT%3AED_PASSWORD_REPEAT 16 Re-enter the password.
11 SC_HID_PASSWD_DOC 16 Re-enter the password.
13 SC_HID_PASSWD_TABLE 2e Type a password. A password is case sensitive.
10 sfx.Edit.2316.28 16 Re-enter the password.
10 sfx.Edit.2316.26 2e Type a password. A password is case sensitive.
2c sfx2%3AEdit%3ADLG_PASSWD%3AED_PASSWD_CONFIRM 16 Re-enter the password.
24 HID_DLG_PASSWORD_TO_OPEN_MODIFY_MORE 38 Click to show or hide the file sharing password options.
2b uui%3AEdit%3ADLG_UUI_PASSWORD%3AED_PASSWORD 2e Type a password. A password is case sensitive.
2d sfx2%3AEdit%3ADLG_PASSWD%3AED_PASSWD_PASSWORD 2e Type a password. A password is case sensitive.
33 uui%3AEdit%3ADLG_UUI_PASSWORD_CRT%3AED_PASSWORD_CRT 2e Type a password. A password is case sensitive.
43 filter%3ACheckBox%3ARID_PDF_TAB_GENER%3ACB_ALLOWDUPLICATEFIELDNAMES 98 Allows to use the same field name for multiple fields in the generated PDF file. If disabled, field names will be exported using generated unique names.
3c filter%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PDF_TAB_OPNFTR%3ARB_MAGNF_VISIBLE 7a Select to generate a PDF file that shows the text and graphics on the page zoomed to fit the width of the reader's window.
3e filter%3ACheckBox%3ARID_PDF_TAB_VPREFER%3ACB_TRANSITIONEFFECTS 4d Selects to export Impress slide transition effects to respective PDF effects.
3e filter%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PDF_TAB_LINKS%3ACB_VIEW_PDF_BROWSER 94 Cross-document links are opened with the Internet browser. The Internet browser must be able to handle the specified file type inside the hyperlink.
36 filter%3ACheckBox%3ARID_PDF_TAB_GENER%3ACB_EXPORTNOTES 45 Selects to export comments of Writer and Calc documents as PDF notes.
3b filter%3ACheckBox%3ARID_PDF_TAB_GENER%3ACB_EXPORTEMPTYPAGES 190 If switched on, automatically inserted blank pages are being exported to pdf file. This is best if you are printing the pdf file double-sided. Example: In a book a chapter paragraph style is set to always start with an odd numbered page. The previous chapter ends on an odd page. %PRODUCTNAME inserts an even numbered blank page. This option controls whether to export that even numbered page or not.
3a filter%3ACheckBox%3ARID_PDF_TAB_GENER%3ACB_EXPORTBOOKMARKS f0 Selects to export bookmarks of Writer documents as PDF bookmarks. Bookmarks are created for all outline paragraphs (Tools - Outline Numbering) and for all table of contents entries for which you did assign hyperlinks in the source document.
3d filter%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PDF_TAB_SECURITY%3ARB_CHANGES_NONE 28 No changes of the content are permitted.
39 filter%3ACheckBox%3ARID_PDF_TAB_SECURITY%3ACB_ENAB_ACCESS 35 Select to enable text access for accessibility tools.
39 filter%3ACheckBox%3ARID_PDF_TAB_GENER%3ACB_PDFA_1B_SELECT ea Converts to the PDF/A-1a format. This is defined as an electronic document file format for long term preservation. All fonts that were used in the source document will be embedded into the generated PDF file. PDF tags will be written.
3e filter%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PDF_TAB_LINKS%3ACB_VIEW_PDF_DEFAULT 6c Links from your PDF document to other documents will be handled as it is specified in your operating system.
35 filter%3AListBox%3ARID_PDF_TAB_GENER%3ALB_FORMSFORMAT 3f Select the format of submitting forms from within the PDF file.
3f filter%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PDF_TAB_SECURITY%3ARB_CHANGES_INSDEL 3a Only inserting, deleting, and rotating pages is permitted.
34 filter%3ACheckBox%3ARID_PDF_TAB_GENER%3ACB_ADDSTREAM 68 This setting enables you to export the document as a .pdf file containing two file formats: PDF and ODF.
40 filter%3ACheckBox%3ARID_PDF_TAB_GENER%3ACB_REDUCEIMAGERESOLUTION 51 Selects to resample or down-size the images to a lower number of pixels per inch.
3c filter%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PDF_TAB_OPNFTR%3ARB_MAGNF_DEFAULT b7 Select to generate a PDF file that shows the page contents without zooming. If the reader software is configured to use a zoom factor by default, the page shows with that zoom factor.
3b filter%3ACheckBox%3ARID_PDF_TAB_GENER%3ACB_EXPORTFORMFIELDS 60 Choose to create a PDF form. This can be filled out and printed by the user of the PDF document.
3d FILTER_NUMERICFIELD_RID_PDF_TAB_OPNFTR_NUM_MAGNF_INITIAL_PAGE 41 Select to show the given page when the reader opens the PDF file.
3e filter%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PDF_TAB_SECURITY%3ARB_PRINT_HIGHRES 2f The document can be printed in high resolution.
43 filter%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PDF_TAB_SECURITY%3ARB_CHANGES_ANY_NOCOPY 33 All changes are permitted, except extracting pages.
3a FILTER_NUMERICFIELD_RID_PDF_TAB_VPREFER_NUM_BOOKMARKLEVELS 5d Select to show bookmark levels down to the selected level when the reader opens the PDF file.
3a filter%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PDF_TAB_OPNFTR%3ARB_PGLY_SINGPG 3c Select to generate a PDF file that shows one page at a time.
3f FILTER_RADIOBUTTON_RID_PDF_TAB_VPREFER_RB_VISIBLEBOOKMARKLEVELS 5d Select to show bookmark levels down to the selected level when the reader opens the PDF file.
3a filter%3ACheckBox%3ARID_PDF_TAB_OPNFTR%3ACB_PGLY_FIRSTLEFT 101 Select to generate a PDF file that shows pages side by side in a continuous column. For more than two pages, the first page is displayed on the left. You must enable support for complex text layout on Language settings - Languages in the Options dialog box.
41 filter%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PDF_TAB_GENER%3ARB_LOSSLESSCOMPRESSION 43 Selects a lossless compression of images. All pixels are preserved.
41 filter%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PDF_TAB_SECURITY%3ARB_CHANGES_FILLFORM 29 Only filling in form fields is permitted.
3b filter%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PDF_TAB_SECURITY%3ARB_PRINT_NONE 27 Printing the document is not permitted.
39 filter%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PDF_TAB_OPNFTR%3ARB_MAGNF_WIND 62 Select to generate a PDF file that shows the page zoomed to fit entirely into the reader's window.
3d filter%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PDF_TAB_SECURITY%3ARB_PRINT_LOWRES 65 The document can only be printed in low resolution (150 dpi). Not all PDF readers honor this setting.
3b filter%3ACheckBox%3ARID_PDF_TAB_VPREFER%3ACB_WNDOPT_OPNFULL 69 Select to generate a PDF file that is shown in a full screen reader window in front of all other windows.
40 filter%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PDF_TAB_SECURITY%3ARB_CHANGES_COMMENT 38 Only commenting and filling in form fields is permitted.
3d filter%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PDF_TAB_GENER%3ARB_JPEGCOMPRESSION ca Selects a JPEG compression of images. With a high quality level, almost all pixels are preserved. With a low quality level, some pixels get lost and artefacts are introduced, but file sizes are reduced.
3d filter%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PDF_TAB_OPNFTR%3ARB_OPNMODE_THUMBS 54 Select to generate a PDF file that shows a thumbnails palette and the page contents.
3a filter%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PDF_TAB_OPNFTR%3ARB_MAGNF_WIDTH 61 Select to generate a PDF file that shows the page zoomed to fit the width of the reader's window.
3e filter%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PDF_TAB_OPNFTR%3ARB_OPNMODE_OUTLINE 53 Select to generate a PDF file that shows a bookmarks palette and the page contents.
40 filter%3AComboBox%3ARID_PDF_TAB_GENER%3ACO_REDUCEIMAGERESOLUTION 2c Select the target resolution for the images.
39 filter%3ACheckBox%3ARID_PDF_TAB_VPREFER%3ACB_DISPDOCTITLE 5e Select to generate a PDF file that is shown with the document title in the reader's title bar.
3d filter%3ACheckBox%3ARID_PDF_TAB_VPREFER%3ACB_UOP_HIDEVTOOLBAR 40 Select to hide the reader's toolbar when the document is active.
3b filter%3ACheckBox%3ARID_PDF_TAB_VPREFER%3ACB_WNDOPT_RESINIT 5a Select to generate a PDF file that is shown in a window displaying the whole initial page.
3d filter%3ACheckBox%3ARID_PDF_TAB_GENER%3ACB_EMBEDSTANDARDFONTS fd Normally the 14 standard Postscript fonts are not embedded in a PDF file, because every PDF reader software already contains these fonts. Enable this option to embed the standard fonts that are installed on your system and that are used in the document.
3b filter%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PDF_TAB_OPNFTR%3ARB_PGLY_DEFAULT 6a Select to generate a PDF file that shows the pages according to the layout setting of the reader software.
2c filter%3AEdit%3ARID_PDF_TAB_GENER%3AED_PAGES 26 Exports the pages you type in the box.
3b filter%3ACheckBox%3ARID_PDF_TAB_LINKS%3ACB_CNV_OOO_DOCTOPDF d2 Enable this checkbox to convert the URLs referencing other ODF files to PDF files with the same name. In the referencing URLs the extensions .odt, .odp, .ods, .odg, and .odm are converted to the extension .pdf.
33 filter%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PDF_TAB_GENER%3ARB_RANGE 26 Exports the pages you type in the box.
3f filter%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PDF_TAB_OPNFTR%3ARB_OPNMODE_PAGEONLY 40 Select to generate a PDF file that shows only the page contents.
12 .uno%3AExportToPDF 45 Saves the current file to Portable Document Format (PDF) version 1.4.
31 filter%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PDF_TAB_GENER%3ARB_ALL 5c Exports all defined print ranges. If no print range is defined, exports the entire document.
37 filter%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PDF_TAB_GENER%3ARB_SELECTION 1e Exports the current selection.
3b filter%3ACheckBox%3ARID_PDF_TAB_VPREFER%3ACB_WNDOPT_CNTRWIN 52 Select to generate a PDF file that is shown in a reader window centered on screen.
3b filter%3ACheckBox%3ARID_PDF_TAB_LINKS%3ACB_EXP_BMRK_TO_DEST 141 The bookmarks (targets of references) in PDF files can be defined as rectangular areas. Additionally, bookmarks to named objects can be defined by their names. Enable the checkbox to export the names of objects in your document as valid bookmark targets. This allows to link to those objects by name from other documents.
38 filter%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PDF_TAB_OPNFTR%3ARB_PGLY_CONT 4f Select to generate a PDF file that shows pages in a continuous vertical column.
3b FILTER_RADIOBUTTON_RID_PDF_TAB_VPREFER_RB_ALLBOOKMARKLEVELS 46 Select to show all bookmark levels when the reader opens the PDF file.
33 FILTER_RADIOBUTTON_RID_PDF_TAB_OPNFTR_RB_MAGNF_ZOOM 3e Select a given zoom factor when the reader opens the PDF file.
35 filter%3AMetricField%3ARID_PDF_TAB_GENER%3ANF_QUALITY 2d Enter the quality level for JPEG compression.
34 filter%3ACheckBox%3ARID_PDF_TAB_GENER%3ACB_TAGGEDPDF 47 Selects to write PDF tags. This can increase file size by huge amounts.
3d filter%3ACheckBox%3ARID_PDF_TAB_VPREFER%3ACB_UOP_HIDEVMENUBAR 41 Select to hide the reader's menu bar when the document is active.
3d filter%3ACheckBox%3ARID_PDF_TAB_VPREFER%3ACB_UOP_HIDEVWINCTRL 41 Select to hide the reader's controls when the document is active.
38 filter%3ACheckBox%3ARID_PDF_TAB_SECURITY%3ACB_ENDAB_COPY 35 Select to enable copying of content to the clipboard.
3b filter%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PDF_TAB_OPNFTR%3ARB_PGLY_CONTFAC 96 Select to generate a PDF file that shows pages side by side in a continuous column. For more than two pages, the first page is displayed on the right.
3b filter%3ACheckBox%3ARID_PDF_TAB_LINKS%3ACB_ENAB_RELLINKFSYS 82 Enable this checkbox to export URLs to other documents as relative URLs in the file system. See "relative hyperlinks" in the Help.
34 filter%3APushButton%3ARID_PDF_TAB_SECURITY%3ABTN_PWD 35 Click to open a dialog where you enter the passwords.
34 FILTER_METRICFIELD_RID_PDF_TAB_OPNFTR_NUM_MAGNF_ZOOM 3e Select a given zoom factor when the reader opens the PDF file.
42 filter%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PDF_TAB_LINKS%3ACB_VIEW_PDF_APPLICATION c2 Cross-document links are opened with the PDF reader application that currently shows the document. The PDF reader application must be able to handle the specified file type inside the hyperlink.
17 .uno%3ASendMailDocAsPDF a6 Shows the Export as PDF dialog, exports the current document to Portable Document Format (PDF), and then opens an e-mail sending window with the PDF as an attachment.
1b UUI_HID_XMLSECDLG_MACROWARN 6a Enable or disable the macros. Choose %PRODUCTNAME - Security in the Options dialog box to set the options.
23 SFX2_HID_WARNING_SECURITY_HYPERLINK 6a Enable or disable the macros. Choose %PRODUCTNAME - Security in the Options dialog box to set the options.
43 xmlsecurity%3APushButton%3ARID_XMLSECDLG_CERTCHOOSER%3ABTN_VIEWCERT 51 Opens the View Certificate dialog where you can examine the selected certificate.
2c XMLSECURITY_HID_XMLSEC_CTRL_CHOOSESIGNATURES 51 Select the certificate that you want to digitally sign the current document with.
3f xmlsecurity%3APushButton%3ARID_XMLSECTP_CERTPATH%3ABTN_VIEWCERT 51 Opens the View Certificate dialog where you can examine the selected certificate.
e .uno%3AWebHtml 95 Creates a temporary copy of the current document in HTML format, opens the system default Web browser, and displays the HTML file in the Web browser.
20 SVX_HID_XFORMS_TOOLBOX_ITEM_EDIT 56 Opens a dialog to edit the selected item (element, attribute, submission, or binding).
1f SVX_HID_MN_XFORMS_MODELS_REMOVE 43 Deletes the selected XForm model. You cannot delete the last model.
3c svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_ADD_MODEL%3ACB_MODIFIES_DOCUMENT d4 When enabled, the document status will be set to "modified" when you change any form control that is bound to any data in the model. When not enabled, such a change does not set the document status to "modified".
16 SVX_HID_XFORMS_TOOLBOX 3c Specifies the data structure of the current XForms document.
18 .uno%3AShowDataNavigator 3c Specifies the data structure of the current XForms document.
1a SVX_HID_XFORMS_MODELS_LIST 2e Selects the XForms model that you want to use.
1e SVX_HID_MN_XFORMS_SHOW_DETAILS 2d Switches the display to show or hide details.
29 SVX_HID_XFORMS_TOOLBOX_ITEM_ADD_ATTRIBUTE 70 Opens a dialog to add a new item (element, attribute, submission, or binding) as a sub-item of the current item.
22 SVX_HID_MN_XFORMS_INSTANCES_REMOVE 42 Deletes the current instance. You cannot delete the last instance.
20 SVX_HID_XFORMS_INSTANCES_MENUBTN 3a This button has submenus to add, edit or remove instances.
30 svx%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXDLG_ADD_MODEL%3AED_INST_NAME f Enter the name.
27 SVX_HID_XFORMS_TOOLBOX_ITEM_ADD_ELEMENT 70 Opens a dialog to add a new item (element, attribute, submission, or binding) as a sub-item of the current item.
19 SVX_HID_XFORMS_ITEMS_LIST 34 Lists the items that belong to the current instance.
22 SVX_HID_XFORMS_TOOLBOX_ITEM_REMOVE 47 Deletes the selected item (element, attribute, submission, or binding).
1f SVX_HID_MN_XFORMS_INSTANCES_ADD 30 Opens a dialog where you can add a new instance.
1d SVX_HID_XFORMS_MODELS_MENUBTN 29 Adds, renames, and removes XForms models.
20 SVX_HID_MN_XFORMS_INSTANCES_EDIT 39 Opens a dialog where you can modify the current instance.
1d SVX_HID_MN_XFORMS_MODELS_EDIT 21 Renames the selected Xform model.
1a SVX_HID_XFORMS_TAB_CONTROL 3c Specifies the data structure of the current XForms document.
1f SVX_HID_XFORMS_TOOLBOX_ITEM_ADD 70 Opens a dialog to add a new item (element, attribute, submission, or binding) as a sub-item of the current item.
1c SVX_HID_MN_XFORMS_MODELS_ADD 3c Opens the Add Model dialog where you can add an XForm model.
38 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_ADD_DATAITEM%3ACB_CONSTRAINT 22 Declares the item as a constraint.
36 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_ADD_DATAITEM%3ACB_REQUIRED 34 Specifies if the item must be included on the XForm.
3a svx%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_ADD_DATAITEM%3APB_CONSTRAINT 1f Declares the item as read-only.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_CONSTRAINT 22 Declares the item as a constraint.
38 svx%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_ADD_DATAITEM%3APB_REQUIRED 1e Declares the item as relevant.
38 svx%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_ADD_DATAITEM%3APB_RELEVANT 22 Declares the item as a constraint.
36 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_ADD_DATAITEM%3ACB_READONLY 1f Declares the item as read-only.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_REQUIRED 34 Specifies if the item must be included on the XForm.
35 svx%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_ADD_DATAITEM%3ALB_DATATYPE 2b Select the data type for the selected item.
38 svx%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_ADD_DATAITEM%3APB_READONLY 25 Declares that the item is calculated.
2e svx%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXDLG_ADD_DATAITEM%3AED_NAME 1b Enter the name of the item.
37 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_ADD_DATAITEM%3ACB_CALCULATE 25 Declares that the item is calculated.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_READONLY 1f Declares the item as read-only.
31 svx%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXDLG_ADD_DATAITEM%3AED_DEFAULT 2c Enter a default value for the selected item.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_CALCULATION 25 Declares that the item is calculated.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_RELEVANT 1e Declares the item as relevant.
36 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_ADD_DATAITEM%3ACB_RELEVANT 1e Declares the item as relevant.
3d svx%3AMultiLineEdit%3ARID_SVXDLG_ADD_CONDITION%3AED_CONDITION 12 Enter a condition.
40 svx%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_ADD_CONDITION%3APB_EDIT_NAMESPACES 4f Opens the Form Namespaces dialog where you can add, edit, or delete namespaces.
21 SVX_HID_XFORMS_NAMESPACEITEM_LIST 34 Lists the currently defined namespaces for the form.
3f svx%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_NAMESPACE_ITEM%3APB_ADD_NAMESPACE 21 Adds a new namespace to the list.
42 svx%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_NAMESPACE_ITEM%3APB_DELETE_NAMESPACE 1f Deletes the selected namespace.
40 svx%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_NAMESPACE_ITEM%3APB_EDIT_NAMESPACE 1d Edits the selected namespace.
25 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_MIN_EXCLUSIVE 2e Specifies an exclusive lower bound for values.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XML_DATA_MODEL 43 Select a model from the list of all models in the current document.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_BINDING_NAME d1 Select or enter the name of a binding. Selecting the name of an existing binding associates the binding with the form control. Entering a new name creates a new binding and associates it with the form control.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_DATA_TYPE 41 Select a data type which the control should be validated against.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_CONSTRAINT 22 Declares the item as a constraint.
25 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_MIN_INCLUSIVE 2e Specifies an inclusive lower bound for values.
21 EXTENSIONS_UID_PROP_ADD_DATA_TYPE ac Click the button to open a dialog where you can enter the name of a new user-defined data type. The new data type inherits all facets from the currently selected data type.
27 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_FRACTION_DIGITS 66 Specifies the maximum total number of fractional digits that values of the decimal data type can have.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_WHITESPACES f2 Specifies how whitespaces are to be handled when a string of the current data type is being processed. Possible values are Preserve, Replace, and Collapse. The sematics follow the definition at http://www.w3.org/TR/xmlschema-2/#rf-whiteSpace.
24 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_TOTAL_DIGITS 5b Specifies the maximum total number of digits that values of the decimal data type can have.
25 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_MAX_EXCLUSIVE 2e Specifies an exclusive upper bound for values.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_REQUIRED 34 Specifies if the item must be included on the XForm.
1f EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_PATTERN 125 Specifies a regular expression pattern. Strings validated against the data type must conform to this pattern to be valid. The XSD data type syntax for regular expressions is different from the regular expression syntax used elseswhere in %PRODUCTNAME, for example in the Find & Replace dialog.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_LENGTH 30 Specifies the number of characters for a string.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_MAX_LENGTH 38 Specifies the maximum number of characters for a string.
25 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_MAX_INCLUSIVE 2e Specifies an inclusive upper bound for values.
24 EXTENSIONS_UID_PROP_REMOVE_DATA_TYPE 5a Select a user-defined data type and click the button to delete the user-defined data type.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_READONLY 1f Declares the item as read-only.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_BIND_EXPRESSION 71 Enter the DOM node to bind the control model to. Click the ... button for a dialog to enter the XPath expression.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_CALCULATION 25 Declares that the item is calculated.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_RELEVANT 1e Declares the item as relevant.
13 .uno%3APrintDefault 66 Prema na icona Imprimir para imprimir o documento activo coa configuración de impresión predefinida.
16 .uno%3ABezier_Unfilled 168 Debuxa unha curva de Bézier suave. Prema no lugar onde desexa que comece a curva, arrastre, solte e mova o apuntador ata o lugar onde desexa que remate a curva e prema. Mova o apuntador e prema de novo para engadir un segmento de liña recta á curva. Prema dúas veces para rematar o debuxo da curva. Se o fai no seu punto inicial creará unha forma pechada.
10 .uno%3ACircleCut 1c1 Debuxa unha forma chea definida polo arco dun círculo e por unha liña de diámetro. Para debuxar un segmento circular, arrastre un círculo ata alcanzar o tamaño desexado e prema para definir o punto inicial da liña de diámetro. Mova o apuntador ata o lugar onde desexa situar o punto final da liña de diámetro e prema. Non é necesario premer no círculo. Para debuxar un segmento elíptico, manteña premida a tecla Maiús mentres arrastra.
18 .uno%3AFreeline_Unfilled be Draws a freeform line where you drag in the current document. To end the line, release the mouse button. To draw a closed shape, release the mouse button near the starting point of the line.
e .uno%3AEllipse d8 Debuxa unha forma oval ao arrastrar o apuntador. Prema no lugar onde desexa debuxar a forma oval e arrastre ata alcanzar o tamaño desexado. Para debuxar un círculo, manteña premida a tecla Maiús mentres arrastra.
b .uno%3ALine 87 Debuxa unha liña recta ao arrastrar o apuntador. Para restrinxir a liña a 45 graos, manteña premida a tecla Maiús mentres arrastra.
a .uno%3AArc 156 Debuxa un arco. Para facelo, arrastre unha forma oval ata alcanzar o tamaño desexado e despois prema para definir o punto inicial do arco. Mova o apuntador ata o lugar onde desexe situar o punto final e prema. Non é necesario premer na forma oval. Para debuxar un arco baseado nun círculo, manteña premida a tecla Maiús mentres arrastra.
11 .uno%3AInsertDraw 7d Prema para abrir ou pechar a barra Debuxo, onde pode engadir formas, liñas, texto e textos explicativos ao documento actual.
17 .uno%3APolygon_Unfilled 12a Debuxa unha liña composta dunha serie de segmentos en liña recta. Arrastre para debuxar un segmento da liña, prema para definir o seu punto final e arrastre para debuxar un novo segmento. Prema dúas veces para rematar o debuxo da liña. Se o fai no seu punto inicial creará unha forma pechada.
12 .uno%3ADrawCaption 169 Debuxa, desde onde se arrastra, unha liña que remata nun texto explicativo rectangular con dirección horizontal. Para redimensionar un texto explicativo arrastre unha das súas agarradoiras. Para engadirlle texto, prema no seu bordo e escriba ou pegue o texto. Pode arredondalo arrastrando a agarradoira do canto maior cando o apuntador se converte nunha man.
13 .uno%3AText_Marquee c4 Insire un texto animado con dirección horizontal. Arrastre un marco de texto e escriba ou pegue o seu texto. Para atribuír o efecto de animación, escolla Formato - Texto -  Animación de texto.
b .uno%3ARect e5 Debuxa un rectángulo ao arrastrar o apuntador. Para debuxar un cadrado, manteña premida a tecla Maiús mentres arrastra. Prema no lugar onde desexa situar un dos cantos do rectángulo e arrastre ata alcanzar o tamaño desexado.
13 .uno%3AVerticalText 15d Debuxa unha caixa de texto con dirección vertical ao premer ou arrastrar o cursor. Prema calquera lugar do documento e escriba ou pegue o seu texto. Tamén pode mover o cursor ata o lugar onde desexa engadir o texto, arrastrar unha caixa de texto e escribir ou pegar o texto. Só dispoñíbel cando está activado o soporte para idiomas asiáticos.
f .uno%3ADrawText e9 Debuxa unha caixa de texto co texto en horizontal ao arrastrar. Arrastre unha caixa de texto ata alcanzar o tamaño desexado en calquera lugar do documento e escriba ou pegue o texto. Rode a caixa de texto para obter un texto rodado.
16 .uno%3AVerticalCaption 1aa Debuxa, desde onde se arrastra, unha liña que remata nun texto explicativo rectangular con dirección vertical. Para redimensionar o texto explicativo arrastre unha das súas agarradoiras. Para engadir texto prema o seu bordo e escriba ou pegue o texto. Pode arredondalo arrastrando a agarradoira do canto maior cando o apuntador se converte nunha man. Só dispoñíbel cando está activado o soporte para idiomas asiáticos.
a .uno%3APie 1ab Debuxa unha forma chea definida polo arco dunha forma oval e por dúas liñas de raio. Para debuxar un sector elíptico, arrastre unha forma oval ata alcanzar o tamaño desexado e prema para definir a primeira liña de raio. Mova o apuntador ata o lugar onde desexa situar a segunda liña de raio e prema. Non é necesario premer na forma oval. Para debuxar un sector circular, manteña premida a tecla Maiús mentres arrastra.
11 .uno%3ASpinButton 19 Crea un botón xiratorio.
c .uno%3ALabel 2d Crea un campo para a visualización de texto.
10 .uno%3ATimeField 16 Crea un campo de hora.
13 .uno%3AMoreControls 2b Abre a barra de ferramentas Máis Controis.
10 .uno%3AScrollBar 21 Crea unha barra de desprazamento.
12 .uno%3AFileControl 31 Crea un botón que permite seleccionar ficheiros.
b .uno%3AGrid 47 Crea un control de táboa para visualizar unha táboa de base de datos.
b .uno%3AEdit 19 Crea unha caixa de texto.
12 .uno%3AImagebutton 28 Crea un botón que se mostra como imaxe.
12 .uno%3ARadioButton 18 Crea botóns de opción.
13 .uno%3AImageControl 52 Crea un control de imaxe. Só pode usarse para engadir imaxes dunha base de datos.
10 .uno%3ADateField 16 Crea un campo de data.
15 .uno%3AFormattedField 18 Crea un campo formatado.
f .uno%3ACheckBox 1d Crea caixas de verificación.
f .uno%3AGroupBox 37 Crea un marco para agrupar visualmente varios controis.
11 .uno%3APushbutton 18 Crea un botón de ordes.
13 .uno%3ANumericField 18 Crea un campo numérico.
17 .uno%3AAutoControlFocus 100 Se a opción Foco de control automático está activada, ao abrir o documento selecciónase o primeiro control de formulario. Se está desactivada, selecciónase o texto. A orde de tabulación especificada determina cal é o primeiro control de formulario.
f .uno%3AComboBox 20 Crea unha caixa de combinación.
12 .uno%3ARadiobutton 18 Crea botóns de opción.
f .uno%3ACombobox 20 Crea unha caixa de combinación.
f .uno%3AGroupbox 37 Crea un marco para agrupar visualmente varios controis.
14 .uno%3ACurrencyField 18 Crea un campo monetario.
16 .uno%3AFormDesignTools 32 Abre a barra de ferramentas Deseño de formulario.
14 .uno%3ANavigationBar 1f Crea unha barra de navegación.
e .uno%3AListBox 19 Crea unha caixa de lista.
d .uno%3AConfig 55 The Form Controls toolbar contains tools that you need to create an interactive form.
13 .uno%3APatternField 19 Crea un campo de patrón.
f .uno%3ACheckbox 1d Crea caixas de verificación.
11 .uno%3ASpinbutton 19 Crea un botón xiratorio.
14 .uno%3AConvertToEdit 3a O control seleccionado transfórmase nunha caixa de texto.
18 .uno%3AConvertToCheckBox 42 O control seleccionado transfórmase nunha caixa de verificación.
17 .uno%3AConvertToNumeric 39 O control seleccionado transfórmase nun campo numérico.
15 .uno%3AConvertToFixed 34 O control seleccionado transfórmase nunha etiqueta.
18 .uno%3AConvertToCurrency 39 O control seleccionado transfórmase nun campo monetario.
18 .uno%3AChangeControlType 71 Abre un submenú que permite seleccionar un tipo de control para substituír o control seleccionado no documento.
15 .uno%3AConvertToRadio 3b O control seleccionado transfórmase nun botón de opción.
14 .uno%3AConvertToList 3a O control seleccionado transfórmase nunha caixa de lista.
1c .uno%3AConvertToImageControl 3a O control seleccionado transfórmase nun control de imaxe.
18 .uno%3AConvertToImageBtn 39 O control seleccionado transfórmase nun botón de imaxe.
16 .uno%3AConvertToButton 30 O control seleccionado transfórmase nun botón.
17 .uno%3AConvertToPattern 3a O control seleccionado transfórmase nun campo de patrón.
1b .uno%3AConvertToFileControl 43 O control seleccionado transfórmase nunha selección de ficheiros.
19 .uno%3AConvertToFormatted 39 O control seleccionado transfórmase nun campo formatado.
14 .uno%3AConvertToDate 38 O control seleccionado transfórmase nun campo de datos.
15 .uno%3AConvertToCombo 41 O control seleccionado transfórmase nunha caixa de combinación.
14 .uno%3AConvertToTime 37 O control seleccionado transfórmase nun campo horario.
18 SVX_HID_FM_SHOWCOLS_MORE 2a Abre a caixa de diálogo Mostrar columnas.
14 SVX_HID_FM_DELETECOL 1f Elimina a columna seleccionada.
12 SVX_HID_FM_HIDECOL 1e Oculta a columna seleccionada.
14 SVX_HID_FM_CHANGECOL 76 Abre un submenú para seleccionar un campo de datos que substitúa o campo de datos seleccionado no control de táboa.
16 SVX_HID_FM_SHOWALLCOLS 2e Prema Todo se quere mostrar todas as columnas.
14 SVX_HID_FM_INSERTCOL 57 Abre un submenú para seleccionar un campo de datos e incorporalo no control de táboa.
2f cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVX_DLG_SHOWGRIDCOLUMNS%3A1 8d In the Show Columns dialog you can select the columns to be shown. Hold down the Shift or Ctrl (Mac: Command) key to select multiple entries.
13 SVX_HID_FM_SHOWCOLS 4e Abre un submenú onde pode seleccionar as columnas que desexa mostrar de novo.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_FM_PROPDLG_TABCTR 57 Abre unha caixa de diálogo que permite editar as propiedades dun control seleccionado.
18 .uno%3AControlProperties 57 Abre unha caixa de diálogo que permite editar as propiedades dun control seleccionado.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_VALUEMIN 67 You can determine here a value for the control field to prevent the user from entering a smaller value.
19 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_WIDTH 21 Defines the width of the control.
26 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_DEFAULT_SELECT_SEQ 4a Especifica a entrada da caixa de lista que debe marcarse como predefinida.
1b EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_DATEMIN 3e Determina a data máis temperá que o usuario pode introducir.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SCROLLVALUE_MIN 41 Especifica o valor mínimo dun control de barra de desprazamento.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_DEFAULT_TIME 1e Estabelece a hora predefinida.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_VISUALEFFECT 6a Especifica se as caixas de verificación e os botóns de opción se mostran en 3D (predefinido) ou planos.
1f EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_VISIBLESIZE f7 Especifica en "unidades de valor" o tamaño do cursor da barra de desprazamento. Un valor de "Valor máx. de desprazamento" menos "Valor mín. de desprazamento" / 2 resulta nun cursor da barra de desprazamento que ocupa a metade da área de fondo.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_STRICTFORMAT 5e Se a función de formato estrito está activada (Si), só se aceptan os caracteres permitidos.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_FORMATKEY 66 Especifica o código de formato do control. Prema no botón ... para seleccionar o código do formato.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_HIDDEN_VALUE 36 Pode introducir os datos herdados polo control oculto.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_EFFECTIVEMIN 67 You can determine here a value for the control field to prevent the user from entering a smaller value.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SHOW_POSITION 7a Especifica se os elementos de posicionamento deben mostrarse ou ocultarse no control seleccionado na barra de navegación.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_ICONSIZE 5b Especifica se as iconas da barra de navegación seleccionada deben ser grandes ou pequenas.
18 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_NAME 9f On the Properties tab page, this option specifies the name for the control field. On the Form Properties tab page, this option specifies the name for the form.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_TABINDEX 83 A propiedade Orde de tabulación determina a orde seguida no formulario para enfocar os controis ao premer na tecla de tabulación.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_VALUESTEP 21 Determines spin button intervals.
1f EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_ANCHOR_TYPE 2b Defines where the control will be anchored.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SHOW_NAVIGATION 77 Especifica se os elementos de navegación deben mostrarse ou ocultarse no control seleccionado na barra de navegación.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_TARGET_URL 59 Specifies the URL address that opens when you click an "Open document / web page" button.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_DEFAULT_DATE 1e Estabelece a data predefinida.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_WHEEL_BEHAVIOR 165 Sets whether the value changes when the user scrolls a mouse wheel. Never: No change of the value. When focused: (default) The value changes when the control has the focus and the wheel is pointing at the control and gets scrolled. Always: The value changes when the wheel is pointing at the control and gets scrolled, no matter which control has the focus.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_TRISTATE 93 Especifica se unha caixa de verificación tamén pode representar valores CERO dunha base de datos ligada, á parte dos valores VERDADEIRO e FALSO.
1b EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_TIMEMAX 4c Determina unha hora que ningún valor introducido polo usuario pode exceder.
1b EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_ENABLED 5f Se o campo de control ten a propiedade "Activado" (Si), o usuario do formulario pode utilizalo.
18 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_FONT 3a Select the font for the text that is in the control field.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_LINEINCREMENT 6b Especifica o valor que se debe sumar ou subtraer cando o usuario preme na frecha da barra de desprazamento.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_MULTISELECTION 40 Permítelle seleccionar máis dun elemento dunha caixa de lista.
19 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_LABEL 58 A propiedade Etiqueta define a etiqueta do campo de control que se mostra no formulario.
25 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_DEFAULT_SPINVALUE 2f Define o valor predefinido do campo de control.
1f EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_BORDERCOLOR 5b Especifica a cor de bordo dos controis que teñen a propiedade Bordo definida como "plana".
24 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_CURRSYM_POSITION 63 Determina se o símbolo monetario debe mostrarse antes ou despois do número nos campos monetarios.
1a EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_HEIGHT 22 Defines the height of the control.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_PRINTABLE 4e Especifica se se desexa mostrar o campo de control na impresión do documento.
1b EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_TABSTOP 5b A propiedade Tabulación determina se un campo de control pode seleccionarse coa tecla Tab.
1f EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_ORIENTATION 50 Specifies the horizontal or vertical orientation for a scrollbar or spin button.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_STRINGITEMLIST 105 Defines the list entries visible in the document. Open this list and type your text. Use Shift+Enter for a new line. With list and combo boxes, you can define the list entries that will be visible in the document. Open the List entries field and type your text.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_AUTOCOMPLETE 48 Atribúe a función Encher automaticamente a unha caixa de combinación.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SHOWTHOUSANDSEP 20 Insire un separador de millares.
18 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SPIN 6f A opción "Si" transforma o campo de control nun botón xiratorio en que se engaden as frechas correspondentes.
1f EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_LITERALMASK 76 Defines the literal mask. The literal mask contains the initial values and is always visible after downloading a form.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_MAXTEXTLEN 45 Define o número máximo de caracteres que o usuario pode introducir.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_DEFAULTVALUE 2f Define o valor predefinido do campo de control.
1a EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_TOGGLE 13a Especifica se un botón de ordes se comporta como botón de alternancia. Se define Alternar escollendo "Si", poderá alternar entre os estados de control "Seleccionado" e "Non seleccionado" ao premer no botón ou na barra de espazos mentres o control está enfocado. Os botóns "seleccionados" aparecen "premidos".
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_RECORDMARKER 7f Especifica se a primeira columna se debe mostrar ou non con etiquetas de filas en que o rexistro actual se marque cunha frecha.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_ENABLE_VISIBLE 68 Defines whether the control will be visible in live mode. In design mode, the control is always visible.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_ROWHEIGHT 3b Especifica a altura de fila dun campo de control de táboa.
1b EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_DATEMAX 59 Determina unha data que non pode ser excedida por ningún valor introducido polo usuario.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_CURRENCYSYMBOL 4e Pode introducir un carácter ou cadea de caracteres para o símbolo monetario.
1b EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_VSCROLL 47 Engade á caixa de texto o tipo de barra de desprazamento especificada.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_READONLY 49 Determines if the control is read-only (Yes) or if it can be edited (No).
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_WORDBREAK 24 Displays text on more than one line.
29 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_HIDEINACTIVESELECTION 5b Especifica se se ocultan as seleccións de texto cando os controis xa non están enfocados.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_DATEFORMAT 41 Here, you can determine the format you want for the date readout.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_POSITIONY 3e Defines the Y position of the control, relative to the anchor.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_IMAGEPOSITION 4e Especifica a opción de aliñamento do texto ou das imaxes usadas nun control.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_IMAGE_URL 63 A propiedade Imaxes especifica o nome do ficheiro e o camiño da imaxe que quere exhibir no botón.
1f EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SYMBOLCOLOR 62 Especifica a cor dos símbolos dos controis, por exemplo, as frechas dunha barra de desprazamento.
1b EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_HSCROLL 47 Engade á caixa de texto o tipo de barra de desprazamento especificada.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SCROLLVALUE_MAX 41 Especifica o valor máximo dun control de barra de desprazamento.
1b EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_HELPURL 7d Especifica unha etiqueta de lote en URL que se refire a un documento de axuda e que pode abrirse mediante o campo de control.
17 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_TAG 4d Especifica información adicional ou un texto descritivo do campo de control.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_DEFAULT_BUTTON 67 A propiedade Botón predefinido especifica que se activará o botón correspondente ao premer en Intro.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SHOW_FILTERSORT 5f Specifies to show or hide the filtering and sorting items in a selected Navigation Bar control.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SCALEIMAGE 3a Redimensiona a imaxe para adecuala ao tamaño do control..
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_REPEAT_DELAY 3c Especifica o atraso en milisegundos entre eventos repetidos.
24 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_EFFECTIVEDEFAULT 2f Define o valor predefinido do campo de control.
1a EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_BORDER 58 Determina se o bordo do campo debe mostrarse "Sen marco", con "Aparencia 3D" ou "Plano".
27 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_DEFAULT_SCROLLVALUE 35 Define o valor predefinido da barra de desprazamento.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SHOW_SCROLLBARS 47 Engade á caixa de texto o tipo de barra de desprazamento especificada.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SPININCREMENT 58 Determines intervals to add or subtract with each activation of the spin button control.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_FOCUSONCLICK 51 Se define esta opción escollendo "Si", enfócase o botón da orde ao premer nel.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SPINVALUE_MAX 60 Define un valor para o campo de control que ningún valor introducido polo usuario pode exceder.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_HELPTEXT 5a Ofrece a opción de introducir un texto de axuda que se mostra como suxestión no control.
1a EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_REPEAT 80 Especifica se se repite a acción dun control, como un botón xiratorio, ao premer no control e manter premido o botón do rato.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_BUTTONTYPE 52 A propiedade Acción determina a acción que se debe iniciar ao activar un botón.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_TEXTTYPE 102 Permítelle usar quebras de liña e formatados nun campo de control como, por exemplo, as caixas de texto ou as etiquetas. Para introducir manualmente unha quebra de liña, prema Intro. Seleccione "Multiliña con formatado" para introducir o texto formatado.
19 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_ALIGN 4e Especifica a opción de aliñamento do texto ou das imaxes usadas nun control.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_NAVIGATIONBAR 5b Especifica se a barra de navegación debe mostrarse no bordo inferior do control da táboa.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SPINVALUE_MIN 67 You can determine here a value for the control field to prevent the user from entering a smaller value.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_EFFECTIVEMAX 60 Define un valor para o campo de control que ningún valor introducido polo usuario pode exceder.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_BLOCKINCREMENT 6b Especifica o valor que se debe sumar ou subtraer cando o usuario preme na frecha da barra de desprazamento.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_EDITMASK 8d Define a máscara de edición. Ao especificar un código de carácter pódese determinar o que pode introducir o usuario no campo de control.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_MULTILINE 102 Permítelle usar quebras de liña e formatados nun campo de control como, por exemplo, as caixas de texto ou as etiquetas. Para introducir manualmente unha quebra de liña, prema Intro. Seleccione "Multiliña con formatado" para introducir o texto formatado.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_TARGET_FRAME 6b Specifies the target frame to display the document that is opened by the "Open document / web page" action.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_ECHO_CHAR ba Se a caixa de texto se usa como entrada de contrasinal, introduza o código ASCII do carácter de visualización. Ese carácter mostrarase en lugar dos caracteres tecleados polo usuario.
26 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SHOW_RECORDACTIONS 73 Especifica se os elementos de acción deben mostrarse ou ocultarse no control seleccionado na barra de navegación.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_POSITIONX 3e Defines the X position of the control, relative to the anchor.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_VALUEMAX 60 Define un valor para o campo de control que ningún valor introducido polo usuario pode exceder.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_BACKGROUNDCOLOR 2a Define a cor de fondo do campo de control.
1b EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_TIMEMIN 38 Determina a hora mínima que pode introducir un usuario.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_TIMEFORMAT 3e Pode definir o formato desexado para a visualización da hora.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_CONTROLLABEL 32 Especifica o tipo de letra da etiqueta do control.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_LINECOUNT 8b Specifies how many lines should be displayed in the dropdown list. This setting is only active if you chose "Yes" in the "Dropdown" option.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_LINEEND_FORMAT 81 Nos campos de texto seleccione o código de fin de liña que se vai utilizar ao escribir un texto nunha columna de base de datos.
24 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_DECIMAL_ACCURACY 46 Determina o número de díxitos mostrados á dereita do punto decimal.
18 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_TEXT 34 Sets the default text for a text box or a combo box.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_DROPDOWN 42 Specifies whether the combo box should dropdown (Yes) or not (No).
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_FILTERPROPOSAL 105 Ao deseñar o seu formulario pode definir a propiedade "Proposta de filtro" para cada caixa de texto do separador Datos da caixa de diálogo Propiedades correspondente. Nas seguintes buscas en modo filtro, pode utilizar toda a información contida neses campos.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_CONTROLSOURCE 4f Especifica o campo da táboa da fonte de datos ao cal fai referencia o control.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_EMPTY_IS_NULL c9 Defines how an empty string input should be handled. If set to Yes, an input string of length zero will be treated as a value NULL. If set to No, any input will be treated as-is without any conversion.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_REFVALUE f3 Pode introducir un valor referencial para o formulario web. Ese valor remitirase ao servidor cando se envíe o formulario. Nos formularios de base de datos, o valor introducido grávase no campo da base de datos atribuído ao campo de control.
26 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_CELL_EXCHANGE_TYPE 5c Seleccione o modo de ligazón das caixas de lista coas celas ligadas nas follas de cálculo.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_BOUND_CELL 8a Especifica a referencia a unha cela ligada nunha folla de cálculo. O contido ou estado activo do control está ligado ao contido da cela.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_LISTSOURCETYPE 5b Determina os datos con que se deben encher as listas nas caixas de combinación e de lista.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_LISTSOURCE d8 En formularios de bases de datos, especifica a fonte de datos do contido de lista do elemento de formulario. Este campo pode usarse para definir unha lista de valores para documentos sen conexión con bases de datos.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_LIST_CELL_RANGE 79 Introduza un intervalo de celas que conteña as entradas dunha caixa de lista ou de combinación dunha folla de cálculo.
25 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_UNCHECKEDREFVALUE 112 Check boxes and radio buttons in spreadsheets can be bound to cells in the current document. If the control is enabled, the value you enter in Reference value (on) is copied to the cell. If the control is disabled, the value from Reference value (off) is copied to the cell.
1f EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_BOUNDCOLUMN cf Use un índice para especificar o campo da táboa ou a consulta SQL da táboa que desexa ligar ao campo fornecido en Campo de datos. Os valores válidos para esta propiedade son 1, 2, 3 e así sucesivamente.
1a EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_CHANGED 67 O evento Modificado acontece cando se modifica o contido do control tras deixar de estar este enfocado.
1f EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_MOUSEENTERED 49 O evento Rato dentro acontece se o rato está dentro do campo de control.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_FOCUSLOST 55 O evento Ao perder o foco acontece cando un campo de control deixa de estar enfocado.
18 EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_KEYUP 5d The Key released event occurs when the user releases any key while the control has the focus.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_FOCUSGAINED 48 O evento Ao recibir o foco acontece cando se enfoca un campo de control.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_ACTIONPERFORMED 3a The Execute action event occurs when an action is started.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_TEXTCHANGED 5d O evento Texto modificado acontece se se introduce ou modifica un texto nun campo de entrada.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_ITEMSTATECHANGED 50 O evento Estado modificado acontece se se modifica o estado do campo de control.
1f EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_MOUSEDRAGGED 65 The Mouse moved while key pressed event takes place when the mouse is dragged while a key is pressed.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_MOUSEEXITED 4a O evento Rato fóra acontece cando o rato está fóra do campo de control.
1f EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_MOUSEPRESSED 76 O evento Botón do rato premido acontece ao premer o botón do rato mentres o apuntador está situado sobre o control.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_MOUSEMOVED 45 O evento Movemento do rato acontece ao mover o rato sobre o control..
1b EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_KEYTYPED 66 O evento Tecla premida acontece cando o usuario preme calquera tecla mentres o control está enfocado.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_MOUSERELEASED 78 O evento Botón do rato liberado acontece ao liberar o botón do rato mentres o apuntador está situado sobre o control.
29 EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_APPROVEACTIONPERFORMED 4d This event takes place before an action is triggered by clicking the control.
15 .uno%3AFormProperties 72 Nesta caixa de diálogo pode especificar, entre outras cousas, a fonte de datos e os eventos de todo o formulario.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SUBMIT_ENCODING 3d Especifica o tipo de codificación da transferencia de datos.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SUBMIT_METHOD 4d Especifica o método para transferir a información do formulario completado.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_POSITIONING 62 O evento Antes de modificar o rexistro acontece antes de modificar o apuntador do rexistro actual.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_SUBMITTED 49 O evento Antes de enviar acontece antes de enviar os datos do formulario.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_APPROVEPARAMETER 70 O evento Encher parámetros acontece cando o formulario que se vai cargar posúe parámetros que deben encherse.
1b EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_RELOADED 4e O evento Ao recargar acontece inmediatamente despois de recargar o formulario.
1b EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_RESETTED 4d O evento Despois de restaurar acontece despois de restabelecer un formulario.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_CONFIRMDELETE 5e O evento Confirmar eliminación acontece no momento en que se eliminan os datos do formulario.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_ERROROCCURRED 58 The Error occurred event is activated if an error occurs when accessing the data source.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_AFTERUPDATE 6e O evento Despois de actualizar acontece despois de gravar na fonte de datos o control modificado polo usuario.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_ROWCHANGE 67 O evento Despois da acción no rexistro acontece inmediatamente despois de modificar o rexistro actual.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_POSITIONED 75 O evento Despois de modificar o rexistro acontece inmediatamente despois de modificar o apuntador do rexistro actual.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_RELOADING 43 O evento Antes de recargar acontece antes de recargar o formulario.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_APPROVERESETTED 49 O evento Antes de restaurar acontece antes de restabelecer un formulario.
1b EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_UNLOADED 84 O evento Ao descargar acontece imediatamente despois de descargar o formulario, ou sexa, despois de separalo da súa fonte de datos.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_UNLOADING 78 O evento Antes de descargar acontece antes de descargar o formulario, ou sexa, antes de separalo da súa fonte de datos.
19 EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_LOADED 4a O evento Ao cargar acontece inmediatamente despois de cargar o formulario.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_APPROVEROWCHANGE 54 O evento Antes da acción no rexistro acontece antes de modificar o rexistro actual.
1f EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_ALLOW_EDITS 29 Determina se é posíbel modificar datos.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_NAVIGATION 58 Especifica se poden usarse as funcións de navegación da barra de formularios inferior.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_DATAENTRY 6e Determina se o formulario só permite incluír datos novos (Si) ou se tamén permite outras propiedades (Non).
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_MASTERFIELDS 87 Se crea un subformulario, introduza o campo de datos do formulario superior responsábel da sincronización entre el e o subformulario.
19 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_CYCLE 41 Determina como facer a navegación usando a tecla de tabulación.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_ALLOW_DELETIONS 2b Determina se é posíbel eliminar os datos.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_ALLOW_ADDITIONS 27 Determina se é posíbel engadir datos.
1f EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SLAVEFIELDS 7e Se crea un subformulario, introduza a variábel onde se poidan almacenar os valores posíbeis do campo do formulario superior.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_DATASOURCE 41 Define a fonte de datos a que debe facer referencia o formulario.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SORT_CRITERIA a2 Especifica as condicións para ordenar os datos no formulario. A especificación das condicións de ordenación segue as regras SQL sen usar a cláusula ORDER BY.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_CURSORSOURCE fc Determina que contido debe utilizarse para o formulario. Pode ser unha táboa ou consulta previamente creada na base de datos ou pode definirse mediante unha instrución SQL. Antes de introducir un contido debe definir o tipo exacto en Tipo de contido.
24 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_CURSORSOURCETYPE 94 Define se a fonte de datos vai ser unha táboa ou consulta existente na base de datos ou se o formulario vai xerarse a partir dunha instrución SQL.
25 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_ESCAPE_PROCESSING 46 Specifies whether the SQL statement is to be analyzed by %PRODUCTNAME.
15 HID_TABORDER_CONTROLS 7b Lista os controis do formulario, que se poden seleccionar coa tecla de tabulación na orde especificada de arriba a abaixo.
10 .uno%3ATabDialog 83 A caixa de diálogo Orde de tabulación permite modificar a orde de enfoque dos campos de control ao premer a tecla de tabulación.
f .uno%3AAddField 52 Opens a window where you can select a database field to add to the form or report.
11 SVX_HID_FIELD_SEL 88 The field selection window lists all database fields of the table or query that was specified as the data source in the Form Properties.
1e .uno%3ASwitchControlDesignMode be Activa ou desactiva o modo deseño. Esta función úsase para alternar rapidamente entre os modos deseño e usuario. Actívea para editar os controis de formulario e desactívea para usalos.
1d .uno%3ASwitchXFormsDesignMode be Activa ou desactiva o modo deseño. Esta función úsase para alternar rapidamente entre os modos deseño e usuario. Actívea para editar os controis de formulario e desactívea para usalos.
15 SVX_HID_FM_NEW_HIDDEN a6 Creates a hidden control in the selected form that is not displayed on the screen. A hidden control serves to include data that is transmitted together with the form.
e SVX_HID_FM_NEW 8f Engade novos elementos ao formulario. A función Engadir só pode seleccionarse se hai un formulario seleccionado no Explorador de formularios.
16 SVX_HID_FORM_NAVIGATOR 78 O Explorador de formularios contén unha lista dos formularios creados (lóxicos) cos campos de control correspondentes.
1a .uno%3AShowPropertyBrowser 3d Abre a caixa de diálogo Propiedades da entrada seleccionada.
13 SVX_HID_FM_NEW_FORM 23 Creates a new form in the document.
15 .uno%3AShowFmExplorer 7f Abre o Explorador de formularios, que mostra os formularios e subformularios do documento actual cos seus respectivos controis.
18 SVX_HID_FM_RENAME_OBJECT 1f Renomea o obxecto seleccionado.
11 SVX_HID_FM_DELETE 1f Elimina a entrada seleccionada.
13 .uno%3AOpenReadOnly 3e Abre os formularios en modo deseño para que se poidan editar.
11 .uno%3AUseWizards 59 Especifica se o asistente debe iniciarse de forma automática ao inserir un novo control.
15 .uno%3ADesignerDialog 73 Especifica se a xanela Estilos e formatado debe mostrarse ou ocultarse. Nela atribúense e organízanse os estilos.
11 .uno%3AStyleApply 54 Atribúe un estilo ao parágrafo actual e aos obxectos ou parágrafos seleccionados.
16 .uno%3AStyleApplyState 54 Atribúe un estilo ao parágrafo actual e aos obxectos ou parágrafos seleccionados.
15 SVX_HID_STYLE_LISTBOX 54 Atribúe un estilo ao parágrafo actual e aos obxectos ou parágrafos seleccionados.
13 .uno%3ACharFontName 58 Permítelle seleccionar un nome de tipo de letra na lista ou introducir un directamente.
11 .uno%3AFontHeight 6f Permítelle introducir un tamaño de tipo de letra ou escoller entre os diferentes tamaños presentes na lista.
1f .uno%3ATextdirectionLeftToRight 2c Especifica a dirección horizontal do texto.
1f .uno%3ATextdirectionTopToBottom 2a Especifica a dirección vertical do texto.
16 .uno%3ADecrementIndent 99 Prema na icona Reducir sangría para reducir a sangría esquerda do contido da cela ou do parágrafo e estabelecela na posición de tabulación anterior.
16 .uno%3AIncrementIndent 90 Click the Increase Indent icon to increase the left indent of the current paragraph or cell content and set it to the next default tab position.
10 .uno%3ABackColor 119 Aplica a cor de realce actual ao fondo dunha selección de texto. Se non hai texto seleccionado, prema na icona Realce, seleccione o texto que desexa realzar e prema de novo na icona. Para cambiar a cor de realce, prema na frecha situada ao lado da icona e despois na cor desexada.
16 .uno%3ABackgroundColor ab Click to open a toolbar where you can click a background color for a paragraph. The color is applied to the background of the current paragraph or the selected paragraphs.
18 .uno%3AParaspaceIncrease 65 Para aumentar o espazamento superior do parágrafo seleccionado, prema na icona Aumentar espazamento.
18 .uno%3AParaspaceDecrease 65 Para diminuír o espazamento superior do parágrafo seleccionado, prema na icona Reducir espazamento.
15 .uno%3ASetBorderStyle 78 Premendo na icona Bordos aparece a barra de ferramentas onde pode modificar o bordo dun obxecto ou da área dunha folla.
10 .uno%3ALineStyle 78 Prema nesta icona para abrir a barra de ferramentas Estilo de liña, a cal permite modificar o estilo de liña do bordo.
15 .uno%3AFrameLineColor 86 Prema na icona Cor de liña (do bordo) para abrir a barra de ferramentas Cor de bordo, que permite cambiar a cor do bordo dun obxecto.
17 .uno%3AToggleAnchorType 2f Allows you to switch between anchoring options.
14 .uno%3AOptimizeTable 6c Abre unha barra de ferramentas que contén funcións para a optimización das filas e columnas dunha táboa.
13 .uno%3ALineEndStyle 80 Abre a barra de ferramentas Puntas de frecha. Use os símbolos mostrados para definir o estilo do extremo da liña seleccionada.
1d .uno%3AToggleObjectRotateMode 1c Roda o obxecto seleccionado.
12 .uno%3AObjectAlign 32 Modifica o aliñamento dos obxectos seleccionados.
13 .uno%3AOutlineRight 5c Baixa o parágrafo seleccionado un nivel dentro dunha xerarquía de numeración ou viñetas.
15 .uno%3ADecrementLevel 5c Baixa o parágrafo seleccionado un nivel dentro dunha xerarquía de numeración ou viñetas.
12 .uno%3AOutlineLeft 5b Sobe o parágrafo seleccionado un nivel dentro dunha xerarquía de numeración ou viñetas.
15 .uno%3AIncrementLevel 5b Sobe o parágrafo seleccionado un nivel dentro dunha xerarquía de numeración ou viñetas.
d .uno%3AMoveUp 3b Coloca o parágrafo seleccionado antes do situado sobre el.
10 .uno%3AOutlineUp 3b Coloca o parágrafo seleccionado antes do situado sobre el.
f .uno%3AMoveDown 40 Coloca o parágrafo seleccionado despois do situado debaixo del.
12 .uno%3AOutlineDown 40 Coloca o parágrafo seleccionado despois do situado debaixo del.
14 .uno%3ADefaultBullet 4d Atribúe viñetas aos parágrafos seleccionados ou elimínallas se as teñen.
e .uno%3AOpenUrl 9f Loads a document specified by an entered URL. You can type a new URL, edit an URL, or select one from the list. Displays the full path of the current document.
a SID_RELOAD 3c Substitúe o documento actual pola última versión gardada.
d .uno%3AReload 3c Substitúe o documento actual pola última versión gardada.
21 SFX2_HID_HELP_TEXT_SELECTION_MODE e9 Para activar un cursor de selección en textos só de lectura ou na Axuda, escolla Editar - Seleccionar texto ou abra o menú de contexto dun documento só de lectura e escolla Seleccionar texto. O cursor de selección non pestanexa.
e .uno%3AEditDoc 49 Permítelle editar documentos só de lectura ou táboas de base de datos.
15 .uno%3ASelectTextMode e9 Para activar un cursor de selección en textos só de lectura ou na Axuda, escolla Editar - Seleccionar texto ou abra o menú de contexto dun documento só de lectura e escolla Seleccionar texto. O cursor de selección non pestanexa.
11 .uno%3ADSBEditDoc 3f Activa ou desactiva o modo edición da táboa de base de datos.
b .uno%3AStop 73 Click to interrupt the current loading process, Ctrl-click (Mac: Command-click) to interrupt all loading processes.
f SID_BROWSE_STOP 73 Click to interrupt the current loading process, Ctrl-click (Mac: Command-click) to interrupt all loading processes.
18 .uno%3AExportDirectToPDF 66 Exporta o documento directamente como PDF. Non se mostra ningunha caixa de diálogo de configuración.
15 .uno%3AStatusGetTitle 42 Exhibe información sobre o documento activo de %PRODUCTNAMEBasic.
18 .uno%3AStatusGetPosition 83 Mostra a posición do cursor no documento de %PRODUCTNAME Basic. Especifícase o número da fila e, a seguir, o número da columna.
1a SVX_HID_OFA_HYPERLINK_NAME 32 Atribúe un nome a un ficheiro ou URL da internet.
19 SVX_HID_OFA_HYPERLINK_URL 47 Permítelle escribir un URL ou arrastralo e soltalo desde un documento.
13 .uno%3ASetHyperlink 35 Insire no documento unha hiperligazón do URL actual.
1c SVX_HID_OFA_HYPERLINK_TARGET 3a Especifica o tipo de marco de destino do URL especificado.
1c CUI_HID_ICCDIALOG_CANCEL_BTN 25 Pecha a caixa de diálogo sen gardar.
16 .uno%3ARemoveHyperlink 2a Removes the hyperlink, leaving plain text.
1c .uno%3AOpenHyperlinkOnCursor 30 Opens the hyperlink in your default web browser.
14 .uno%3AEditHyperlink 1b Opens the Hyperlink dialog.
16 .uno%3AHyperlinkDialog 46 Abre unha caixa de diálogo que permite crear e editar hiperligazóns.
1b CUI_HID_ICCDIALOG_RESET_BTN 40 Restabelece o estado orixinal das entradas da caixa de diálogo.
1c CUI_HID_ICCDIALOG_CHOICECTRL 36 Seleccione o tipo de hiperligazón que desexa inserir.
18 CUI_HID_ICCDIALOG_OK_BTN 1d Aplica os datos ao documento.
1c .uno%3ACopyHyperlinkLocation 20 Copies the URL to the clipboard.
3f cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_INTERNET%3ABTN_SCRIPT 9e Abre a caixa de diálogo Atribuír macro para atribuír a eventos como "rato sobre o obxecto" ou "activar hiperligazón" os seus propios códigos de programa.
38 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_NEWDOCUMENT%3AED_TEXT 27 Introduza un nome para a hiperligazón.
43 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_INTERNET%3ARB_LINKTYP_FTP 1c Crea unha hiperligazón FTP.
42 cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_NEWDOCUMENT%3ABTN_SCRIPT 9e Abre a caixa de diálogo Atribuír macro para atribuír a eventos como "rato sobre o obxecto" ou "activar hiperligazón" os seus propios códigos de programa.
1f CUI_HID_HYPERLINK_MARKWND_APPLY 45 Insire o destino no campo Destino da caixa de diálogo Hiperligazón.
36 cui%3AComboBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_MAIL%3ACB_FRAME c4 Introduza o nome do marco en que desexa abrir o ficheiro ligado ou seleccione un marco predefinido da lista. Se deixa esta caixa está en branco, o ficheiro ligado ábrese na xanela do explorador.
1f CUI_HID_HYPERLINK_MARKWND_CLOSE 63 Tras introducir a hiperligazón, prema Pechar para definir a ligazón e saír da caixa de diálogo.
48 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_INTERNET%3ARB_LINKTYP_INTERNET 1d Crea unha hiperligazón http.
38 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_INTERNET%3ALB_FORM 47 Especifica se a hiperligazón debe inserirse como texto ou como botón.
3f cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_INTERNET%3ABTN_BROWSE 35 Abre un explorador da web para cargar o URL desexado.
35 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_INTERNET%3AED_TEXT 27 Introduza un nome para a hiperligazón.
3b cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_DOCUMENT%3AED_INDICATION 42 Especifica o texto visíbel ou a lenda do botón da hiperligazón.
38 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_DOCUMENT%3ALB_FORM 47 Especifica se a hiperligazón debe inserirse como texto ou como botón.
37 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_MAIL%3AED_INDICATION 42 Especifica o texto visíbel ou a lenda do botón da hiperligazón.
3f cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_INTERNET%3ACBX_ANONYMOUS 44 Permítelle iniciar a sesión no enderezo FTP como usuario anónimo.
35 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_DOCUMENT%3AED_TEXT 27 Introduza un nome para a hiperligazón.
1a CUI_HID_HYPERDLG_INET_PATH a3 Enter a URL for the file that you want to open when you click the hyperlink. If you do not specify a target frame, the file opens in the current document or frame.
3a cui%3AComboBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_INTERNET%3ACB_FRAME c4 Introduza o nome do marco en que desexa abrir o ficheiro ligado ou seleccione un marco predefinido da lista. Se deixa esta caixa está en branco, o ficheiro ligado ábrese na xanela do explorador.
1e CUI_HID_HYPERLINK_MARKWND_TREE 40 Especifica a posición no documento de destino á cal desexa ir.
3b cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_NEWDOCUMENT%3ALB_FORM 47 Especifica se a hiperligazón debe inserirse como texto ou como botón.
3e cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_NEWDOCUMENT%3AED_INDICATION 42 Especifica o texto visíbel ou a lenda do botón da hiperligazón.
31 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_MAIL%3AED_TEXT 27 Introduza un nome para a hiperligazón.
3f cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_DOCUMENT%3ABTN_SCRIPT 9e Abre a caixa de diálogo Atribuír macro para atribuír a eventos como "rato sobre o obxecto" ou "activar hiperligazón" os seus propios códigos de programa.
34 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_MAIL%3ALB_FORM 47 Especifica se a hiperligazón debe inserirse como texto ou como botón.
3b cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_INTERNET%3AED_INDICATION 42 Especifica o texto visíbel ou a lenda do botón da hiperligazón.
3b cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_MAIL%3ABTN_SCRIPT 9e Abre a caixa de diálogo Atribuír macro para atribuír a eventos como "rato sobre o obxecto" ou "activar hiperligazón" os seus propios códigos de programa.
3a cui%3AComboBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_DOCUMENT%3ACB_FRAME c4 Introduza o nome do marco en que desexa abrir o ficheiro ligado ou seleccione un marco predefinido da lista. Se deixa esta caixa está en branco, o ficheiro ligado ábrese na xanela do explorador.
3d cui%3AComboBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_NEWDOCUMENT%3ACB_FRAME c4 Introduza o nome do marco en que desexa abrir o ficheiro ligado ou seleccione un marco predefinido da lista. Se deixa esta caixa está en branco, o ficheiro ligado ábrese na xanela do explorador.
36 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_INTERNET%3AED_LOGIN 46 Especifica o nome de inicio de sesión, se traballa con enderezos FTP.
1a CUI_HID_HYPERLINK_INTERNET 1d Crea unha hiperligazón http.
37 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_INTERNET%3AED_PASSWD 38 Especifica o contrasinal, se traballa con enderezos FTP.
1a CUI_HID_HYPERDLG_MAIL_PATH 6c Especifica o URL completo do destinatario, no formato mailto:nome@fornecedor.com ou news:grupo.servidor.com.
34 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_MAIL%3AED_SUBJECT 24 Especifica o asunto da nova mensaxe.
40 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_MAIL%3ARB_LINKTYP_MAIL 49 Atribúe o enderezo de correo electrónico especificado á hiperligazón.
3f cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_MAIL%3ABTN_ADRESSBOOK 27 Hides or shows the data source browser.
40 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_MAIL%3ARB_LINKTYP_NEWS 32 Atribúe un enderezo de noticias á hiperligazón.
16 CUI_HID_HYPERLINK_MAIL 49 Atribúe o enderezo de correo electrónico especificado á hiperligazón.
3f cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_DOCUMENT%3ABTN_BROWSE 24 Opens the Target in Document dialog.
1a CUI_HID_HYPERLINK_DOCUMENT a3 Enter a URL for the file that you want to open when you click the hyperlink. If you do not specify a target frame, the file opens in the current document or frame.
3b cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_DOCUMENT%3AED_TARGET_DOC 4c Specifies a target for the hyperlink into the document specified under Path.
41 cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_DOCUMENT%3ABTN_FILEOPEN 33 Opens the Open dialog, where you can select a file.
19 CUI_HID_HYPERDLG_DOC_PATH a3 Enter a URL for the file that you want to open when you click the hyperlink. If you do not specify a target frame, the file opens in the current document or frame.
45 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_NEWDOCUMENT%3ALB_DOCUMENT_TYPES 2d Specifies the file type for the new document.
3f cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_NEWDOCUMENT%3AED_PATH_NEWDOC 4c Enter a URL for the file that you want to open when you click the hyperlink.
42 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_NEWDOCUMENT%3ARB_EDITNOW 4e Specifies that the new document is created and immediately opened for editing.
1d CUI_HID_HYPERLINK_NEWDOCUMENT 4e Specifies that the new document is created and immediately opened for editing.
42 cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_NEWDOCUMENT%3ABTN_CREATE 3a Opens the Select Path dialog, where you can select a path.
44 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_NEWDOCUMENT%3ARB_EDITLATER 48 Specifies that the document is created but it is not immediately opened.
d .uno%3APageUp 27 Volve á páxina anterior do documento.
13 .uno%3APreviousPage 27 Volve á páxina anterior do documento.
f .uno%3APageDown 25 Vai á seguinte páxina do documento.
f .uno%3ANextPage 25 Vai á seguinte páxina do documento.
15 .uno%3AGoToStartOfDoc 30 Desprázase ata a primeira páxina do documento.
10 .uno%3AFirstPage 30 Desprázase ata a primeira páxina do documento.
13 .uno%3AGoToEndOfDoc 2f Desprázase ata a última páxina do documento.
f .uno%3ALastPage 2f Desprázase ata a última páxina do documento.
f .uno%3ACloseWin 1a Closes the current window.
22 DBACCESS_HID_BROWSER_EDIT_DATABASE 37 Abre a base de datos seleccionada para a súa edición.
21 DBACCESS_HID_BROWSER_ADMINISTRATE b3 Opens a dialog to add/edit/remove a database file from the list of registered databases. The same dialog opens by choosing %PRODUCTNAME Base - Databases in the Options dialog box.
18 .uno%3ADSBrowserExplorer 36 Turns on and off the view of the data source explorer.
21 DBACCESS_HID_BROWSER_RENAME_ENTRY c5 To rename an entry, call this command and enter the new name. You can also do this by selecting the entry and pressing F2. The database must support renaming, otherwise this command is not enabled.
1e DBACCESS_HID_BROWSER_CLOSECONN 68 Closes the connection to the data source. See %PRODUCTNAME Base - Connections in the Options dialog box.
f .uno%3ASortDown 39 Sorts the data of the selected field in descending order.
11 .uno%3AAutoFilter 4f Filters the records, based on the content of the currently selected data field.
17 .uno%3ARemoveFilterSort 49 Cancela a configuración de filtro e exhibe todos os rexistros da táboa.
28 DBACCESS_HID_BROWSER_REFRESH_REBUILDVIEW 4d Reconstrúe a visualización da táboa despois de modificar a súa estrutura.
e .uno%3ARefresh 1d Actualiza os datos mostrados.
13 .uno%3ASbaBrwInsert 49 Insire na posición do cursor os campos do rexistro marcado no documento.
39 sw%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_AP_INSERT_DB_SEL%3ARB_HEADL_COLNMS 63 Utiliza os nomes de campo da táboa de base de datos como títulos das columnas da táboa de texto.
36 sw%3AListBox%3ADLG_AP_INSERT_DB_SEL%3ALB_TBL_DB_COLUMN 50 Especifica as columnas da base de datos que se deben inserir na táboa de texto.
39 sw%3AImageButton%3ADLG_AP_INSERT_DB_SEL%3AIB_DBCOL_ONE_TO 44 Move o campo seleccionado ata a caixa de lista Columna(s) da táboa.
3b sw%3AImageButton%3ADLG_AP_INSERT_DB_SEL%3AIB_DBCOL_ONE_FROM 44 Elimina o campo seleccionado da caixa de lista Columna(s) da táboa.
35 sw%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_AP_INSERT_DB_SEL%3ARB_AS_TABLE 5b Insire no documento datos en forma de táboa seleccionados do explorador de fonte de datos.
38 sw%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_AP_INSERT_DB_SEL%3ARB_HEADL_EMPTY 32 Inserts an empty heading line into the text table.
36 sw%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_AP_INSERT_DB_SEL%3ACB_TABLE_HEADON 53 Especifica se debe inserirse unha liña de título nas columnas da táboa de texto.
3a sw%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_AP_INSERT_DB_SEL%3ARB_DBFMT_FROM_DB 24 Acepta os formatos da base de datos.
39 sw%3AImageButton%3ADLG_AP_INSERT_DB_SEL%3AIB_DBCOL_ALL_TO 50 Move os campos listados da base de datos á caixa de lista Columna(s) da táboa.
37 sw%3APushButton%3ADLG_AP_INSERT_DB_SEL%3APB_TBL_AUTOFMT 93 Abre a caixa de diálogo Formato automático, que permite seleccionar estilos de formato que se aplican inmediatamente despois de inserir a táboa.
3b sw%3AImageButton%3ADLG_AP_INSERT_DB_SEL%3AIB_DBCOL_ALL_FROM 50 Elimina todos os campos de base de datos da caixa de lista Columna(s) da táboa.
36 sw%3APushButton%3ADLG_AP_INSERT_DB_SEL%3APB_TBL_FORMAT 8f Abre a caixa de diálogo Formato de táboa, que permite a definición das propiedades da táboa, isto é, bordos, fondo e largura das columnas.
37 sw%3AListBox%3ADLG_AP_INSERT_DB_SEL%3ALB_DBFMT_FROM_USR 6a Especifica un formato da lista se non se acepta a información de formato de determinados campos de datos.
3b sw%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_AP_INSERT_DB_SEL%3ARB_DBFMT_FROM_USR 6a Especifica un formato da lista se non se acepta a información de formato de determinados campos de datos.
32 sw%3AListBox%3ADLG_AP_INSERT_DB_SEL%3ALB_TABLE_COL 44 Lista as columnas da base de datos que deben inserirse no documento.
34 sw%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_AP_INSERT_DB_SEL%3ARB_AS_TEXT 56 Insire como texto no documento os datos seleccionados no explorador da fonte de datos.
17 .uno%3ADSBInsertContent 51 Actualiza o contido dos campos da base de datos por medio dos rexistros marcados.
28 .uno%3ADataSourceBrowser%2FInsertContent 51 Actualiza o contido dos campos da base de datos por medio dos rexistros marcados.
11 .uno%3AFilterCrit 28 Permite definir as opcións de filtraxe.
1b DBACCESS_HID_DLG_FILTERCRIT 28 Permite definir as opcións de filtraxe.
2b sc%3AListBox%3ARID_SCDLG_FILTER%3ALB_FIELD3 43 Especifica os nomes de campo da táboa para definilos no argumento.
33 dbaccess%3AListBox%3ADLG_FILTERCRIT%3ALB_WHERECOMP1 73 Especifica os operadores de comparación a través dos cales se ligan as entradas dos campos Nome de campo e Valor.
2a sc%3AComboBox%3ARID_SCDLG_FILTER%3AED_VAL2 29 Especifica un valor para filtrar o campo.
31 dbaccess%3AEdit%3ADLG_FILTERCRIT%3AET_WHEREVALUE1 29 Especifica un valor para filtrar o campo.
33 dbaccess%3AListBox%3ADLG_FILTERCRIT%3ALB_WHERECOMP3 73 Especifica os operadores de comparación a través dos cales se ligan as entradas dos campos Nome de campo e Valor.
1f .uno%3ADataFilterStandardFilter 3b Specifies the logical conditions to filter your table data.
31 dbaccess%3AEdit%3ADLG_FILTERCRIT%3AET_WHEREVALUE2 29 Especifica un valor para filtrar o campo.
33 dbaccess%3AListBox%3ADLG_FILTERCRIT%3ALB_WHERECOND2 4a Para os seguintes argumentos, escolla entre os operadores lóxicos E e OU.
2b sc%3AListBox%3ARID_SCDLG_FILTER%3ALB_FIELD1 43 Especifica os nomes de campo da táboa para definilos no argumento.
34 dbaccess%3AListBox%3ADLG_FILTERCRIT%3ALB_WHEREFIELD2 43 Especifica os nomes de campo da táboa para definilos no argumento.
2a sc%3AListBox%3ARID_SCDLG_FILTER%3ALB_COND1 73 Especifica os operadores de comparación a través dos cales se ligan as entradas dos campos Nome de campo e Valor.
34 dbaccess%3AListBox%3ADLG_FILTERCRIT%3ALB_WHEREFIELD3 43 Especifica os nomes de campo da táboa para definilos no argumento.
2a sc%3AComboBox%3ARID_SCDLG_FILTER%3AED_VAL3 29 Especifica un valor para filtrar o campo.
2a sc%3AComboBox%3ARID_SCDLG_FILTER%3AED_VAL1 29 Especifica un valor para filtrar o campo.
34 dbaccess%3AListBox%3ADLG_FILTERCRIT%3ALB_WHEREFIELD1 43 Especifica os nomes de campo da táboa para definilos no argumento.
2a sc%3AListBox%3ARID_SCDLG_FILTER%3ALB_COND3 73 Especifica os operadores de comparación a través dos cales se ligan as entradas dos campos Nome de campo e Valor.
28 sc%3AListBox%3ARID_SCDLG_FILTER%3ALB_OP2 4a Para os seguintes argumentos, escolla entre os operadores lóxicos E e OU.
2b sc%3AListBox%3ARID_SCDLG_FILTER%3ALB_FIELD2 43 Especifica os nomes de campo da táboa para definilos no argumento.
33 dbaccess%3AListBox%3ADLG_FILTERCRIT%3ALB_WHERECOND3 4a Para os seguintes argumentos, escolla entre os operadores lóxicos E e OU.
2a sc%3AListBox%3ARID_SCDLG_FILTER%3ALB_COND2 73 Especifica os operadores de comparación a través dos cales se ligan as entradas dos campos Nome de campo e Valor.
33 dbaccess%3AListBox%3ADLG_FILTERCRIT%3ALB_WHERECOMP2 73 Especifica os operadores de comparación a través dos cales se ligan as entradas dos campos Nome de campo e Valor.
31 dbaccess%3AEdit%3ADLG_FILTERCRIT%3AET_WHEREVALUE3 29 Especifica un valor para filtrar o campo.
28 sc%3AListBox%3ARID_SCDLG_FILTER%3ALB_OP1 4a Para os seguintes argumentos, escolla entre os operadores lóxicos E e OU.
10 .uno%3AOrderCrit 47 Especifica os criterios de ordenación para a visualización dos datos.
1a DBACCESS_HID_DLG_ORDERCRIT 47 Especifica os criterios de ordenación para a visualización dos datos.
13 CUI_HID_SEARCH_TEXT 3d Introduza na caixa o termo de busca ou seleccióneo na lista.
13 CUI_HID_SEARCH_CASE 56 Especifica que durante a busca se teñan en conta as letras maiúsculas e minúsculas.
18 CUI_HID_SEARCH_BTN_CLOSE 61 Pecha a caixa de diálogo. A configuración da última busca gárdase ata que peche %PRODUCTNAME.
19 CUI_HID_SEARCH_BTN_SEARCH 1a Inicia ou cancela a busca.
17 CUI_HID_SEARCH_POSITION 43 Especifica a relación entre o termo de busca e o contido do campo.
3a cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCHFORM%3ARB_SINGLEFIELD 22 Busca nun campo de datos concreto.
10 .uno%3ARecSearch 31 Busca en táboas de bases de datos e formularios.
2f cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCHFORM%3ALB_FORM 3b Indica o formulario lóxico en que desexa realizar a busca.
3c cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCHFORM%3ARB_SEARCHFORNULL 2d Indica que se van localizar campos sen datos.
1d CUI_HID_SEARCH_FIELDSELECTION 22 Busca nun campo de datos concreto.
3f cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCHFORM%3ARB_SEARCHFORNOTNULL 2d Indica que se van localizar campos con datos.
17 CUI_HID_SEARCH_BACKWARD 5e Especifica que a busca se realiza na dirección inversa, do último rexistro cara ao primeiro.
16 CUI_HID_SEARCH_REGULAR 22 Searches with regular expressions.
18 CUI_HID_SEARCH_STARTOVER 6d Reinicia a busca. As buscas cara a adiante recomezan no primeiro rexistro e as cara a atrás fano no último.
18 CUI_HID_SEARCH_FORMATTER 5e Especifica que se teñen en conta os formatos de campo ao efectuar buscas no documento actual.
18 CUI_HID_SEARCH_ALLFIELDS 19 Busca en todos os campos.
17 CUI_HID_SEARCH_WILDCARD 24 Permite buscar cos comodíns * ou ?.
3c cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCHFORM%3ARB_SEARCHFORTEXT 3d Introduza na caixa o termo de busca ou seleccióneo na lista.
11 .uno%3AFormFilter 60 Solicita ao servidor da base de datos que filtre os datos visíbeis cos criterios especificados.
13 .uno%3AFormFiltered 41 Alterna entre a visualización filtrada e non-filtrada da táboa.
15 .uno%3AViewFormAsGrid 5b Activa unha visualización de táboa adicional cando está en visualización de formulario.
2d .uno%3ADataSourceBrowser%2FDocumentDataSource 4b Mostra a táboa ligada ao documento actual no explorador da fonte de datos.
1c .uno%3ADSBDocumentDataSource 4b Mostra a táboa ligada ao documento actual no explorador da fonte de datos.
14 .uno%3ASbaExecuteSql 2c Executa a consulta SQL e mostra o resultado.
13 .uno%3ADBClearQuery 35 Elimina a consulta e as táboas da xanela de deseño.
24 DBACCESS_HID_JOINSH_ADDTAB_TABLELIST 40 Especifica as táboas que se deben engadir na xanela de deseño.
20 DBACCESS_HID_JOINSH_ADDTAB_CLOSE 2a Pecha a caixa de diálogo Engadir táboas.
3a dbaccess%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_JOIN_TABADD%3ARB_CASE_QUERIES 13 Shows only queries.
39 dbaccess%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_JOIN_TABADD%3ARB_CASE_TABLES 12 Shows only tables.
f .uno%3AAddTable 40 Especifica as táboas que se deben engadir na xanela de deseño.
35 dbaccess%3APushButton%3ADLG_JOIN_TABADD%3APB_ADDTABLE 1d Insire a táboa seleccionada.
19 .uno%3ADBChangeDesignMode 47 Mostra a visualización de deseño ou a visualización SQL da consulta.
13 .uno%3ASbaNativeSql 7e En modo SQL nativo é posíbel introducir ordes SQL que $[officename] non interpreta e que van directamente á fonte de datos.
16 .uno%3ADBViewFunctions 66 Mostra a fila "Función" na parte inferior da visualización de deseño da xanela Deseño de consulta.
17 .uno%3ADBViewTableNames 47 Mostra a fila "Táboa" na parte inferior da xanela Deseño de consulta.
14 .uno%3ADBViewAliases 47 Mostra a fila "Alcume" na parte inferior da xanela Deseño de consulta.
17 .uno%3ADBDistinctValues 62 Expande, por medio do parámetro DISTINCT, a instrución Select da consulta SQL na columna actual.
13 .uno%3ASelectObject 35 Allows you to select objects in the current document.
11 .uno%3ASourceView 7d Mostra o texto fonte do documento HTML. Para ver a fonte HTML de novos documentos ten antes que gardalos como documento HTML.
11 SW_HID_SOURCEVIEW 7d Mostra o texto fonte do documento HTML. Para ver a fonte HTML de novos documentos ten antes que gardalos como documento HTML.
14 .uno%3APageStyleName 92 Mostra o estilo de páxina actual. Prema dúas veces para editar o estilo ou prema co botón dereito do rato para seleccionar un estilo diferente.
13 .uno%3ALayoutStatus 92 Mostra o estilo de páxina actual. Prema dúas veces para editar o estilo ou prema co botón dereito do rato para seleccionar un estilo diferente.
16 .uno%3AStatusPageStyle 92 Mostra o estilo de páxina actual. Prema dúas veces para editar o estilo ou prema co botón dereito do rato para seleccionar un estilo diferente.
10 .uno%3AStateZoom 39 Especifica o factor de zoom da visualización da páxina.
11 .uno%3AInsertMode 5d Displays the current insert mode. You can toggle between INSRT = insert and OVER = overwrite.
14 .uno%3ASelectionMode 7b Displays the current selection mode. You can switch between STD = Standard, EXT = Extend, ADD = Add, BLK = Block selection.
1a .uno%3AStatusSelectionMode 7b Displays the current selection mode. You can switch between STD = Standard, EXT = Extend, ADD = Add, BLK = Block selection.
13 .uno%3AModifyStatus 9a If changes to the document have not yet been saved, a "*" is displayed in this field on the Status Bar. This also applies to new, not yet saved documents.
15 .uno%3AModifiedStatus 9a If changes to the document have not yet been saved, a "*" is displayed in this field on the Status Bar. This also applies to new, not yet saved documents.
f .uno%3AModified 9a If changes to the document have not yet been saved, a "*" is displayed in this field on the Status Bar. This also applies to new, not yet saved documents.
12 .uno%3ACurrentTime 15 Mostra a hora actual.
12 .uno%3ACurrentDate 15 Mostra a data actual.
1b .uno%3AGraphicFilterToolbox 70 Esta icona da barra Imaxe abre a barra Filtro gráfico, onde pode utilizar varios filtros na imaxe seleccionada.
4f cui%3ANumericField%3ARID_SVX_GRFFILTER_DLG_POSTER%3ADLG_FILTERPOSTER_NUM_POSTER 3c Especifica o número de cores a que se debe reducir a imaxe.
4a cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVX_GRFFILTER_DLG_MOSAIC%3ADLG_FILTERMOSAIC_CBX_EDGES 33 Mellora ou aumenta a nitidez dos bordos do obxecto.
4d cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVX_GRFFILTER_DLG_MOSAIC%3ADLG_FILTERMOSAIC_MTR_WIDTH 28 Define a largura das pezas dos mosaicos.
1c .uno%3AGraphicFilterSolarize cd Abre unha caixa de diálogo para definir a solarización. A solarización é un efecto semellante ao que acontece cando hai exceso de luz durante o revelado fotográfico. As cores invértense parcialmente.
1a .uno%3AGraphicFilterRelief 31 Mostra unha caixa de diálogo para crear relevos.
1a .uno%3AGraphicFilterInvert 8e Inverte os valores da cor dunha imaxe en cor ou os de brillo dunha imaxe en escala de grises. Aplique o filtro de novo para reverter o efecto.
19 .uno%3AGraphicFilterSobel 6b Mostra a imaxe como un debuxo a carbón. Os contornos debúxanse en negro e as cores orixinais suprímense.
1a .uno%3AGraphicFilterMosaic 48 Asocia pequenos grupos de píxeles en áreas rectangulares da mesma cor.
1f .uno%3AGraphicFilterRemoveNoise 28 Elimina ruido aplicando un filtro medio.
1a .uno%3AGraphicFilterPoster 4a Abre unha caixa de diálogo para determinar o número de cores do póster.
4e cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVX_GRFFILTER_DLG_MOSAIC%3ADLG_FILTERMOSAIC_MTR_HEIGHT 27 Define a altura das pezas dos mosaicos.
19 .uno%3AGraphicFilterSepia ac Todos os píxeles están definidos para valores de gris e as canles de cor verde e azul están reducidas a cantidade que espefique. A canle de cor vermella non se modifica.
4f cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVX_GRFFILTER_DLG_SOLARIZE%3ADLG_FILTERSOLARIZE_CBX_INVERT 32 Especifica tamén para inverter todos os píxeles.
1b .uno%3AGraphicFilterSharpen 31 Aumenta a imaxe aplicando un filtro de paso alto.
1a .uno%3AGraphicFilterSmooth 3c Suaviza ou esfuma a imaxe aplicando un filtro de paso baixo.
55 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVX_GRFFILTER_DLG_SOLARIZE%3ADLG_FILTERSOLARIZE_MTR_THRESHOLD 5b Especifica o nivel de brillo, en porcentaxe, por riba do cal deben solarizarse os píxeles.
1a .uno%3AGraphicFilterPopart 28 Converte unha imaxe nun formato pop art.
4b cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVX_GRFFILTER_DLG_SEPIA%3ADLG_FILTERSEPIA_MTR_SEPIA 99 Define a intensidade de envellecemento en porcentaxe. Ao 0% verá os valores de gris de todos os píxeles. Ao 100% só permanece a canle de cor vermella.
f .uno%3AGrafMode ad Lista os atributos de visualización do obxecto gráfico seleccionado. O obxecto gráfico incorporado ou ligado ao ficheiro non se modifica, só a visualización do obxecto.
e .uno%3AGrafRed 55 Specifies the proportion of red RGB color components for the selected graphic object.
10 .uno%3AGrafGreen 57 Specifies the proportion of green RGB color components for the selected graphic object.
f .uno%3AGrafBlue 4f Specifies the proportion of blue RGB color components for the selected graphic.
14 .uno%3AGrafLuminance 35 Especifica o brillo do obxecto gráfico seleccionado.
13 .uno%3AGrafContrast 48 Especifica o contraste da visualización da imaxe gráfica seleccionada.
10 .uno%3AGrafGamma 72 Specifies the gamma value for the view of the selected object, which affects the brightness of the midtone values.
17 .uno%3AGrafTransparence 31 Specifies the transparency in the graphic object.
13 .uno%3AGrafAttrCrop 76 Allows to crop the display of an inserted picture. Only the display gets cropped, the inserted picture is not changed.
b .uno%3ACrop 3b Drag any of the eight cropping handles to crop the picture.
1c .uno%3ABasicShapes.block-arc 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1a .uno%3ABasicShapes.diamond 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1a .uno%3ABasicShapes.ellipse 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1c .uno%3ABasicShapes.trapezoid 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1a .uno%3ABasicShapes.quadrat 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
12 .uno%3ABasicShapes 55 Abre a barra de ferramentas Formas básicas, que permite inserir imaxes no documento.
18 .uno%3ABasicShapes.cross 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
17 .uno%3ABasicShapes.ring 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
19 .uno%3ABasicShapes.circle 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
17 .uno%3ABasicShapes.cube 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1b .uno%3ABasicShapes.pentagon 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
25 .uno%3ABasicShapes.isosceles-triangle 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
16 .uno%3ABasicShapes.can 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
18 .uno%3ABasicShapes.paper 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
21 .uno%3ABasicShapes.right-triangle 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1a .uno%3ABasicShapes.hexagon 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
20 .uno%3ABasicShapes.round-quadrat 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1c .uno%3ABasicShapes.rectangle 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
18 .uno%3ABasicShapes.frame 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
22 .uno%3ABasicShapes.round-rectangle 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1a .uno%3ABasicShapes.octagon 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
20 .uno%3ABasicShapes.parallelogram 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1d .uno%3ABasicShapes.circle-pie 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
22 .uno%3AArrowShapes.s-sharped-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
25 .uno%3AArrowShapes.left-arrow-callout 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1a .uno%3AArrowShapes.chevron 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
20 .uno%3AArrowShapes.up-down-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
2b .uno%3AArrowShapes.left-right-arrow-callout 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
23 .uno%3AArrowShapes.left-right-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1d .uno%3AArrowShapes.quad-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
26 .uno%3AArrowShapes.notched-right-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1d .uno%3AArrowShapes.down-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
29 .uno%3AArrowShapes.up-down--arrow-callout 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
21 .uno%3AArrowShapes.circular-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
21 .uno%3AArrowShapes.pentagon-right 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
26 .uno%3AArrowShapes.up-right-down-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
25 .uno%3AArrowShapes.down-arrow-callout 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1e .uno%3AArrowShapes.right-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
21 .uno%3AArrowShapes.up-right-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
12 .uno%3AArrowShapes 54 Abre a barra de ferramentas Frechas largas, que permite inserir imaxes no documento.
1d .uno%3AArrowShapes.left-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1e .uno%3AArrowShapes.split-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
24 .uno%3AArrowShapes.split-round-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
23 .uno%3AArrowShapes.up-arrow-callout 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1b .uno%3AArrowShapes.up-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
26 .uno%3AArrowShapes.right-arrow-callout 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
26 .uno%3AArrowShapes.striped-right-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
29 .uno%3AArrowShapes.up-right-arrow-callout 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
25 .uno%3AArrowShapes.quad-arrow-callout 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
25 .uno%3AArrowShapes.corner-right-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
2e .uno%3ACalloutShapes.round-rectangular-callout 55 Click an icon from the Callouts toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
22 .uno%3ACalloutShapes.round-callout 55 Click an icon from the Callouts toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
23 .uno%3ACalloutShapes.line-callout-3 55 Click an icon from the Callouts toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
23 .uno%3ACalloutShapes.line-callout-2 55 Click an icon from the Callouts toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
23 .uno%3ACalloutShapes.line-callout-1 55 Click an icon from the Callouts toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
28 .uno%3ACalloutShapes.rectangular-callout 55 Click an icon from the Callouts toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
14 .uno%3ACalloutShapes 66 Abre a barra de ferramentas Textos explicativos, que permite inserir elementos gráficos no documento.
22 .uno%3ACalloutShapes.cloud-callout 55 Click an icon from the Callouts toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
14 .uno%3AColorSettings 57 A barra de ferramentas Cor permite editar algunhas propiedades do obxecto seleccionado.
2d .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-punched-tape 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
31 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-summing-junction 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
33 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-predefined-process 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
2c .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-stored-data 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
16 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes 54 Abre a barra de ferramentas Frechas largas, que permite inserir imaxes no documento.
2d .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-manual-input 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
29 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-document 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
2a .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-connector 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
28 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-extract 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
32 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-sequential-access 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
25 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-card 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
23 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-or 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
28 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-process 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
31 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-manual-operation 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
36 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-direct-access-storage 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
32 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-alternate-process 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
26 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-merge 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
29 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-decision 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
2c .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-preparation 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
31 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-internal-storage 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
2e .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-magnetic-disk 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
26 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-delay 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
25 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-sort 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
28 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-display 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
28 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-collate 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
33 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-off-page-connector 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
2b .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-terminator 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
2e .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-multidocument 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
25 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-data 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1d .uno%3AFontworkGalleryFloater 4d Abre a Galería de Fontwork, que permite inserir texto gráfico no documento.
17 .uno%3AFormatPaintbrush 93 First select some text or an object, then click this icon. Then click on or drag across other text or click an object to apply the same formatting.
11 .uno%3AStarShapes 4f Abre a barra de ferramentas Símbolos, que permite inserir imaxes no documento.
18 .uno%3AStarShapes.star12 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
23 .uno%3AStarShapes.horizontal-scroll 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
18 .uno%3AStarShapes.star24 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
17 .uno%3AStarShapes.star4 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
16 .uno%3AStarShapes.bang 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
17 .uno%3AStarShapes.star8 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1f .uno%3AStarShapes.concave-star6 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
18 .uno%3AStarShapes.signet 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
17 .uno%3AStarShapes.star6 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
21 .uno%3AStarShapes.vertical-scroll 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1b .uno%3AStarShapes.doorplate 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
17 .uno%3AStarShapes.star5 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
20 .uno%3ASymbolShapes.bracket-pair 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
20 .uno%3ASymbolShapes.left-bracket 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
13 .uno%3ASymbolShapes 4f Abre a barra de ferramentas Símbolos, que permite inserir imaxes no documento.
21 .uno%3ASymbolShapes.diamond-bevel 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
19 .uno%3ASymbolShapes.cloud 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1e .uno%3ASymbolShapes.quad-bevel 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1a .uno%3ASymbolShapes.flower 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
18 .uno%3ASymbolShapes.moon 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
21 .uno%3ASymbolShapes.right-bracket 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
17 .uno%3ASymbolShapes.sun 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1e .uno%3ASymbolShapes.brace-pair 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1a .uno%3ASymbolShapes.puzzle 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1d .uno%3ASymbolShapes.lightning 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
21 .uno%3ASymbolShapes.octagon-bevel 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1a .uno%3ASymbolShapes.smiley 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1f .uno%3ASymbolShapes.right-brace 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1e .uno%3ASymbolShapes.left-brace 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1d .uno%3ASymbolShapes.forbidden 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
19 .uno%3ASymbolShapes.heart 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
18 SFX2_HID_HELP_TABCONTROL 6a O panel de navegación da xanela da Axuda contén os separadores Contido, Índice, Localizar e Marcadores.
23 SFX2_HID_HELP_TOOLBOXITEM_BOOKMARKS 22 Engade esta páxina aos marcadores
2c sfx2%3AComboBox%3ARID_DLG_SEARCH%3AED_SEARCH 51 Introduza o texto que desexa buscar ou seleccione unha entrada de texto da lista.
15 SFX2_HID_HELP_LISTBOX 66 Na caixa de lista situada na parte superior pode seleccionar outros módulos da Axuda de %PRODUCTNAME.
2c sfx2%3APushButton%3ARID_DLG_SEARCH%3APB_FIND 30 Localiza a seguinte ocorrencia do termo buscado.
11 .uno%3AHelpOnHelp 2d Ofrece unha visión xeral do sistema da Axuda
2f sfx2%3ACheckBox%3ARID_DLG_SEARCH%3ACB_BACKWARDS 37 Busca cara a atrás desde a posición actual do cursor.
1f SFX2_HID_HELP_TOOLBOXITEM_INDEX 26 Mostra e oculta o panel de navegación
1f SFX2_HID_HELP_TOOLBOXITEM_PRINT 18 Imprime a páxina actual
30 sfx2%3ACheckBox%3ARID_DLG_SEARCH%3ACB_WHOLEWORDS 20 Só localiza palabras completas.
2f sfx2%3ACheckBox%3ARID_DLG_SEARCH%3ACB_MATCHCASE 3c Distingue entre texto en maiúsculas e texto en minúsculas.
22 SFX2_HID_HELP_TOOLBOXITEM_BACKWARD 19 Volve á páxina anterior
26 SFX2_HID_HELP_TOOLBOXITEM_SEARCHDIALOG 31 Abre a caixa de diálogo Localizar nesta páxina.
30 sfx2%3ACheckBox%3ARID_DLG_SEARCH%3ACB_WRAPAROUND 47 Busca en toda a páxina da Axuda, comeza na posición actual do cursor.
21 SFX2_HID_HELP_TOOLBOXITEM_FORWARD 1a Avanza á seguinte páxina
1f SFX2_HID_HELP_TOOLBOXITEM_START 2f Vai á primeira páxina do tema actual da Axuda
15 SFX2_HID_HELP_TOOLBOX 57 A barra de ferramentas contén funcións importantes para o control do sistema da Axuda
2a sfx2%3AComboBox%3ATP_HELP_INDEX%3ACB_INDEX 54 Prema dúas veces nunha entrada ou teclee a palabra que desexa localizar no índice.
31 sfx2%3APushButton%3ATP_HELP_INDEX%3APB_OPEN_INDEX 23 Prema para ver o tema seleccionado.
2b sfx2%3AListBox%3ATP_HELP_SEARCH%3ALB_RESULT 7d Lista os títulos das páxinas localizadas na Busca en todo o texto. Para ver unha páxina prema dúas veces na súa entrada.
33 sfx2%3APushButton%3ATP_HELP_SEARCH%3APB_OPEN_SEARCH 27 Mostra a entrada seleccionada da lista.
2e sfx2%3APushButton%3ATP_HELP_SEARCH%3APB_SEARCH 2b Prema para iniciar a busca en todo o texto.
2c sfx2%3AComboBox%3ATP_HELP_SEARCH%3AED_SEARCH 58 Introduza aquí o termo de busca. A busca non distingue entre maiúsculas e minúsculas.
2f sfx2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_HELP_SEARCH%3ACB_FULLWORDS 6b Especifica se vai realizarse unha busca exacta da palabra inserida. Non se localizarán partes de palabras.
2b sfx2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_HELP_SEARCH%3ACB_SCOPE 4b Especifica se a busca dun termo se realiza só nos títulos dos documentos.
1c SFX2_HID_HELP_BOOKMARKS_OPEN 25 exhibe o asunto seleccionado da Axuda
1e SFX2_HID_HELP_BOOKMARKS_DELETE 1f elimina o marcador seleccionado
36 sfx2%3AEdit%3ADLG_HELP_ADDBOOKMARK%3AED_BOOKMARK_TITLE 58 Mostra o nome da páxina marcada. Se o desexa pode teclear un novo nome para o marcador.
1e SFX2_HID_HELP_BOOKMARKS_RENAME 46 abre unha caixa de diálogo onde pode atribuír outro nome ao marcador
31 sfx2%3AListBox%3ATP_HELP_BOOKMARKS%3ALB_BOOKMARKS 95 Ao premer na tecla Intro ou dúas veces sobre un marcador ábrese a páxina asignada. Se preme no botón dereito do rato ábrese o menú de contexto.
1e SFX2_HID_HELP_TABPAGE_CONTENTS 6e Mostra os temas principais da axuda, organizados de maneira semellante aos cartafoles dun xestor de ficheiros.
16 .uno%3AExtrusionTiltUp 39 Inclina cinco graos cara a arriba o obxecto seleccionado.
1f .uno%3AExtrusionLightingFloater 29 Abre a xanela Iluminación de extrusión.
17 .uno%3AExtrusion3DColor 2e Abre a barra de ferramentas Cor de extrusión.
19 .uno%3AExtrusionTiltRight 3b Inclina cinco graos cara á dereita o obxecto seleccionado.
18 .uno%3AExtrusionTiltLeft 3c Inclina cinco graos cara á esquerda o obxecto seleccionado.
18 .uno%3AExtrusionTiltDown 39 Inclina cinco graos cara a abaixo o obxecto seleccionado.
1e .uno%3AExtrusionSurfaceFloater 27 Abre a xanela Superficie de extrusión.
16 .uno%3AExtrusionToggle 3a Activa/desactiva os efectos 3D dos obxectos seleccionados.
3c svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_EXTRUSION_DEPTH%3AMTR_DEPTH 2a Introduza unha profundidade de extrusión.
20 .uno%3AExtrusionDirectionFloater 27 Abre a xanela Dirección de extrusión.
1c .uno%3AExtrusionDepthFloater 29 Abre a xanela Profundidade de extrusión.
1a SVX_HID_POPUP_LINEEND_CTRL 1b Seleccione unha dirección.
14 .uno%3AAutoPilotMenu 58 Guíano na creación de cartas comerciais e persoais, fax, axendas, presentacións, etc.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_ABSPILOT_NEXT 39 Garda a configuración actual e pasa á seguinte páxina.
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_0_CMDNEXT 39 Garda a configuración actual e pasa á seguinte páxina.
38 service%3Acom.sun.star.wizards.letter.CallWizard%3Fstart 27 Inicia o asistente de modelos de carta.
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_0_CMDPREV 32 Mostra as seleccións feitas nos pasos anteriores.
1a WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZARD_BACK 32 Mostra as seleccións feitas nos pasos anteriores.
16 .uno%3AAutoPilotLetter 27 Inicia o asistente de modelos de carta.
1c WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZARD_CREATE 74 O asistente crea un novo modelo de documento a partir das opcións seleccionadas e despois gárdao no disco ríxido.
1a WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZARD_NEXT 39 Garda a configuración actual e pasa á seguinte páxina.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_ABSPILOT_PREVIOUS 32 Mostra as seleccións feitas nos pasos anteriores.
23 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_CHKBUSINESSPAPER a2 Especifica se vai usarse papel con logotipos impresos, enderezos ou liñas de pés de páxina. O asistente mostra a seguir a páxina de deseño do papel timbrado.
23 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_OPTPRIVATELETTER 2f Especifica que se vai crear unha carta persoal.
24 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_OPTBUSINESSLETTER 39 Especifica que se vai crear un modelo de carta comercial.
27 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_LSTPRIVOFFICIALSTYLE 28 Seleccione o deseño do modelo de carta.
22 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_LSTPRIVATESTYLE 28 Seleccione o deseño do modelo de carta.
28 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_OPTPRIVOFFICIALLETTER 36 Especifica que se vai crear unha carta persoal formal.
23 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_LSTBUSINESSSTYLE 28 Seleccione o deseño do modelo de carta.
13 SW_HID_LETTER_PAGE1 3b Especifica se se vai crear unha carta persoal ou comercial.
1b WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_NUMLOGOX 4d Define a distancia entre o logotipo e a marxes esquerda e dereita da páxina.
21 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_CHKPAPERFOOTER 6c Especifica que xa hai un pé de páxina impreso no papel timbrado. %PRODUCTNAME non imprime pés de páxina.
23 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_NUMADDRESSHEIGHT 1c Define a altura do logotipo.
26 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_CHKPAPERCOMPANYLOGO 67 Especifica que xa hai un logotipo impreso no seu papel timbrado. %PRODUCTNAME non imprime ningún logo.
1b WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_NUMLOGOY 4f Define a distancia entre o logotipo e as marxes superior e inferior da páxina.
22 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_NUMFOOTERHEIGHT 74 Introduza a altura da área do pé de páxina xa impreso no seu papel timbrado. %PRODUCTNAME non imprime nesa área.
1f WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_NUMLOGOWIDTH 1d Define a largura do logotipo.
25 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_CHKCOMPANYRECEIVER a7 Especifica que o enderezo xa está impreso en tamaño reducido por enriba da área do enderezo do destinatario. %PRODUCTNAME non imprime enderezos en tamaño reducido.
22 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_NUMADDRESSWIDTH 1d Define a largura do logotipo.
13 SW_HID_LETTER_PAGE2 45 Permítelle especificar os elementos presentes no seu papel timbrado.
29 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_CHKPAPERCOMPANYADDRESS 66 Especifica a existencia dun enderezo xa impreso no papel timbrado. %PRODUCTNAME non imprime enderezos.
1e WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_NUMADDRESSX 4d Define a distancia entre o logotipo e a marxes esquerda e dereita da páxina.
1e WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_NUMADDRESSY 4f Define a distancia entre o logotipo e as marxes superior e inferior da páxina.
20 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_NUMLOGOHEIGHT 1c Define a altura do logotipo.
28 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_CHKUSEADDRESSRECEIVER 3c Inclúe un enderezo de remite en pequeno no modelo de carta.
1f WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_CHKUSEFOOTER 2d Inclúe un pé de páxina no modelo de carta.
20 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_LSTSALUTATION 45 Inclúe un saúdo no modelo de carta, seleccióneo na caixa de lista.
1d WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_CHKUSELOGO 27 Inclúe un logotipo no modelo de carta.
20 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_LSTLETTERNORM 3b Seleccione un país para usar un deseño de carta adecuado.
20 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_CHKUSESUBJECT 30 Inclúe unha liña de asunto no modelo de carta.
1e WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_CHKUSESIGNS 4d Inclúe unha liña con referencias a unha carta comercial no modelo de carta.
13 SW_HID_LETTER_PAGE3 2a Define o texto e a posición do remitente.
23 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_CHKUSESALUTATION 45 Inclúe un saúdo no modelo de carta, seleccióneo na caixa de lista.
22 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_CHKUSEBENDMARKS 2b Inclúe marcas de dobra no modelo de carta.
1e WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_LSTGREETING 53 Inclúe unha frase de despedida no modelo de carta. Selecciónea na caixa de lista.
21 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_CHKUSEGREETING 53 Inclúe unha frase de despedida no modelo de carta. Selecciónea na caixa de lista.
20 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_TXTSENDERCITY 2d Especifica os datos de enderezo do remitente.
26 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_TXTSENDERSTATE_TEXT 2d Especifica os datos de enderezo do remitente.
20 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_TXTSENDERNAME 1f Especifica o nome do remitente.
29 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_OPTRECEIVERPLACEHOLDER 52 Especifica que se insiran os campos de marcadores de posición no modelo de carta.
22 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_TXTSENDERSTREET 2b Especifica o enderezo da rúa do remitente.
13 SW_HID_LETTER_PAGE4 2f Define os datos do destinatario e do remitente.
26 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_OPTRECEIVERDATABASE 46 Os campos de base de datos de enderezos insírense no modelo de carta.
22 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_OPTSENDERDEFINE 3b Utiliza os datos de enderezo das seguintes caixas de texto.
27 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_OPTSENDERPLACEHOLDER 4d Use the address data from %PRODUCTNAME - User Data in the Options dialog box.
24 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_TXTSENDERPOSTCODE 2d Especifica os datos de enderezo do remitente.
25 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_CHKFOOTERNEXTPAGES 4b Seleccione esta opción para suprimir o pé de páxina da primeira páxina.
1c WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_TXTFOOTER 2f Introduza o texto das liñas de pé de páxina.
13 SW_HID_LETTER_PAGE5 48 Especifica os elementos que se van incluír no espazo do pé de páxina.
27 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_CHKFOOTERPAGENUMBERS 60 Marque esta caixa de verificación se desexa incluír os números de páxina no modelo de carta.
1a WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_TXTPATH 5d Introduza o camiño e o nome do ficheiro do modelo ou prema no botón ... para seleccionalos.
22 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_OPTCREATELETTER 59 Garda e pecha o modelo e, a seguir, abre un novo documento sen título baseado no modelo.
1a WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_CMDPATH 5d Introduza o camiño e o nome do ficheiro do modelo ou prema no botón ... para seleccionalos.
22 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_TXTTEMPLATENAME 2c Especifica o título do modelo de documento.
21 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_OPTMAKECHANGES 2d Garda o modelo e manteno aberto para editalo.
13 SW_HID_LETTER_PAGE6 38 Especifica onde e baixo que nome se vai gardar o modelo.
1c WIZARDS_HID_FAXWIZARD_CREATE bd O asistente crea un modelo de documento a partir das opcións seleccionadas e gárdao. Móstrase na área de traballo un novo documento baseado no modelo, co nome de ficheiro "SentítuloX".
1a WIZARDS_HID_FAXWIZARD_NEXT 7e O asistente garda a configuración e avanza á seguinte páxina. O botón Seguinte fica inactivo ao chegar á última páxina.
1a WIZARDS_HID_FAXWIZARD_BACK b1 Prema no botón Volver para ver o configurado na páxina anterior. A configuración actual non se modifica nin elimina. Este botón móstrase activo a partir da segunda páxina.
35 service%3Acom.sun.star.wizards.fax.CallWizard%3Fstart 18 Abre o Asistente de fax.
13 .uno%3AAutoPilotFax 18 Abre o Asistente de fax.
1b WIZARDS_HID_LSTPRIVATESTYLE 21 Especifica o deseño predefinido.
10 SW_HID_FAX_PAGE1 28 Define o estilo do seu documento de fax.
20 WIZARDS_HID_FAXWIZ_OPTPRIVATEFAX 28 Crea un modelo de fax de estilo persoal.
23 WIZARDS_HID_FAXWIZ_LSTBUSINESSSTYLE 21 Especifica o deseño predefinido.
21 WIZARDS_HID_FAXWIZ_OPTBUSINESSFAX 2a Crea un modelo de fax de estilo comercial.
19 WIZARDS_HID_CHKUSESUBJECT 1f Inclúe un logotipo da empresa.
1a WIZARDS_HID_CHKUSEGREETING 46 Inclúe unha liña de tipo de mensaxe, selecciónea na caixa de lista.
1c WIZARDS_HID_CHKUSESALUTATION 1a Inclúe un campo de datos.
19 WIZARDS_HID_LSTSALUTATION 46 Inclúe unha liña de tipo de mensaxe, selecciónea na caixa de lista.
1b WIZARDS_HID_TXTSENDERSTREET 1a Inclúe un pé de páxina.
20 WIZARDS_HID_OPTSENDERPLACEHOLDER 32 Inclúe un saúdo. Seleccióneo na caixa de lista.
19 WIZARDS_HID_TXTSENDERNAME 4b Inclúe unha fórmula cordial de despedida, seleccióneo na caixa de lista.
10 SW_HID_FAX_PAGE2 2f Especifica os elementos do fax que se imprimen.
18 WIZARDS_HID_CHKUSEFOOTER 32 Inclúe un saúdo. Seleccióneo na caixa de lista.
17 WIZARDS_HID_LSTGREETING 1d Inclúe unha liña de asunto.
1b WIZARDS_HID_OPTSENDERDEFINE 4b Inclúe unha fórmula cordial de despedida, seleccióneo na caixa de lista.
10 SW_HID_FAX_PAGE3 40 Especifica a información do remitente e do destinatario do fax.
1c WIZARDS_HID_FILETEMPLATEPATH 67 Insire campos de base de datos para unha posterior combinación de correspondencia co documento de fax.
18 WIZARDS_HID_TXTSENDERFAX 2c Introduza os datos do enderezo do remitente.
1b WIZARDS_HID_TXTTEMPLATENAME 72 Insire marcadores de posición para o enderezo no modelo de fax, onde, máis adiante, introducirá os datos reais.
19 WIZARDS_HID_TXTSENDERCITY 8b Seleccióneo para introducir os datos de enderezo nas caixas de texto presentes. Os datos insírense como texto normal no documento de fax.
1e WIZARDS_HID_CHKFOOTERNEXTPAGES 2c Introduza os datos do enderezo do remitente.
20 WIZARDS_HID_CHKFOOTERPAGENUMBERS 2c Introduza os datos do enderezo do remitente.
1f WIZARDS_HID_OPTRECEIVERDATABASE 2c Introduza os datos do enderezo do remitente.
1a WIZARDS_HID_TXTSENDERSTATE 72 Insire marcadores de posición para o enderezo no modelo de fax, onde, máis adiante, introducirá os datos reais.
15 WIZARDS_HID_TXTFOOTER 2c Introduza os datos do enderezo do remitente.
22 WIZARDS_HID_OPTRECEIVERPLACEHOLDER 2c Introduza os datos do enderezo do remitente.
10 SW_HID_FAX_PAGE4 2c Especifica a información do pé de páxina.
10 SW_HID_FAX_PAGE5 28 Define o nome e localización do modelo.
38 service%3Acom.sun.star.wizards.agenda.CallWizard%3Fstart 3c Inicia o asistente para axudalo a crear un modelo de axenda.
16 .uno%3AAutoPilotAgenda 3c Inicia o asistente para axudalo a crear un modelo de axenda.
23 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_1_LIST_PAGEDESIGN 32 Seleccione o deseño de páxina na caixa de lista.
13 SW_HID_AGENDA_PAGE1 24 Especifica un deseño para a axenda.
1f WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_1_CHK_MINUTES 53 Imprime unha páxina que pode utilizarse para redactar as actas durante a reunión.
1d WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_2_TXT_TITLE 1e Especifica o nome da reunión.
1c WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_2_TXT_DATE 1e Especifica a data da reunión.
20 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_2_TXT_LOCATION 1f Especifica o sitio de reunión.
13 SW_HID_AGENDA_PAGE2 3a Especifica a data, hora, nome e localización da reunión.
1c WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_2_TXT_TIME 1e Especifica a hora da reunión.
13 SW_HID_AGENDA_PAGE3 35 Especifica os títulos que desexa incluír na axenda.
1c WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_3_CHK_READ 3a Especifica se é necesario imprimir unha liña "Lecturas".
1d WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_3_CHK_BRING 44 Especifica se é necesario imprimir unha liña "Material necesario".
1d WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_3_CHK_NOTES 37 Especifica se é necesario imprimir unha liña "Notas".
24 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_3_CHK_MEETING_TYPE 42 Especifica se é necesario imprimir unha liña "Tipo de reunión".
23 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_4_CHK_FACILITATOR 4f Especifica se é necesario incluír unha liña para introducir os observadores.
21 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_4_CHK_ATTENDEES 5c Especifica se é necesario incluír unha liña para introducir os participantes na reunión.
21 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_4_CHK_NOTETAKER 5c Especifica se é necesario incluír unha liña para introducir os participantes na reunión.
21 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_4_CHK_OBSERVERS 4f Especifica se é necesario incluír unha liña para introducir os observadores.
27 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_4_CHK_RESOURCEPERSONS 5c Especifica se é necesario incluír unha liña para introducir os participantes na reunión.
22 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_4_CHK_TIMEKEEPER 4f Especifica se é necesario incluír unha liña para introducir os observadores.
13 SW_HID_AGENDA_PAGE4 32 Especifica os nomes que se van incluír na axenda.
21 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_4_CHK_CALLED_BY 6f Especifica se é necesario incluír unha liña que permita introducir o nome da persoa que convocou a reunión.
1c WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_5_BTN_DOWN 21 Move cara a abaixo o tema actual.
1a WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_5_BTN_UP 21 Move cara a arriba o tema actual.
13 SW_HID_AGENDA_PAGE5 3c Especifica os temas que desexa imprimir no modelo de axenda.
1e WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_5_BTN_REMOVE 1f Elimina a liña de tema actual.
25 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_5_TXT_RESPONSIBLE_1 58 Introduza os temas da axenda. Use os botóns Mover arriba e Mover abaixo para ordenalos.
1f WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_5_TXT_TOPIC_1 58 Introduza os temas da axenda. Use os botóns Mover arriba e Mover abaixo para ordenalos.
1e WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_5_BTN_INSERT 38 Insire unha nova liña baleira de tema enriba da actual.
21 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_5_TXT_MINUTES_1 58 Introduza os temas da axenda. Use os botóns Mover arriba e Mover abaixo para ordenalos.
23 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_6_OPT_MAKECHANGES 41 Crea e garda o modelo de axenda e, a seguir, ábreo para editalo.
24 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_6_BTN_TEMPLATEPATH 51 Especifique o camiño completo, incluído o nome de ficheiro do modelo de axenda.
13 SW_HID_AGENDA_PAGE6 37 Escolla o nome e localización para o modelo de axenda.
24 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_6_OPT_CREATEAGENDA 5a Crea e garda o modelo de axenda e, a seguir, abre un novo documento de axenda baseado nel.
24 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_6_TXT_TEMPLATENAME 26 Especifica o nome do modelo de axenda.
24 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_6_TXT_TEMPLATEPATH 51 Especifique o camiño completo, incluído o nome de ficheiro do modelo de axenda.
24 sd%3APushButton%3ADLG_ASS%3ABUT_LAST 3d Volve á etapa anterior sen eliminar a configuración actual.
24 sd%3APushButton%3ADLG_ASS%3ABUT_NEXT 38 Acepta a nova configuración e pasa á seguinte páxina.
c slot%3A10425 8e Use o asistente para crear presentacións de modo interactivo. Co asistente pode modificar as mostras de modelos segundo as súas necesidades.
1d .uno%3AAutoPilotPresentations 8e Use o asistente para crear presentacións de modo interactivo. Co asistente pode modificar as mostras de modelos segundo as súas necesidades.
16 .uno%3ANewPresentation 8e Use o asistente para crear presentacións de modo interactivo. Co asistente pode modificar as mostras de modelos segundo as súas necesidades.
18 SD_HID_SD_AUTOPILOT_OPEN 108 Lists the presentations that you created and saved to the Templates directory that is specified under %PRODUCTNAME - Paths in the Options dialog box. To edit the layout and formatting of a presentation with the wizard, select the presentation, and then click Next.
29 sd%3APushButton%3ADLG_ASS%3APB_PAGE1_OPEN 46 Prema en Abrir para ver a caixa de diálogo de selección de ficheiro.
26 sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_ASS%3ACB_STARTWITH 71 Specifies that you only want the Wizard to start when you expressly request it with File - Wizard - Presentation.
2b sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_ASS%3ARB_PAGE1_EMPTY 27 Crea unha nova presentación (baleira).
1d SD_HID_SD_AUTOPILOT_TEMPLATES 41 Lista as categorías de modelo dispoñíbeis para presentacións.
2a sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_ASS%3ARB_PAGE1_OPEN 3a Exhibe unha lista de presentacións creadas anteriormente.
2e sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_ASS%3ARB_PAGE1_TEMPLATE 49 Abre unha caixa de lista que contén varias presentacións modificábeis.
19 SD_HID_SD_AUTOPILOT_PAGE1 47 Especifica o tipo de presentación e permítelle seleccionar un modelo.
1a SD_HID_SD_AUTOPILOT_REGION 41 Lista as categorías de modelo dispoñíbeis para presentacións.
24 sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_ASS%3ACB_PREVIEW 44 Especifica que se mostren os modelos na xanela de previsualización.
2d sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_ASS%3ARB_PAGE2_MEDIUM2 34 Crea unha presentación para usala como diapositiva.
2d sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_ASS%3ARB_PAGE2_MEDIUM4 35 Crea unha presentación que pode imprimirse en papel.
2d sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_ASS%3ARB_PAGE2_MEDIUM3 36 Crea unha presentación para usala como transparencia.
2d sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_ASS%3ARB_PAGE2_MEDIUM5 30 Utiliza o formato orixinal de páxina do modelo.
21 SD_HID_SD_AUTOPILOT_PAGETEMPLATES 6d Permítelle seleccionar un estilo de diapositiva para a presentación seleccionada na páxina 1 do asistente.
2d sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_ASS%3ARB_PAGE2_MEDIUM1 31 Crea só unha presentación de pantalla completa.
28 sd%3AListBox%3ADLG_ASS%3ALB_PAGE2_LAYOUT 6d Permítelle seleccionar un estilo de diapositiva para a presentación seleccionada na páxina 1 do asistente.
19 SD_HID_SD_AUTOPILOT_PAGE2 6d Permítelle seleccionar un estilo de diapositiva para a presentación seleccionada na páxina 1 do asistente.
27 sd%3AListBox%3ADLG_ASS%3ALB_PAGE3_SPEED 1c Determines the effect speed.
27 sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_ASS%3ACB_PAGE3_LOGO 5f Specifies whether to display the $[officename] logo during the pause between each presentation.
28 sd%3AListBox%3ADLG_ASS%3ALB_PAGE3_EFFECT 2a Specifies an effect for your presentation.
2a sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_ASS%3ARB_PAGE3_LIVE 60 The Default option runs the presentation as a full screen presentation with the specified speed.
19 SD_HID_SD_AUTOPILOT_PAGE3 46 Assigns special effects to your presentation and determines its speed.
2a sd%3ATimeField%3ADLG_ASS%3ATMF_PAGE3_BREAK 2c Defines the pause between each presentation.
29 sd%3ATimeField%3ADLG_ASS%3ATMF_PAGE3_TIME 2f Defines the duration of each presentation page.
2b sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_ASS%3ARB_PAGE3_KIOSK 49 Runs the presentation automatically, and restarts it again after a break.
28 sd%3AEdit%3ADLG_ASS%3AEDT_PAGE4_ASKTOPIC 23 Especifica o tema da presentación.
37 sd%3AMultiLineEdit%3ADLG_ASS%3AEDT_PAGE4_ASKINFORMATION 64 Utilice este campo para introducir outras ideas e puntos que lle gustaría abordar na presentación.
27 sd%3AEdit%3ADLG_ASS%3AEDT_PAGE4_ASKNAME 2f Especifica o seu nome e o nome de súa empresa.
19 SD_HID_SD_AUTOPILOT_PAGE4 2f Especifica o seu nome e o nome de súa empresa.
2a sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_ASS%3ACB_PAGE5_SUMMARY 35 Crea un resumo do contido de todas as presentacións.
19 SD_HID_SD_AUTOPILOT_PAGE5 35 Crea un resumo do contido de todas as presentacións.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDFINISH 31 Prema para crear formularios sen máis preguntas.
1a WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_DIALOG 33 Activa o asistente para a creación de formularios.
2c WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDMOVEDOWN_PK_SELECTED 4a Prema para mover unha entrada cara a abaixo o campo seleccionado na lista.
27 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_CMDFILTERMOVEUP 4a Prema para mover unha entrada cara a arriba o campo seleccionado na lista.
29 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_SUB_CMDREMOVESELECTED 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
25 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_MASTER_CMDMOVEALL 42 Click to move all fields to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
27 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTFILTERFIELDS 47 Lists the names of the data base fields in the selected table or query.
21 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_CMDMOVEUP 4a Prema para mover unha entrada cara a arriba o campo seleccionado na lista.
26 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDREMOVESELECTED 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_SUB_CMDMOVEDOWN 4a Prema para mover unha entrada cara a abaixo o campo seleccionado na lista.
27 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_SUB_FIELDSAVAILABLE 47 Lists the names of the data base fields in the selected table or query.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_MASTER_LBTABLES 45 Especifica a táboa ou consulta para a que desexa crear o formulario.
29 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_CMDFILTERMOVEDOWN 4a Prema para mover unha entrada cara a abaixo o campo seleccionado na lista.
26 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_MASTER_CMDMOVEDOWN 4a Prema para mover unha entrada cara a abaixo o campo seleccionado na lista.
2c WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_MASTER_CMDREMOVESELECTED 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
2a WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_MASTER_FIELDSAVAILABLE 47 Lists the names of the data base fields in the selected table or query.
19 WIZARDS_HID2_BTN_DOC_DOWN 4a Prema para mover unha entrada cara a abaixo o campo seleccionado na lista.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_SUB_CMDREMOVEALL 42 Click to move all fields to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
2a WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_MASTER_CMDMOVESELECTED 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
27 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_CMDMOVESELECTED 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDMOVESELECTED 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
21 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTFIELDS 47 Lists the names of the data base fields in the selected table or query.
2d WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_CMDFILTERMOVESELECTED 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
29 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_CMDREMOVESELECTED 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
17 WIZARDS_HID2_BTN_DOC_UP 4a Prema para mover unha entrada cara a arriba o campo seleccionado na lista.
27 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_SUB_CMDMOVESELECTED 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
2a WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDMOVEUP_PK_SELECTED 4a Prema para mover unha entrada cara a arriba o campo seleccionado na lista.
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDMOVEALL 42 Click to move all fields to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
29 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_MASTER_FIELDSSELECTED 32 Mostra os campos dispoñíbeis no novo formulario.
24 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_CMDREMOVEALL 42 Click to move all fields to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_MASTER_CMDMOVEUP 4a Prema para mover unha entrada cara a arriba o campo seleccionado na lista.
21 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDREMOVEALL 42 Click to move all fields to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
23 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_CMDMOVEDOWN 4a Prema para mover unha entrada cara a abaixo o campo seleccionado na lista.
20 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDMOVEDOWN 4a Prema para mover unha entrada cara a abaixo o campo seleccionado na lista.
2f WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_CMDFILTERREMOVESELECTED 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
1e WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDMOVEUP 4a Prema para mover unha entrada cara a arriba o campo seleccionado na lista.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_FIELDSAVAILABLE 47 Lists the names of the data base fields in the selected table or query.
27 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_MASTER_CMDREMOVEALL 42 Click to move all fields to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
21 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_SUB_CMDMOVEUP 4a Prema para mover unha entrada cara a arriba o campo seleccionado na lista.
22 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_CMDMOVEALL 42 Click to move all fields to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_SUB_CMDMOVEALL 42 Click to move all fields to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
25 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_OPTSELECTMANUALLY 4e Prema para engadir un subformulario baseado nunha selección manual de campos.
29 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_OPTONEXISTINGRELATION 46 Prema para engadir un subformulario baseado nunha relación existente.
20 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_lstRELATIONS 37 Seleccione a relación en que se basea o subformulario.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CHKCREATESUBFORM 36 Seleccione esta opción para engadir un subformulario.
26 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_SUB_FIELDSSELECTED 38 Mostra os campos que se van incluír no novo formulario.
20 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_SUB_LBTABLES 43 Especifica a táboa ou consulta para a que se crea o subformulario.
29 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_LINKER_LSTMASTERLINK2 80 Seleccione o campo de formulario principal asociado ao campo do subformulario, que pode seleccionar na caixa de lista adxacente.
29 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_LINKER_LSTMASTERLINK1 80 Seleccione o campo de formulario principal asociado ao campo do subformulario, que pode seleccionar na caixa de lista adxacente.
29 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_LINKER_LSTMASTERLINK4 80 Seleccione o campo de formulario principal asociado ao campo do subformulario, que pode seleccionar na caixa de lista adxacente.
29 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_LINKER_LSTMASTERLINK3 80 Seleccione o campo de formulario principal asociado ao campo do subformulario, que pode seleccionar na caixa de lista adxacente.
28 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_LINKER_LSTSLAVELINK4 80 Seleccione o campo de subformulario asociado co campo do formulario principal, que pode seleccionar na caixa de lista adxacente.
28 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_LINKER_LSTSLAVELINK3 80 Seleccione o campo de subformulario asociado co campo do formulario principal, que pode seleccionar na caixa de lista adxacente.
28 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_LINKER_LSTSLAVELINK2 80 Seleccione o campo de subformulario asociado co campo do formulario principal, que pode seleccionar na caixa de lista adxacente.
28 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_LINKER_LSTSLAVELINK1 80 Seleccione o campo de subformulario asociado co campo do formulario principal, que pode seleccionar na caixa de lista adxacente.
20 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDALIGNLEFT 24 As etiquetas alíñanse á esquerda.
21 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDTOPLABELED 59 Aliña os campos da base de datos en forma de columnas, coas etiquetas enriba dos campos.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDTOPJUSTIFIED 36 Dispón as etiquetas enriba dos datos correspondentes.
21 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDTABLESTYLE 33 Aliña os campos da base de datos de forma tabular.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDLEFTLABELED 5e Aliña os campos da base de datos en forma de columnas, coas etiquetas á esquerda dos campos.
21 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDALIGNRIGHT 23 As etiquetas alíñanse á dereita.
25 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CHKNOMODIFICATION 3a Seleccione esta opción para prohibir a edición de datos.
21 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CHKNOADDITION 42 Seleccione esta opción para prohibir a inclusión de datos novos.
25 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_OPTDISPLAYALLDATA 68 Crea un formulario que pode usarse tanto para mostrar datos existentes como para introducir datos novos.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_OPTNEWDATAONLY 3e Crea un formulario que só se usa para introducir datos novos.
21 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CHKNODELETION 3e Seleccione esta opción para prohibir a eliminación de datos.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_LSTSTYLES 2d Especifica o estilo de páxina do formulario.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDSIMPLEBORDER 2f Especifica que os bordos do campo sexan planos.
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMD3DBORDER 3b Especifica que os bordos do campo teñan unha aparencia 3D.
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDNOBORDER 2b Especifica que os campos non teñan bordos.
21 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_OPTMODIFYFORM 44 Garda o formulario e ábreo en modo edición para cambiar o deseño.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_OPTWORKWITHFORM 5c Garda o formulario e ábreo como documento de formulario para introducir e visualizar datos.
1b WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_TXTPATH 20 Especifica o nome do formulario.
1c WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_DIALOG 25 Seleccione as propiedades do informe.
23 DBACCESS_HID_DOCUMENT_CREATE_REPWIZ 30 Activa o asistente para a creación de informes.
27 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_1_CMDMOVESELECTED 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
29 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_1_CMDREMOVESELECTED 4d Click to move the selected field(s) to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
27 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_1_FIELDSAVAILABLE 4a Displays the names of the data base fields in the selected table or query.
20 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_1_LBTABLES 3f Seleccione a táboa ou consulta para a que vai crear o informe.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_1_CMDREMOVEALL 42 Click to move all fields to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
26 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_1_FIELDSSELECTED 2c Mostra os campos incluídos no novo informe.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_1_CMDMOVEALL 42 Click to move all fields to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_6_TXTTITLE_6 8d Mostra os nomes dos campos que van incluírse no informe. Pode introducir á dereita unha etiqueta para cada campo que se imprime no informe.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_6_TXTTITLE_5 8d Mostra os nomes dos campos que van incluírse no informe. Pode introducir á dereita unha etiqueta para cada campo que se imprime no informe.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_6_TXTTITLE_4 8d Mostra os nomes dos campos que van incluírse no informe. Pode introducir á dereita unha etiqueta para cada campo que se imprime no informe.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_6_TXTTITLE_3 8d Mostra os nomes dos campos que van incluírse no informe. Pode introducir á dereita unha etiqueta para cada campo que se imprime no informe.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_6_TXTTITLE_2 8d Mostra os nomes dos campos que van incluírse no informe. Pode introducir á dereita unha etiqueta para cada campo que se imprime no informe.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_6_TXTTITLE_1 8d Mostra os nomes dos campos que van incluírse no informe. Pode introducir á dereita unha etiqueta para cada campo que se imprime no informe.
27 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_2_PREGROUPINGDEST cb Lista os campos utilizados para agrupar o informe. Para eliminar un nivel do agrupamento, seleccione o nome do campo e, a seguir, prema no botón <-. Pódense seleccionar ata catro niveis de agrupamento.
20 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_2_CMDGROUP 4a Click to move the selected field to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_2_CMDUNGROUP 4a Click to move the selected field to the box that the arrow is pointing to.
20 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_2_GROUPING d8 Lista os campos seleccionados na páxina anterior do asistente. Para agrupar o informe partindo dun campo, seleccione o nome do campo e, a seguir, prema no botón ->. Pode seleccionar ata catro niveis de agrupamento.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_3_OPTDESCEND1 2e Ordena o contido do campo de modo descendente.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_3_OPTASCEND1 2d Ordena o contido do campo de modo ascendente.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_3_OPTASCEND2 2d Ordena o contido do campo de modo ascendente.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_3_OPTDESCEND4 2e Ordena o contido do campo de modo descendente.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_3_OPTDESCEND2 2e Ordena o contido do campo de modo descendente.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_3_SORT4 35 Seleccione un campo adicional para ordenar o informe.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_3_SORT1 41 Seleccione o primeiro campo que se usará para ordenar o informe.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_3_OPTDESCEND3 2e Ordena o contido do campo de modo descendente.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_3_OPTASCEND3 2d Ordena o contido do campo de modo ascendente.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_3_OPTASCEND4 2d Ordena o contido do campo de modo ascendente.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_3_SORT2 35 Seleccione un campo adicional para ordenar o informe.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_3_SORT3 35 Seleccione un campo adicional para ordenar o informe.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_4_PAGELAYOUT b1 Define un deseño de páxina para o informe. Os deseños de páxina cárganse a partir de ficheiros modelo, que atribúen unha cabeceira, un pé de páxina e o fondo da páxina.
20 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_4_PORTRAIT 40 Selecciona unha páxina de orientación vertical para o informe.
21 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_4_LANDSCAPE 42 Selecciona unha páxina de orientación horizontal para o informe.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_4_DATALAYOUT 74 Define un conxunto de estilos para o informe. Os estilos atribúen tipos de letra, sangrías, fondos de táboa, etc.
27 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_5_OPTSTATDOCUMENT 6a Garda o informe como estático. Se o abre, mostra sempre os mesmos datos que no momento da súa creación.
27 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_5_OPTEDITTEMPLATE 3e Se preme en Rematar o modelo gárdase e ábrese para edición.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_4_TITLE 48 Especifica o título que se imprime na liña de título de cada páxina.
26 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_5_OPTDYNTEMPLATE 4d Garda o informe como modelo. Os informes dinámicos mostran os datos actuais.
26 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_5_OPTUSETEMPLATE 26 Se preme en Rematar o modelo gárdase.
33 sd%3APushButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE1_DEL_DESIGN 34 Elimina o deseño seleccionado da lista de deseños.
34 sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE1_OLD_DESIGN 77 Carga un deseño existente da lista de deseños e utilízao como punto de partida para os pasos seguintes do asistente.
1a SD_HID_SD_HTMLEXPORT_PAGE1 34 Crea un deseño nas páxinas seguintes do asistente.
34 sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE1_NEW_DESIGN 34 Crea un deseño nas páxinas seguintes do asistente.
2d sd%3AListBox%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE1_DESIGNS 1e Mostra os deseños existentes.
2e sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE2_PERL 4c Utilizado pola exportación WebCast para crear páxinas HTML e scripts Perl.
34 sd%3ATimeField%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE2_DURATION_TMF 32 Define o tempo de exhibición de cada diapositiva.
2d sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE2_ASP a5 Se selecciona a opción ASP , a exportación WebCast crea páxinas ASP. Teña en conta que as presentacións HTML só as ofrecen servidores web con soporte para ASP.
2c sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE2_NOTES 30 Especifica que se mostren tamén as súas notas.
32 sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE2_STANDARD 42 Crea páxinas HTML estándar a partir de páxinas de exportación.
26 sd%3AEdit%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE2_URL 63 Especifica o URL (absoluto ou relativo) onde se gardou a presentación HTML creada no servidor web.
31 sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE2_WEBCAST 52 In a WebCast export, automatic scripts will be generated with Perl or ASP support.
26 sd%3AEdit%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE2_CGI 45 Especifica o URL (absoluto ou relativo) para as scripts Perl xeradas.
2e sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE2_ENDLESS 5c Reinicia automaticamente a presentación HTML despois da exhibición da última diapositiva.
30 sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE2_FRAMES 9c Crea páxinas HTML estándar con marcos. A páxina exportada sitúase no marco principal e o marco da esquerda mostra un índice en forma de hiperligazóns.
32 sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE2_CHG_AUTO 73 A transición de páxinas faise automaticamente tras o tempo especificado e non depende do contido da presentación
2f sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE2_KIOSK 99 Crea unha presentación HTML predefinida como unha exportación de quiosco, en que as diapositivas avanzan automaticamente despois dun tempo determinado.
35 sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE2_CHG_DEFAULT dd A transición da diapositiva depende do intervalo que defina na presentación para cada diapositiva. Se define unha transición manual de páxina, a presentación HTML introduce unha nova páxina ao premer calquera tecla.
1a SD_HID_SD_HTMLEXPORT_PAGE2 42 Crea páxinas HTML estándar a partir de páxinas de exportación.
28 sd%3AEdit%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE2_INDEX 5f Especifica o URL (absoluto ou relativo) que debe introducir o usuario para ver a presentación.
2e sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE2_CONTENT 23 Crea unha portada para o documento.
2d sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE3_JPG 82 The files are exported as JPEG files. JPEG files are compressed, with adjustable compression and can contain more than 256 colors.
30 sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE3_SLD_SOUND 51 Indica que se exportan os ficheiros de son definidos como efectos de transición.
1a SD_HID_SD_HTMLEXPORT_PAGE3 79 The files are exported as PNG files. PNG files are compressed without loss of data, and can contain more than 256 colors.
2d sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE3_GIF 75 The files are exported as GIF files. GIF files are compressed without loss of data, and have a maximum of 256 colors.
2e sd%3AComboBox%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE3_QUALITY b4 Specifies the compression factor of the JPEG graphic. A 100% value offers the best quality for a large data range. The 25% factor indicates small files with inferior image quality.
2d sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE3_PNG 79 The files are exported as PNG files. PNG files are compressed without loss of data, and can contain more than 256 colors.
36 sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE3_RESOLUTION_3 5b Seleccione unha resolución alta para unha visualización de diapositivas de alta calidade.
36 sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE3_RESOLUTION_2 4d Seleccione unha resolución media para unha presentación de tamaño mediano.
36 sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE3_RESOLUTION_1 80 Seleccione unha resolución baixa para manter o tamaño de ficheiro reducido, mesmo para presentacións con moitas diapositivas.
2b sd%3AEdit%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE4_WWW_EDIT 46 Especifica o seu sitio web. Insire unha hiperligazón na publicación.
29 sd%3AEdit%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE4_AUTHOR 2b Especifica o nome do autor da publicación.
1a SD_HID_SD_HTMLEXPORT_PAGE4 2b Especifica o nome do autor da publicación.
30 sd%3AMultiLineEdit%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE4_MISC 3b Especifica o texto adicional que se vai mostrar na portada.
2d sd%3AEdit%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE4_EMAIL_EDIT 2d Especifica o enderezo de correo electrónico.
1a SD_HID_SD_HTMLEXPORT_PAGE5 31 Insire hiperligazóns de texto en vez de botóns.
2f sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE5_TEXTONLY 31 Insire hiperligazóns de texto en vez de botóns.
31 sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE6_DEFAULT 3b Utiliza as cores predefinidas do explorador web do usuario.
2d sd%3APushButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE6_LINK 5c Abre a caixa de diálogo Cor, onde pode seleccionar a cor da hiperligazón da presentación.
2d sd%3APushButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE6_BACK 54 Abre a caixa de diálogo Cor, onde pode seleccionar a cor de fondo da presentación.
33 sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE6_DOCCOLORS 47 Determina as cores a partir dos estilos utilizados no documento actual.
2d sd%3APushButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE6_TEXT 55 Abre a caixa de diálogo Cor , onde pode seleccionar a cor do texto da presentación.
2e sd%3APushButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE6_VLINK 60 Abre a caixa de diálogo Cor, onde pode seleccionar a cor da ligazón visitada da presentación.
2e sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE6_USER 4e Permite definir as súas propias cores nalgúns dos obxectos da presentación.
2e sd%3APushButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE6_ALINK 5e Abre a caixa de diálogo Cor, onde pode seleccionar a cor da ligazón activa da presentación.
1a SD_HID_SD_HTMLEXPORT_PAGE6 47 Determina as cores a partir dos estilos utilizados no documento actual.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_LISTWIZARD_FINISH 13 Creates the object.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_GROUPWIZARD_FINISH 13 Creates the object.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_GRIDWIZARD_FINISH 13 Creates the object.
1c WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_DIALOG 53 Copia e converte documentos ao formato XML de OpenDocument usado por $[officename].
27 macro%3A%2F%2F%2FImportWizard.Main.Main 53 Copia e converte documentos ao formato XML de OpenDocument usado por $[officename].
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_0_CMDHELP 53 Copia e converte documentos ao formato XML de OpenDocument usado por $[officename].
26 WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_0_OPTMSDOCUMENTS 5b Converte documentos en formato *.doc de Microsoft Word en documentos *.odt de OpenDocument.
26 WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_0_OPTSODOCUMENTS 51 Converts old binary documents into the OpenDocument format used by $[officename].
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_0_CHKCALC 55 Converts documents in the old format of Calc *.sdc into OpenDocument *.ods documents.
25 WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_0_CHKMATHGLOBAL 9a Converts documents in the old format of Writer master documents *.sgl into OpenDocument *.odm documents, and Math *.smf into OpenDocument *.odf documents.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_0_CHKLOGFILE 5a Crea un ficheiro de rexistro no cartafol de traballo que mostra os documentos convertidos.
20 WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_2_CHKEXCEL 5c Converte documentos en formato *.xls de Microsoft Excel en documentos *.ods de OpenDocument.
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_2_CHKWORD 5b Converte documentos en formato *.doc de Microsoft Word en documentos *.odt de OpenDocument.
21 WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_0_CHKWRITER 57 Converts documents in the old format of Writer *.sdw into OpenDocument *.odt documents.
25 WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_2_CHKPOWERPOINT 61 Converte documentos en formato *.ppt de Microsoft PowerPoint en documentos *.odp de OpenDocument.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_0_CHKIMPRESS 8a Converts documents in the old format of Draw *.sda into OpenDocument *.odg documents, and Impress *.sdd into OpenDocument *.odp documents.
29 WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_2_CBDOCUMENTRECURSE 61 Indicates that the subdirectories of the selected directory are also searched for matching files.
26 WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_2_EDDOCUMENTPATH 43 Specifies the directory to which the destination files are written.
29 WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_2_CBTEMPLATERECURSE 61 Indicates that the subdirectories of the selected directory are also searched for matching files.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_2_CBDOCUMENT 31 Indicates that the documents are to be converted.
2d WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_2_CMDDOCUMENTPATHSELECT 2a Opens a dialog to select the desired path.
26 WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_2_LBDOCUMENTPATH 34 Specifies the directory containing the source files.
2d WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_2_CMDTEMPLATEPATHSELECT 2a Opens a dialog to select the desired path.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_2_CBTEMPLATE 2d Specifies that templates are to be converted.
26 WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_2_EDTEMPLATEPATH 43 Specifies the directory to which the destination files are written.
26 WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_2_LBTEMPLATEPATH 34 Specifies the directory containing the source files.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_OPTIONBUTTON3 39 Convértense todas as celas de moeda do documento activo.
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_TBSOURCE 3e Indica o cartafol ou o nome do documento que desexa converter.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_DIALOG 94 Converte en euros os valores monetarios encontrados en documentos de $[officename] Calc e en campos e táboas de documentos de $[officename] Writer.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_CBHELP 24 Activa a axuda da caixa de diálogo.
25 WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_CHECKRECURSIVE 47 Especifica se incluír todos os subcartafoles do cartafol seleccionado.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_CBBACK 30 Volve á primeira páxina do Conversor de euros.
20 WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_COMBOBOX1 31 Especifica a moeda que desexa converter en euros.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_OPTIONBUTTON4 56 Convértense as celas de moeda do intervalo seleccionado antes de activar o conversor.
20 WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_CHECKBOX1 1a Converte todo o documento.
14 .uno%3AEuroConverter 94 Converte en euros os valores monetarios encontrados en documentos de $[officename] Calc e en campos e táboas de documentos de $[officename] Writer.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_CBGOON 15 Inicia a conversión.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_CBTARGETOPEN 66 Abre unha caixa de diálogo onde pode seleccionar un cartafol para almacenar os ficheiros convertidos.
21 WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_CHKPROTECT c0 Especifica que durante a conversión se desactiva a protección da folla e que se reactiva despois. Se a folla está protexida cun contrasinal, aparece unha caixa de diálogo para introducilo.
27 WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_CHKTEXTDOCUMENTS 56 Converte valores monetarios de campos e táboas de documentos de $[officename] Writer.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_OPTIONBUTTON1 2d Convértense as celas co estilo seleccionado.
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_LISTBOX1 33 Mostra os intervalos da lista que se van converter.
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_TBTARGET 47 Especifica o cartafol e o camiño onde gardar os ficheiros convertidos.
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_CBCANCEL 1b Pecha o Conversor de euros.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_CBSOURCEOPEN 4e Abre unha caixa de diálogo para seleccionar o cartafol ou documento desexado.
31 macro%3A%2F%2F%2FEuro.AutoPilotRun.StartAutoPilot 94 Converte en euros os valores monetarios encontrados en documentos de $[officename] Calc e en campos e táboas de documentos de $[officename] Writer.
1c WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_OBDIR 6d Converte todos os documentos e modelos de $[officename] Calc e $[officename] Writer no cartafol seleccionado.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_OPTIONBUTTON2 2f Convértense as celas de moeda da folla activa.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_OBFILE 2a Converts a single $[officename] Calc file.
3a extensions%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PAGE_SELECTABTYPE%3ARB_MORK 4f Select this option if you already use an address book in Seamonkey or Netscape.
41 extensions%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PAGE_SELECTABTYPE%3ARB_THUNDERBIRD 4e Seleccione esta opción se xa utiliza unha axenda de enderezos en Thunderbird.
17 EXTENSIONS_HID_ABSPILOT 60 Este asistente rexistra unha axenda de enderezos existente como fonte de datos en $[officename].
3b extensions%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PAGE_SELECTABTYPE%3ARB_MACAB 4e Seleccione esta opción se xa utiliza unha axenda de enderezos en Thunderbird.
3f extensions%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PAGE_SELECTABTYPE%3ARB_EVOLUTION 4e Seleccione esta opción se xa utiliza unha axenda de enderezos en Thunderbird.
3a extensions%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PAGE_SELECTABTYPE%3ARB_LDAP 4e Seleccione esta opción se xa dispón de datos de enderezos nun servidor LDAP.
21 .uno%3AAutoPilotAddressDataSource 60 Este asistente rexistra unha axenda de enderezos existente como fonte de datos en $[officename].
49 extensions%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PAGE_SELECTABTYPE%3ARB_EVOLUTION_GROUPWISE 4e Seleccione esta opción se xa utiliza unha axenda de enderezos en Thunderbird.
c slot%3A10934 60 Este asistente rexistra unha axenda de enderezos existente como fonte de datos en $[officename].
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_ABSPILOT_FINISH 46 Estabelece a conexión coa fonte de datos e pecha a caixa de diálogo.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_ABSPILOT_CANCEL 2c Sae do asistente sen aplicar ningún cambio.
44 extensions%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PAGE_SELECTABTYPE%3ARB_OUTLOOKEXPRESS 53 Select this option if you already use an address book in Microsoft Outlook Express.
3d extensions%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PAGE_SELECTABTYPE%3ARB_OUTLOOK 61 Select this option if you already use an address book in Microsoft Outlook (not Outlook Express).
39 extensions%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PAGE_SELECTABTYPE%3ARB_KAB 4e Seleccione esta opción se xa utiliza unha axenda de enderezos en Thunderbird.
3b extensions%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PAGE_SELECTABTYPE%3ARB_OTHER 6b Seleccione esta opción se desexa rexistrar outra fonte de datos como axenda de enderezos en $[officename].
44 extensions%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PAGE_SELECTABTYPE%3ARB_EVOLUTION_LDAP 4e Seleccione esta opción se xa utiliza unha axenda de enderezos en Thunderbird.
2c extensions%3ATabPage%3ARID_PAGE_SELECTABTYPE 60 Este asistente rexistra unha axenda de enderezos existente como fonte de datos en $[officename].
4b extensions%3APushButton%3ARID_PAGE_ADMININVOKATION%3APB_INVOKE_ADMIN_DIALOG 47 Abre unha caixa de diálogo en que pode configurar opcións adicionais.
3d extensions%3AListBox%3ARID_PAGE_TABLESELECTION%3ALB_TABLELIST 5b Especifica a táboa que vai servir de axenda de enderezos para os modelos de $[officename].
36 extensions%3AEdit%3ARID_PAGE_FINAL%3AET_DATASOURCENAME 24 Especifica o nome da fonte de datos.
37 extensions%3ACheckBox%3ARID_PAGE_FINAL%3ACB_REGISTER_DS fe Rexistra en %PRODUCTNAME o ficheiro de base de datos recén creado. A base de datos inclúese na xanela da fonte de datos (F4). Se esta caixa de verificación está desmarcada, só é posíbel acceder á base de datos abrindo o ficheiro de base de datos.
1f DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_BROWSECONN 47 Especifica a localización mediante unha caixa de diálogo de ficheiro.
34 extensions%3APushButton%3ARID_PAGE_FINAL%3APB_BROWSE 47 Especifica a localización mediante unha caixa de diálogo de ficheiro.
49 extensions%3APushButton%3ARID_PAGE_FIELDMAPPING%3APB_INVOKE_FIELDS_DIALOG 33 Abre a Modelos: Atribución de axenda de enderezos.
35 service%3Acom.sun.star.wizards.web.CallWizard%3Fstart 4a O Asistente de web axúdao a manter un sitio web nun servidor da internet.
16 WIZARDS_HID0_WEBWIZARD 4a O Asistente de web axúdao a manter un sitio web nun servidor da internet.
18 WIZARDS_HID1_BTN_DEL_SES 26 Elimina a configuración seleccionada.
19 WIZARDS_HID1_LST_SESSIONS 7f Select the settings that you want to load and then click Load. To start the wizard with the default settings, select "default".
1b WIZARDS_HID2_LST_DOC_EXPORT 51 Selecccione o formato de ficheiro ao que desexa exportar o ficheiro seleccionado.
19 WIZARDS_HID2_TXT_DOC_DESC 39 Introduza unha descrición para o documento seleccionado.
18 WIZARDS_HID2_BTN_ADD_DOC dd Opens a dialog where you can select the files that you want to upload to your web site. The order of the list determines the order in which the hyperlinks to the documents are displayed on the index page of your web site.
1b WIZARDS_HID2_TXT_DOC_AUTHOR 34 Introduza o nome do autor do documento seleccionado.
1a WIZARDS_HID2_TXT_DOC_TITLE 91 Introduza o título do documento seleccionado. O título aparece como hiperligazón ao documento seleccionado na páxina de índice do sitio web.
18 WIZARDS_HID2_BTN_REM_DOC 29 Elimina da lista o ficheiro seleccionado.
15 WIZARDS_HID2_LST_DOCS ff Lista os documentos escollidos para seren publicados no sitio web. O asistente pode converter documentos de %PRODUCTNAME en formatos HTML, PDF e, nalgúns casos, a formato Flash, antes de cargalos. Os ficheiros restantes cárganse no seu formato orixinal.
1c WIZARDS_HID3_IL_LAYOUTS_IMG9 2f Seleccione o deseño para a páxina de índice.
1c WIZARDS_HID3_IL_LAYOUTS_IMG8 2f Seleccione o deseño para a páxina de índice.
1c WIZARDS_HID3_IL_LAYOUTS_IMG7 2f Seleccione o deseño para a páxina de índice.
1c WIZARDS_HID3_IL_LAYOUTS_IMG6 2f Seleccione o deseño para a páxina de índice.
1c WIZARDS_HID3_IL_LAYOUTS_IMG3 2f Seleccione o deseño para a páxina de índice.
1c WIZARDS_HID3_IL_LAYOUTS_IMG2 2f Seleccione o deseño para a páxina de índice.
1c WIZARDS_HID3_IL_LAYOUTS_IMG5 2f Seleccione o deseño para a páxina de índice.
1c WIZARDS_HID3_IL_LAYOUTS_IMG4 2f Seleccione o deseño para a páxina de índice.
1c WIZARDS_HID3_IL_LAYOUTS_IMG1 2f Seleccione o deseño para a páxina de índice.
20 WIZARDS_HID4_CHK_DISPLAY_UP_DATE 4a Inclúe a data da última modificación do ficheiro na páxina de índice.
21 WIZARDS_HID4_CHK_DISPLAY_FILENAME 43 Inclúe os nomes de ficheiros dos documentos na páxina de índice.
1e WIZARDS_HID4_GRP_OPTIMAIZE_640 4b Optimiza o sitio web para unha resolución de pantalla de 640x480 píxeles.
1f WIZARDS_HID4_CHK_DISPLAY_FORMAT 35 Mostra o formato dos ficheiros na páxina de índice.
1e WIZARDS_HID4_CHK_DISPLAY_PAGES 44 Mostra o número de páxinas do seu sitio web na páxina de índice.
1f WIZARDS_HID4_CHK_DISPLAY_F_ICON 3c Mostra a icona do formato de ficheiro na páxina de índice.
24 WIZARDS_HID4_CHK_DISPLAY_DESCRIPTION 46 Inclúe a información de resumo dos documentos na páxina de índice.
20 WIZARDS_HID4_CHK_DISPLAY_CR_DATE 43 Inclúe as datas de creación dos documentos na páxina de índice.
1f WIZARDS_HID4_GRP_OPTIMAIZE_1024 4c Optimiza o sitio web para unha resolución de pantalla de 1024x768 píxeles.
1d WIZARDS_HID4_CHK_DISPLAY_SIZE 41 Mostra o tamaño do ficheiro en quilobytes na páxina de índice.
1f WIZARDS_HID4_CHK_DISPLAY_AUTHOR 4d Inclúe os nomes das persoas que crearon os documentos na páxina de índice.
1e WIZARDS_HID4_GRP_OPTIMAIZE_800 4b Optimiza o sitio web para unha resolución de pantalla de 800x600 píxeles.
16 WIZARDS_HID5_BTN_ICONS 5c Seleccione as iconas que desexa usar para os elementos de navegación da páxina de índice.
17 WIZARDS_HID5_LST_STYLES 38 Seleccione o esquema de cores para a páxina de índice.
18 WIZARDS_HID5_BTN_BACKGND 39 Seleccione unha Imaxe de fondo para a páxina de índice.
18 WIZARDS_HID_BG_BTN_OTHER 72 Abre unha caixa de diálogo de ficheiros para seleccionar un ficheiro de imaxe de fondo para a páxina de índice.
e WIZARDS_HID_BG 42 Especifique unha imaxe de fondo para o estilo de Asistente de web.
17 WIZARDS_HID_BG_BTN_NONE 2d Limpa a imaxe de fondo da páxina de índice.
17 WIZARDS_HID_IS_BTN_NONE 31 Limpa o conxunto de iconas da páxina de índice.
e WIZARDS_HID_IS 53 Select an icon set for navigation on HTML presentation documents in the Web Wizard.
1b WIZARDS_HID6_TXT_SITE_EMAIL 78 Introduza o enderezo de correo electrónico da páxina de índice. O enderezo está almacenado nunha etiqueta meta HTML.
1e WIZARDS_HID6_DATE_SITE_CREATED 66 Introduza a data de creación da páxina de índice. A data está almacenada nunha etiqueta meta HTML.
1f WIZARDS_HID6_TXT_SITE_COPYRIGHT 78 Introduza a nota sobre os dereitos de autor para a páxina de índice. A nota está almacenada nunha etiqueta meta HTML.
1e WIZARDS_HID6_DATE_SITE_UPDATED 64 Introduza a data modificada da páxina de índice. A data está almacenada nunha etiqueta meta HTML.
1b WIZARDS_HID6_TXT_SITE_TITLE 6f Introduza o título da páxina de índice. Este elemento móstrase na barra de título dos exploradores da web.
1a WIZARDS_HID6_TXT_SITE_DESC 6e Introduza unha descrición para a páxina de índice. A descrición está almacenada nunha etiqueta meta HTML.
16 WIZARDS_HID7_TXT_LOCAL ec Carga a páxina de índice e os ficheiros nun cartafol local. A páxina de índice gárdase na localización especificada. Os ficheiros restantes gárdanse no cartafol "omeusitioweb", dentro do cartafol que contén a páxina de índice.
1c WIZARDS_HID7_CHK_PUBLISH_FTP d3 Carga os ficheiros nun servidor FTP. A páxina de índice gárdase na localización especificada. Os ficheiros restantes gárdanse no cartafol "omeusitioweb", dentro do cartafol que contén a páxina de índice.
1e WIZARDS_HID7_CHK_PUBLISH_LOCAL ec Carga a páxina de índice e os ficheiros nun cartafol local. A páxina de índice gárdase na localización especificada. Os ficheiros restantes gárdanse no cartafol "omeusitioweb", dentro do cartafol que contén a páxina de índice.
16 WIZARDS_HID7_BTN_LOCAL 39 Abre unha caixa de diálogo para seleccionar un cartafol.
14 WIZARDS_HID7_BTN_FTP 74 Abre a caixa de diálogo Conexión FTP, onde pode editar e probar a configuración da conexión para o servidor FTP.
1c WIZARDS_HID7_CHK_PUBLISH_ZIP 11c Engade a páxina de índice e os ficheiros a un ficheiro de datos comprimido e carga o ficheiro no sitio web. A páxina de índice gárdase na localización especificada. Os ficheiros restantes gárdanse no cartafol "omeusitioweb", dentro do cartafol que contén a páxina de índice.
15 WIZARDS_HID7_TXT_SAVE 2f Introduza o nome do ficheiro de configuración.
14 WIZARDS_HID7_BTN_ZIP 57 Abre unha caixa de diálogo onde pode especificar a localización do ficheiro de datos.
15 WIZARDS_HID7_CHK_SAVE 37 Garda a configuración que especificou neste asistente.
18 WIZARDS_HID7_BTN_PREVIEW 4d Abre a páxina web no explorador da web predefinido do seu sistema operativo.
14 WIZARDS_HID7_TXT_FTP d3 Carga os ficheiros nun servidor FTP. A páxina de índice gárdase na localización especificada. Os ficheiros restantes gárdanse no cartafol "omeusitioweb", dentro do cartafol que contén a páxina de índice.
14 WIZARDS_HID7_TXT_ZIP 11c Engade a páxina de índice e os ficheiros a un ficheiro de datos comprimido e carga o ficheiro no sitio web. A páxina de índice gárdase na localización especificada. Os ficheiros restantes gárdanse no cartafol "omeusitioweb", dentro do cartafol que contén a páxina de índice.
18 WIZARDS_HID_FTP_TXT_PATH 5f Introduza a localización dun cartafol no servidor FTP onde desexe almacenar os seus ficheiros.
18 WIZARDS_HID_FTP_BTN_PATH 69 Abre unha caixa de diálogo onde pode especificar o cartafol do servidor FTP para almacenar os ficheiros.
14 WIZARDS_HID_FTP_TEST 30 Proba a conexión FTP coa configuración actual.
14 WIZARDS_HID_FTP_PASS 3c Teclee o contrasinal necesario para acceder ao servidor FTP.
f WIZARDS_HID_FTP 50 Edite e probe a configuración de conexión do servidor FTP do Asistente de web.
18 WIZARDS_HID_FTP_USERNAME 40 Teclee o nome de usuario necesario para acceder ao servidor FTP.
16 WIZARDS_HID_FTP_SERVER 2d Teclee o nome ou enderezo IP do servidor FTP.
1d DBACCESS_HID_QRYDGN_ROW_ORDER 66 If you click the cell, you can select among the sorting options: ascending, descending and not sorted.
1d DBACCESS_HID_QRYDGN_ROW_FIELD 91 Introduza o nome do campo de datos a que fixo referencia na consulta. A configuración estabelecida nas filas inferiores refírese  a este campo.
1c DBACCESS_HID_QRYDGN_ROW_CRIT 41 Especifica os criterios de filtraxe do contido do campo de datos.
26 DBACCESS_HID_QUERY_EDIT_JOINCONNECTION 15 Edit Join Properties.
2d dbaccess%3AComboBox%3ADLG_SAVE_AS%3AET_SCHEMA 53 Introduza o nome do esquema atribuído á consulta ou á visualización de táboas.
20 DBACCESS_HID_QRYDGN_ROW_FUNCTION 39 Seleccione aquí unha función para executar na consulta.
1d DBACCESS_HID_QRYDGN_ROW_TABLE 49 Aquí móstrase a táboa de base de datos do campo de datos seleccionado.
1b DBACCESS_HID_CTL_QRYDGNCRIT 32 Seleccione as condicións para definir a consulta.
1d DBACCESS_HID_QRYDGN_ROW_ALIAS 90 Especifica un alcume, que se lista nunha consulta en vez do nome de campo. Isto posibilita o uso de etiquetas de columna definidas polo usuario.
1a DBACCESS_HID_CTL_QRYDGNTAB 65 Prema dúas veces nos campos para engadilos á consulta. Arrastre e solte para definir as relacións.
1f DBACCESS_HID_QRYDGN_ROW_VISIBLE 44 Se marca un campo de datos como Visíbel, faise visíbel na consulta
28 dbaccess%3AEdit%3ADLG_SAVE_AS%3AET_TITLE 3c Introduza o nome de consulta ou de visualización de táboa.
1d DBACCESS_HID_DLG_QRY_JOINTYPE 2d Specifies the link type of the selected link.
20 DBACCESS_HID_DLG_QRY_RIGHT_TABLE 2f Especifica as dúas táboas que desexa asociar.
1f DBACCESS_HID_DLG_QRY_LEFT_TABLE 2f Especifica as dúas táboas que desexa asociar.
21 DBACCESS_HID_DLG_QRY_JOIN_CONTROL f7 Inserts the keyword NATURAL into the SQL statement that defines the relation. The relation joins all columns that have the same column name in both tables. The resulting joined table contains only one column for each pair of equally named columns.
2f dbaccess%3AEdit%3ADLG_PASSWORD%3AED_OLDPASSWORD 21 Introduza o contrasinal anterior.
29 sfx2%3AEdit%3ADLG_PASSWD%3AED_PASSWD_USER 22 Especifica o nome do novo usuario.
33 dbaccess%3AEdit%3ADLG_PASSWORD%3AED_PASSWORD_REPEAT 24 Teclee outra vez o novo contrasinal.
2c dbaccess%3AEdit%3ADLG_PASSWORD%3AED_PASSWORD 1d Introduza o novo contrasinal.
1c DBACCESS_HID_TAB_ENT_DEFAULT 3c Especifica o valor predefinido dos novos rexistros de datos.
29 DBACCESS_HID_TABLEDESIGN_TABED_PRIMARYKEY 67 Se esta orde presenta unha marca de verificación, o campo de datos desta liña é unha chave primaria.
1f DBACCESS_HID_TABDESIGN_TYPECELL 1b Especifica o tipo de campo.
21 DBACCESS_HID_TABDESIGN_BACKGROUND 29 Nesta área define a estrutura da táboa.
25 DBACCESS_HID_TABLE_DESIGN_HELP_WINDOW 1a Mostra os textos de axuda.
22 DBACCESS_HID_TAB_ENT_FORMAT_SAMPLE 41 Mostra o código de formato que pode seleccionar co botón ... ).
1b DBACCESS_HID_TAB_ENT_FORMAT 36 Este botón abre a caixa de diálogo Formato de campo.
23 DBACCESS_HID_TABLEDESIGN_INSERTROWS 97 Se a táboa non foi gravada insere unha fila baleira por riba da fila actual . Se a táboa xa está gravada insere unha fila baleira na fin da táboa .
1f DBACCESS_HID_TABDESIGN_NAMECELL 93 Especifica o nome do campo de datos. Teña en conta as restricións da base de datos, como o tamaño do nome, os caracteres especiais e os espazos.
22 DBACCESS_HID_TABDESIGN_COMMENTCELL 25 Especifica unha descrición opcional.
32 dbaccess%3APushButton%3ADLG_INDEXDESIGN%3APB_CLOSE 12 Closes the dialog.
28 DBACCESS_HID_DLGINDEX_INDEXDETAILS_FIELD 57 Displays a list of the fields in the current table. You can select more than one field.
14 .uno%3ADBIndexDesign 4a The Index Design dialog allows you edit the indexes for the current table.
31 dbaccess%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_INDEXDESIGN%3ACB_UNIQUE 3e Specifies whether the current index allows only unique values.
1d DBACCESS_HID_DLGIDX_SAVEINDEX 2b Saves the current index in the data source.
1d DBACCESS_HID_DLGIDX_INDEXLIST 85 Displays the available indexes. Select an index from the list to edit. The details of the selected index are displayed in the dialog.
1d DBACCESS_HID_DLGIDX_DROPINDEX 1a Deletes the current index.
28 dbaccess%3AModalDialog%3ADLG_INDEXDESIGN 4a The Index Design dialog allows you edit the indexes for the current table.
1f DBACCESS_HID_DLGIDX_RENAMEINDEX 1a Renames the current index.
1c DBACCESS_HID_DLGIDX_NEWINDEX 14 Creates a new index.
1e DBACCESS_HID_DLGIDX_RESETINDEX 50 Resets the current index to the setting that it had when the dialog was started.
2c DBACCESS_HID_DLGINDEX_INDEXDETAILS_SORTORDER 1a Determines the sort order.
1c DBACCESS_HID_CTL_RELATIONTAB 59 Aquí pode ligar as táboas da base de datos actual por medio de campos de datos comúns.
14 .uno%3ADBAddRelation 3c Permite definir e editar unha relación entre dúas táboas.
29 DBACCESS_HID_RELATIONDIALOG_LEFTFIELDCELL 58 Os nomes das táboas seleccionadas para a ligazón aparecen aquí como nomes de columna.
2a DBACCESS_HID_RELATIONDIALOG_RIGHTFIELDCELL 58 Os nomes das táboas seleccionadas para a ligazón aparecen aquí como nomes de columna.
1d DBACCESS_HID_RELDLG_KEYFIELDS 27 Define os campos de chave da relación.
23 DBACCESS_HID_TAB_WIZ_TABLENAME_EDIT 1b Especifica o nome da copia.
3a dbaccess%3ARadioButton%3ATAB_WIZ_COPYTABLE%3ARB_APPENDDATA 39 Anexa os datos da táboa que desexa copiar noutra táboa.
34 dbaccess%3ARadioButton%3ATAB_WIZ_COPYTABLE%3ARB_VIEW d8 Se a base de datos soporta visualizacións, só pode seleccionar esta opción ao copiar unha consulta nun depósito de táboa. Esta opción permítelle ver e editar unha consulta como visualización normal de táboa.
30 dbaccess%3AEdit%3ATAB_WIZ_COPYTABLE%3AET_KEYNAME 41 Especifica o nome da chave primaria xerada. Ese nome é opcional.
33 dbaccess%3ARadioButton%3ATAB_WIZ_COPYTABLE%3ARB_DEF 40 Só copia a definición da táboa, non os datos correspondentes.
3b dbaccess%3ACheckBox%3ATAB_WIZ_COPYTABLE%3ACB_PRIMARY_COLUMN 4a Automatically generates a primary key data field and fills it with values.
37 dbaccess%3ARadioButton%3ATAB_WIZ_COPYTABLE%3ARB_DEFDATA 1e Crea unha copia 1:1 da táboa.
45 dbaccess%3AMultiListBox%3ATAB_WIZ_COLUMN_SELECT%3ALB_NEW_COLUMN_NAMES 36 Lista os campos que desexa incluír na táboa copiada.
3d dbaccess%3AImageButton%3ATAB_WIZ_COLUMN_SELECT%3AIB_COLUMN_LH 5a Adds or removes the selected field (> or < button) or all of the fields (<< or >> button).
3e dbaccess%3AImageButton%3ATAB_WIZ_COLUMN_SELECT%3AIB_COLUMNS_LH 5a Adds or removes the selected field (> or < button) or all of the fields (<< or >> button).
3e dbaccess%3AImageButton%3ATAB_WIZ_COLUMN_SELECT%3AIB_COLUMNS_RH 5a Adds or removes the selected field (> or < button) or all of the fields (<< or >> button).
45 dbaccess%3AMultiListBox%3ATAB_WIZ_COLUMN_SELECT%3ALB_ORG_COLUMN_NAMES bc Lists the available data fields that you can include in the copied table. To copy a data field, click its name, and then click the > button. To copy all of the fields, click the >> button.
3d dbaccess%3AImageButton%3ATAB_WIZ_COLUMN_SELECT%3AIB_COLUMN_RH 5a Adds or removes the selected field (> or < button) or all of the fields (<< or >> button).
21 DBACCESS_HID_TAB_ENT_BOOL_DEFAULT 31 Seleccione o valor predefinido dos campos Si/Non.
43 dbaccess%3AMultiListBox%3ATAB_WIZ_TYPE_SELECT%3ALB_NEW_COLUMN_NAMES 3d Lista os campos de datos que se incluirán na táboa copiada.
35 dbaccess%3APushButton%3ATAB_WIZ_TYPE_SELECT%3APB_AUTO 24 Activa o recoñecemento automático.
19 DBACCESS_HID_TAB_ENT_TYPE 1c Selecciona un tipo de campo.
18 DBACCESS_HID_TAB_ENT_LEN 34 Introduza o número de caracteres do campo de datos.
37 dbaccess%3ANumericField%3ATAB_WIZ_TYPE_SELECT%3AET_AUTO 50 Introduza o número de liñas que desexa usar para o recoñecemento automático.
1d DBACCESS_HID_TAB_ENT_TEXT_LEN 34 Introduza o número de caracteres do campo de datos.
1a DBACCESS_HID_TAB_ENT_SCALE 83 Introduza o número de decimais do campo de datos. Esta opción só está dispoñíbel para campos de datos numéricos ou decimais.
1f DBACCESS_HID_TAB_ENT_COLUMNNAME 58 Mostra o nome do campo de datos seleccionado. Se o desexa, pode introducir un novo nome.
36 dbaccess%3APushButton%3ATAB_WIZ_NAME_MATCHING%3APB_ALL 2d Selecciona todos os campos de datos da lista.
3d dbaccess%3AImageButton%3ATAB_WIZ_NAME_MATCHING%3AIB_COLUMN_UP 37 A entrada seleccionada ascende unha posición na lista.
28 DBACCESS_HID_TAB_NAMEMATCHING_COLS_AVAIL 155 Lista os campos de datos da táboa fonte. Para incluír un deses campos na táboa de destino, marque a caixa de verificación situada diante do nome do campo de datos. Para atribuír o contido dun campo de datos da táboa fonte a un campo de datos da táboa de destino, prema no campo na lista da táboa fonte e, a seguir, nunha das frechas.
37 dbaccess%3APushButton%3ATAB_WIZ_NAME_MATCHING%3APB_NONE 2a Limpa as caixas de verificación da lista.
43 dbaccess%3AImageButton%3ATAB_WIZ_NAME_MATCHING%3AIB_COLUMN_UP_RIGHT 37 A entrada seleccionada ascende unha posición na lista.
45 dbaccess%3AImageButton%3ATAB_WIZ_NAME_MATCHING%3AIB_COLUMN_DOWN_RIGHT 39 A entrada seleccionada descende unha posición na lista..
3f dbaccess%3AImageButton%3ATAB_WIZ_NAME_MATCHING%3AIB_COLUMN_DOWN 39 A entrada seleccionada descende unha posición na lista..
29 DBACCESS_HID_TAB_NAMEMATCHING_COLS_ASSIGN 9b Lista os campos de datos posíbeis na táboa de destino. Na táboa de destino só se inclúen os campos de datos seleccionados na lista da táboa de orixe.
1f DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_SQL92CHECK 6d Nas fontes de datos, só permite nomes con caracteres que se axusten ás restricións de nomeamento de SQL92.
1f DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_USECATALOG b2 Uses the current data source of the Catalog. This is useful when the ODBC data source is a database server. If the ODBC data source is a dBASE driver, leave this check box clear.
21 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_ODBC_OPTIONS 52 Use este campo de texto se necesita configurar opcións adicionais do controlador.
22 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_RETRIEVE_AUTO 7c Introduza unha instrución SQL que devolva o último valor incrementado automaticamente do campo de datos de chave primaria.
27 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_AUTOINCREMENTVALUE 72 Introduza a orde SQL que indica á fonte de datos o incremento automático do campo de datos INTEGER especificado.
28 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_AUTORETRIEVEENABLED 75 Permite a $[officename] soportar campos de datos incrementados automaticamente na fonte de datos ODBC ou JDBC actual.
23 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_DBASE_INDICIES 61 Opens the Indexes dialog, where you can organize the table indexes in the current dBASE database.
20 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_SHOWDELETED 91 Mostra os rexistros dun ficheiro, incluíndo os marcados como eliminados. Se selecciona esta caixa de verificación, non pode eliminar rexistros.
33 dbaccess%3AComboBox%3ADLG_DBASE_INDEXES%3ACB_TABLES 38 Seleccione a táboa de base de datos que desexa indexar.
36 dbaccess%3AImageButton%3ADLG_DBASE_INDEXES%3AIB_REMOVE 49 Move os índices de táboa seleccionados á lista Índices dispoñíbeis.
39 dbaccess%3AImageButton%3ADLG_DBASE_INDEXES%3AIB_REMOVEALL 41 Move todos os índices de táboa á lista Índices dispoñíbeis.
38 dbaccess%3AListBox%3ADLG_DBASE_INDEXES%3ALB_TABLEINDEXES 42 Lista os índices actuais da táboa de base de datos seleccionada.
36 dbaccess%3AImageButton%3ADLG_DBASE_INDEXES%3AIB_ADDALL 41 Move todos os índices dispoñíbeis á lista Índices de táboa.
33 dbaccess%3AImageButton%3ADLG_DBASE_INDEXES%3AIB_ADD 38 Move o índice seleccionado á lista Índices de táboa.
37 dbaccess%3AListBox%3ADLG_DBASE_INDEXES%3ALB_FREEINDEXES 41 Lista os índices dispoñíbeis que pode atribuír a unha táboa.
2f dbaccess%3AListBox%3ADLG_DIRECTSQL%3ALB_HISTORY 6d Lista os ordes SQL executados anteriormente. Para executar de novo unha orde prema nel e despois en Executar.
34 dbaccess%3AMultiLineEdit%3ADLG_DIRECTSQL%3AME_STATUS 41 Mostra os resultados, incluíndo os erros, da orde SQL executado.
31 dbaccess%3AMultiLineEdit%3ADLG_DIRECTSQL%3AME_SQL 3c Introduza a orde de administración SQL que desexa executar.
32 dbaccess%3APushButton%3ADLG_DIRECTSQL%3APB_EXECUTE 3d Executa a orde introducido na caixa Orde que será executada.
27 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_SUPPRESS_VERSIONCL 123 Algunhas bases de datos rastrexan os cambios realizados en cada rexistro a través da atribución de números de versión aos campos alterados. Cada vez que se altera un campo, o número increméntase unha unidade. Mostra na táboa de base de datos o número de versión interno do rexistro.
d .uno%3ASortup 5f Ordena de maneira ascendente a lista de nomes de táboas, comezando polo principio do alfabeto.
1f DBACCESS_HID_TAB_PAGE_TBLGRANTS 57 Mostra e permite editar os dereitos de acceso á base de datos do usuario seleccionado.
1e DBACCESS_HID_TAB_PAGE_PBCHGPWD 45 Cambia o contrasinal do usuario actual para acceder á base de datos.
1c DBACCESS_HID_TAB_PAGE_PBUSER 42 Engade un novo usuario para acceder á base de datos seleccionada.
22 DBACCESS_HID_TAB_PAGE_PBUSERDELETE 1f Elimina o usuario seleccionado.
1c DBACCESS_HID_TAB_PAGE_LBUSER 3a Seleccione o usuario cuxa configuración desexa modificar.
34 dbaccess%3AEdit%3ADLG_ADABASSTAT%3AET_TRANSACTIONLOG 35 Mostra o camiño e o nome do ficheiro TRANSACTIONLOG.
2e dbaccess%3AEdit%3ADLG_ADABASSTAT%3AET_FREESIZE 50 Mostra a cantidade de espazo libre (en megabytes) dispoñíbel na base de datos.
2a dbaccess%3AEdit%3ADLG_ADABASSTAT%3AET_SIZE 37 Mostra o tamaño total (en megabytes) da base de datos.
39 dbaccess%3ANumericField%3ADLG_ADABASSTAT%3AET_MEMORYUSING 39 Mostra a porcentaxe de espazo utilizado da base de datos.
31 dbaccess%3AListBox%3ADLG_ADABASSTAT%3ALB_DATADEVS 33 Mostra o camiño e o nome do ficheiro DATADEVSPACE.
31 dbaccess%3AEdit%3ADLG_ADABASSTAT%3AET_SYSDEVSPACE 32 Mostra o camiño e o nome do ficheiro SYSDEVSPACE.
1b DBACCESS_HID_DLG_ADABAS_USR a7 Teclee o nome do usuario de dominio usado internamente por Adabas. Normalmente, a configuración predefinida do nome e contrasinal do usuario de dominio non se altera.
1e DBACCESS_HID_DLG_ADABAS_SYSPWD 19 Introduza un contrasinal.
22 DBACCESS_HID_DLG_ADABAS_CACHE_SIZE 34 Introduza en megabytes o tamaño da caché de datos.
1e DBACCESS_HID_DLG_ADABAS_CONPWD 19 Introduza un contrasinal.
24 DBACCESS_HID_DLG_ADABAS_DATADEVSPACE 29 Introduza o camiño do DEVSPACE de datos.
2b DBACCESS_HID_DLG_ADABAS_TRANSACTIONLOG_SIZE 3d Introduza en megabytes o tamaño do ficheiro de transacción.
1e DBACCESS_HID_DLG_ADABAS_CONUSR e6 Introduza o nome do usuario a que desexa conceder un control limitado para a modificación dalgúns parámetros da base de datos. Normalmente, a configuración predefinida do nome e contrasinal do usuario de control non se altera.
1e DBACCESS_HID_DLG_ADABAS_DBNAME 1f Teclee o nome da base de datos.
29 DBACCESS_HID_DLG_ADABAS_DATADEVSPACE_SIZE 58 Introduza aquí o tamaño en megabytes da base de datos. O tamaño máximo é de 100 MB.
26 DBACCESS_HID_DLG_ADABAS_PBDATADEVSPACE 47 Localice o cartafol en que desexa gardar o ficheiro e prema en Aceptar.
28 DBACCESS_HID_DLG_ADABAS_PBTRANSACTIONLOG 47 Localice o cartafol en que desexa gardar o ficheiro e prema en Aceptar.
21 DBACCESS_HID_DLG_ADABAS_DOMAINPWD 19 Introduza un contrasinal.
1e DBACCESS_HID_DLG_ADABAS_SYSUSR 33 Introduza o nome do administrador da base de datos.
25 DBACCESS_HID_DLG_ADABAS_PBSYSDEVSPACE 47 Localice o cartafol en que desexa gardar o ficheiro e prema en Aceptar.
23 DBACCESS_HID_DLG_ADABAS_SYSDEVSPACE 28 Introduza o camiño do sistema DEVSPACE.
26 DBACCESS_HID_DLG_ADABAS_TRANSACTIONLOG 3c Introduza o camiño do ficheiro de rexistro da transacción.
2a DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_CHECK_REQUIRED_FIELDS d8 When you enter a new record or update an existing record in a form, and you leave a field empty which is bound to a database column which requires input, then you will see a message complaining about the empty field.
28 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_IGNOREINDEXAPPENDIX 2d Crea un índice con instrucións ASC ou DESC.
1f HID_DSADMIN_PRIMARY_KEY_SUPPORT 5f Enable to overrule Base's heuristics used to detect whether the database supports primary keys.
1b HID_DSADMIN_ESCAPE_DATETIME 35 Use date/time literals that conform to ODBC standard.
26 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_BOOLEANCOMPARISON 3f Seleccione o tipo de comparación booleana que desexa utilizar.
24 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_ENABLEOUTERJOIN 59 Uso de secuencias de escape para asociacións externas. A súa sintaxe é {oj outer-join}
25 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_APPENDTABLEALIAS 3c Anexiona o alcume ao nome da táboa nas instrucións SELECT.
1b DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_SCHEMA 3b Permite utilizar o nome do esquema nas instrucións SELECT.
20 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_DOSLINEENDS 82 Seleccione para usar o código CR + LF  para finalizar cada liña de texto (preferentemente en sistemas operativos DOS e Windows).
27 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_PARAMETERNAMESUBST 5a Substitúe por un punto de interrogación (?) os parámetros nomeados nas fontes de datos.
26 HID_DSADMIN_AS_BEFORE_CORRELATION_NAME 9b Some databases use the keyword "AS" between a name and its alias, while other databases use a whitespace. Enable this option to insert AS before the alias.
27 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_SUPPRESS_VERSIONCL 4c Mostra o número de versión interna do rexistro na táboa da base de datos.
1c DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_CATALOG b7 Uses the current data source of the catalog. This option is useful when the ODBC data source is a database server. Do not select this option if the ODBC data source is a dBASE driver.
26 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_IGNOREDRIVER_PRIV 4a Ignora privilexios de acceso fornecidos polo controlador da base de datos.
1c DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_CHARSET 65 Seleccione o conxunto de caracteres que desexa usar para visualizar a base de datos en $[officename].
24 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_SPECIAL_MESSAGE 3c Seleccione o tipo de base de datos co cal desexa conectarse.
2d DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_JDBC_ET_MYSQLCLASS 47 Introduza o nome do controlador JDBC que se conecta coa fonte de datos.
31 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_JDBC_PB_TESTMYSQLCLASS 4a Proba a conexión da base de datos a través da clase de controlador JDBC.
3c dbaccess%3ACheckBox%3APAGE_CONNECTION%3ACB_PASSWORD_REQUIRED 5b Se está marcada, o usuario deberá introducir o contrasinal para acceder á base de datos.
1e DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_CALC_PATH 59 Introduza o camiño ao documento de folla de cálculo que desexa usar como base de datos.
2e DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_JDBC_ET_MYSQLDBNAME 22 Introduza o nome da base de datos.
1f DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_DBASE_PATH 3f Introduza o camiño do cartafol que contén os ficheiros dBASE.
1e DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_FLAT_PATH 42 Introduza o camiño ao cartafol que contén os ficheiros de texto.
3b dbaccess%3APushButton%3APAGE_CONNECTION%3APB_TESTCONNECTION 3d Proba a conexión da base de datos coa configuración actual.
20 DBACCESS_HID_DLG_DATABASE_WIZARD 6e O asistente da base de datos crea un ficheiro de base de datos que contén información sobre a base de datos.
39 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_GENERAL_RB_GETEXISTINGDATABASE 6e Seleccione esta opción para crear documentos de base de datos para a conexión con bases de datos existentes.
1b DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_DSTYPE 52 Seleccione o tipo de base de datos para a conexión con bases de datos existentes.
33 dbaccess%3AListBox%3APAGE_GENERAL%3ALB_DOCUMENTLIST a0 Seleccione da lista de ficheiros utilizados recentemente un ficheiro de base de datos para o abrir. Prema en Rematar para abrir o ficheiro e saír do asistente.
3a dbaccess%3ARadioButton%3APAGE_GENERAL%3ARB_OPENEXISTINGDOC a6 Seleccione esta opción para abrir un ficheiro de base de datos dunha lista de ficheiros utilizados recentemente ou dunha caixa de diálogo de selección de ficheiro.
36 dbaccess%3APushButton%3APAGE_GENERAL%3APB_OPENDOCUMENT b2 Abre unha caixa de diálogo de selección de ficheiro onde pode seleccionar un ficheiro de base de datos. Prema en Abrir ou en Aceptar para abrir o ficheiro e saír do asistente.
36 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_GENERAL_RB_CREATEDBDATABASE 3b Seleccione esta opción para crear unha nova base de datos.
36 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_FINAL_RB_REGISTERDATASOURCE 118 Select to register the database within your user copy of %PRODUCTNAME. After registering, the database is displayed in the View - Data Sources window. You must register a database to be able to insert the database fields in a document (Insert - Fields - Other) or in a mail merge.
32 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_FINAL_CB_OPENAFTERWARDS 5e Seleccione esta opción para mostrar o ficheiro onde pode editar a estrutura da base de datos.
3a DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_FINAL_RB_DONTREGISTERDATASOURCE 6f Seleccioe esta opción para manter a información da base de datos tan só no ficheiro de base de datos creado.
34 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_FINAL_CB_STARTTABLEWIZARD 73 Seleccione esta opción para chamar o asistente de táboas despois da finalización do asistente de bases de datos.
37 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_MSACCESS_PB_MSACCESSLOCATION 43 Prema para abrir unha caixa de diálogo de selección de ficheiros.
37 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_MSACCESS_ET_MSACCESSLOCATION 32 Especifica o camiño do ficheiro de base de datos.
2f DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_ADABAS_PB_ADABASNAME 43 Prema para abrir unha caixa de diálogo de selección de ficheiros.
2f DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_ADABAS_ET_ADABASNAME 2e Introduza o nome do ficheiro de base de datos.
3e DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_AUTHENTIFICATION_ET_GENERALUSERNAME 3a Os nomes de usuario poden ter un máximo de 18 caracteres.
46 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_AUTHENTIFICATION_CB_GENERALPASSWORDREQUIRED 32 Os contrasinais deben ter entre 3 e 18 caracteres.
28 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_ADO_ET_ADOURL 22 Introduza o URL da fonte de datos.
28 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_ADO_PB_ADOURL 47 Prema para abrir unha caixa de diálogo de selección de base de datos.
31 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_DBASE_ET_DBASELOCATION 31 Introduza o camiño do ficheiro da base de datos.
31 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_DBASE_PB_DBASELOCATION 35 Abre unha caixa de diálogo de selección de camiño.
32 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_JDBC_ET_MYSQLHOSTSERVER 47 nomeservidor é o nome do computador que executa a base de datos MySQL.
20 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_DRIVERCLASS 25 Introduza o nome do controlador JDBC.
2c DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_JDBC_ET_MYSQLPORT f1 Introduza o URL da base de datos. Por exemplo, para o controlador JDBC para MySQL, introduza "jdbc:mysql://<Servername>/<name of the database>. Para obter máis información sobre o controlador JDBC, consulte a documentación do controlador.
2a DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_JDBC_ET_JDBCURL f1 Introduza o URL da base de datos. Por exemplo, para o controlador JDBC para MySQL, introduza "jdbc:mysql://<Servername>/<name of the database>. Para obter máis información sobre o controlador JDBC, consulte a documentación do controlador.
29 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_LDAP_ET_BASEDN 52 Introduza o punto de inicio da busca da base de datos LDAP, por exemplo, "dc=com".
20 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_LDAP_BASEDN 52 Introduza o punto de inicio da busca da base de datos LDAP, por exemplo, "dc=com".
29 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_LDAP_CB_USESSL 54 Crea unha conexión segura co servidor LDAP a través de SSL (Secure Sockets Layer).
2d DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_LDAP_ET_PORTNUMBER 39 Introduza o porto do servidor LDAP. Normalmente é o 389.
2d DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_LDAP_ET_HOSTSERVER 49 Introduza o nome do servidor LDAP utilizando o formato "ldap.server.com".
24 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_LDAP_PORTNUMBER 39 Introduza o porto do servidor LDAP. Normalmente é o 389.
22 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_LDAP_HOSTNAME 49 Introduza o nome do servidor LDAP utilizando o formato "ldap.server.com".
32 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_MYSQL_RB_CONNECTVIAJDBC 40 Conecta con fontes de datos JDBC definidas nun nivel do sistema.
32 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_MYSQL_RB_CONNECTVIAODBC 40 Conecta con fontes de datos ODBC definidas nun nivel do sistema.
37 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_ODBC_ET_NAMEOFODBCDATASOURCE 31 Introduza o camiño do ficheiro da base de datos.
37 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_ODBC_PB_NAMEOFODBCDATASOURCE 4d Prema para abrir unha caixa de diálogo de selección de fonte de datos ODBC:
2f DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_ORACLE_ET_ORACLEPORT 3a Introduza o número de porto do servidor da base de datos.
35 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_ORACLE_ET_ORACLEHOSTSERVER 29 Introduza o nome da base de datos Oracle.
30 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_ORACLE_ET_ORACLECLASS 2d Introduza o URL do servidor da base de datos.
39 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_SPREADSHEET_ET_SPREADSHEETPATH 3c Introduce o nome e camiño do ficheiro de folla de cálculo.
39 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_SPREADSHEET_PB_SPREADSHEETPATH 43 Prema para abrir unha caixa de diálogo de selección de ficheiros.
45 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_SPREADSHEET_CB_SPREADSHEETPASSWORDREQUIRED 5f Seleccione esta opción para solicitar un contrasinal ao usuario do documento de base de datos.
28 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_THOUSANDS_SEPARATOR 86 Introduza ou seleccione o carácter usado como separador de millares no ficheiro de texto; por exemplo, coma (1,000) ou punto (1.000).
26 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_DECIMAL_SEPARATOR 86 Introduza ou seleccione o carácter usado como separador decimal no ficheiro de texto; por exemplo, un punto (0.5) ou unha coma (0,5).
33 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_TEXT_PB_LOCATIONTEXTFILE 43 Prema para abrir unha caixa de diálogo de selección de ficheiros.
33 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_TEXT_RB_ACCESSOTHERFILES 5a Prema para acceder aos ficheiros personalizados. Introduza a extensión na caixa de texto.
24 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_FIELD_SEPARATOR 5b Introduza ou seleccione o carácter de separación de campos de datos do ficheiro de texto.
2f DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_TEXT_ET_OWNEXTENSION 5a Prema para acceder aos ficheiros personalizados. Introduza a extensión na caixa de texto.
23 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_TEXT_SEPARATOR 5a Introduza ou seleccione o carácter que identifica un campo de texto no ficheiro de texto.
31 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_TEXT_RB_ACCESSCSVFILES 25 Prema para acceder aos ficheiros csv.
33 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_TEXT_ET_LOCATIONTEXTFILE 108 Introduza o camiño dos ficheiros de texto. Se só quere un ficheiro, use calquera extensión. Se introduce un nome de cartafol, os ficheiros de texto nel incluídos deben ter a extensión *.csv para que sexan recoñecidos como ficheiros da base de datos de texto.
31 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_TEXT_RB_ACCESSTXTFILES 25 Prema para acceder aos ficheiros txt.
1f DBACCESS_HID_BROWSER_TABLE_EDIT 5b Abre unha xanela na cal pode editar a táboa, consulta, formulario ou informe seleccionado.
f .uno%3ADBRename 87 Renomea o obxecto seleccionado. Dependendo da base de datos, pode que algúns nomes, caracteres e tamaños de nomes non sexan válidos.
f .uno%3ADBDelete 3f Elimina a táboa, consulta, formulario ou informe seleccionado.
1f .uno%3ADBDatabasePropertiesMenu 11 Abre un submenú.
2b .uno%3ADBNewReportAutoPilotWithPreSelection 52 Inicia o Asistente de informes da táboa, consulta ou visualización seleccionada.
16 .uno%3ADBConvertToView 109 Converte en visualización a consulta seleccionada. A consulta orixinal permanece no ficheiro da base de datos e xérase unha visualización adicional no servidor da base de datos. Debe ter permiso de escritura para engadir unha visualización a unha base de datos.
19 .uno%3ADBDSConnectionType 26 Abre o Asistente de tipo de conexión.
15 .uno%3ADBDSProperties 36 Abre a caixa de diálogo Propiedades da base de datos.
29 .uno%3ADBNewFormAutoPilotWithPreSelection 55 Inicia o Asistente de formularios da táboa, consulta ou visualización seleccionada.
21 DBACCESS_HID_BROWSER_TABLE_DELETE 3f Elimina a táboa, consulta, formulario ou informe seleccionado.
d .uno%3ADBEdit 5b Abre unha xanela na cal pode editar a táboa, consulta, formulario ou informe seleccionado.
1b .uno%3ADBDSAdvancedSettings 32 Abre a caixa de diálogo de Propiedades avanzadas.
d .uno%3ADBOpen 36 Abre o obxecto seleccionado no último estado gardado.
1b .uno%3ADBSendReportToWriter 99 Exporta o informe seleccionado a un documento de texto. Créase un informe dinámico como copia dos contidos da base de datos no momento da exportación.
19 .uno%3ADBSendReportAsMail 127 Abre o aplicativo de correo electrónico predefinido para enviar correos electrónicos. O informe seleccionado engádese como anexo. Pode introducir o asunto, os destinatarios e o corpo da mensaxe. No momento da exportación créase un informe dinámico como copia dos contidos da base de datos.
42 dbaccess%3AImageButton%3ADLG_COLLECTION_VIEW%3ABTN_EXPLORERFILE_UP 36 Prema para subir un nivel na xerarquía de cartafoles.
49 dbaccess%3AImageButton%3ADLG_COLLECTION_VIEW%3ABTN_EXPLORERFILE_NEWFOLDER 3f Prema para crear un novo cartafol no ficheiro da base de datos.
43 dbaccess%3APushButton%3ADLG_COLLECTION_VIEW%3ABTN_EXPLORERFILE_SAVE 3c Prema para gardar o formulario no ficheiro de base de datos.
40 dbaccess%3AEdit%3ADLG_COLLECTION_VIEW%3AED_EXPLORERFILE_FILENAME 33 Introduza o nome de ficheiro do formulario gardado.
13 .uno%3ADBNewViewSQL 2a Abre unha nova visualización en modo SQL.
11 .uno%3ADBNewTable 2b Abre a visualización de deseño de táboa.
12 .uno%3ADBNewReport 48 Starts the Report Builder window for the selected table, view, or query.
12 .uno%3ADBNewFolder 5d Abre unha caixa de diálogo que permite gardar un novo cartafol no ficheiro de base de datos.
14 .uno%3ADBNewQuerySql 24 Abre unha nova consulta en modo SQL.
11 .uno%3ADBNewQuery 28 Abre unha nova consulta en modo deseño.
10 .uno%3ADBNewForm 33 Abre un novo documento de texto en modo formulario.
10 .uno%3ADBNewView 2e Abre unha nova visualización en modo deseño.
28 DBACCESS_HID_BROWSER_TABLE_CREATE_DESIGN 2b Abre a visualización de deseño de táboa.
12 .uno%3ADBUserAdmin 5d Abre a caixa de diálogo Administración de usuario, se a base de datos soporta esa función.
23 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_TABLE_SELECTOR 7d Abre a caixa de diálogo Filtro de táboa, na cal pode especificar as táboas da base de datos que desexa mostrar ou ocultar.
17 .uno%3ADBRelationDesign 69 Abre a visualización Deseño de relación e verifica se a conexión da base de datos soporta relacións.
12 .uno%3ADBDirectSQL 46 Abre a caixa de diálogo SQL, na cal pode introducir instrucións SQL.
14 .uno%3ADBTableFilter 7d Abre a caixa de diálogo Filtro de táboa, na cal pode especificar as táboas da base de datos que desexa mostrar ou ocultar.
14 .uno%3ADBViewQueries 5e Selecciona o depósito de consultas e mostra todas as consultas na visualización de detalles.
10 .uno%3ADBPreview 11 Abre un submenú.
1c .uno%3ADBDatabaseObjectsMenu 11 Abre un submenú.
12 .uno%3ADBViewForms 62 Selecciona o depósito de formularios e mostra todos os formularios na visualización de detalles.
17 .uno%3ADBDisablePreview 39 Desactiva a previsualización na xanela da base de datos.
17 .uno%3ADBShowDocPreview 41 A previsualización mostra o documento dun formulario ou informe.
16 .uno%3ADBRefreshTables 15 Actualiza as táboas.
d .uno%3ADBSort 11 Abre un submenú.
1b .uno%3ADBShowDocInfoPreview 60 A xanela de previsualización mostra a información sobre o documento dun formulario ou informe.
14 .uno%3ADBViewReports 5c Selecciona o depósito de informes e mostra todos os informes na visualización de detalles.
13 .uno%3ADBViewTables 5a Selecciona o depósito de táboas e mostra todas as táboas na visualización de detalles.
17 .uno%3ADBMigrateScripts 96 The Database Document Macro Migration Wizard moves existing macros from sub-documents of an old Base file into the new Base file's macro storage area.
32 dbaccess%3AMultiLineEdit%3ATP_SUMMARY%3AED_CHANGES 42 The list shows all changes that were applied to the database file.
45 dbaccess%3APushButton%3ATP_SAVE_DBDOC_AS%3APB_BROWSE_SAVE_AS_LOCATION c1 Choose a location and file name to save the new database file. By default, the new file gets the same name as the old file, while the old file gets renamed with the string "backup" in the name.
36 svtools%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_LOGIN%3ACB_LOGIN_SAVEPASSWORD 9e Escolla esta opción para usar o mesmo nome de usuario e o mesmo contrasinal ao conectarse de novo coa mesma fonte de datos na sesión actual de %PRODUCTNAME.
2e svtools%3AEdit%3ADLG_LOGIN%3AED_LOGIN_PASSWORD 3c Introduza o contrasinal para a conexión coa fonte de datos.
2e svtools%3AEdit%3ADLG_LOGIN%3AED_LOGIN_USERNAME 40 Introduza o nome de usuario para a conexión coa fonte de datos.
17 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD 49 O Asistente de consultas axuda no deseño de consultas de bases de datos.
21 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTTABLES 32 Especifica a táboa para a cal se crea a consulta.
24 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTSELFIELDS 36 Mostra os campos que se van incluír na nova consulta.
22 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTASCEND3 46 Prema para ordenar alfabética ou numericamente de maneira ascendente.
23 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTDESCEND4 47 Prema para ordenar alfabética ou numericamente de maneira descendente.
23 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTDESCEND3 47 Prema para ordenar alfabética ou numericamente de maneira descendente.
23 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTDESCEND1 47 Prema para ordenar alfabética ou numericamente de maneira descendente.
1d WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_SORT2 77 Especifica campos adicionais utilizados para ordenar a consulta creada, se os campos de ordenación previos son iguais.
1d WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_SORT1 4a Especifica o campo utilizado como criterio para ordenar a consulta creada.
23 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTDESCEND2 47 Prema para ordenar alfabética ou numericamente de maneira descendente.
22 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTASCEND1 46 Prema para ordenar alfabética ou numericamente de maneira ascendente.
1d WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_SORT4 77 Especifica campos adicionais utilizados para ordenar a consulta creada, se os campos de ordenación previos son iguais.
1d WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_SORT3 77 Especifica campos adicionais utilizados para ordenar a consulta creada, se os campos de ordenación previos son iguais.
22 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTASCEND4 46 Prema para ordenar alfabética ou numericamente de maneira ascendente.
22 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTASCEND2 46 Prema para ordenar alfabética ou numericamente de maneira ascendente.
26 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTFIELDNAME_3 33 Seleccione o nome de campo da condición de filtro.
25 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTOPERATOR_2 22 Seleccione a condición do filtro.
23 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTMATCHALL 64 Seleccione esta opción para filtrar a consulta por todas as condicións que usen o valor lóxico E.
25 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTOPERATOR_3 22 Seleccione a condición do filtro.
22 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_TXTVALUE_2 2a Introduza o valor da condición de filtro.
22 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_TXTVALUE_3 2a Introduza o valor da condición de filtro.
22 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_TXTVALUE_1 2a Introduza o valor da condición de filtro.
25 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTOPERATOR_1 22 Seleccione a condición do filtro.
23 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTMATCHANY 63 Seleccione esta opción para filtrar a consulta por calquera condición que use o valor lóxico OU.
26 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTFIELDNAME_2 33 Seleccione o nome de campo da condición de filtro.
26 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTFIELDNAME_1 33 Seleccione o nome de campo da condición de filtro.
28 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_BTNAGGREGATEPLUS 22 Engade unha nova fila de controis.
30 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTAGGREGATESUMMARYQUERY 4f Seleccione esta opción para mostrar só os resultados das funcións agregadas.
29 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_BTNAGGREGATEMINUS 23 Elimina a última fila de controis.
2c WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTAGGREGATEFIELDS_1 25 Seleccione o nome do campo numérico.
2e WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTAGGREGATEFUNCTION_1 1f Seleccione a función agregada.
2f WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTAGGREGATEDETAILQUERY 44 Seleccione esta opción para mostrar todos os rexistros da consulta.
2a WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTFILTERSELFIELDS 38 Mostra os campos que se usarán para agrupar a consulta.
28 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTGROUPMATCHALL 5d Seleccione esta opción para agrupar a consulta polas condicións que usen o valor lóxico E.
2c WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTFILTERFIELDNAME_3 38 Seleccione o nome de campo da condición de agrupamento.
28 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_TXTFILTERVALUE_1 2f Introduza o valor da condición de agrupamento.
28 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_TXTFILTERVALUE_3 2f Introduza o valor da condición de agrupamento.
2c WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTFILTERFIELDNAME_1 38 Seleccione o nome de campo da condición de agrupamento.
2b WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTFILTEROPERATOR_2 27 Seleccione a condición do agrupamento.
2b WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTFILTEROPERATOR_3 27 Seleccione a condición do agrupamento.
2c WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTFILTERFIELDNAME_2 38 Seleccione o nome de campo da condición de agrupamento.
28 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_TXTFILTERVALUE_2 2f Introduza o valor da condición de agrupamento.
28 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTGROUPMATCHANY 69 Seleccione esta opción para agrupar a consulta por calquera das condicións que usen o valor lóxico OU.
2b WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTFILTEROPERATOR_1 27 Seleccione a condición do agrupamento.
22 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_TXTTITLE_1 24 Introduza o alcume do nome de campo.
22 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_TXTSUMMARY 1d Mostra un resumo da consulta.
27 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTDISPLAYQUERY 39 Seleccione esta opción para gardar e mostrar a consulta.
25 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_TXTQUERYTITLE 1d Introduza o nome da consulta.
26 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTMODIFYQUERY 46 Seleccione esta opción para gardar a consulta e abrila para edición.
2e REPORTDESIGN_CHECKBOX_RID_DATETIME_DLG_CB_TIME 8b Activar Incluír hora para inserir unha hora na área activa do informe. O campo da hora mostra mostra a hora cando o informe é executado.
2e REPORTDESIGN_CHECKBOX_RID_DATETIME_DLG_CB_DATE 92 Activar Incluír data para inserir un campo de data na área activa do informe. O campo da data mostra a data actual cando o informe é executado.
1a .uno%3AInsertDateTimeField 5f You can open the Date and Time dialog of the Report Builder by choosing Insert - Date and Time.
14 .uno%3ASectionShrink 42 Shrinks the selected section to remove top and bottom empty space.
16 .uno%3ASectionAlignTop 62 Select two or more objects and click this icon to align the objects at the top margin of the area.
19 .uno%3ASectionAlignBottom 65 Select two or more objects and click this icon to align the objects at the bottom margin of the area.
15 .uno%3ASmallestHeight 5c Select two or more objects and click this icon to resize the objects to the smallest height.
17 .uno%3ASectionAlignLeft 63 Select two or more objects and click this icon to align the objects at the left margin of the area.
15 .uno%3AGreatestHeight 5c Select two or more objects and click this icon to resize the objects to the greatest height.
18 .uno%3ASectionAlignRight 64 Select two or more objects and click this icon to align the objects at the right margin of the area.
1a .uno%3ASectionShrinkBottom 3a Shrinks the selected section to remove bottom empty space.
14 .uno%3ASmallestWidth 5b Select two or more objects and click this icon to resize the objects to the smallest width.
11 .uno%3AHFixedLine 2e Inserts a horizontal line to the current area.
17 .uno%3ASectionShrinkTop 37 Shrinks the selected section to remove top empty space.
11 .uno%3AVFixedLine 2c Inserts a vertical line to the current area.
14 .uno%3AGreatestWidth 5b Select two or more objects and click this icon to resize the objects to the greatest width.
16 .uno%3AReportNavigator 7f The Report Navigator reveals the structure of the report. You can use the Report Navigator to insert functions into the report.
28 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_DEEPTRAVERSING e8 If Deep traversing is enabled, functions are evaluated considering all lower levels of hierarchy. This would be used for instance for line numbering. If Deep traversing is not enabled, only the first level of hierarchy is evaluated.
12 .uno%3ANewFunction a9 In the context menu of the Report Navigator, you see the same commands as in the Report Builder view, plus additional commands to create new functions or to delete them.
26 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_PREEVALUATED 57 If Pre evaluation is enabled, functions are evaluated only when the report is finished.
28 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_INITIALFORMULA 5a Enter the initial value for the evaluation of the formula. Often this is set to 0 or to 1.
26 REPORTDESIGN_HID_REPORT_NAVIGATOR_TREE 9f Click an entry in the Report Navigator. The corresponding object or area is selected in the Report Builder view. Right-click an entry to open the context menu.
21 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_FORMULA 44 Enter the formula that defines the function. Use OpenFormula syntax.
3b REPORTDESIGN_RADIOBUTTON_RID_PAGENUMBERS_RB_PAGE_BOTTOMPAGE e Páxina N de M
38 REPORTDESIGN_RADIOBUTTON_RID_PAGENUMBERS_RB_PAGE_TOPPAGE e Páxina N de M
32 REPORTDESIGN_RADIOBUTTON_RID_PAGENUMBERS_RB_PAGE_N e Páxina N de M
32 REPORTDESIGN_LISTBOX_RID_PAGENUMBERS_LST_ALIGNMENT e Páxina N de M
37 REPORTDESIGN_RADIOBUTTON_RID_PAGENUMBERS_RB_PAGE_N_OF_M e Páxina N de M
24 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_RPT_HEIGHT 2a Defines the height of the selected object.
2a REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_PAGEFOOTEROPTION 78 Specifies in which context the page footer will be printed: on all pages, or not on pages with a report header or footer
2e REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_PRINTWHENGROUPCHANGE 17 Print when group change
1e REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_FIELD_SEL c4 The Add Field window is shown automatically when you have selected a table in the Contents box and leave that box. You can also click the Add Field icon on the toolbar, or choose View - Add Field.
34 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_CONDITIONALPRINTEXPRESSION 5b If the Conditional Print Expression evaluates to TRUE, the selected object will be printed.
29 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_BACKTRANSPARENT 51 Specifies whether the background of the selected object is transparent or opaque.
23 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_DATAFIELD 43 On the Data tab page, you can change the data contents to be shown.
26 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_FORCENEWPAGE 66 Force New Page specifies whether the current section and/or the next section is printed on a new page.
27 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_RPT_POSITIONY 2a Set the Y Position for the selected object
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_VERTICAL_ALIGN e Páxina N de M
27 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_RPT_POSITIONX 2a Set the X Position for the selected object
13 .uno%3ASelectReport 5a To display the Data or General tab page for the whole report, choose Edit - Select Report.
22 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_RPT_FONT 2d Select the font for the selected text object.
2a REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_PAGEHEADEROPTION 79 Specifies in which context the page header will be printed: on all pages, or not on pages with a report header or footer.
25 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_PRESERVEIRI f5 For a picture, you can specify to either insert the picture as a link to a file or only as an embedded object in the Base file. The embedded option increases the size of the Base file, while the link option is not as portable to other computers.
23 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_RPT_WIDTH 26 Sets the width of the selected object.
21 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_VISIBLE 68 An invisible object is not shown in the executed report. It is still visible in the Report Builder view.
23 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_BACKCOLOR 53 Sets the background color for the selected object, both on screen and for printing.
26 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_KEEPTOGETHER 78 Keep Together specifies to print the current object starting on top of a new page if it doesn't fit on the current page.
2b REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_GROUPKEEPTOGETHER 5c Groups are kept together by page or by column (default). You must enable Keep Together also.
2d REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_PRINTREPEATEDVALUES 23 Specifies to print repeated values.
25 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_NEWROWORCOL 93 New Row Or Column specifies, for a multi-column design, whether the current section and/or the next section will be printed on a new row or column.
25 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_GROUPSORT_DELETE 29 Removes the selected field from the list.
41 reportdesign%3AListBox%3ARID_GROUPS_SORTING%3ALST_KEEPTOGETHERLST 4e Select the level of detail by which a group is kept together on the same page.
1e REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_GROUPSBRW 9f Lists the fields that will be used for sorting or grouping. The field at the top has the highest priority, the second field has the second priority, and so on.
24 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_FIELDEXPRESSION 37 Click to open a list from which you can select a field.
40 REPORTDESIGN_NUMERICFIELD_RID_GROUPS_SORTING_ED_GROUPINTERVALLST 3b Enter the group interval value that records are grouped by.
36 REPORTDESIGN_LISTBOX_RID_GROUPS_SORTING_LST_GROUPONLST 4b Select to create a new group on each changed value, or on other properties.
35 REPORTDESIGN_LISTBOX_RID_GROUPS_SORTING_LST_FOOTERLST 28 Select to show or hide the Group Footer.
1b .uno%3ADbSortingAndGrouping b2 In the Sorting and Grouping dialog of Report Builder, you can define the fields that should be sorted in your report, and the fields that should be kept together to form a group.
35 REPORTDESIGN_LISTBOX_RID_GROUPS_SORTING_LST_HEADERLST 28 Select to show or hide the Group Header.
26 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_GROUPSORT_MOVE_UP 28 Moves the selected field up in the list.
28 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_GROUPSORT_MOVE_DOWN 2a Moves the selected field down in the list.
31 REPORTDESIGN_LISTBOX_RID_GROUPS_SORTING_LST_ORDER 19 Select the sorting order.
1b WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_DIALOG 3f O asistente de táboas axuda a crear táboas de bases de datos.
20 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_OPTBUSINESS 4e Seleccione a categoría de negocio para ver só mostras de táboas comerciais.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_FIELDSSELECTED 38 Mostra todos os campos que se incluirán na nova táboa.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_LBTABLES bb Escolla unha das táboas de mostra e, a seguir, seleccione algúns campos desa táboa na caixa de lista situada á esquerda. Repita este paso ata seleccionar todos os campos que necesite.
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_OPTPRIVATE 49 Seleccione a categoría persoal para ver só mostras de táboas persoais.
23 DBACCESS_HID_TAB_AUTOINCREMENTVALUE 72 Introduza a orde SQL que indica á fonte de datos o incremento automático do campo de datos INTEGER especificado.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDMINUS 30 Eliminar o campo seleccionado da caixa de lista.
1d DBACCESS_HID_TAB_ENT_REQUIRED 3d Se está definido como Si, este campo non pode estar baleiro.
1c WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_COLNAME 58 Mostra o nome do campo de datos seleccionado. Se o desexa, pode introducir un novo nome.
22 DBACCESS_HID_TAB_ENT_AUTOINCREMENT 4b Se a opción é Si, o mecanismo da base de datos xera o valor para o campo.
1c WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDPLUS 31 Engadir un novo campo de datos á caixa de lista.
25 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_LB_SELFIELDNAMES 2f Seleccione un campo para editar a información.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CHK_USEPRIMEKEY 118 Seleccione esta opción para crear unha chave primaria. Engada unha chave primaria a cada táboa da base de datos para identificar de forma exclusiva cada rexistro. Nalgúns sistemas de base de datos de %PRODUCTNAME o uso de chaves primarias é obrigatorio para editar as táboas.
28 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_FIELDS_PK_AVAILABLE 55 Seleccione un campo ou prema en > para engadilo á lista de campos de chave primaria.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CK_PK_AUTOVALUE dd Seleccione esta opción para introducir automaticamente un valor e incrementar o valor dos campos en cada novo rexistro. A base de datos debe soportar o incremento automático para poder usar a función Valor automático.
25 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_OPT_PK_AUTOMATIC 5e Seleccione esta opción para engadir automaticamente unha chave primaria como campo adicional.
2a WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDREMOVE_PK_SELECTED ae Seleccione un campo e prema en < para eliminalo da lista de campos de chave primaria. A chave primaria créase como concatenación dos campos desta lista, de arriba a abaixo.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_LB_PK_FIELDNAME 1b Seleccione o nome de campo.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_OPT_PK_SEVERAL 5d Seleccione esta opción para crear chaves primarias mediante a combinación de varios campos.
2e WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CK_PK_AUTOVALUE_AUTOMATIC dd Seleccione esta opción para introducir automaticamente un valor e incrementar o valor dos campos en cada novo rexistro. A base de datos debe soportar o incremento automático para poder usar a función Valor automático.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_OPT_PK_SINGLE 60 Seleccione esta opción para usar como chave primaria un campo existente con valores exclusivos.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_TXT_NAME 1c Especifica o nome da táboa.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_OPT_MODIFYTABLE 5f Seleccione esta opción para gardar o deseño da táboa e abrir a táboa para introducir datos.
26 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_OPT_WORKWITHTABLE 41 Seleccione esta opción para gardar e editar o deseño da táboa.
20 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_LST_CATALOG 5a Seleccione o catálogo da táboa. (Só dispoñíbel se a base de datos soporta catálogos)
28 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_OPT_STARTFORMWIZARD b2 Seleccione esta opción para crear un formulario baseado nesta táboa. O formulario créase nun documento de texto coa última configuración usada polo Asistente de formularios.
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_LST_SCHEMA 56 Seleccione o esquema da táboa. (Só dispoñíbel se a base de datos soporta esquemas)
12 .uno%3ADBTableEdit 36 Abre a táboa seleccionada para modificar a estrutura.
12 .uno%3ADBTableOpen 49 Abre a táboa seleccionada para introducir, editar ou eliminar rexistros.
15 .uno%3ADBReportDelete 1f Elimina o informe seleccionado.
14 .uno%3ADBQueryDelete 20 Elimina a consulta seleccionada.
14 .uno%3ADBQueryRename 20 Renomea a consulta seleccionada.
12 .uno%3ADBQueryOpen 4b Abre a consulta seleccionada para introducir, editar ou eliminar rexistros.
11 .uno%3ADBFormOpen 4d Abre o formulario seleccionado para introducir, editar ou eliminar rexistros.
15 .uno%3ADBReportRename 1f Renomea o informe seleccionado.
12 .uno%3ADBQueryEdit 38 Abre a consulta seleccionada para modificar a estrutura.
13 .uno%3ADBReportEdit 35 Abre o informe seleccionado para modificar o deseño.
13 .uno%3ADBFormRename 22 Renomea o formulario seleccionado.
13 .uno%3ADBReportOpen 4a Abre o informe seleccionado para introducir, editar ou eliminar rexistros.
11 .uno%3ADBFormEdit 3e Abre o formulario seleccionado para poder modificar o deseño.
14 .uno%3ADBTableRename 1e Renomea a táboa seleccionada.
14 .uno%3ADBTableDelete 1e Elimina a táboa seleccionada.
13 .uno%3ADBFormDelete 22 Elimina o formulario seleccionado.
20 .uno%3AFontworkSameLetterHeights 64 Cambia a altura das letras Fontwork dos obxectos seleccionados de normal á mesma altura para todos.
3c SVX_HID_SVX_CHINESE_TRANSLATION_RB_CONVERSION_TO_TRADITIONAL 56 Prema para aplicar o espazamento entre caracteres aos obxectos Fontwork seleccionados.
1f .uno%3AFontworkAlignmentFloater 26 Abre a xanela Aliñamento de Fontwork.
19 .uno%3AFontworkShapeTypes 70 Abre a barra de ferramentas Forma Fontwork. Prema nunha forma para aplicala aos obxectos Fontwork seleccionados.
26 .uno%3AFontworkCharacterSpacingFloater 34 Abre a xanela Espazamento entre caracteres Fontwork.
c FontWork1TBO 45 Prema para aplicar o aliñamento aos obxectos Fontwork seleccionados.
c FontWork2TBO 3b Introduza o valor de espazamento entre caracteres Fontwork.
16 SC_HID_SCDLG_CONFLICTS 89 If the same contents are changed by different users, the Resolve Conflicts dialog opens. For each conflict, decide which changes to keep.
32 sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_SHAREDOCUMENT%3ACB_SHARE dc Enable to share the current document with other users. Disable to use the document unshared. This will invalidate the not yet saved edits that other users applied in the time since you last opened or saved this document.
37 sc%3APushButton%3ARID_SCDLG_CONFLICTS%3ABTN_KEEPALLMINE 30 Keeps all your changes, voids all other changes.
14 .uno%3AShareDocument 66 Opens the Share Document dialog where you can enable or disable collaborative sharing of the document.
34 sc%3APushButton%3ARID_SCDLG_CONFLICTS%3ABTN_KEEPMINE 2a Keeps your change, voids the other change.
39 sc%3APushButton%3ARID_SCDLG_CONFLICTS%3ABTN_KEEPALLOTHERS 39 Keeps the changes of all other users, voids your changes.
35 sc%3APushButton%3ARID_SCDLG_CONFLICTS%3ABTN_KEEPOTHER 36 Keeps the change of the other user, voids your change.
18 .uno%3AFormFilterExecute 79 Se preme na icona Aplicar filtro baseado en formulario na barra de ferramentas Filtro de formulario, aplicarase o filtro.
15 .uno%3AFormFilterExit 6b Se preme no botón Pechar da barra de ferramentas Filtro de formulario, o formulario móstrase sen filtros.
1e .uno%3AConfigureToolboxVisible 39 Opens a dialog where you can add, edit, and remove icons.
19 SVX_HID_FM_FILTER_IS_NULL e8 Nese menú pode editar as condicións de filtraxe directamente como texto. Para verificar se un filtro posúe ou non contido, pode seleccionar as condicións de filtro "baleiro" (SQL:"é nulo") ou "non baleiro" (SQL: "non é nulo").
18 SVX_HID_FILTER_NAVIGATOR 18d As condicións de filtraxe definidas móstranse no Navegador de filtros. Ao definir un filtro, aparece unha entrada de filtro en branco na parte inferior do Navegador de filtro. Pode seleccionar esa entrada premendo na palabra "Ou", o que lle permitirá introducir condicións de filtraxe adicionais. Estas condicións están ligadas mediante un OU booleano coas condicións definidas previamente.
f SVX_HID_FM_EDIT e8 Nese menú pode editar as condicións de filtraxe directamente como texto. Para verificar se un filtro posúe ou non contido, pode seleccionar as condicións de filtro "baleiro" (SQL:"é nulo") ou "non baleiro" (SQL: "non é nulo").
16 SVX_HID_FM_IS_NOT_NULL e8 Nese menú pode editar as condicións de filtraxe directamente como texto. Para verificar se un filtro posúe ou non contido, pode seleccionar as condicións de filtro "baleiro" (SQL:"é nulo") ou "non baleiro" (SQL: "non é nulo").
1a .uno%3AFormFilterNavigator 76 Para conectar varias condicións de filtraxe co OU booleano, prema a icona Navegación de filtros na barra de filtros.
1e SVX_HID_CTL_FONTWORK_FAVORITES bc Select a Fontwork style and click OK to insert the Fontwork into your document. Double-click or Ctrl+double-click the Fontwork in your document to enter text edit mode and change the text.
12 .uno%3ASaveGraphic 99 To export a bitmap in Writer: Right-click the bitmap, choose Save Graphics. You see the Graphics Export dialog. Enter a file name and select a file type.
20 .HelpId%3AStartCenter%3ADBButton 42 The document icons each open a new document of the specified type.
22 .HelpId%3AStartCenter%3AMathButton 42 The document icons each open a new document of the specified type.
15 FWK_HID_BACKINGWINDOW 36 Click an icon to open a new document or a file dialog.
24 .HelpId%3AStartCenter%3AWriterButton 42 The document icons each open a new document of the specified type.
22 .HelpId%3AStartCenter%3ADrawButton 42 The document icons each open a new document of the specified type.
22 .HelpId%3AStartCenter%3AOpenButton 35 The Open a Document icon presents a file open dialog.
25 .HelpId%3AStartCenter%3AImpressButton 42 The document icons each open a new document of the specified type.
22 .HelpId%3AStartCenter%3ACalcButton 42 The document icons each open a new document of the specified type.
26 .HelpId%3AStartCenter%3ATemplateButton 3c The Templates icon opens the Templates and Documents dialog.
12 .uno%3AShowLicense 3d Amosa o cadro de diálogo da licenza e da información legal.
f .uno%3AHelpMenu 51 O menú da Axuda permite iniciar e controlar o sistema da Axuda de $[officename].
c .uno%3AAbout 57 Mostra información xeral sobre o programa, como o número de versión e os copyrights.
12 .uno%3AShowCredits db Amosa o documento CREDITS.odt no que se inclúe a lista cos nomes dos colaboradores que contribuíron no código fonte de OpenOffice.org (e con contribucións importadas a LibreOffice) ou a LibreOffice desde 28-09-2010.
10 .uno%3AHelpIndex 64 Abre a páxina principal da Axuda de $[officename] do aplicativo que está a ser usado nese momento.
e RID_ENVTOOLBOX 8b A barra estándar está localizada na parte superior da xanela de $[officename] e está dispoñíbel en todos os aplicativos $[officename].
13 .uno%3AExtendedHelp 5c Activa as suxestións de axuda adicionais baixo o apuntador do rato ata que se volva premer.
18 .HelpId%3Atableobjectbar 7a A barra Táboa contén as funcións necesarias para traballar con táboas. Aparece ao situar o cursor dentro dunha táboa.
14 .uno%3ADSBFormLetter 53 Inicia o asistente de combinación de correspondencia para crear cartas formulario.
17 .uno%3ADSBInsertColumns 49 Insire os campos do rexistro marcado na posición do cursor no documento.
10 .uno%3ANewRecord 16 Crea un novo rexistro.
13 .uno%3ADeleteRecord 4f Elimina un rexistro. Para eliminar unha consulta é necesario confirmala antes.
e .uno%3ARecUndo 2b Permítelle desfacer unha entrada de datos.
e .uno%3ARecSave 48 Garda unha nova entrada de datos. O cambio rexístrase na base de datos.
11 .uno%3ANextRecord 1c Lévao ao seguinte rexistro.
11 .uno%3ALastRecord 1b Lévao ao último rexistro.
12 .uno%3AFirstRecord 1c Lévao ao primeiro rexistro.
11 .uno%3APrevRecord 1c Lévao ao rexistro anterior.
15 .uno%3AAbsoluteRecord 5d Mostra o número do rexistro actual. Introduza un número para ir ao rexistro correspondente.
e .uno%3AGridUse 43 Especifica que só pode mover os obxectos entre os puntos da grade.
16 .uno%3ABezierSymmetric 44 Esta icona converte un punto de canto ou suave nun punto simétrico.
12 HID_BEZIER_TOOLBOX 55 A barra Editar puntos aparece cando selecciona un polígono e preme en Editar puntos.
13 .uno%3ABezierDelete ac Utilice a icona Eliminar puntos para eliminar un ou varios puntos seleccionados. Para seleccionar varios puntos, manteña premida a tecla Maiús ao premer en cada un deles.
14 .uno%3ABezierConvert 30 Converte unha curva en liña recta ou viceversa.
12 .uno%3ABezierClose 1f Pecha unha liña ou unha curva.
13 .uno%3ABezierSmooth 38 Converte un punto de canto ou simétrico en punto suave.
13 .uno%3ABezierInsert 32 Activa o modo inserir, que permite inserir puntos.
11 .uno%3ABezierMove 28 Activa un modo en que pode mover puntos.
14 .uno%3ABezierCutLine 72 A icona Dividir curva divide unha curva. Seleccione o punto ou puntos onde desexa dividir a curva e prema na icona
1c .uno%3ABezierEliminatePoints 3c Marca o punto actual ou os puntos seleccionados para borrar.
11 .uno%3ABezierEdge 3c Converte en puntos de canto o punto ou puntos seleccionados.
18 .uno%3AOptionsTreeDialog 5f Esta orde abre unha caixa de diálogo que permite configurar o programa de forma personalizada.
1a CUI_HID_OFADLG_TREELISTBOX 27 Seleccione a entrada que desexa editar.
29 sw%3AEdit%3ATP_PRIVATE_DATA%3AED_SHORTCUT 19 Teclee as súas iniciais.
2b cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SFXPAGE_GENERAL%3AED_TITLE 21 Teclee o seu título profesional.
25 sw%3AEdit%3ATP_PRIVATE_DATA%3AED_CITY 2b Teclee o nome da súa cidade de residencia.
2f cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SFXPAGE_GENERAL%3AED_FIRSTNAME 12 Teclee o seu nome.
25 sw%3AEdit%3ATP_PRIVATE_DATA%3AED_NAME 18 Teclee os seus apelidos.
2f cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SFXPAGE_GENERAL%3AED_SHORTNAME 19 Teclee as súas iniciais.
2d cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SFXPAGE_GENERAL%3AED_COUNTRY 22 Teclee o nome do estado onde vive.
30 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SFXPAGE_GENERAL%3AED_TELCOMPANY 2e Teclee o número de teléfono da súa empresa.
25 sw%3AEdit%3ATP_BUSINESS_DATA%3AED_FAX 1c Teclee o seu número de fax.
26 sw%3AEdit%3ATP_BUSINESS_DATA%3AED_COMP 2a Teclee neste campo o nome da súa empresa.
29 sw%3AEdit%3ATP_BUSINESS_DATA%3AED_COUNTRY 22 Teclee o nome do estado onde vive.
17 CUI_HID_OPTIONS_GENERAL 41 Use este separador para introducir ou editar os datos de usuario.
2a cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SFXPAGE_GENERAL%3AED_CITY 2b Teclee o nome da súa cidade de residencia.
26 sw%3AEdit%3ATP_BUSINESS_DATA%3AED_MAIL 21 Teclee o seu correo electrónico.
29 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SFXPAGE_GENERAL%3AED_FAX 1c Teclee o seu número de fax.
29 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SFXPAGE_GENERAL%3AED_PLZ 1c Teclee o seu código postal.
2a sw%3AEdit%3ATP_PRIVATE_DATA%3AED_FIRSTNAME 12 Teclee o seu nome.
2d cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SFXPAGE_GENERAL%3AED_COMPANY 2a Teclee neste campo o nome da súa empresa.
26 sw%3AEdit%3ATP_PRIVATE_DATA%3AED_TITLE 21 Teclee o seu título profesional.
24 sw%3AEdit%3ATP_PRIVATE_DATA%3AED_FAX 1c Teclee o seu número de fax.
26 sw%3AEdit%3ATP_BUSINESS_DATA%3AED_CITY 2b Teclee o nome da súa cidade de residencia.
28 sw%3AEdit%3ATP_BUSINESS_DATA%3AED_STREET 1b Teclee o nome da súa rúa.
25 sw%3AEdit%3ATP_PRIVATE_DATA%3AED_MAIL 21 Teclee o seu correo electrónico.
2e cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SFXPAGE_GENERAL%3AED_US_STATE 22 Teclee o nome do estado onde vive.
2a cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SFXPAGE_GENERAL%3AED_NAME 18 Teclee os seus apelidos.
2a sw%3AEdit%3ATP_BUSINESS_DATA%3AED_POSITION 13 Teclee o seu cargo.
28 sw%3AEdit%3ATP_PRIVATE_DATA%3AED_COUNTRY 22 Teclee o nome do estado onde vive.
2e cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SFXPAGE_GENERAL%3AED_POSITION 13 Teclee o seu cargo.
25 sw%3AEdit%3ATP_BUSINESS_DATA%3AED_ZIP 1c Teclee o seu código postal.
30 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SFXPAGE_GENERAL%3AED_US_ZIPCODE 1c Teclee o seu código postal.
2f cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SFXPAGE_GENERAL%3AED_TELPRIVAT 2a Teclee o seu número de teléfono privado.
24 sw%3AEdit%3ATP_PRIVATE_DATA%3AED_ZIP 1c Teclee o seu código postal.
2c cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SFXPAGE_GENERAL%3AED_STREET 1b Teclee o nome da súa rúa.
2d cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SFXPAGE_GENERAL%3AED_US_CITY 2b Teclee o nome da súa cidade de residencia.
27 sw%3AEdit%3ATP_PRIVATE_DATA%3AED_STREET 1b Teclee o nome da súa rúa.
2b cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SFXPAGE_GENERAL%3AED_EMAIL 21 Teclee o seu correo electrónico.
30 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SFXPAGE_SAVE%3ABTN_AUTOSAVE a5 Especifica que %PRODUCTNAME garde a información necesaria para restabelecer os documentos abertos en caso de falla. Pode indicar o intervalo temporal de gravación.
35 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SFXPAGE_SAVE%3ABTN_RELATIVE_INET 3c Select this box for relative saving of URLs to the Internet.
35 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SFXPAGE_SAVE%3ABTN_RELATIVE_FSYS 59 Marque esta caixa para seleccionar a gravación relativa de URLs no sistema de ficheiros.
29 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SFXPAGE_SAVE%3ALB_APP 5b Especifica o tipo de documento para o que desexa definir o formato de ficheiro predefinido.
34 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SFXPAGE_SAVE%3ACB_LOAD_SETTINGS 47 Carga co documento a configuración específica do usuario gardada nel.
14 CUI_HID_OPTIONS_SAVE 7d Na sección Xeralpode seleccionar a configuración predefinida para gardar documentos e os formatos predefinidos de ficheiro.
31 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SFXPAGE_SAVE%3ALB_ODF_VERSION fc Some companies or organizations may require ODF documents in the ODF 1.0/1.1 format. You can select that format to save in the listbox. This older format cannot store all new features, so the new format ODF 1.2 (Extended) is recommended where possible.
36 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SFXPAGE_SAVE%3ACB_LOAD_DOCPRINTER 16c If enabled, the printer settings will be loaded with the document. This can cause a document to be printed on a distant printer, if you do not change the printer manually in the Print dialog. If disabled, your standard printer will be used to print this document. The current printer settings will be stored with the document whether or not this option is checked.
38 sfx2%3ACheckBox%3ARID_DLG_ALIEN_WARNING%3ACB_WARNING_OFF c2 You can choose to get a warning message when you save a document in a format that is not OpenDocument or which you did not set as default format in Load/Save - General in the Options dialog box.
2e cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SFXPAGE_SAVE%3ABTN_BACKUP ba Cada vez que garda o documento garda tamén a versión anterior como copia de seguranza, coa extensión .BAK. Sempre que %PRODUCTNAME crea unha copia de seguranza, substitúe a anterior.
37 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SFXPAGE_SAVE%3ABTN_WARNALIENFORMAT c2 You can choose to get a warning message when you save a document in a format that is not OpenDocument or which you did not set as default format in Load/Save - General in the Options dialog box.
38 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SFXPAGE_SAVE%3ABTN_NOPRETTYPRINTING 61 When saving the document, %PRODUCTNAME writes the XML data without indents and extra line breaks.
2c cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SFXPAGE_SAVE%3ALB_FILTER cb Especifica que os documentos do tipo seleccionado á esquerda se garden sempre con este tipo de ficheiro. Pode seleccionar outro tipo de ficheiro para o documento actual na caixa de diálogo Gardar como.
2f cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SFXPAGE_SAVE%3ABTN_DOCINFO 65 Especifica que a caixa de diálogo Propiedades aparecerá cada vez que seleccione a orde Gardar como.
33 cui%3ANumericField%3ARID_SFXPAGE_SAVE%3AED_AUTOSAVE 60 Especifica cada cantos minutos gardar os documentos para a opción de recuperación automática.
18 CUI_HID_OPTPATH_CTL_PATH 72 Se quere modificar unha entrada da lista, selecciónea e prema Editar ou prema directamente dúas veces sobre ela.
2e cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SFXPAGE_PATH%3ABTN_PATH 4f Prema para acceder á caixa de diálogo Seleccionar camiño ou Editar camiños.
14 CUI_HID_OPTIONS_PATH 8b Esta sección contén os camiños predefinidos para acceder a cartafoles importantes de $[officename]. O usuario pode editar eses camiños.
32 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SFXPAGE_PATH%3ABTN_STANDARD 5d O botón Predefinido restabelece os camiños predefinidos de todas as entradas seleccionadas.
3b cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_MULTIPATH%3ABTN_ADD_MULTIPATH 8b Abre a caixa de diálogo Seleccionar camiños para seleccionar outro cartafol ou a caixa de diálogo Abrir para seleccionar outro ficheiro.
33 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_MULTIPATH%3ALB_MULTIPATH 5e Contén unha lista dos camiños xa engadidos. Marca o camiño predefinido para novos ficheiros
1b CUI_HID_LNGDLG_NUM_PREBREAK 51 Teclee o número mínimo de caracteres que debe haber antes ou despois do guión.
2a cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SFXDLG_EDITDICT%3AED_WORD 88 Pódese introducir unha palabra nova para a súa inclusión no dicionario. Na lista verase o contido do dicionario personalizado actual.
31 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SFXDLG_EDITDICT%3ALB_DICTLANG 3b Atribúe un novo idioma ao dicionario personalizado actual.
3c cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SFXPAGE_LINGU%3APB_LINGU_MODULES_EDIT 34 To edit a language module, select it and click Edit.
18 CUI_HID_OPTIONS_DICT_NEW ab Abre a caixa de diálogo Novo dicionario, onde pode atribuír un nome a un novo dicionario definido polo usuario ou a un dicionario de excepcións, e especificar o idioma.
2d cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SFXDLG_NEWDICT%3AED_DICTNAME 33 Especifica o nome do novo dicionario personalizado.
3d cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SFXPAGE_LINGU%3APB_LINGU_DICS_EDIT_DIC 94 Abre a caixa de diálogo Editar dicionario personalizado, que permite facer adicións no seu dicionario personalizado ou editar entradas existentes.
3c cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SFXPAGE_LINGU%3APB_LINGU_DICS_NEW_DIC ab Abre a caixa de diálogo Novo dicionario, onde pode atribuír un nome a un novo dicionario definido polo usuario ou a un dicionario de excepcións, e especificar o idioma.
3c cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SFXPAGE_LINGU%3APB_LINGU_OPTIONS_EDIT 3d Para cambiar un valor seleccione a entrada e prema en Editar.
1d CUI_HID_CLB_EDIT_MODULES_DICS 2e Lista os dicionarios de usuario dispoñíbeis.
30 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SFXDLG_NEWDICT%3ALB_DICTLANG 54 Ao seleccionar un idioma determinado pode limitar o uso do dicionario personalizado.
37 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SFXDLG_EDITDICT%3APB_NEW_REPLACE b8 Engade no dicionario personalizado actual a palabra situada no campo de texto Palabra. Cando se traballa con dicionarios de excepcións engádese tamén a situada no campo Suxestión .
19 CUI_HID_OPTIONS_DICT_EDIT 94 Abre a caixa de diálogo Editar dicionario personalizado, que permite facer adicións no seu dicionario personalizado ou editar entradas existentes.
19 CUI_HID_CLB_LINGU_OPTIONS 44 Define as opcións da verificación ortográfica e da guionización.
12 .uno%3ASpellOnline 4b Verifica a ortografía e subliña os erros de forma automática ao teclear.
3a cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SFXDLG_EDITDICT%3APB_DELETE_REPLACE 36 Elimina a palabra marcada do dicionario personalizado.
41 cui%3ANumericField%3ARID_SVXDLG_LNG_ED_NUM_PREBREAK%3AED_PREBREAK 51 Teclee o número mínimo de caracteres que debe haber antes ou despois do guión.
15 CUI_HID_OPTIONS_LINGU 68 Especifica as propiedades da verificación ortográfica, do dicionario de sinónimos e da guionización.
3c cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SFXPAGE_LINGU%3APB_LINGU_DICS_DEL_DIC 5d Elimina o dicionario seleccionado depois de confirmar, se non está protexido contra escrita.
31 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SFXDLG_EDITDICT%3ALB_ALLDICTS 25 Especifica o libro que se vai editar.
30 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SFXDLG_NEWDICT%3ABTN_EXCEPT 4a Especifica se o usuario desexa evitar certas palabras nos seus documentos.
19 CUI_HID_CLB_LINGU_MODULES 29 Contén os módulos de idioma instalados.
2d cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SFXDLG_EDITDICT%3AED_REPLACE b4 Este campo de entrada está unicamente dispoñíbel cando se edita un dicionario de excepcións. O campo mostra a suxestión relacionada coa palabra que aparece na caixa "Palabra".
44 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_EDIT_MODULES%3APB_EDIT_MODULES_PRIO_UP 48 Aumenta un nivel a prioridade do módulo seleccionado na caixa de lista.
46 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_EDIT_MODULES%3APB_EDIT_MODULES_PRIO_DOWN 4a Disminúe un nivel a prioridade do módulo seleccionado na caixa de lista.
20 CUI_HID_CLB_EDIT_MODULES_MODULES 8b Especifica o idioma, a ortografía, a guionización e os submódulos do dicionario de sinónimos dispoñíbeis para o módulo seleccionado.
42 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_EDIT_MODULES%3ALB_EDIT_MODULES_LANGUAGE 1f Especifica o idioma do módulo.
46 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_EDIT_MODULES%3APB_EDIT_MODULES_PRIO_BACK 4a Prema nesta opción para desfacer os cambios realizados na caixa de lista.
15 CUI_HID_TPCOLOR_RGB_2 5 Verde
15 CUI_HID_TPCOLOR_RGB_1 8 Vermello
31 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_COLOR%3ALB_COLORMODEL 6c Para modificar, seleccione o modelo de cor: RGB (Vermello-Verde-Azul) ou CMYK (Ciano-Maxenta-Amarelo-Negro).
30 cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_COLOR%3ABTN_SAVE 68 Abre a caixa de diálogo Gardar como, que lle permite gardar a táboa actual de cores cun nome concreto.
2e cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_COLOR%3ABTN_ADD 15 Engade unha nova cor.
29 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_COLOR%3AEDT_NAME 34 Especifica o nome da cor seleccionada ou dunha nova.
15 CUI_HID_OPTIONS_COLOR 62 Permítelle seleccionar unha cor da táboa de cores, editar unha existente ou definir novas cores.
30 cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_COLOR%3ABTN_LOAD 54 Accede á caixa  de diálogo Abrir, que lle permite seleccionar unha paleta de cores
31 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_COLOR%3ABTN_MODIFY 14 Cambia a cor actual.
2c cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_COLOR%3ALB_COLOR 5b Contén a lista das cores dispoñíbeis. Se desexa seleccionar unha cor escóllaa na lista.
15 CUI_HID_TPCOLOR_RGB_3 4 Azul
32 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_COLOR%3ABTN_WORK_ON 54 Accede á caixa  de diálogo Abrir, que lle permite seleccionar unha paleta de cores
32 svtools%3ANumericField%3ADLG_COLOR%3ANUM_LUMINANCE 27 Define o brillo no modelo de cores HSB.
2c svtools%3ANumericField%3ADLG_COLOR%3ANUM_HUE 26 Define o matiz no modelo de cores HSB.
31 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_COLOR%3AMTR_FLD_4 3d Define o valor ou chave da cor negra no modelo de cores CMYK.
16 CUI_HID_TPCOLOR_CMYK_2 36 Define o valor da cor maxenta no modelo de cores CMYK.
2b svtools%3AMetricField%3ADLG_COLOR%3ANUM_KEY 3d Define o valor ou chave da cor negra no modelo de cores CMYK.
28 svtools%3APushButton%3ADLG_COLOR%3ABTN_2 b5 Sitúa o cursor de selección pequeno da xanela dereita sobre a cor que corresponde á seleccionada na xanela esquerda, e actualiza os valores correspondentes nos campos numéricos.
2c svtools%3AMetricField%3ADLG_COLOR%3ANUM_CYAN 34 Define o valor da cor ciano no modelo de cores CMYK.
28 svtools%3APushButton%3ADLG_COLOR%3ABTN_1 a4 Prema no botón <-- para substituír a cor seleccionada na paleta pola cor seleccionada á dereita. O botón actívase ao seleccionar unha cor nun dos catro cantos.
2d svtools%3ANumericField%3ADLG_COLOR%3ANUM_BLUE 32 Define o valor da cor azul no modelo de cores RGB.
16 CUI_HID_TPCOLOR_CMYK_3 36 Define o valor da cor amarela no modelo de cores CMYK.
2e svtools%3AMetricField%3ADLG_COLOR%3ANUM_YELLOW 36 Define o valor da cor amarela no modelo de cores CMYK.
2e svtools%3ANumericField%3ADLG_COLOR%3ANUM_GREEN 33 Define o valor da cor verde no modelo de cores RGB.
2c svtools%3ANumericField%3ADLG_COLOR%3ANUM_RED 36 Define o valor da cor vermella no modelo de cores RGB.
2f svtools%3AMetricField%3ADLG_COLOR%3ANUM_MAGENTA 36 Define o valor da cor maxenta no modelo de cores CMYK.
33 svtools%3ANumericField%3ADLG_COLOR%3ANUM_SATURATION 2c Define a saturación no modelo de cores HSB.
16 CUI_HID_TPCOLOR_CMYK_1 34 Define o valor da cor ciano no modelo de cores CMYK.
29 cui%3ACheckBox%3AOFA_TP_MISC%3ACB_TOOLTIP 86 Displays the icon names and more bubble help information, for example, chapter names when you scroll through a document with chapters.
33 cui%3APushButton%3AOFA_TP_MISC%3APB_HELPAGENT_RESET 8b Prema no botón Redefinir o asistente da Axuda para restaurar a lista predefinida das situacións en que se mostrará o asistente da Axuda.
29 cui%3ACheckBox%3AOFA_TP_MISC%3ACB_EXTHELP 79 Mostra un texto de axuda ao pousar o apuntador sobre unha icona, un menú de ordes ou un control dunha caixa de diálogo.
2b cui%3ACheckBox%3AOFA_TP_MISC%3ACB_HELPAGENT ca Especifica que o asistente da Axuda se mostre automaticamente nas situacións seleccionadas. Prema a xanela do Asistente de Axuda para ver unha páxina de Axuda con información sobre o contexto actual.
2b cui%3ACheckBox%3AOFA_TP_MISC%3ACB_DOCSTATUS 41 Especifica se a impresión do documento conta como modificación.
29 cui%3ACheckBox%3AOFA_TP_MISC%3ACB_FILEDLG a5 Especifica se as caixas de diálogo de $[officename] se van usar para abrir e gardar documentos. De non ser así, úsanse as caixas de diálogo do sistema operativo.
2f cui%3ANumericField%3AOFA_TP_MISC%3ANF_YEARVALUE 55 Define un intervalo de data, dentro do cal o sistema recoñece anos de dous díxitos.
2b cui%3AListBox%3AOFA_TP_MISC%3ALB_HELPFORMAT 30 Escolla un estilo para a Axuda de $[officename].
39 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVX_FONT_SUBSTITUTION%3ALB_FONTHEIGHT 5d Seleccione un tamaño de tipo de letra para a visualización dos códigos fonte HTML e Basic.
38 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVX_FONT_SUBSTITUTION%3ACB_USETABLE 43 Activa a configuración de substitución de tipo de letra definida.
18 CUI_HID_OFA_SUBST_DELETE 29 Elimina a substitución de tipo de letra.
35 cui%3AComboBox%3ARID_SVX_FONT_SUBSTITUTION%3ACB_FONT2 41 Insira ou seleccione o nome do tipo de letra que desexa utilizar.
35 cui%3AComboBox%3ARID_SVX_FONT_SUBSTITUTION%3ACB_FONT1 44 Teclee ou seleccione o nome do tipo de letra que desexa substituír.
1d CUI_HID_OFA_FONT_SUBSTITUTION e6 Substitutes a font with a font of your choice. The substitution replaces a font only when it is displayed on screen, or on screen and when printing. The replacement does not change the font settings that are saved in the document.
37 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVX_FONT_SUBSTITUTION%3ACB_NONPROP 61 Comprobe que na lista de caixa Tipos de letra só se visualizan tipos de letra non proporcionais.
37 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVX_FONT_SUBSTITUTION%3ALB_FONTNAME 50 Seleccione o tipo de letra para a visualización dos código fonte HTML e Basic.
1a CUI_HID_OFA_FONT_SUBST_CLB f0 Lists the original font and the font that will replace it. Select Always to replace the font, even if the original font is installed on your system. Select Screen only to replace the screen font only and never replace the font for printing.
17 CUI_HID_OFA_SUBST_APPLY 28 Aplica a substitución de tipo de letra.
27 SVX_CHECKBOX_OFA_TP_VIEW_CB_SYSTEM_FONT 88 Especifica a utilización do tipo de letra do sistema nos menús e caixas de diálogo. Se non, utilízase outro tipo de letra instalado.
30 svx%3ACheckBox%3AOFA_TP_VIEW%3ACB_USE_ANTIALIASE af When supported, you can enable and disable anti-aliasing of graphics. With anti-aliasing enabled, the display of most graphical objects looks smoother and with less artifacts.
2d cui%3ACheckBox%3AOFA_TP_VIEW%3ACB_SYSTEM_FONT 88 Especifica a utilización do tipo de letra do sistema nos menús e caixas de diálogo. Se non, utilízase outro tipo de letra instalado.
32 cui%3ACheckBox%3AOFA_TP_VIEW%3ACB_FONTANTIALIASING 47 Seleccione esta opción para suavizar a aparencia do texto en pantalla.
13 CUI_HID_OFA_TP_VIEW 26 Especifica opcións de visualización.
29 cui%3AListBox%3AOFA_TP_VIEW%3ALB_MOUSEPOS 6f Especifica se o apuntador do rato se debe colocar nas caixas de diálogo acabadas de abrir e como debe facerse.
19 .uno%3ARestoreEditingView b8 Especifica se restaurar ou non a visualización do último documento utilizado. Restauraranse moitas das propiedades de visualización válidas a última vez que se gardou o documento.
12 .uno%3ARefreshView 56 Prema Maiús+Ctrl+R para restaurar ou actualizar a visualización do documento actual.
2e svx%3AMetricField%3AOFA_TP_VIEW%3AMF_SELECTION 7a Select the transparency level for transparent selections. The default value is 75%. You can select values from 10% to 90%.
29 cui%3AListBox%3AOFA_TP_VIEW%3ALB_ICONSIZE 2c Specifies the display size of toolbar icons.
2a cui%3AListBox%3AOFA_TP_VIEW%3ALB_ICONSTYLE 38 Select the icon style for icons in toolbars and dialogs.
2e cui%3ACheckBox%3AOFA_TP_VIEW%3ACB_FONT_HISTORY 94 No comezo da lista situada na caixa Nome de tipo de letra da barra Formatado móstranse os últimos cinco tipos de letra usados no documento actual.
23 SVX_LISTBOX_OFA_TP_VIEW_LB_ICONSIZE 2c Specifies the display size of toolbar icons.
2b svx%3ACheckBox%3AOFA_TP_VIEW%3ACB_SELECTION b0 If enabled, the text selection in Writer and the cell selection in Calc will be shown using a transparent color. If not enabled, the selection will be shown by inverted colors.
24 SVX_LISTBOX_OFA_TP_VIEW_LB_ICONSTYLE 38 Select the icon style for icons in toolbars and dialogs.
2b cui%3AListBox%3AOFA_TP_VIEW%3ALB_MENU_ICONS a4 Displays icons next to the corresponding menu items. Select from "Automatic", "Hide" and "Show". "Automatic" displays icons according to system settings and themes.
2c cui%3AListBox%3AOFA_TP_VIEW%3ALB_MOUSEMIDDLE 2c Define a función do botón central do rato.
2b cui%3ACheckBox%3AOFA_TP_VIEW%3ACB_FONT_SHOW 97 Mostra os nomes dos tipos de letra seleccionábeis no tipo de letra correspondente, por exemplo, os situados na caixa Tipo de letra da barra Formatado.
2f cui%3AMetricField%3AOFA_TP_VIEW%3AMF_WINDOWSIZE 8f Usa a escala do percentil para o tamaño do tipo de letra nos elementos da interface de usuario, como caixas de diálogo e etiquetas de iconas.
30 cui%3ACheckBox%3AOFA_TP_VIEW%3ACB_USE_HARDACCELL 80 Accede directamente aos recursos de hardware do adaptador gráfico de visualización para mellorar a visualización da pantalla.
33 cui%3ANumericField%3AOFA_TP_VIEW%3ANF_AA_POINTLIMIT 47 Introduza o tamaño menor de tipo de letra para aplicar a suavización.
44 sfx2%3ARadioButton%3ATP_COMMONPRINTOPTIONS%3ARB_REDUCEBITMAPS_NORMAL 73 A calidade de impresión alta corresponde a unha resolución de 300 ppp e a de impresión normal a unha de 200 ppp.
3f sfx2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_COMMONPRINTOPTIONS%3ACB_REDUCETRANSPARENCY aa Ao marcar este campo, os obxectos transparentes imprímense da maneira habitual e os obxectos non transparentes segundo o escollido nos dous botóns de opción seguintes.
36 sfx2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_COMMONPRINTOPTIONS%3ACB_PAPERSIZE 61 Marque esta caixa de verificación se necesita un tamaño de papel específico para a impresión.
47 sfx2%3ARadioButton%3ATP_COMMONPRINTOPTIONS%3ARB_REDUCETRANSPARENCY_AUTO 75 Especifica que a transparencia só se imprimirá se a área transparente abrangue menos dun cuarto de toda a páxina.
3f sfx2%3ARadioButton%3ATP_COMMONPRINTOPTIONS%3ARB_PRINTFILEOUTPUT 5c Especifica se a configuración se aplica á impresión directa ou á impresión en ficheiro.
3a sfx2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_COMMONPRINTOPTIONS%3ACB_REDUCEBITMAPS 74 Especifica que os mapas de bits se imprimen con calidade reducida. A resolución pode reducirse mais non aumentarse.
44 sfx2%3AListBox%3ATP_COMMONPRINTOPTIONS%3ALB_REDUCEBITMAPS_RESOLUTION 7b Especifica a calidade máxima de impresión en ppp (puntos por polgada). A resolución pode reducirse mais non aumentarse..
39 sfx2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_COMMONPRINTOPTIONS%3ACB_TRANSPARENCY 67 Marque esta caixa de verificación para recibir un aviso se o documento contén obxectos transparentes.
45 sfx2%3ARadioButton%3ATP_COMMONPRINTOPTIONS%3ARB_REDUCEGRADIENTS_COLOR 46 Especifica que as gradacións se impriman nunha única cor intermedia.
45 sfx2%3ARadioButton%3ATP_COMMONPRINTOPTIONS%3ARB_REDUCEBITMAPS_OPTIMAL 73 A calidade de impresión alta corresponde a unha resolución de 300 ppp e a de impresión normal a unha de 200 ppp.
47 sfx2%3ARadioButton%3ATP_COMMONPRINTOPTIONS%3ARB_REDUCEGRADIENTS_STRIPES 47 Especifica o número máximo de faixas de gradación para a impresión.
47 sfx2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_COMMONPRINTOPTIONS%3ACB_REDUCEBITMAPS_TRANSPARENCY 84 Se marca este campo, a redución da calidade de impresión dos mapas de bits aplícase tamén ás áreas transparentes dos obxectos.
48 sfx2%3ARadioButton%3ATP_COMMONPRINTOPTIONS%3ARB_REDUCEBITMAPS_RESOLUTION 7b Especifica a calidade máxima de impresión en ppp (puntos por polgada). A resolución pode reducirse mais non aumentarse..
3c sfx2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_COMMONPRINTOPTIONS%3ACB_REDUCEGRADIENTS 46 Se marca este campo, as gradacións imprímense con calidade reducida.
3d sfx2%3ARadioButton%3ATP_COMMONPRINTOPTIONS%3ARB_PRINTEROUTPUT 5c Especifica se a configuración se aplica á impresión directa ou á impresión en ficheiro.
4a sfx2%3ANumericField%3ATP_COMMONPRINTOPTIONS%3ANF_REDUCEGRADIENTS_STEPCOUNT 47 Especifica o número máximo de faixas de gradación para a impresión.
3d sfx2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_COMMONPRINTOPTIONS%3ACB_PAPERORIENTATION 5a Marque esta caixa de verificación se necesita orientar o papel dunha maneira determinada.
47 sfx2%3ARadioButton%3ATP_COMMONPRINTOPTIONS%3ARB_REDUCETRANSPARENCY_NONE 3a Se escolle esta opción non se imprimirá a transparencia.
40 sfx2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_COMMONPRINTOPTIONS%3ACB_CONVERTTOGREYSCALES 3a Especifica que as cores se impriman como escala de grises.
30 cui%3ANumericField%3AOFA_TP_MEMORY%3ANF_OLECACHE 3d Escolla o número máximo de obxectos OLE reunidos na caché.
2f cui%3ACheckBox%3AOFA_TP_MEMORY%3ACB_QUICKLAUNCH 89 Mark this check box if you want $[officename] to enable quickstart. This option is available if the Quickstart module has been installed.
3a cui%3ANumericField%3AOFA_TP_MEMORY%3ANF_GRAPHICOBJECTCACHE 64 Especifica que non se copien na caché os obxectos maiores que o número de megabytes seleccionados.
36 cui%3ATimeField%3AOFA_TP_MEMORY%3ATF_GRAPHICOBJECTTIME 49 Especifica en horas e minutos o tempo que permanece cada imaxe na caché.
2c cui%3ANumericField%3AOFA_TP_MEMORY%3AED_UNDO 5e Permite especificar o número de pasos que poden desfacerse seleccionando un número da lista.
34 cui%3ANumericField%3AOFA_TP_MEMORY%3ANF_GRAPHICCACHE 3a Especifica o tamaño total da caché para todas as imaxes.
27 CUI_HID_OPTIONS_COLORCONFIG_NAME_SCHEME 2a Introduza un nome para o esquema de cores.
3a cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_COLORCONFIG%3APB_SAVESCHEME 62 Garda a configuración actual como un esquema de cores que máis adiante vostede poderá recargar.
38 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_COLORCONFIG%3ALB_COLORSCHEME 32 Selecciona o esquema de cores que desexa utilizar.
3c cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_COLORCONFIG%3APB_DELETESCHEME 61 Elimina o esquema de cores mostrado na caixa Esquema. O esquema predefinido non se pode eliminar.
29 CUI_HID_OPTIONS_COLORCONFIG_COLORLIST_WIN 3e Seleccione as cores para os elementos da interface de usuario.
44 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ACCESSIBILITYCONFIG%3ACB_AUTO_DETECT_HC 59 Cambia %PRODUCTNAME ao modo alto contraste cando a cor do fondo do sistema é moi escura.
3d cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ACCESSIBILITYCONFIG%3ACB_TIPHELP 5c Oculta as suxestións da Axuda ao transcorrer o número de segundos introducido por vostede.
47 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ACCESSIBILITYCONFIG%3ACB_ANIMATED_GRAPHICS 42 Previsualiza imaxes animadas, como as imaxes GIF, en %PRODUCTNAME.
41 cui%3ANumericField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ACCESSIBILITYCONFIG%3ANF_TIPHELP 52 Especifique durante cantos segundos desexa que se mostren as suxestións da Axuda.
43 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ACCESSIBILITYCONFIG%3ACB_TEXTSELECTION 2d Mostra o cursor en documentos só de lectura.
43 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ACCESSIBILITYCONFIG%3ACB_PAGE_PREVIEWS 61 Aplica a configuración de alto contraste do sistema operativo ás previsualizacións de páxina.
48 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ACCESSIBILITYCONFIG%3ACB_ACCESSIBILITY_TOOL 114 Permite usar ferramentas tecnolóxicas adaptadas para persoas con discapacidades, como lectores de pantalla externos, dispositivos Braille ou de recoñecemento de voz. Para poder activalas é necesario que o JRE (contorno de execución Java) estea instalado no seu computador.
4a cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ACCESSIBILITYCONFIG%3ACB_AUTOMATIC_FONT_COLOR 89 Mostra os tipos de letra en %PRODUCTNAME usando a configuración de cor do sistema. Esta opción afecta só á presentación en pantalla.
44 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ACCESSIBILITYCONFIG%3ACB_ANIMATED_TEXTS 50 Previsualiza texto animado, como o que pestanexa e se despraza, en %PRODUCTNAME.
32 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_INET_PROXY%3AED_FTP_PROXY 29 Teclee o nome do servidor proxy para FTP.
33 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_INET_PROXY%3AED_HTTP_PROXY 2a Teclee o nome do servidor proxy para HTTP.
33 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_INET_PROXY%3AED_SOCKS_PORT 30 Teclee o porto do servidor proxy correspondente.
31 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_INET_PROXY%3AED_FTP_PORT 30 Teclee o porto do servidor proxy correspondente.
33 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_INET_PROXY%3AED_NOPROXYFOR 5f Especifica os nomes dos servidores que non requiren servidor proxy, separados por punto e coma.
15 CUI_HID_OPTIONS_PROXY 2a Especifica o tipo de definición de proxy.
33 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_INET_PROXY%3AED_HTTPS_PORT 30 Teclee o porto do servidor proxy correspondente.
32 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_INET_PROXY%3AED_HTTP_PORT 30 Teclee o porto do servidor proxy correspondente.
34 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_INET_PROXY%3AED_HTTPS_PROXY 53 Type the name of the proxy server for HTTPS. Type the port in the right-hand field.
35 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_INET_PROXY%3ALB_PROXYMODE 2a Especifica o tipo de definición de proxy.
31 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_INET_MAIL%3AED_MAILERURL 40 Introduza o camiño e o nome do programa de correo electrónico.
37 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_INET_MAIL%3APB_MAILERURL 5b Abre unha caixa de diálogo de ficheiro para seleccionar o programa de correo electrónico.
3f cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_INET_MOZPLUGIN%3ACB_MOZPLUGIN_CODE c4 Enables the Browser Plug-in to show %PRODUCTNAME documents in a browser window. Select, click OK, then restart your browser. Then, in the browser window, click any %PRODUCTNAME document hyperlink.
3a cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_SECURITY_OPTIONS%3ACB_SIGNDOCS cb Select to see a warning dialog when you try to sign a document that contains recorded changes, versions, fields, references to other sources (for example linked sections or linked pictures), or comments.
3c cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_WEBCONNECTION_INFO%3APB_CHANGE 51 Opens a dialog where you can view and change the password for the selected entry.
3f cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_WEBCONNECTION_INFO%3APB_REMOVEALL 28 Elimina a entrada seleccionada da lista.
42 uui%3AEdit%3ADLG_UUI_MASTERPASSWORD_CRT%3AED_MASTERPASSWORD_REPEAT 20 Enter the master password again.
3f cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_SECURITY_OPTIONS%3ACB_CTRLHYPERLINK 88 If enabled, you must hold down the Ctrl key while clicking a hyperlink to follow that link. If not enabled, a click opens the hyperlink.
37 uui%3AEdit%3ADLG_UUI_MASTERPASSWORD%3AED_MASTERPASSWORD 26 Enter the master password to continue.
41 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_INET_SECURITY%3ACB_SEC_SAVEPASSWORDS bb If enabled, %PRODUCTNAME will securely store all passwords that you use to access files from web servers. You can retrieve the passwords from the list after you enter the master password.
3e cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_SECURITY_OPTIONS%3ACB_RECOMMENDPWD c8 Active a opción Gardar con contrasinal para que se solicite un contrasinal nas caixas de diálogo para gardar ficheiros. Desmarque a opción se desexa gardar os ficheiros por defecto sen contrasinal.
41 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_INET_SECURITY%3APB_SEC_CONNECTIONS 70 Asks for the master password. If master password is correct, shows the Stored Web Connection Information dialog.
3b cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_SECURITY_OPTIONS%3ACB_CREATEPDF 93 Select to see a warning dialog when you try to export a document to PDF format that displays recorded changes in Writer, or that displays comments.
45 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_INET_SECURITY%3APB_SEC_SECURITYOPTIONS 30 Opens the "Security options and warning" dialog.
3b cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_SECURITY_OPTIONS%3ACB_PRINTDOCS 6b Select to see a warning dialog when you try to print a document that contains recorded changes or comments.
3e cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_INET_SECURITY%3APB_SEC_MACROSEC 2c Abre a caixa de diálogo Seguranza de macro.
3c cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_WEBCONNECTION_INFO%3APB_REMOVE 28 Elimina a entrada seleccionada da lista.
3f uui%3AEdit%3ADLG_UUI_MASTERPASSWORD_CRT%3AED_MASTERPASSWORD_CRT 1a Enter the master password.
44 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_INET_SECURITY%3APB_SEC_MASTERPASSWORD 27 Opens the Enter Master Password dialog.
3c cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_SECURITY_OPTIONS%3ACB_REMOVEINFO d8 Select to always remove user data from the file properties. If this option is not selected, you can still remove the personal information for the current document with the Reset button on File - Properties - General.
3e cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_SECURITY_OPTIONS%3ACB_SAVESENDDOCS 7d Select to see a warning dialog when you try to save or send a document that contains recorded changes, versions, or comments.
3b cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_HTMLOPT%3ACB_STARBASIC_WARNING 7e Se este campo está marcado ao exportar para HTML móstrase un aviso que advirte da perda das macros básicas de %PRODUCTNAME.
33 cui%3ANumericField%3ARID_OFAPAGE_HTMLOPT%3ANF_SIZE2 a6 Utilice os botóns xiratorios Tamaño 1 a Tamaño 7 para definir os tamaños correspondentes de tipo de letra para as etiquetas HTML de <font size=1> a <font size=7>.
36 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_HTMLOPT%3ACB_UNKNOWN_TAGS 78 Marque esta caixa de verificación se quere que se importen como campos as etiquetas non recoñecidas por $[officename].
33 cui%3ANumericField%3ARID_OFAPAGE_HTMLOPT%3ANF_SIZE3 a6 Utilice os botóns xiratorios Tamaño 1 a Tamaño 7 para definir os tamaños correspondentes de tipo de letra para as etiquetas HTML de <font size=1> a <font size=7>.
30 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_HTMLOPT%3ALB_CHARSET 41 Seleccione o conxunto de caracteres apropiado para a exportación
33 cui%3ANumericField%3ARID_OFAPAGE_HTMLOPT%3ANF_SIZE1 a6 Utilice os botóns xiratorios Tamaño 1 a Tamaño 7 para definir os tamaños correspondentes de tipo de letra para as etiquetas HTML de <font size=1> a <font size=7>.
33 cui%3ANumericField%3ARID_OFAPAGE_HTMLOPT%3ANF_SIZE4 a6 Utilice os botóns xiratorios Tamaño 1 a Tamaño 7 para definir os tamaños correspondentes de tipo de letra para as etiquetas HTML de <font size=1> a <font size=7>.
3c cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_HTMLOPT%3ACB_NUMBERS_ENGLISH_US d6 If not checked, numbers will be interpreted according to the setting in Language Settings - Language of - Locale setting in the Options dialog box. If checked, numbers will be interpreted as 'English (USA)' locale.
3a cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_HTMLOPT%3ACB_IGNORE_FONTNAMES ae Marque esta caixa de verificación se desexa ignorar a configuración do tipo de letra durante a importación. Usaranse os tipos de letra definidos no estilo de páxina HTML.
39 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_HTMLOPT%3ACB_PRINT_EXTENSION 55 If you mark this field, the print layout of the current document is exported as well.
33 cui%3ANumericField%3ARID_OFAPAGE_HTMLOPT%3ANF_SIZE5 a6 Utilice os botóns xiratorios Tamaño 1 a Tamaño 7 para definir os tamaños correspondentes de tipo de letra para as etiquetas HTML de <font size=1> a <font size=7>.
33 cui%3ANumericField%3ARID_OFAPAGE_HTMLOPT%3ANF_SIZE7 a6 Utilice os botóns xiratorios Tamaño 1 a Tamaño 7 para definir os tamaños correspondentes de tipo de letra para as etiquetas HTML de <font size=1> a <font size=7>.
33 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_HTMLOPT%3ACB_LOCAL_GRF fd Marque esta caixa de verificación para cargar automaticamente as imaxes incorporadas do servidor da internet cando envie por FTP. Use a caixa de diálogo Gardar como para gardar o documento e introduza un URL completo como nome de ficheiro na internet.
33 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_HTMLOPT%3ACB_STARBASIC 78 Marque esta caixa de verificación para incluír as instruccións $[officename] Basic cando exporte para o formato HTML.
2f cui%3AListBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_HTMLOPT%3ALB_EXPORT 3b Define a configuración de exportación de documentos HTML.
33 cui%3ANumericField%3ARID_OFAPAGE_HTMLOPT%3ANF_SIZE6 a6 Utilice os botóns xiratorios Tamaño 1 a Tamaño 7 para definir os tamaños correspondentes de tipo de letra para as etiquetas HTML de <font size=1> a <font size=7>.
14 .uno%3ASwEditOptions a1 Esta configuración determina como tratar os documentos de texto creados en $[officename]. Tamén pode definir a configuración para o documento de texto actual.
27 sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_CONTENT_OPT%3ACB_GRF 3f Especifica se deben mostrarse en pantalla os obxectos e imaxes.
2b sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_CONTENT_OPT%3ACB_VSCROLL 29 Mostra a barra de desprazamento vertical.
2a sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_CONTENT_OPT%3ACB_HRULER 55 Mostra a regra horizontal. Seleccione unha unidade de medida na lista correspondente.
2a sw%3AListBox%3ATP_CONTENT_OPT%3ALB_VMETRIC 59 Mostra a regra vertical. Seleccione a unidade de medida desexada na lista correspondente.
2a sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_CONTENT_OPT%3ACB_VRULER 59 Mostra a regra vertical. Seleccione a unidade de medida desexada na lista correspondente.
2d sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_CONTENT_OPT%3ACB_ANY_RULER 73 Activa as regras. Use as dúas caixas de verificación seguintes para seleccionar a(s) regra(s) que desexa mostrar.
2b sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_CONTENT_OPT%3ACB_HSCROLL 2b Mostra a barra de desprazamento horizontal.
27 sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_CONTENT_OPT%3ACB_TBL 2a Mostra as táboas existentes no documento.
29 sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_CONTENT_OPT%3ACB_FIELD 46 Mostra os nomes dos campos existentes no documento, en vez do contido.
29 sw%3AListBox%3ATP_CONTENT_OPT%3ALB_METRIC 2a Especifica a unidade para documentos HTML.
29 sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_CONTENT_OPT%3ACB_CROSS ab Displays snap lines around the frames when frames are moved. You can select the Helplines While Moving option to show the exact position of the object using lineal values.
2a sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_CONTENT_OPT%3ACB_POSTIT dc Displays comments. Click a comment to edit the text. Use the context menu in Navigator to locate or delete a comment. Use the comments's context menu to delete this comment or all comments or all comments of this author.
31 sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_CONTENT_OPT%3ACB_SMOOTH_SCROLL 34 Activa a función de desprazamento suave de páxina.
30 sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_CONTENT_OPT%3ACB_VRULER_RIGHT 29 Aliña a regra vertical ao bordo dereito.
2b sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_CONTENT_OPT%3ACB_DRWFAST 33 Mostra os debuxos e controis contidos no documento.
2a sw%3AListBox%3ATP_CONTENT_OPT%3ALB_HMETRIC 55 Mostra a regra horizontal. Seleccione unha unidade de medida na lista correspondente.
16 .uno%3ATableBoundaries b0 Para mostrar os límites de táboa prema co botón dereito do rato en calquera táboa e escolla Bordos de táboa ou escolla Táboa - Límites de táboa nun documento de Writer.
24 sw%3AComboBox%3ATP_STD_FONT%3ALB_IDX 5c Especifica o tipo de letra utilizado para índices, índices alfabéticos e índices xerais.
25 sw%3AComboBox%3ATP_STD_FONT%3ALB_LIST 4f Especifica os tipos de letra para as listas, a numeración e estilos derivados.
2f sw%3AMetricBox%3ATP_STD_FONT%3ALB_STANDARD_SIZE 26 Especifica o tamaño do tipo de letra.
2c sw%3AMetricBox%3ATP_STD_FONT%3ALB_TITLE_SIZE 26 Especifica o tamaño do tipo de letra.
28 sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_STD_FONT%3ACB_DOCONLY 42 Especifica que a configuración se aplica só ao documento actual.
2c sw%3AMetricBox%3ATP_STD_FONT%3ALB_LABEL_SIZE 26 Especifica o tamaño do tipo de letra.
f SW_HID_STD_FONT 46 Especifica a configuración de tipos de letra básicos dos documentos.
2c sw%3AMetricBox%3ATP_STD_FONT%3ALB_INDEX_SIZE 26 Especifica o tamaño do tipo de letra.
29 sw%3AComboBox%3ATP_STD_FONT%3ALB_STANDARD 53 Especifica o tipo de letra que desexa usar para o estilo de parágrafo predefinido.
26 sw%3AComboBox%3ATP_STD_FONT%3ALB_TITLE 3c Especifica o tipo de letra que desexa usar para os títulos.
2b sw%3AMetricBox%3ATP_STD_FONT%3ALB_LIST_SIZE 26 Especifica o tamaño do tipo de letra.
26 sw%3AComboBox%3ATP_STD_FONT%3ALB_LABEL 48 Especifica o tipo de letra utilizado para as lendas de imaxes e táboas.
2d sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTPRINT_PAGE%3ACB_CTRLFLD 4b Specifies whether the form control fields of the text document are printed.
38 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintEmptyPages%3ACheckBox 1d0 Estando esta opción activada, imprímense páxinas en branco inseridas automaticamente. Isto é útil cando se imprime por dúas caras. Nos libros, por exemplo, pódese definir o estilo de parágrafo "capítulo" de forma que comece sempre nunha páxina impar. Se o capítulo precedente termina nunha páxina impar, %PRODUCTNAME insire unha páxina en branco co número par correspondente. Este opción serve para estabelecer se se imprime esta páxina par ou non.
34 sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTPRINT_PAGE%3ACB_PAPERFROMSETUP a9 For printers with multiple trays, the "Paper tray from printer settings" option specifies whether the paper tray used is specified by the system settings of the printer.
2d sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTPRINT_PAGE%3ACB_REVERSE 72 Specifies whether to reverse the printing order. The last page of the document will then be the first one printed.
2c sw_CheckBox_TP_OPTPRINT_PAGE_CB_PROSPECT_RTL 59 Check to print the pages of the brochure in the correct order for a right-to-left script.
30 sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTPRINT_PAGE%3ACB_SINGLEJOBS 62 Specifies that each new print job will begin on a new page even if you are using a duplex printer.
3b .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintAnnotationMode%3AListBox 38 Specifies whether comments in your document are printed.
36 .HelpId%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintControls%3ACheckBox 4b Specifies whether the form control fields of the text document are printed.
28 SW%3ALISTBOX%3ATP_OPTPRINT_PAGE%3ALB_FAX 8e Se instalou un programa de fax no computador e desexa enviar un fax directamente desde o documento de texto, seleccione o fax que desexa usar.
30 sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTPRINT_PAGE%3ACB_BLACK_FONT 30 Specifies whether to always print text in black.
40 .HelpId%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintPicturesAndObjects%3ACheckBox 41 Specifies whether the graphics of your text document are printed.
2b SW%3ARADIOBUTTON%3ATP_OPTPRINT_PAGE%3ARB_NO 38 Specifies whether comments in your document are printed.
38 .HelpId%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintBlackFonts%3ACheckBox 30 Specifies whether to always print text in black.
2c sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTPRINT_PAGE%3ACB_RIGHTP 4a Specifies whether to print all right (odd numbered) pages of the document.
30 sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTPRINT_PAGE%3ACB_BACKGROUND 95 Specifies whether to include colors and objects that are inserted to the background of the page (Format - Page - Background) in the printed document.
2b sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTPRINT_PAGE%3ACB_LEFTP 4a Specifies whether to print all left (even numbered) pages of the document.
2b sw_CheckBox_TP_OPTPRINT_PAGE_CB_HIDDEN_TEXT 3a Enable this option to print text that is marked as hidden.
14 SW_HID_OPTPRINT_PAGE 49 Especifica a configuración de impresión nun documento de texto ou HTML.
30 sw_CheckBox_TP_OPTPRINT_PAGE_CB_TEXT_PLACEHOLDER 78 Enable this option to print text placeholders. Disable this option to leave the text placeholders blank in the printout.
38 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintHiddenText%3ACheckBox 3a Enable this option to print text that is marked as hidden.
2a sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTPRINT_PAGE%3ACB_PGRF 41 Specifies whether the graphics of your text document are printed.
2e sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTPRINT_PAGE%3ACB_PROSPECT 45 Select the Brochure option to print your document in brochure format.
3c .HelpId%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintPageBackground%3ACheckBox 95 Specifies whether to include colors and objects that are inserted to the background of the page (Format - Page - Background) in the printed document.
2f sw_CheckBox_TP_OPTPRINT_PAGE_CB_PRINTEMPTYPAGES 1d0 Estando esta opción activada, imprímense páxinas en branco inseridas automaticamente. Isto é útil cando se imprime por dúas caras. Nos libros, por exemplo, pódese definir o estilo de parágrafo "capítulo" de forma que comece sempre nunha páxina impar. Se o capítulo precedente termina nunha páxina impar, %PRODUCTNAME insire unha páxina en branco co número par correspondente. Este opción serve para estabelecer se se imprime esta páxina par ou non.
3d .HelpId%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintTextPlaceholder%3ACheckBox 78 Enable this option to print text placeholders. Disable this option to leave the text placeholders blank in the printout.
14 SW_HID_OPTTABLE_PAGE 38 Define os atributos das táboas nos documentos de texto.
33 sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTTABLE_PAGE%3ACB_REPEAT_HEADER 5f Especifica se o título da táboa se reproduce na nova páxina despois dunha quebra de páxina.
2c sw%3ARadioButton%3ATP_OPTTABLE_PAGE%3ARB_FIX 74 Especifica que as modificacións efectuadas sobre unha fila ou columna só afectan a correspondente área adxacente.
37 sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTTABLE_PAGE%3ACB_NUMFMT_FORMATTING b9 Se a opción Recoñecemento de formato numérico non está seleccionada, só se aceptan as entradas co formato definido na cela. As demais entradas estabelecen o seu formato como Texto.
2c sw%3ARadioButton%3ATP_OPTTABLE_PAGE%3ARB_VAR 58 Especifica que os cambios realizados nunha fila ou columna afectan ao tamaño da táboa.
32 sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTTABLE_PAGE%3ACB_NUMALIGNMENT 4f Especifica que os números se aliñen sempre na parte inferior dereita da cela.
2c sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTTABLE_PAGE%3ACB_HEADER 60 Especifica que a primeira fila da táboa se formate co estilo de parágrafo "Título de táboa".
2c sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTTABLE_PAGE%3ACB_BORDER 3e Especifica que as celas da táboa teñan un bordo predefinido.
1d .uno%3ATableNumberRecognition 60 Especifica que os números situados nas táboas de texto se recoñezan e formaten como números.
30 sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTTABLE_PAGE%3ACB_DONT_SPLIT 4a Especifica que ningún tipo de quebra de fluxo de texto divida as táboas.
33 sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTTABLE_PAGE%3ACB_NUMFORMATTING 60 Especifica que os números situados nas táboas de texto se recoñezan e formaten como números.
30 sw%3AMetricField%3ATP_OPTTABLE_PAGE%3AMF_ROWMOVE 38 Especifica o valor que debe utilizarse para mover filas.
30 sw%3ARadioButton%3ATP_OPTTABLE_PAGE%3ARB_FIXPROP 53 Especifica que os cambios realizados nunha fila ou columna afectan a toda a táboa.
32 sw%3AMetricField%3ATP_OPTTABLE_PAGE%3AMF_COLINSERT 35 Especifica o valor predefinido para inserir columnas.
32 sw%3AMetricField%3ATP_OPTTABLE_PAGE%3AMF_ROWINSERT 32 Especifica o valor predefinido para inserir filas.
30 sw%3AMetricField%3ATP_OPTTABLE_PAGE%3AMF_COLMOVE 3b Especifica o valor que debe utilizarse para mover columnas.
28 sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTSHDWCRSR%3ACB_PARA 7d Especifica se deben mostrarse os delimitadores de parágrafos, os cales conteñen información sobre o formato de parágrafo.
35 sw%3ARadioButton%3ATP_OPTSHDWCRSR%3ARB_SHDWCRSFILLTAB 7a Ao usar o cursor directo engádense no novo parágrafo as tabulacións necesarias para alcanzar a posición na que premeu.
38 sw%3ARadioButton%3ATP_OPTSHDWCRSR%3ARB_SHDWCRSFILLINDENT 93 Ao usar o cursor directo, a sangría esquerda defínese na posición horizontal en que prema co cursor directo. O parágrafo alíñase á esquerda.
2f sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTSHDWCRSR%3ACB_CHAR_HIDDEN 7c Mostra o texto que utiliza o formato de carácter "oculto" cando a opción Ver - Caracteres non imprimíbeis está activada.
37 sw%3ARadioButton%3ATP_OPTSHDWCRSR%3ARB_SHDWCRSFILLSPACE 84 Ao usar o cursor directo engádense no novo parágrafo as tabulacións e espazos necesarios para alcanzar a posición na que premeu.
33 sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTSHDWCRSR%3ACB_FLD_HIDDEN_PARA 7d Se vostede inseriu texto utilizando o campo Parágrafo oculto, esta opción especifica se o parágrafo oculto debe mostrarse.
38 sw%3ARadioButton%3ATP_OPTSHDWCRSR%3ARB_SHDWCRSFILLMARGIN ec Define o aliñamento do parágrafo ao usar o cursor directo. O parágrafo aliñarase á esquerda, centrado ou á dereita segundo o lugar onde prema co rato. Antes de premer, o cursor indica mediante un triángulo o aliñamento definido.
31 sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTSHDWCRSR%3ACB_ALLOW_IN_PROT 64 Especifica que vostede pode situar o cursor nunha área protexida, mais non realizar ningún cambio.
12 SW_HID_OPTSHDWCRSR 77 Define a visualización de determinados caracteres e do cursor directo nos documentos HTML e de texto de $[officename].
2a sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTSHDWCRSR%3ACB_HSPACE c6 Specifies that non-breaking spaces are shown as gray boxes. Non-breaking spaces are not broken at the end of a line and are entered with the Command+Shift+Spacebar Ctrl+Shift+Spacebar shortcut keys.
29 sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTSHDWCRSR%3ACB_SHYPH 164 Especifica se deben mostrarse os delimitadores definidos polo usuario, que son uns delimitadores ocultos que se introducen nas palabras ao premer Comando+guión(-) Ctrl+guión(-). As palabras con delimitadores definidos polo usuario só se separan na fin de liña no punto en que se inseriu o delimitador, estea ou non activada a guionización automática.
29 sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTSHDWCRSR%3ACB_BREAK 87 Mostra todas as quebras de liña inseridas mediante o atallo Maiús+Intro. Esas quebras crean novas liñas, mais non novos parágrafos.
2e sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTSHDWCRSR%3ACB_FLD_HIDDEN 45 Mostra o texto oculto polos campos Texto condicional ou Texto oculto.
29 sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTSHDWCRSR%3ACB_SPACE 4a Especifica se deben representarse cun punto os espazos presentes no texto.
30 sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTSHDWCRSR%3ACB_SHDWCRSONOFF 18 Activa o cursor directo.
27 sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTSHDWCRSR%3ACB_TAB 40 Especifica que as tabulacións se mostren como frechas pequenas.
2a sw%3AListBox%3ATP_REDLINE_OPT%3ALB_MARKPOS 3e Defines if and where changed lines in the document are marked.
2a sw%3AListBox%3ATP_REDLINE_OPT%3ALB_DEL_COL ee Tamén se pode seleccionar unha cor para cada tipo de modificación gravada. Ao escoller na lista a condición "Por autor", $[officename] determina automaticamente a cor e múdaa de xeito que se corresponda co autor de cada modificación.
29 sw%3AListBox%3ATP_REDLINE_OPT%3ALB_LC_COL 43 Especifica a cor usada para realzar as liñas modificadas no texto.
2b sw%3AListBox%3ATP_REDLINE_OPT%3ALB_DEL_ATTR cd Especifica como deben mostrarse os cambios realizados no documento ao eliminar un texto. Se rexistra eliminacións de texto, este móstrase co atributo seleccionado (por exemplo, riscado) e non se elimina.
2b sw%3AListBox%3ATP_REDLINE_OPT%3ALB_INS_ATTR 56 Seleccione como deben mostrarse os cambios realizados no documento ao inserir o texto.
2a sw%3AListBox%3ATP_REDLINE_OPT%3ALB_INS_COL ee Tamén se pode seleccionar unha cor para cada tipo de modificación gravada. Ao escoller na lista a condición "Por autor", $[officename] determina automaticamente a cor e múdaa de xeito que se corresponda co autor de cada modificación.
12 SW_HID_REDLINE_OPT 37 Define a aparencia dos cambios realizados no documento.
2b sw%3AListBox%3ATP_REDLINE_OPT%3ALB_CHG_ATTR 9e Define como deben mostrarse no documento as modificacións realizadas nos atributos de texto, que afectan a atributos como a negra, a cursiva ou o subliñado.
2a sw%3AListBox%3ATP_REDLINE_OPT%3ALB_CHG_COL ee Tamén se pode seleccionar unha cor para cada tipo de modificación gravada. Ao escoller na lista a condición "Por autor", $[officename] determina automaticamente a cor e múdaa de xeito que se corresponda co autor de cada modificación.
2e sw%3ARadioButton%3ATP_OPTLOAD_PAGE%3ARB_ALWAYS 35 Actualiza sempre as ligazóns ao cargar un documento.
13 SW_HID_OPTLOAD_PAGE 3a Especifica a configuración xeral dos documentos de texto.
37 sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTLOAD_PAGE%3ACB_AUTO_UPDATE_FIELDS c8 The contents of all fields are updated automatically whenever the screen contents are displayed as new. Even with this box unchecked, some fields are updated each time a special condition takes place.
37 sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTLOAD_PAGE%3ACB_AUTO_UPDATE_CHARTS d5 Especifica se actualizar automaticamente as gráficas. Sempre que se modifica o valor dunha cela dunha táboa de Writer, a gráfica que mostra ese valor actualízase automaticamente así que o cursor deixa a cela.
2d sw%3ARadioButton%3ATP_OPTLOAD_PAGE%3ARB_NEVER 38 As ligazóns nunca se actualizan ao cargar un documento.
2f sw%3ARadioButton%3ATP_OPTLOAD_PAGE%3ARB_REQUEST 44 Ao cargar un documento actualiza as ligazóns só cando se solicita.
2a sw%3AListBox%3ATP_OPTLOAD_PAGE%3ALB_METRIC 37 Especifica a unidade de medida dos documentos de texto.
2f sc%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SCPAGE_LAYOUT%3ARB_NEVER 38 As ligazóns nunca se actualizan ao cargar un documento.
2b sw%3AMetricField%3ATP_OPTLOAD_PAGE%3AMF_TAB 3b Especifica o espazamento entre as tabulacións individuais.
31 sc%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SCPAGE_LAYOUT%3ARB_REQUEST 44 Ao cargar un documento actualiza as ligazóns só cando se solicita.
30 sc%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SCPAGE_LAYOUT%3ARB_ALWAYS 35 Actualiza sempre as ligazóns ao cargar un documento.
38 sd%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTIONS_MISC%3ACB_USE_PRINTER_METRICS 82 Especifica que os parámetros da impresora se aplican tanto para a impresión como para o formatado da visualización na pantalla.
37 sw%3APushButton%3ATP_OPTCOMPATIBILITY_PAGE%3APB_DEFAULT 7e Prema para que a configuración deste separador se aplique como predefinida en sesións futuras de traballo con  %PRODUCTNAME.
1c SW_HID_OPTCOMPATIBILITY_PAGE 9f Especifica a configuración de compatibilidade para documentos de texto. Estas opcións axudan a axustar %PRODUCTNAME ao importar documentos de Microsoft Word.
30 sw%3AListBox%3ATP_OPTCAPTION_PAGE%3ALB_CHARSTYLE 21 Especifica o estilo de carácter.
2e sw%3AListBox%3ATP_OPTCAPTION_PAGE%3ABOX_FORMAT 2c Especifica o tipo de numeración solicitado.
29 sw%3AEdit%3ATP_OPTCAPTION_PAGE%3AEDT_TEXT 5a Define o carácter que se vai mostrar despois do número de nivel de título ou capítulo.
2c sw%3AListBox%3ATP_OPTCAPTION_PAGE%3ALB_LEVEL 56 Especifica os niveis de títulos ou capítulos en que desexa que comece a numeración.
2d sw%3AEdit%3ATP_OPTCAPTION_PAGE%3AED_SEPARATOR 5a Define o carácter que se vai mostrar despois do número de nivel de título ou capítulo.
15 SW_HID_OPTCAPTION_CLB 59 Seleccione o tipo de obxecto para o cal é válida a configuración de Lenda automática.
2b sw%3AListBox%3ATP_OPTCAPTION_PAGE%3ABOX_POS 37 Determina a posición da lenda en relación ao obxecto.
33 sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTCAPTION_PAGE%3ACB_APPLYBORDER 2c Engade un bordo ou sombra ao marco da lenda.
31 sw%3AComboBox%3ATP_OPTCAPTION_PAGE%3ABOX_CATEGORY 30 Especifica a categoría do obxecto seleccionado.
3a svx%3ANumericField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRID%3ANUM_FLD_DIVISION_X 4c Specify the number of intermediate spaces between grid points on the X-axis.
15 .uno%3AHelplinesFront 2c Sets the snap lines in front of all objects.
14 SVX_HID_OPTIONS_GRID af Especifica a configuración da grade nas páxinas do documento. Esta grade axuda a determinar a posición exacta dos obxectos. Pode aliñarse coa grade de axuste "magnética".
10 .uno%3AGridFront 2e Sets the visible grid in front of all objects.
34 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRID%3ACBX_GRID_VISIBLE 25 Especifica se a grade debe mostrarse.
35 svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRID%3AMTR_FLD_DRAW_Y 64 Define o espazamento que hai entre os puntos da grade, na unidade de medida escollida para o eixo Y.
33 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRID%3ACBX_SYNCHRONIZE 53 Especifica se é necesario cambiar a configuración da grade actual simetricamente.
3a svx%3ANumericField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRID%3ANUM_FLD_DIVISION_Y 4c Specify the number of intermediate spaces between grid points on the Y-axis.
34 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRID%3ACBX_USE_GRIDSNAP 5a Specifies whether to move frames, drawing elements, and controls only between grid points.
35 svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRID%3AMTR_FLD_DRAW_X 64 Define o espazamento que hai entre os puntos da grade, na unidade de medida escollida para o eixo X.
12 .uno%3AGridVisible 25 Especifica se a grade debe mostrarse.
13 .uno%3AToolsOptions 11e Define varias opcións das follas de cálculo, o contido que se debe mostrar e o sentido do cursor tras realizar entradas en celas. Tamén permite definir listas de clasificación, determinar o número de decimais e a configuración quen se van usar para rexistrar e realzar os cambios.
14 .uno%3AScEditOptions 11e Define varias opcións das follas de cálculo, o contido que se debe mostrar e o sentido do cursor tras realizar entradas en celas. Tamén permite definir listas de clasificación, determinar o número de decimais e a configuración quen se van usar para rexistrar e realzar os cambios.
2f sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_CONTENT%3ACB_OUTLINE 80 Se definiu un esquema, a opción Símbolos de esquema especifica se eses símbolos de esquema deben mostrarse no bordo da folla.
32 sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_CONTENT%3ACB_PAGEBREAKS 61 Especifica se deben visualizarse as quebras de páxina dentro dunha área de impresión concreta.
2d sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_CONTENT%3ACB_RFIND cc Especifica o uso de cores para realzar as referencias situadas na fórmula. O intervalo de celas resáltase cun bordo coloreado no momento de seleccionar a cela que contén a referencia que se vai editar.
2d sc%3AListBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_CONTENT%3ALB_OBJGRF 34 Defines if objects and graphics are shown or hidden.
2b sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_CONTENT%3ACB_NIL 35 Especifica se deben mostrarse os números de valor 0.
12 .uno%3ANoteVisible 5f To display a comment permanently, select the Show comment command from the cell's context menu.
34 sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_CONTENT%3ACB_ROWCOLHEADER 41 Especifica se deben mostrarse as cabeceiras das filas e columnas.
2f sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_CONTENT%3ACB_FORMULA 4b Especifica se nas celas deben mostrarse as fórmulas en vez dos resultados.
2b sc%3AListBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_CONTENT%3ALB_GRID db Specifies when grid lines will be displayed. Default is to display grid lines only on cells that do not have a background color. You can choose to also display grid lines on cells with background color, or to hide them.
2e sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_CONTENT%3ACB_ANCHOR 5d Especifica se a icona de áncora aparece ao seleccionar un obxecto inserido, como unha imaxe.
2d sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_CONTENT%3ACB_ANNOT d1 Specifies that a small rectangle in the top right corner of the cell indicates that a comment exists. The comment will be shown only when you enable tips under %PRODUCTNAME - General in the Options dialog box.
2c sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_CONTENT%3ACB_CLIP fd Cando a largura do texto é superior á da cela que o contén, o excedente de texto móstrase nas celas adxacentes baleiras da mesma fila. Cando non hai máis celas baleiras aparece un pequeno triángulo no bordo da cela indicando que o texto continúa.
2c sc%3AListBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_CONTENT%3ALB_COLOR 3d Specifies a color for the grid lines in the current document.
15 SC_HID_SCPAGE_CONTENT 8b Define que elementos se mostran da xanela principal de %PRODUCTNAME Calc. Tamén permite mostrar ou ocultar o realce de valores en táboas.
2e sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_CONTENT%3ACB_TBLREG 56 Especifica se os separadores de follas deben mostrarse na parte inferior do documento.
2f sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_CONTENT%3ACB_HSCROLL 6a Especifica se a barra de desprazamento horizontal debe mostrarse na parte inferior da xanela do documento.
30 sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_CONTENT%3ACB_SYNCZOOM 74 If checked, all sheets are shown with the same zoom factor. If not checked, each sheet can have its own zoom factor.
2b sc%3AListBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_CONTENT%3ALB_DRAW 40 Defines if drawing objects in your document are shown or hidden.
2d sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_CONTENT%3ACB_VALUE db Mark the Value highlighting box to show the cell contents in different colors, depending on type. Text cells are formatted in black, formulas in green, and number cells in blue, no matter how their display is formatted.
2f sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_CONTENT%3ACB_VSCROLL 64 Especifica se debe mostrarse unha barra de desprazamento vertical á dereita da xanela do documento.
2e sc%3AListBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_CONTENT%3ALB_DIAGRAM 37 Defines if charts in your document are shown or hidden.
31 sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_CONTENT%3ACB_GUIDELINE 69 Especifica se deben mostrarse as guías durante o movemento de debuxos, marcos, imaxes e outros obxectos.
2d sc%3AMetricField%3ARID_SCPAGE_LAYOUT%3AMF_TAB 24 Define a distancia das tabulacións.
2e sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_LAYOUT%3ACB_MARKHDR 4f Especifica se as cabeceiras das filas e columnas seleccionadas deben realzarse.
2c sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_LAYOUT%3ACB_ALIGN 63 Determina a dirección en que se moverá o cursor na folla de cálculo tras premer na tecla Intror.
2f sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_LAYOUT%3ACB_EDITMODE 50 Permítelle editar imediatamente a cela seleccionada tras premer na tecla Intro.
2e sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_LAYOUT%3ACB_TEXTFMT 6f Especifica que se está aplicando a métrica da impresora paraimprimir e formatar a visualización na pantalla.
2f sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_LAYOUT%3ACB_REPLWARN 8a Especifica que debe mostrarse un aviso ao pegar celas desde o portapapeis ata un intervalo de celas non baleiro. Aparece unha advertencia.
13 .uno%3ASetInputMode 50 Permítelle editar imediatamente a cela seleccionada tras premer na tecla Intro.
2b sc%3AListBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_LAYOUT%3ALB_ALIGN 63 Determina a dirección en que se moverá o cursor na folla de cálculo tras premer na tecla Intror.
2d sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_LAYOUT%3ACB_FORMAT 6b Especifica se os atributos de formatado da cela seleccionada deben aplicarse ás celas adxacentes baleiras.
2a sc%3AListBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_LAYOUT%3ALB_UNIT 31 Define a unidade de medida en follas de cálculo.
2d sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_LAYOUT%3ACB_EXPREF 145 Especifica se as referencias deben expandirse durante a inserción de columnas ou filas adxacentes ao intervalo de referencia. Isto só é posíbel se o intervalo de referencia, onde está inserida a columna ou fila, ocupaba orixinalmente un mínimo dúas celas orientadas no mesmo sentido en que se pretenden orientar agora.
30 sc%3APushButton%3ARID_SCPAGE_USERLISTS%3ABTN_NEW 34 Insire o contido dunha nova lista na caixa Entradas.
36 sc%3AMultiLineEdit%3ARID_SCPAGE_USERLISTS%3AED_ENTRIES 49 Mostra o contido da lista seleccionada nese momento, o cal pode editarse.
17 SC_HID_SCPAGE_USERLISTS d9 As listas definidas polo usuario móstranse na caixa de diálogo Listas de ordenación. Pode definir e editar as súas propias listas. Só é posíbel usar texto como listas de ordenación, os números non se aceptan.
31 sc%3APushButton%3ARID_SCPAGE_USERLISTS%3ABTN_COPY 12b Copia o contido das celas na caixa Copiar a lista de. Se selecciona unha referencia a filas e columnas, despois de premer no botón aparece a caixa de diálogo Copiar lista. Utilice esa caixa de diálogo para definir se a referencia se vai converter en listas de ordenación por fila ou por columna.
2e sc%3AEdit%3ARID_SCPAGE_USERLISTS%3AED_COPYFROM a4 Define a folla de cálculo e as celas que van copiarse para incluílas na caixa Listas. O intervalo predefinido é o seleccionado nese momento na folla de cálculo.
30 sc%3APushButton%3ARID_SCPAGE_USERLISTS%3ABTN_ADD 27 Engade unha nova lista á caixa Listas.
2e sc%3AListBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_USERLISTS%3ALB_LISTS 46 Mostra as listas dispoñíbeis, que poden seleccionarse para editalas.
25 sc%3AModalDialog%3ARID_SCDLG_COLORROW 3f Permite copiar as celas xa marcadas nunha lista de ordenación.
36 sc%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SCDLG_COLORROW%3ABTN_GROUP_COLS 5c Seleccione a opción Columnas para resumir nunha lista o contido das columnas seleccionadas.
36 sc%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SCDLG_COLORROW%3ABTN_GROUP_ROWS 56 Seleccione a opción Filas para resumir nunha lista o contido das filas seleccionadas.
2d sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_CALC%3ABTN_ITERATE b5 Especifica se as fórmulas con referencias iterativas (fórmulas que se repiten continuamente ata que o problema se resolve) se calculan tras un número específico de repeticións.
2a sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_CALC%3ABTN_CALC 145 Especifica se os cálculos deben realizarse cos valores arredondados que aparecen na folla de cálculo. As gráficas mostraranse cos valores visualizados. Se a opción Cálculo segundo o visualizado non foi marcada, os números exhibidos arredóndanse. Porén, internamente se calculan partindo dos números non arredondados.
2b sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_CALC%3ABTN_MATCH 14b Especifica que os criterios de busca definidos para as funcións de base de datos de Calc deben aplicarse de forma exacta a toda a cela. Cando a caixa Os criterios de busca = e <> deben ser aplicados a celas enteiras está marcada,  $[officename]  Calc compórtase igual que MS Excel ao buscar celas nas funcións de base de datos.
2d sc%3ANumericField%3ARID_SCPAGE_CALC%3AED_PREC b2 Define o número de decimais con que se mostrarán os números con formato numérico estándar . Os números móstranse como números arredondados, mais non se gardan como tales.
2c sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_CALC%3ABTN_LOOKUP ec Especifica que se pode utilizar o texto de calquera cela como etiqueta para a columna situada debaixo do texto ou para a fila situada á dereita do texto. O texto debe conter unha palabra como mínimo e non pode conter ningún operador.
2b sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_CALC%3ABTN_REGEX 68 Specifies that regular expressions are enabled when searching and also for character string comparisons.
30 sc%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SCPAGE_CALC%3ABTN_DATESTD 21 Define 30/12/1899 como día cero.
2a sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_CALC%3ABTN_CASE 74 Especifica se o aplicativo debe distinguir entre maiúsculas e minúsculas no texto, ao comparar o contido de celas.
31 sc%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SCPAGE_CALC%3ABTN_DATESC10 83 Define 1/1/1900 como día cero. Utilice esta configuración coas follas de cálculo de StarCalc 1.0 que conteñan entradas de data.
12 SC_HID_SCPAGE_CALC 32 Defines the calculation settings for spreadsheets.
31 sc%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SCPAGE_CALC%3ABTN_DATE1904 72 Define 1/1/1904 como día cero. Utilice esta configuración coas follas de cálculo importadas en formato externo.
32 sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_CALC%3ABTN_GENERAL_PREC dd You can specify the maximum number of decimal places that are shown by default for cells with General number format. If not enabled, cells with General number format show as many decimal places as the column width allows.
2e sc%3ANumericField%3ARID_SCPAGE_CALC%3AED_STEPS 30 Define o número máximo de pasos de iteración.
24 sc%3AEdit%3ARID_SCPAGE_CALC%3AED_EPS 9a Especifica a diferenza entre o resultado de dous pasos consecutivos dunha iteración. Se é inferior ao valor de modificación mínimo, a iteración para.
17 SC_HID_SCPAGE_OPREDLINE 6a A caixa de diálogo Cambios especifica varias opcións para realzar os cambios rexistrados nos documentos.
30 sc%3AListBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_OPREDLINE%3ACLB_REMOVE 4d Especifica a cor usada para realzar as eliminacións realizadas no documento.
2e sc%3AListBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_OPREDLINE%3ACLB_MOVE 3f Especifica a cor usada para realzar o contido de celas movidas.
31 sc%3AListBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_OPREDLINE%3ACLB_CONTENT 4e Especifica a cor usada para realzar os cambios realizados no contido de celas.
30 sc%3AListBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_OPREDLINE%3ACLB_INSERT 4b Especifica a cor usada para realzar as insercións realizadas no documento.
35 sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_PRINT%3ABTN_SKIPEMPTYPAGES 64 Especifica que non se imprimen as páxinas baleiras sen contido nas celas ou sen obxectos de debuxo.
35 sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCPAGE_PRINT%3ABTN_SELECTEDSHEETS 107 Especifica que só se imprime o contido das follas seleccionadas, mesmo cando se escolle un intervalo maior na caixa de diálogo Ficheiro - Imprimir ou na caixa de diálogo Formato - Intervalos de impresión. O contido das follas non seleccionadas non se imprime.
14 .uno%3ASdEditOptions ad Defines various settings for newly created presentation documents, such as the contents to be displayed, the measurement unit used, if and how grid alignment is carried out.
2f sd%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTIONS_CONTENTS%3ACBX_RULER 5b Especifica se as regras deben mostrarse na parte superior ou inferior da área de traballo.
36 sd%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTIONS_CONTENTS%3ACBX_MOVE_OUTLINE 42 %PRODUCTNAME mostra a liña de contorno de cada obxecto ao movelo.
16 SD_HID_SD_OPTIONS_VIEW 26 Specifies the available display modes.
38 sd%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTIONS_CONTENTS%3ACBX_HANDLES_BEZIER 104 Mostra os puntos de control de todos os puntos de Bézier se previamente seleccionou unha curva de Bézier. Se a opción Todos os puntos de control do editor Bézier non está marcada, só se visualizan os puntos de control dos puntos de Bézier seleccionados.
14 .uno%3AHelplinesMove 3c Especifica se as guías deben mostrarse ao mover un obxecto.
33 sd%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTIONS_CONTENTS%3ACBX_HELPLINES 3c Especifica se as guías deben mostrarse ao mover un obxecto.
1a SD_HID_SD_OPTIONS_CONTENTS 26 Specifies the available display modes.
33 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRID%3ACBX_SNAP_BORDER 61 Especifica se o contorno dun obxecto gráfico debe aliñarse coa marxe de páxina máis próxima.
30 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRID%3ACBX_BIGORTHO 167 Créase un cadrado, partindo do lado máis longo dun rectángulo, se a tecla Maiús é premida antes de soltar o botón do rato. Tamén é aplicábel a unha elipse (créase un círculo baseado no diámetro máis longo da elipse). Se a caixa Estender bordos non está seleccionada, créase un cadrado ou un círculo baseado no lado ou no diámetro máis curto.
34 svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRID%3AMTR_FLD_ANGLE 7c Specifies that graphic objects can only be rotated within the rotation angle that you selected in the When rotating control.
13 .uno%3AHelplinesUse 59 Axusta o bordo dun obxecto arrastrado á liña de axuste máis próxima ao soltar o rato.
11 .uno%3ASnapBorder 61 Especifica se o contorno dun obxecto gráfico debe aliñarse coa marxe de páxina máis próxima.
38 svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRID%3AMTR_FLD_SNAP_AREA cc Defines the snap distance between the mouse pointer and the object contour. $[officename] Impress snaps to a snap point if the mouse pointer is nearer than the distance selected in the Snap range control.
2e svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRID%3ACBX_ROTATE 7c Specifies that graphic objects can only be rotated within the rotation angle that you selected in the When rotating control.
33 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRID%3ACBX_SNAP_POINTS 61 Especifica se o contorno do obxecto debe aliñarse aos puntos do obxecto gráfico máis próximo.
38 svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRID%3AMTR_FLD_BEZ_ANGLE 31 Define o ángulo utilizado na redución de punto.
32 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRID%3ACBX_SNAP_FRAME 5f Especifica se o contorno do obxecto debe aliñarse ao bordo do obxecto gráfico máis próximo.
36 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRID%3ACBX_SNAP_HELPLINES 59 Axusta o bordo dun obxecto arrastrado á liña de axuste máis próxima ao soltar o rato.
10 .uno%3ASnapFrame 5f Especifica se o contorno do obxecto debe aliñarse ao bordo do obxecto gráfico máis próximo.
11 .uno%3ASnapPoints 61 Especifica se o contorno do obxecto debe aliñarse aos puntos do obxecto gráfico máis próximo.
2d svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRID%3ACBX_ORTHO 76 Especifica que os obxectos gráficos se restrinxen vertical, horizontal ou diagonalmente (45°) ao crealos ou movelos.
16 SD_HID_SD_OPTIONS_SNAP 3d Define a configuración da grade para crear e mover obxectos.
2f sd%3ARadioButton%3ATP_PRINT_OPTIONS%3ARBT_COLOR 33 Especifica que desexa imprimir nas cores orixinais.
2c sd%3ACheckBox%3ATP_PRINT_OPTIONS%3ACBX_FRONT 35 Seleccione Fronte para imprimir a fronte dun folleto.
33 sd%3ARadioButton%3ATP_PRINT_OPTIONS%3ARBT_GRAYSCALE 3e Especifica que desexa imprimir as cores como escala de grises.
33 SD%3ACHECKBOX%3ATP_PRINT_OPTIONS%3ACBX_HIDDEN_PAGES 44 Especifica se deben imprimirse as páxinas ocultas na presentación.
2f SD%3ACHECKBOX%3ATP_PRINT_OPTIONS%3ACBX_PAGENAME 3e Especifica se debe imprimirse o nome da páxina dun documento.
17 SD_HID_SD_PRINT_OPTIONS 5a Especifica a configuración de impresión dentro dun documento de debuxo ou presentación.
32 sd%3ARadioButton%3ATP_PRINT_OPTIONS%3ARBT_PAGETILE a8 Specifies that pages are to be printed in tiled format. If the pages or slides are smaller than the paper, several pages or slides will be printed on one page of paper.
31 sd%3ARadioButton%3ATP_PRINT_OPTIONS%3ARBT_DEFAULT 46 Especifica que non desexa modificar a escala das páxinas ao imprimir.
31 sd%3ARadioButton%3ATP_PRINT_OPTIONS%3ARBT_BOOKLET 4b Seleccione a opción Folleto para imprimir o documento en forma de folleto.
2b SD%3ACHECKBOX%3ATP_PRINT_OPTIONS%3ACBX_DATE 2c Especifica se debe imprimirse a data actual.
32 sd%3ARadioButton%3ATP_PRINT_OPTIONS%3ARBT_PAGESIZE 83 Especifica se os obxectos situados alén das marxes de impresión actual deben escalarse para que se axusten ao papel da impresora.
2b SD%3ACHECKBOX%3ATP_PRINT_OPTIONS%3ACBX_TIME 2c Especifica se debe imprimirse a hora actual.
2f sd%3ACheckBox%3ATP_PRINT_OPTIONS%3ACBX_PAPERBIN 55 Determina que debe usarse a bandexa de papel definida na configuración da impresora.
34 sd%3ARadioButton%3ATP_PRINT_OPTIONS%3ARBT_BLACKWHITE 3d Especifica que desexa imprimir o documento en branco e negro.
2b sd%3ACheckBox%3ATP_PRINT_OPTIONS%3ACBX_BACK 37 Seleccione Reverso para imprimir o reverso dun folleto.
34 sd%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTIONS_MISC%3ACB_MERGE_PARA_DIST 6f Especifica que $[officename] Impress calcule o espazamento do parágrafo exactamente como Microsoft PowerPoint.
2f sd%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTIONS_MISC%3ACBX_QUICKEDIT 6e If on, you can edit text immediately after clicking a text object. If off, you must double-click to edit text.
39 sd%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTIONS_MISC%3ACBX_CROOK_NO_CONTORTION 66 Mantén un aliñamento relativo entre os puntos de Bézier e os obxectos 2D ao distorsionar o obxecto.
36 sd%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTIONS_MISC%3ACBX_MASTERPAGE_CACHE 4e Especifica se a caché debe usarse para mostrar obxectos na páxina principal.
34 sd%3AMetricField%3ATP_OPTIONS_MISC%3AMTR_FLD_TABSTOP 2b Define o espazamento entre as tabulacións.
39 sd%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTIONS_MISC%3ACBX_START_WITH_TEMPLATE 6a Especifica se o asistente deber activarse ao abrir unha presentación con Ficheiro - Novo - Presentación.
31 sd%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTIONS_MISC%3ACBX_PICKTHROUGH 46 Especifica se debe seleccionarse un marco de texto ao premer no texto.
10 .uno%3AQuickEdit 6e If on, you can edit text immediately after clicking a text object. If off, you must double-click to edit text.
12 .uno%3APickThrough 46 Especifica se debe seleccionarse un marco de texto ao premer no texto.
3c sd%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTIONS_MISC%3ACBX_START_WITH_ACTUAL_PAGE 4a Especifica que a presentación debe comezar sempre coa dispositiva actual.
3d sd%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTIONS_MISC%3ACBX_MARKED_HIT_MOVES_ALWAYS bd Especifica que desexa mover un obxecto coa ferramenta Rotar activada. Se a opción Obxectos sempre desprazábeis non está marcada, a ferramenta Rotar só pode usarse para rotar un obxecto.
2a sd%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTIONS_MISC%3ACBX_COPY 69 If enabled, a copy is created when you move an object while holding down the Ctrl key (Mac: Command key).
2a sd%3AComboBox%3ATP_OPTIONS_MISC%3ACB_SCALE 28 Determina a escala do debuxo nas regras.
2a sd%3AListBox%3ATP_OPTIONS_MISC%3ALB_METRIC 32 Determina a unidade de medida para presentacións.
16 SD_HID_SD_OPTIONS_MISC 45 Define as opcións xerais para documentos de debuxo ou presentación.
17 .uno%3ASdGraphicOptions cb Define a configuración global para documentos de debuxo, incluíndo o contido que se debe mostrar, a escala que se debe usar, o aliñamento de grade e o contido que se vai imprimir de forma predefinida.
14 .uno%3ASmEditOptions 97 Defines the print format and print options for all new formula documents. These options apply when you print a formula directly from %PRODUCTNAME Math.
3d starmath%3ACheckBox%3ARID_PRINTOPTIONPAGE%3ACB_IGNORE_SPACING 60 Especifica que estes comodíns de espazo deben eliminarse cando se encontran na fin dunha liña.
16 SFX2_HID_PRINT_OPTIONS 46 Define a configuración de fórmulas válida para todos os documentos.
36 starmath%3AMetricField%3ARID_PRINTOPTIONPAGE%3AMF_ZOOM 56 Reduces or enlarges the size of the printed formula by a specified enlargement factor.
31 STARMATH_CHECKBOX_RID_PRINTOPTIONPAGE_CB_TITLEROW 40 Especifica se desexa incluír o nome do documento na impresión.
28 starmath%3ATabPage%3ARID_PRINTOPTIONPAGE 46 Define a configuración de fórmulas válida para todos os documentos.
d tobeannounced 49 Saves only those symbols with each formula that are used in that formula.
36 starmath%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PRINTOPTIONPAGE%3ARB_ZOOM 56 Reduces or enlarges the size of the printed formula by a specified enlargement factor.
3f starmath%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PRINTOPTIONPAGE%3ARB_ORIGINAL_SIZE 41 Imprime a fórmula sen axustar o tamaño de tipo de letra actual,
3c starmath%3ACheckBox%3ARID_PRINTOPTIONPAGE%3ACB_EQUATION_TEXT 59 Especifica se se debe incluír o contido da xanela Ordes na parte inferior da impresión.
2e STARMATH_CHECKBOX_RID_PRINTOPTIONPAGE_CB_FRAME 3a Applies a thin border to the formula area in the printout.
3d starmath%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PRINTOPTIONPAGE%3ARB_FIT_TO_PAGE 40 Axusta a fórmula ao formato de páxina utilizado na impresión.
41 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_OPTPAGE_CHART_DEFCOLORS%3ALB_CHART_COLOR_LIST 34 Mostra as cores dispoñíbeis para a serie de datos.
44 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_OPTPAGE_CHART_DEFCOLORS%3APB_RESET_TO_DEFAULT 41 Restaura a configuración de cor definida ao instalar o programa.
36 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_MSFILTEROPT%3ACB_PBAS_STG 120 Specifies that the original Microsoft Basic code contained in the document is held in a special internal memory for as long as the document remains loaded in $[officename]. When saving the document in Microsoft format the Microsoft Basic is saved again with the code in an unchanged form.
37 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_MSFILTEROPT%3ACB_WBAS_CODE db Carga e garda co documento o código Basic dun documento Microsoft como módulo especial de $[officename] Basic. O código desactivado de Microsoft Basic está visíbel no IDE de $[officename] Basic entre Sub e End Sub.
36 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_MSFILTEROPT%3ACB_WBAS_STG 120 Specifies that the original Microsoft Basic code contained in the document is held in a special internal memory for as long as the document remains loaded in $[officename]. When saving the document in Microsoft format the Microsoft Basic is saved again with the code in an unchanged form.
37 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_MSFILTEROPT%3ACB_PBAS_CODE db Carga e garda co documento o código Basic dun documento Microsoft como módulo especial de $[officename] Basic. O código desactivado de Microsoft Basic está visíbel no IDE de $[officename] Basic entre Sub e End Sub.
3a svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_MSFILTEROPT%3ACB_EBAS_EXECTBL bf The VBA (Visual Basic for Applications) code will be loaded ready to be executed. If this checkbox is not checked, the VBA code will be commented out so it can be inspected, but will not run.
36 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_MSFILTEROPT%3ACB_EBAS_STG 120 Specifies that the original Microsoft Basic code contained in the document is held in a special internal memory for as long as the document remains loaded in $[officename]. When saving the document in Microsoft format the Microsoft Basic is saved again with the code in an unchanged form.
37 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_MSFILTEROPT%3ACB_EBAS_CODE db Carga e garda co documento o código Basic dun documento Microsoft como módulo especial de $[officename] Basic. O código desactivado de Microsoft Basic está visíbel no IDE de $[officename] Basic entre Sub e End Sub.
1b CUI_HID_OFAPAGE_MSFLTR2_CLB ad The List Box field displays the entries for the pair of OLE objects that can be converted when loading into $[officename] (L) and/or when saving into a Microsoft format (S).
2f cui%3AListBox%3AOFA_TP_LANGUAGES%3ALB_WEST_LANG 63 Especifica o idioma utilizado para efectuar a verificación ortográfica con alfabetos occidentais.
37 cui%3ACheckBox%3AOFA_TP_LANGUAGES%3ACB_DECIMALSEPARATOR 7f Especifica o uso da tecla separadora de decimal definida no seu sistema ao premer na correspondente tecla do teclado numérico.
30 cui%3AListBox%3AOFA_TP_LANGUAGES%3ALB_ASIAN_LANG 62 Especifica o idioma utilizado para efectuar a verificación ortográfica con alfabetos asiáticos.
33 cui%3AListBox%3AOFA_TP_LANGUAGES%3ALB_LOCALESETTING 7b Specifies the locale setting of the country setting. This influences settings for numbering, currency and units of measure.
33 cui%3ACheckBox%3AOFA_TP_LANGUAGES%3ACB_ASIANSUPPORT 83 Activa o soporte para idiomas asiáticos. Agora pode modificar a configuración do idioma asiático correspondente en %PRODUCTNAME.
32 cui%3AListBox%3AOFA_TP_LANGUAGES%3ALB_COMPLEX_LANG 5f Especifica o idioma para a verificación ortográfica en idiomas con deseño de texto complexo.
33 cui%3AListBox%3AOFA_TP_LANGUAGES%3ALB_USERINTERFACE c3 Select the language used for the user interface, for example menus, dialogs, help files. You must have installed at least one additional language pack or a multi-language version of %PRODUCTNAME.
32 cui%3ACheckBox%3AOFA_TP_LANGUAGES%3ACB_CURRENT_DOC 5f Especifica que a configuración de idiomas predefinidos só é válida para o documento actual.
31 cui%3ACheckBox%3AOFA_TP_LANGUAGES%3ACB_CTLSUPPORT a1 Activa o soporte para idiomas con deseño de texto complexo. Agora pode modificar a configuración correspondente para deseño de texto complexo en %PRODUCTNAME.
2e cui%3AListBox%3AOFA_TP_LANGUAGES%3ALB_CURRENCY 5c Especifica a moeda que se usará para predefinir o formato monetario e os campos monetarios.
36 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ASIAN_LAYOUT%3ALB_LANGUAGE 4c Especifica o idioma para o cal desexa definir os caracteres de inicio e fin.
39 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ASIAN_LAYOUT%3ARB_NO_COMP 24 Especifica que non haxa compresión.
3c cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ASIAN_LAYOUT%3ARB_CHAR_PUNCT 62 Especifica que o entreletrado se aplica tanto en textos occidentais como á puntuación asiática.
37 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ASIAN_LAYOUT%3ACB_STANDARD 77 Ao marcar Predefinido, as seguintes dúas caixas de texto énchense cos caracteres predefinidos do idioma seleccionado:
41 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ASIAN_LAYOUT%3ARB_PUNCT_KANA_COMP 3c Especifica que a puntuación e o kana xaponés se comprimen.
30 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ASIAN_LAYOUT%3AED_START 48 Especifica os caracteres que non deben aparecer sós no inicio de liña.
3c cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ASIAN_LAYOUT%3ARB_PUNCT_COMP 2d Especifica que se comprima só a puntuación.
3e cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ASIAN_LAYOUT%3ARB_CHAR_KERNING 42 Especifica que o entreletrado só se aplica en textos occidentais.
2e cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ASIAN_LAYOUT%3AED_END 45 Especifica os caracteres que non deben aparecer sós na fin da liña.
44 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_JSEARCH_OPTIONS%3ACB_IGNORE_WHITESPACES 2d Especifica os caracteres que deben ignorarse.
43 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_JSEARCH_OPTIONS%3ACB_IGNORE_MIDDLE_DOT 2d Especifica os caracteres que deben ignorarse.
3d cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_JSEARCH_OPTIONS%3ACB_MATCH_IAIYA 42 Especifica as opcións que deben tratarse como iguais nunha busca.
47 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_JSEARCH_OPTIONS%3ACB_MATCH_FULL_HALF_WIDTH 42 Especifica as opcións que deben tratarse como iguais nunha busca.
47 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_JSEARCH_OPTIONS%3ACB_MATCH_TSITHICHI_DHIZI 42 Especifica as opcións que deben tratarse como iguais nunha busca.
41 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_JSEARCH_OPTIONS%3ACB_MATCH_DIZI_DUZU 42 Especifica as opcións que deben tratarse como iguais nunha busca.
45 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_JSEARCH_OPTIONS%3ACB_MATCH_HYUFYU_BYUVYU 42 Especifica as opcións que deben tratarse como iguais nunha busca.
4a cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_JSEARCH_OPTIONS%3ACB_MATCH_VARIANT_FORM_KANJI 42 Especifica as opcións que deben tratarse como iguais nunha busca.
44 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_JSEARCH_OPTIONS%3ACB_IGNORE_PUNCTUATION 2d Especifica os caracteres que deben ignorarse.
4b cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_JSEARCH_OPTIONS%3ACB_MATCH_PROLONGED_SOUNDMARK 42 Especifica as opcións que deben tratarse como iguais nunha busca.
46 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_JSEARCH_OPTIONS%3ACB_MATCH_OLD_KANA_FORMS 42 Especifica as opcións que deben tratarse como iguais nunha busca.
49 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_JSEARCH_OPTIONS%3ACB_MATCH_HIRAGANA_KATAKANA 42 Especifica as opcións que deben tratarse como iguais nunha busca.
3c cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_JSEARCH_OPTIONS%3ACB_MATCH_KIKU 42 Especifica as opcións que deben tratarse como iguais nunha busca.
41 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_JSEARCH_OPTIONS%3ACB_MATCH_BAVA_HAFA 42 Especifica as opcións que deben tratarse como iguais nunha busca.
44 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_JSEARCH_OPTIONS%3ACB_MATCH_CONTRACTIONS 42 Especifica as opcións que deben tratarse como iguais nunha busca.
42 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_JSEARCH_OPTIONS%3ACB_MATCH_SESHE_ZEJE 42 Especifica as opcións que deben tratarse como iguais nunha busca.
49 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_JSEARCH_OPTIONS%3ACB_MATCH_REPEAT_CHAR_MARKS 42 Especifica as opcións que deben tratarse como iguais nunha busca.
48 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_JSEARCH_OPTIONS%3ACB_MATCH_MINUS_DASH_CHOON 42 Especifica as opcións que deben tratarse como iguais nunha busca.
3c cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_JSEARCH_OPTIONS%3ACB_MATCH_CASE 42 Especifica as opcións que deben tratarse como iguais nunha busca.
3e cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_OPTIONS_CTL%3ACB_SEQUENCECHECKING 4e Activa a verificación da secuencia de entrada para idiomas como o tailandés.
40 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_OPTIONS_CTL%3ARB_MOVEMENT_VISUAL 9b Premendo a frecha cara á dereita móvese o cursor do texto cara á dereita. Premendo a frecha cara á esquerda móvese o cursor do texto cara á esquerda.
41 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_OPTIONS_CTL%3ARB_MOVEMENT_LOGICAL b8 Premendo na frecha cara á dereita móvese o cursor do texto cara ao final do texto actual. Premendo a frecha cara á esquerda móvese o cursor do texto cara ao comezo do texto actual.
35 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_OPTIONS_CTL%3ALB_NUMERALS d1 Selecciona o tipo de numerais utilizados no texto, nos textos incorporados a obxectos, nos campos e nos controis en todos os módulos de %PRODUCTNAME. Isto non afecta ao contido das celas de %PRODUCTNAME Calc.
3f cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_CONNPOOLOPTIONS%3ACB_DRIVERPOOLING 8d Seleccione un controlador da lista e marque a caixa de verificación Activar agrupamento para este controlador para agrupar a súa conexión.
3c cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_CONNPOOLOPTIONS%3ACB_POOL_CONNS 37 Especifica se deben agruparse as conexións escollidas.
24 DBACCESS_HID_DSBROWSER_DISCONNECTING 37 Especifica se deben agruparse as conexións escollidas.
3d cui%3ANumericField%3ARID_OFAPAGE_CONNPOOLOPTIONS%3ANF_TIMEOUT 50 Define o tempo en segundos que se debe esperar ata que se libera unha conexión.
34 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SFXPAGE_DBREGISTER%3ABTN_EDIT 56 Abre a caixa de diálogo Ligazón de base de datos para editar a entrada seleccionada.
36 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SFXPAGE_DBREGISTER%3ABTN_DELETE 28 Elimina da lista a entrada seleccionada.
33 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SFXPAGE_DBREGISTER%3ABTN_NEW 50 Abre a caixa de diálogo Ligazón de base de datos para crear unha nova entrada.
17 CUI_HID_DBPATH_CTL_PATH 81 Lista o ficheiro de base de datos e o nome rexistrado das bases de datos rexistradas. Prema dúas veces para editar unha entrada.
33 cui%3APushButton%3ADLG_DOCUMENTLINK%3APB_BROWSEFILE 5b Abre unha caixa de diálogo de ficheiros onde pode seleccionar o ficheiro de base de datos.
27 cui%3AEdit%3ADLG_DOCUMENTLINK%3AET_NAME 5d Insira un nome para a base de datos. %PRODUCTNAME usa ese nome para acceder á base de datos.
3a cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_OPTIONS_JAVA%3APB_PARAMETER 37 Abre a caixa de diálogo Parámetros de inicio de Java.
34 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_OPTIONS_JAVA%3APB_ADD 3a Engada un camiño ao cartafol raíz dun JRE no computador.
3a cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_OPTIONS_JAVA%3APB_CLASSPATH 2a Abre a caixa de diálogo Camiño de clase.
19 CUI_HID_OPTIONS_JAVA_LIST b7 Select the JRE that you want to use. On some systems, you must wait a minute until the list gets populated. On some systems, you must restart %PRODUCTNAME to use your changed setting.
3a cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_OPTIONS_JAVA%3ACB_JAVA_ENABLE 34 Allows you to run Java applications in %PRODUCTNAME.
39 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_JAVA_CLASSPATH%3APB_ADDPATH 36 Seleccione un cartafol e engádao ao camiño de clase.
33 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_JAVA_CLASSPATH%3ALB_PATH 42 Especifica a localización de clases e bibliotecas de clases Java.
3d cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_JAVA_CLASSPATH%3APB_REMOVE_PATH 6c Seleccione un ficheiro ou cartafol na lista e prema en Eliminar para eliminar o obxecto do camiño de clase.
3c cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_JAVA_CLASSPATH%3APB_ADDARCHIVE 55 Seleccione un ficheiro de datos en formato jar ou zip e engádao ao camiño de clase.
38 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_JAVA_PARAMETER%3APB_REMOVE 33 Elimina o parámetro de inicio de JRE seleccionado.
38 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_JAVA_PARAMETER%3APB_ASSIGN 35 Engade o parámetro de inicio de JRE actual á lista.
35 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXDLG_JAVA_PARAMETER%3AED_PARAMETER bd Introduza un parámetro de inicio para un JRE da mesma forma que o faría nunha liña de ordes. Prema en Atribuír para engadir o parámetro á lista de parámetros de inicio dispoñíbeis.
37 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_JAVA_PARAMETER%3ALB_ASSIGNED 7b Lista os parámetros de inicio de JRE atribuídos. Para eliminar un parámetro de inicio, seleccióneo e prema en Eliminar.
3a xmlsecurity%3ARadioButton%3ARID_XMLSECTP_SECLEVEL%3ARB_LOW db A macro pode configurarse para un comezo automático e, pode realizar accións potencialmente daniñas como eliminar ou renomear ficheiros. Non é recomendábel esta configuración ao abrir documentos de outros autores.
3d xmlsecurity%3ARadioButton%3ARID_XMLSECTP_SECLEVEL%3ARB_MEDIUM 134 As localizacións de ficheiros fiábeis poden definirse no separador Fontes fiábeis. Poden executarse as macros procedentes de fontes fiábeis. Alén diso, pódese executar calquera macro que proceda dunha localización de ficheiro fiábel. Con todas as demais macros é preciso fornecer unha confirmación.
3f xmlsecurity%3ARadioButton%3ARID_XMLSECTP_SECLEVEL%3ARB_VERYHIGH 92 As localizacións de ficheiros fiábeis poden definirse no separador Fontes fiábeis. As macros desas localizacións teñen permiso de execución.
3b xmlsecurity%3ARadioButton%3ARID_XMLSECTP_SECLEVEL%3ARB_HIGH 101 As localizacións de ficheiros fiábeis poden definirse no separador Fontes fiábeis. Só as macros asinadas das fontes fiábeis teñen permiso de execución. Alén diso, todas as macros das localizacións fiábeis de ficheiros teñen permiso de execución.
4a xmlsecurity%3APushButton%3ARID_XMLSECTP_TRUSTSOURCES%3APB_REMOVE_TRUSTCERT 45 Elimina o certificado seleccionado da lista de certificados fiábeis.
48 xmlsecurity%3APushButton%3ARID_XMLSECTP_TRUSTSOURCES%3APB_VIEW_TRUSTCERT 49 Abre a caixa de diálogo Ver certificado para o certificado seleccionado.
4d xmlsecurity%3APushButton%3ARID_XMLSECTP_TRUSTSOURCES%3AFL_REMOVE_TRUSTFILELOC 51 Elimina o cartafol seleccionado da lista de localizacións fiábeis de ficheiros.
43 xmlsecurity%3AListBox%3ARID_XMLSECTP_TRUSTSOURCES%3ALB_TRUSTFILELOC 5f Document macros are only executed if they have been opened from one of the following locations.
4a xmlsecurity%3APushButton%3ARID_XMLSECTP_TRUSTSOURCES%3AFL_ADD_TRUSTFILELOC 7f Abre unha caixa de diálogo de selección de cartafoles. Seleccione un cartafol desde o que se poidan executar todas as macros.
28 XMLSECURITY_HID_XMLSEC_CTRL_TRUSTSOURCES 1f Lista os certificados fiábeis.
2b sw%3ANumericField%3ATP_MAILCONFIG%3ANF_PORT 17 Introduza o porto SMTP.
33 sw%3APushButton%3ATP_MAILCONFIG%3APB_AUTHENTICATION a4 Abre a caixa de diálogo Autenticación de servidor, onde vostede pode especificar a configuración de autenticación do servidor para o correo electrónico seguro.
2a sw%3ACheckBox%3ATP_MAILCONFIG%3ACB_REPLYTO 85 Usa o enderezo de correo electrónico que introduciu na caixa de texto Enderezo de resposta como o enderezo ao que se debe responder.
23 SW_CHECKBOX_TP_MAILCONFIG_CB_SECURE 5a Cando está dispoñíbel, utiliza unha conexión segura para enviar correos electrónicos.
29 sw%3APushButton%3ATP_MAILCONFIG%3APB_TEST 5c Abre a caixa de diálogo Probar configuración da conta para probar a configuración actual.
26 sw%3AEdit%3ATP_MAILCONFIG%3AED_ADDRESS 42 Introduza o seu enderezo de correo electrónico para as respostas.
2a sw%3AEdit%3ATP_MAILCONFIG%3AED_DISPLAYNAME 15 Introduza o seu nome.
25 sw%3AEdit%3ATP_MAILCONFIG%3AED_SERVER 22 Introduza o nome do servidor SMTP.
26 sw%3AEdit%3ATP_MAILCONFIG%3AED_REPLYTO 46 Insira o enderezo que desexa usar para o envio de e-mails de resposta.
3c cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ONLINEUPDATE%3ARB_EVERYMONTH 29 A verificación efectuarase mensualmente.
38 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ONLINEUPDATE%3ACB_AUTOCHECK 82 Mark to check for online updates periodically, then select the time interval how often %PRODUCTNAME will check for online updates.
39 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ONLINEUPDATE%3APB_CHECKNOW 22 A verificación efectuarase agora.
3a cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ONLINEUPDATE%3ARB_EVERYDAY 27 A verificación efectúase diariamente.
3b cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_ONLINEUPDATE%3ARB_EVERYWEEK 48 A verificación efectuarase semanalmente. Esta é a opción predefinida.
33 sw%3AEdit%3ADLG_MM_SERVERAUTHENTICATION%3AED_SERVER 41 Introduza o nome do servidor de mensaxes de correo POP 3 ou IMAP.
46 sw%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_MM_SERVERAUTHENTICATION%3ARB_SEP_AUTHENTICATION 55 Seleccione esta opción se o servidor SMTP esixe un nome de usuario e un contrasinal.
38 sw%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_MM_SERVERAUTHENTICATION%3ARB_IMAP 38 Especifica que o servidor de entrada de correo usa IMAP.
39 sw%3ANumericField%3ADLG_MM_SERVERAUTHENTICATION%3ANF_PORT 2b Introduza o porto no servidor POP3 ou IMAP.
3f sw%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_MM_SERVERAUTHENTICATION%3ACB_AUTHENTICATION 4d Activa a autenticación necesaria para enviar correos electrónicos por SMTP.
35 sw%3AEdit%3ADLG_MM_SERVERAUTHENTICATION%3AED_USERNAME 31 Introduza o nome de usuario para o servidor SMTP.
38 sw%3AEdit%3ADLG_MM_SERVERAUTHENTICATION%3AED_OUTPASSWORD 2f Introduza o contrasinal para o nome de usuario.
38 sw%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_MM_SERVERAUTHENTICATION%3ARB_POP3 39 Especifica que o servidor de entrada de correo usa POP 3.
37 sw%3AEdit%3ADLG_MM_SERVERAUTHENTICATION%3AED_INUSERNAME 31 Introduza o nome de usuario para o servidor IMAP.
37 sw%3AEdit%3ADLG_MM_SERVERAUTHENTICATION%3AED_INPASSWORD 18 Introduza o contrasinal.
40 sw%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_MM_SERVERAUTHENTICATION%3ARB_SMPTAFTERPOP 54 Seleccione se para enviar correos electrónicos é necesario ler antes os recibidos.
3a sw%3AMultiLineEdit%3ADLG_MM_TESTACCOUNTSETTINGS%3AED_ERROR 6b Na caixa de lista Erros pode ler unha explicación dos erros encontrados durante a proba da configuración.
21 SW_HID_MM_TESTACCOUNTSETTINGS_TLB 43 Na caixa de lista superior verá os resultados da sesión de proba.
36 sw%3APushButton%3ADLG_MM_TESTACCOUNTSETTINGS%3APB_STOP 49 Prema no botón Parar para interromper manualmente unha sesión de proba.
2a XMLSECURITY_HID_XMLSEC_CTRL_VIEWSIGNATURES 77 A páxina Camiño do certificado da caixa de diálogo Ver certificado exhibe a localización e o estado do certificado.
22 XMLSECURITY_HID_XMLSEC_TP_CERTPATH 77 A páxina Camiño do certificado da caixa de diálogo Ver certificado exhibe a localización e o estado do certificado.
43 xmlsecurity%3AMultiLineEdit%3ARID_XMLSECTP_CERTPATH%3AML_CERTSTATUS 77 A páxina Camiño do certificado da caixa de diálogo Ver certificado exhibe a localización e o estado do certificado.
3f xmlsecurity%3AMultiLineEdit%3ARID_XMLSECTP_DETAILS%3AML_ELEMENT 52 Use a caixa lista de valores para visualizar os valores e copialos no portapapeis.
21 XMLSECURITY_HID_XMLSEC_TP_DETAILS 6a A páxina Detalles da caixa de diálogo Ver certificado mostra información detallada sobre o certificado.
24 XMLSECURITY_HID_XMLSEC_CTRL_ELEMENTS 6a A páxina Detalles da caixa de diálogo Ver certificado mostra información detallada sobre o certificado.
21 XMLSECURITY_HID_XMLSEC_TP_GENERAL 65 A páxina Xeral da caixa de diálogo Ver certificado mostra información básica sobre o certificado.
22 CHART2_HID_SCH_TBI_DATA_INSERT_ROW 23 Insire unha fila debaixo da actual.
20 CHART2_HID_SCH_TBI_DATA_SWAP_COL 30 Alterna a fila actual coa adxacente por debaixo.
27 CHART2_HID_SCH_TBI_DATA_INSERT_TEXT_COL 56 Inserts a new text column after the current column for hierarchical axes descriptions.
22 CHART2_HID_SCH_TBI_DATA_DELETE_COL 49 Elimina a columna actual. Non é posíbel eliminar a columna da etiqueta.
20 CHART2_HID_SCH_DATA_SERIES_LABEL 29 Introducir nomes para as series de datos.
12 .uno%3ADiagramData 4f Abre a caixa de diálogo Táboa de datos onde pode editar os datos da gráfica.
20 CHART2_HID_SCH_TBI_DATA_SWAP_ROW 30 Alterna a fila actual coa adxacente por debaixo.
22 CHART2_HID_SCH_TBI_DATA_DELETE_ROW 43 Elimina a fila actual. Non é posíbel eliminar a fila da etiqueta.
22 CHART2_HID_SCH_TBI_DATA_INSERT_COL 26 Insire unha columna despois da actual.
16 .uno%3AToggleAxisTitle 6d Prema en Activar/Desativar título do eixo na barra Formatado para mostrar ou ocultar as etiquetas dos eixos.
12 .uno%3AToggleTitle 68 Prema en Activar/Desactivar título na barra Formatado para mostrar ou ocultar o título e o subtítulo.
17 .uno%3AInsertMenuTitles 38 Opens a dialog to enter or modify the titles in a chart.
1e CHART2_HID_SCH_LEGEND_POS_LEFT 2d Coloca a lenda na parte esquerda da gráfica.
17 .uno%3AInsertMenuLegend 89 Opens the Legend dialog, which allows you to change the position of legends in the chart, and to specify whether the legend is displayed.
1d CHART2_HID_SCH_LEGEND_POS_TOP 2d Coloca a lenda na parte superior da gráfica.
34 chart2%3AListBox%3ATP_LEGEND_POS%3ALB_LEGEND_TEXTDIR 99 Specify the text direction for a paragraph that uses complex text layout (CTL). This feature is only available if complex text layout support is enabled.
13 .uno%3AToggleLegend 56 Para mostrar ou ocultar a lenda, prema en Activar/Desactivar lenda na barra Formatado.
20 CHART2_HID_SCH_LEGEND_POS_BOTTOM 2d Coloca a lenda na parte inferior da gráfica.
1f CHART2_HID_SCH_LEGEND_POS_RIGHT 2c Coloca a lenda na parte dereita da gráfica.
22 CHART2_HID_SCH_DATALABEL_PLACEMENT 3d Selects the placement of data labels relative to the objects.
20 CHART2_HID_SCH_DATALABEL_PERCENT 38 Mostra a porcentaxe dos puntos de datos en cada columna.
26 CHART2_HID_SCH_DATALABEL_ROTATION_KNOB 42 Click in the dial to set the text orientation for the data labels.
1f CHART2_HID_SCH_DATALABEL_NUMBER 30 Mostra os valores absolutos dos puntos de datos.
1e CHART2_HID_SCH_DATALABEL_VALUE 30 Mostra os valores absolutos dos puntos de datos.
26 CHART2_HID_SCH_DATALABEL_ROTATION_EDIT 3e Enter the counterclockwise rotation angle for the data labels.
1f CHART2_HID_SCH_DATALABEL_SYMBOL 42 Mostra as iconas de lenda xunto a cada etiqueta de punto de datos.
1e CHART2_HID_SCH_PB_NUMBERFORMAT 2b Opens a dialog to select the number format.
1c CHART2_HID_SCH_TEXTDIRECTION 99 Specify the text direction for a paragraph that uses complex text layout (CTL). This feature is only available if complex text layout support is enabled.
26 CHART2_HID_SCH_PB_PERCENT_NUMBERFORMAT 2f Opens a dialog to select the percentage format.
1b .uno%3AInsertMenuDataLabels 47 Opens the Data Labels dialog, which enables you to set the data labels.
1d CHART2_HID_SCH_DATALABEL_TEXT 2f Mostra as etiquetas de texto do punto de datos.
22 CHART2_HID_SCH_DATALABEL_SEPARATOR 48 Selects the separator between multiple text strings for the same object.
17 CHART2_HID_SCH_CB_XAXIS 30 Displays the X axis as a line with subdivisions.
17 CHART2_HID_SCH_CB_YAXIS 34 Mostra o eixo Y en forma de liña con subdivisións.
17 CHART2_HID_SCH_CB_ZAXIS 34 Mostra o eixo Z en forma de liña con subdivisións.
21 CHART2_HID_SCH_CB_SECONDARY_XAXIS 28 Mostra un eixo X secundario na gráfica.
21 CHART2_HID_SCH_CB_SECONDARY_YAXIS 28 Mostra un eixo Y secundario na gráfica.
15 .uno%3AInsertMenuAxes 30 Specifies the axes to be displayed in the chart.
21 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_FUNCTION 2e Select a function to calculate the error bars.
1e CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_SIGMA 52 Standard Deviation: Displays the standard deviation (square root of the variance).
1a CHART2_HID_SCH_CT_INDICATE 1e Specifies the error indicator.
27 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_NEGATIVE_VALUE 51 Enter the value to subtract from the displayed value as the negative error value.
20 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_VARIANT 60 Variance: Displays the variance calculated from the number of data points and respective values.
20 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_PERCENT 75 Displays a percentage. The display refers to the corresponding data point. Set the percentage in the Parameters area.
26 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_SHOW_NEGATIVE 1f Shows only negative error bars.
23 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_CONSTERROR 41 Displays constant values that you specify in the Parameters area.
22 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_SHOW_BOTH 27 Shows positive and negative error bars.
23 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_PLUS_VALUE 41 Displays constant values that you specify in the Parameters area.
26 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_SHOW_POSITIVE 1f Shows only positive error bars.
27 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_NEGATIVE_RANGE 7c Enter the address range from where to get the negative error values. Use the Shrink button to select the range from a sheet.
1e CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_RANGE 6d Click Cell Range and then specify a cell range from which to take the positive and negative error bar values.
2f CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_POSITIVE_RANGE_CHOOSER 9f Click a button to shrink the dialog, then use the mouse to select the cell range in the spreadsheet. Click the button again to restore the dialog to full size.
27 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_POSITIVE_RANGE 7c Enter the address range from where to get the positive error values. Use the Shrink button to select the range from a sheet.
27 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_POSITIVE_VALUE 4a Enter the value to add to the displayed value as the positive error value.
27 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_BIGERROR_VALUE 97 Error Margin: Displays the highest error margin in percent according to the highest value of the data group. Set the percentage in the Parameters area.
21 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_NO_ERROR 1d Does not show any error bars.
26 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_PERCENT_VALUE 75 Displays a percentage. The display refers to the corresponding data point. Set the percentage in the Parameters area.
26 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_SAME_FOR_BOTH be Enable to use the positive error values also as negative error values. You can only change the value of the "Positve (+)" box. That value gets copied to the "Negative (-)" box automatically.
24 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_FUNCTION_LB 2e Select a function to calculate the error bars.
2f CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_NEGATIVE_RANGE_CHOOSER 9f Click a button to shrink the dialog, then use the mouse to select the cell range in the spreadsheet. Click the button again to restore the dialog to full size.
21 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_BIGERROR 97 Error Margin: Displays the highest error margin in percent according to the highest value of the data group. Set the percentage in the Parameters area.
24 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_MINUS_VALUE 41 Displays constant values that you specify in the Parameters area.
1b .uno%3AInsertMenuYErrorBars 40 Use the Y Error Bars dialog to display error bars for 2D charts.
1e .uno%3AInsertTrendlineEquation 91 To show the trend line equation, select the trend line in the chart, right-click to open the context menu, and choose Insert Trend Line Equation.
27 CHART2_HID_SCH_TRENDLINE_RB_LOGARITHMIC 16 Definir a resolución.
20 CHART2_HID_SCH_TRENDLINE_RB_NONE 16 Definir a resolución.
22 CHART2_HID_SCH_TRENDLINE_RB_LINEAR 16 Definir a resolución.
26 CHART2_HID_SCH_TRENDLINE_SHOW_EQUATION 35 Shows the trend line equation next to the trend line.
1b .uno%3AInsertMenuTrendlines 4f Trend lines can be added to all 2D chart types except for Pie and Stock charts.
27 CHART2_HID_SCH_TRENDLINE_SHOW_R_SQUARED 3e Shows the coefficient of determination next to the trend line.
21 CHART2_HID_SCH_TRENDLINE_RB_POWER 16 Definir a resolución.
27 CHART2_HID_SCH_TRENDLINE_RB_EXPONENTIAL 16 Definir a resolución.
1b .uno%3AInsertMenuMeanValues 8c Mean Value Lines are special trend lines that show the mean value. Use Insert - Mean Value Lines to insert mean value lines for data series.
31 chart2%3ARadioButton%3ATP_OPTIONS%3ARB_DONT_PAINT 67 For a missing value, no data will be shown. This is the default for chart types Column, Bar, Line, Net.
32 chart2%3ARadioButton%3ATP_OPTIONS%3ARBT_OPT_AXIS_2 9d Modifica a escala do eixo Y. Este eixo só é visíbel se ten polo menos unha serie de datos atribuída e se o modo de visualización do eixo está activado.
2a chart2%3AMetricField%3ATP_OPTIONS%3AMT_GAP 37 Define, en porcentaxe, o espazamento entre as columnas.
2e chart2%3AMetricField%3ATP_OPTIONS%3AMT_OVERLAP 40 Define a configuración necesaria para sobrepor series de datos.
22 CHART2_HID_SCH_STARTING_ANGLE_DIAL 151 Drag the small dot along the circle or click any position on the circle to set the starting angle of a pie or donut chart. The starting angle is the mathematical angle position where the first piece is drawn. The value of 90 degrees draws the first piece at the 12 o'clock position. A value of 0 degrees starts at the 3 o'clock position.
35 chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTIONS%3ACB_BARS_SIDE_BY_SIDE 58 The bars from different data series are shown as if they were attached only to one axis.
34 chart2%3ARadioButton%3ATP_OPTIONS%3ARB_CONTINUE_LINE 75 For a missing value, the interpolation from the neighbor values will be shown. This is the default for chart type XY.
32 chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_POLAROPTIONS%3ACB_CLOCKWISE ab The default direction in which the pieces of a pie chart are ordered is counterclockwise. Enable the Clockwise direction checkbox to draw the pieces in opposite direction.
2d chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTIONS%3ACB_CONNECTOR a3 Nas gráficas de columnas "amontoadas" e "porcentuais" (barra vertical), marque esta caixa de verificación para conectar as capas de columna asociadas ás liñas.
32 chart2%3ARadioButton%3ATP_OPTIONS%3ARB_ASSUME_ZERO 60 For a missing value, the y-value will be shown as zero. This is the default for chart type Area.
32 chart2%3ARadioButton%3ATP_OPTIONS%3ARBT_OPT_AXIS_1 6a Esta opción está activada como predefinida.Todas as series de datos están aliñadas no eixo Y primario.
38 chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTIONS%3ACB_INCLUDE_HIDDEN_CELLS 51 Check to also show values of currently hidden cells within the source cell range.
3b chart2%3ANumericField%3ATP_POLAROPTIONS%3ANF_STARTING_ANGLE 70 Enter the starting angle between 0 and 359 degrees. You can also click the arrows to change the displayed value.
21 CHART2_HID_SCH_CB_SECONDARY_ZGRID 48 Engade liñas de grade que dividen o eixo Z en seccións máis pequenas.
1b .uno%3AToggleGridHorizontal e4 A icona Activar/Desactivar grade horizontal da barra Formatación alterna a visualización da grade mostrando o eixo X. Nota: Só funciona se se limpan as caixas de verificación de Grade secundaria situadas en Inserir - Grades.
19 .uno%3AToggleGridVertical dd A icona Activar/Desactivar Grade vertical da barra de ferramentas Formatación alterna a visualización da grade para o eixo Y. Nota: Só funciona se a grade secundariado eixo X non está seleccionada en Inserir - Grades.
21 CHART2_HID_SCH_CB_SECONDARY_YGRID 48 Engade liñas de grade que dividen o eixo Y en seccións máis pequenas.
16 .uno%3AInsertMenuGrids ad You can divide the axes into sections by assigning gridlines to them. This allows you to get a better overview of the chart, especially if you are working with large charts.
21 CHART2_HID_SCH_CB_SECONDARY_XGRID 48 Agrega liñas de grade que dividen o eixo X en seccións máis pequenas.
16 .uno%3AFormatSelection 1c Formats the selected object.
16 .uno%3ASecondaryYTitle 30 Modifica as propiedades do título seleccionado.
d .uno%3AZTitle 30 Modifica as propiedades do título seleccionado.
d .uno%3AXTitle 30 Modifica as propiedades do título seleccionado.
16 .uno%3ASecondaryXTitle 30 Modifica as propiedades do título seleccionado.
f .uno%3ASubTitle 30 Modifica as propiedades do título seleccionado.
10 .uno%3AMainTitle 30 Modifica as propiedades do título seleccionado.
d .uno%3AYTitle 5e Modifica as propiedades do título seleccionado ou as propiedades de todos os títulos xuntos.
10 .uno%3AAllTitles 5e Modifica as propiedades do título seleccionado ou as propiedades de todos os títulos xuntos.
25 CHART2_HID_SCH_TEXTDIRECTION_EQUATION 99 Specify the text direction for a paragraph that uses complex text layout (CTL). This feature is only available if complex text layout support is enabled.
22 CHART2_HID_SCH_TEXTDIRECTION_TITLE 99 Specify the text direction for a paragraph that uses complex text layout (CTL). This feature is only available if complex text layout support is enabled.
3d chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_AXIS_LABEL%3ACB_AXIS_LABEL_TEXTOVERLAP 40 Especifica que o texto das celas pode sobreporse a outras celas.
3b chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_AXIS_LABEL%3ACB_AXIS_LABEL_TEXTBREAK 1d Permite unha quebra de texto.
3b chart2%3ARadioButton%3ATP_AXIS_LABEL%3ARB_AXIS_LABEL_DOWNUP 4f Dispón os números nos eixos, cos números impares debaixo dos números pares.
3e chart2%3ARadioButton%3ATP_AXIS_LABEL%3ARB_AXIS_LABEL_AUTOORDER 2c Dispón automaticamente os números no eixo.
32 chart2%3AListBox%3ATP_AXIS_LABEL%3ALB_AXIS_TEXTDIR 99 Specify the text direction for a paragraph that uses complex text layout (CTL). This feature is only available if complex text layout support is enabled.
20 CHART2_HID_SCH_ALIGNMENT_STACKED 42 Atribúe unha orientación de texto vertical aos contidos da cela.
16 .uno%3AToggleAxisDescr 7f A icona Activar/desactivar título do eixo da barra de ferramentas Formatado activa e desactiva a etiquetaxe de todos os eixos.
3b chart2%3ARadioButton%3ATP_AXIS_LABEL%3ARB_AXIS_LABEL_UPDOWN 4d Dispón os números no eixo, cos números pares debaixo dos números impares.
20 CHART2_HID_SCH_ALIGNMENT_DEGREES 36 Permite inserir manualmente o ángulo de orientación.
2c CHART2_LISTBOX_TP_AXIS_LABEL_LB_AXIS_TEXTDIR 99 Specify the text direction for a paragraph that uses complex text layout (CTL). This feature is only available if complex text layout support is enabled.
3d chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_AXIS_LABEL%3ACB_AXIS_LABEL_SCHOW_DESCR 42 Especifica se as etiquetas dos eixos deben mostrarse ou ocultarse.
21 CHART2_HID_SCH_ALIGNMENT_CTR_DIAL 53 A variábel de orientación de texto defínese ao premer en calquera lugar da roda.
3f chart2%3ARadioButton%3ATP_AXIS_LABEL%3ARB_AXIS_LABEL_SIDEBYSIDE 33 Coloca os números no eixo, uns ao lado dos outros.
d .uno%3ALegend 41 Define os atributos de bordo, de área e de carácter das lendas.
13 .uno%3ADiagramAxisB ab Abre unha caixa de diálogo na cal é posíbel editar as propiedades do  eixo Y secundario. Para inserir un eixo Y secundario, escolla Inserir - Eixos e seleccione Eixo Y.
13 .uno%3ADiagramAxisA aa Abre unha caixa de diálogo na cal é posíbel editar as propiedades do eixo X secundario. Para inserir un eixo X secundario, escolla Inserir - Eixos e seleccione Eixo X.
13 .uno%3ADiagramAxisZ 47 Opens a dialog, where you can edit the properties of the selected axis.
15 .uno%3ADiagramAxisAll 47 Opens a dialog, where you can edit the properties of the selected axis.
13 .uno%3ADiagramAxisX 47 Opens a dialog, where you can edit the properties of the selected axis.
13 .uno%3ADiagramAxisY 3c Opens the Y Axis dialog, to change properties of the Y axis.
38 chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_SCALE%3ACBX_REVERSE_MayBeDateAxis 81 Defines where the lower and where the higher values are displayed at the axis. The unchecked state is the mathematical direction.
36 chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_SCALE%3ACBX_REVERSE%3AValueAxis 81 Defines where the lower and where the higher values are displayed at the axis. The unchecked state is the mathematical direction.
24 CHART2_SPINFIELD_TP_SCALE_EDT_ORIGIN 41 Specifies at which position to display the values along the axis.
2d chart2%3ASpinField%3ATP_SCALE%3AEDT_STEP_MAIN 37 Defines the interval for the main division of the axes.
35 chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_SCALE%3ACBX_REVERSE%3ACategory 81 Defines where the lower and where the higher values are displayed at the axis. The unchecked state is the mathematical direction.
37 chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_SCALE%3ACBX_AUTO_TIME_RESOLUTION 4b You must first deselect the Automatic option in order to modify the values.
2d chart2%3AMetricField%3ATP_SCALE%3AMT_STEPHELP 35 Defines the interval for the subdivision of the axes.
2f chart2%3AListBox%3ATP_SCALE%3ALB_HELP_TIME_UNIT 4d Minor interval can be set to show a certain number of days, months, or years.
27 chart2%3ASpinField%3ATP_SCALE%3AEDT_MIN 38 Defines the minimum value for the beginning of the axis.
31 chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_SCALE%3ACBX_AUTO_STEP_HELP 4b You must first deselect the Automatic option in order to modify the values.
2a chart2%3ASpinField%3ATP_SCALE%3AEDT_ORIGIN 41 Specifies at which position to display the values along the axis.
27 chart2%3ASpinField%3ATP_SCALE%3AEDT_MAX 32 Defines the maximum value for the end of the axis.
2f chart2%3AListBox%3ATP_SCALE%3ALB_MAIN_TIME_UNIT 4d Major interval can be set to show a certain number of days, months, or years.
31 chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_SCALE%3ACBX_AUTO_STEP_MAIN 4b You must first deselect the Automatic option in order to modify the values.
2b chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_SCALE%3ACBX_AUTO_MIN 4b You must first deselect the Automatic option in order to modify the values.
30 chart2%3AListBox%3ATP_SCALE%3ALB_TIME_RESOLUTION 47 Resolution can be set to show days, months, or years as interval steps.
2b chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_SCALE%3ACBX_AUTO_MAX 4b You must first deselect the Automatic option in order to modify the values.
2c chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_SCALE%3ACBX_LOGARITHM 42 Specifies that you want the axis to be subdivided logarithmically.
28 CHART2_CHECKBOX_TP_SCALE_CBX_AUTO_ORIGIN 4b You must first deselect the Automatic option in order to modify the values.
2e chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_SCALE%3ACBX_AUTO_ORIGIN 4b You must first deselect the Automatic option in order to modify the values.
33 chart2%3AMetricField%3ATP_SCALE%3AMT_MAIN_DATE_STEP 4d Major interval can be set to show a certain number of days, months, or years.
2a chart2%3AListBox%3ATP_SCALE%3ALB_AXIS_TYPE 6e For some types of axes, you can select to format an axis as text or date, or to detect the type automatically.
30 CHART2_CHECKBOX_TP_AXIS_POSITIONS_CB_TICKS_INNER 3e Specifies that marks are placed on the inner side of the axis.
36 chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_AXIS_POSITIONS%3ACB_TICKS_INNER 3e Specifies that marks are placed on the inner side of the axis.
36 chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_AXIS_POSITIONS%3ACB_MINOR_INNER 5b Especifica que as marcas de intervalo secundario deben colocarse na parte interior do eixo.
35 chart2%3AListBox%3ATP_AXIS_POSITIONS%3ALB_PLACE_TICKS 4b Select where to place the marks: at labels, at axis, or at axis and labels.
36 chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_AXIS_POSITIONS%3ACB_TICKS_OUTER 43 Especifica que as marcas deben colocarse na parte exterior do eixo.
39 CHART2_LISTBOX_TP_AXIS_POSITIONS_LB_CROSSES_OTHER_AXIS_AT 5f Select where to cross the other axis: at start, at end, at a specified value, or at a category.
30 CHART2_CHECKBOX_TP_AXIS_POSITIONS_CB_TICKS_OUTER 43 Especifica que as marcas deben colocarse na parte exterior do eixo.
42 chart2%3ASpinField%3ATP_AXIS_POSITIONS%3AEDT_CROSSES_OTHER_AXIS_AT 40 Enter the value where the axis line should cross the other axis.
36 chart2%3AListBox%3ATP_AXIS_POSITIONS%3ALB_PLACE_LABELS 63 Select where to place the labels: near axis, near axis (other side), outside start, or outside end.
2f CHART2_LISTBOX_TP_AXIS_POSITIONS_LB_PLACE_TICKS 4b Select where to place the marks: at labels, at axis, or at axis and labels.
30 CHART2_LISTBOX_TP_AXIS_POSITIONS_LB_PLACE_LABELS 63 Select where to place the labels: near axis, near axis (other side), outside start, or outside end.
3c CHART2_SPINFIELD_TP_AXIS_POSITIONS_EDT_CROSSES_OTHER_AXIS_AT 40 Enter the value where the axis line should cross the other axis.
44 CHART2_COMBOBOX_TP_AXIS_POSITIONS_EDT_CROSSES_OTHER_AXIS_AT_CATEGORY 44 Select the category where the axis line should cross the other axis.
4a chart2%3AComboBox%3ATP_AXIS_POSITIONS%3AEDT_CROSSES_OTHER_AXIS_AT_CATEGORY 44 Select the category where the axis line should cross the other axis.
30 CHART2_CHECKBOX_TP_AXIS_POSITIONS_CB_MINOR_INNER 5b Especifica que as marcas de intervalo secundario deben colocarse na parte interior do eixo.
36 chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_AXIS_POSITIONS%3ACB_MINOR_OUTER 5c Especifica que as marcas de intervalo secundario deben colocarse na parte exterior do eixo .
30 CHART2_CHECKBOX_TP_AXIS_POSITIONS_CB_MINOR_OUTER 5c Especifica que as marcas de intervalo secundario deben colocarse na parte exterior do eixo .
3f chart2%3AListBox%3ATP_AXIS_POSITIONS%3ALB_CROSSES_OTHER_AXIS_AT 5f Select where to cross the other axis: at start, at end, at a specified value, or at a category.
17 .uno%3ADiagramGridYHelp 4b Abre a caixa de diálogo Grade para a definición das propiedades de grade.
15 .uno%3ADiagramGridAll 4b Abre a caixa de diálogo Grade para a definición das propiedades de grade.
17 .uno%3ADiagramGridZHelp 4b Abre a caixa de diálogo Grade para a definición das propiedades de grade.
17 .uno%3ADiagramGridYMain 4b Abre a caixa de diálogo Grade para a definición das propiedades de grade.
17 .uno%3ADiagramGridXHelp 4b Abre a caixa de diálogo Grade para a definición das propiedades de grade.
17 .uno%3ADiagramGridXMain 4b Abre a caixa de diálogo Grade para a definición das propiedades de grade.
17 .uno%3ADiagramGridZMain 4b Abre a caixa de diálogo Grade para a definición das propiedades de grade.
12 .uno%3ADiagramWall b1 Abre a caixa de diálogo Paredes da gráfica, onde pode modificar as propiedades o fondo da gráfica. Trátase do fondo "vertical" situado detrás da área de datos da gráfica.
13 .uno%3ADiagramFloor bb Abre a caixa de diálogo Base da gráfica, onde pode modificar as propiedades da base da gráfica. É a parte inferior das gráficas 3D. Esta función só é válida para as gráficas 3D.
12 .uno%3ADiagramArea ae Abre a caixa de diálogo Área da gráfica, onde pode modificar as propiedades da área da gráfica. A área da gráfica é o fondo situado detrás dos elementos da gráfica.
3b chart2%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_SPLINE_PROPERTIES%3ARB_SPLINES_B 1b Aplicar un modelo spline B.
3e chart2%3AMetricField%3ADLG_SPLINE_PROPERTIES%3AMF_SPLINE_ORDER 22 Set the degree of the polynomials.
43 chart2%3AMetricField%3ADLG_SPLINE_PROPERTIES%3AMF_SPLINE_RESOLUTION 16 Definir a resolución.
3f chart2%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_SPLINE_PROPERTIES%3ARB_SPLINES_CUBIC 21 Aplicar un modelo spline cúbico.
3c chart2%3AImageButton%3ATP_3D_SCENEILLUMINATION%3ABTN_LIGHT_4 39 Prema para activar ou desactivar a fonte de luz uniforme.
3f chart2%3AMetricField%3ATP_3D_SCENEGEOMETRY%3AMTR_FLD_Y_ROTATION 5e Define a rotación da gráfica no eixo y. A previsualización responde á nova configuración.
3c chart2%3AImageButton%3ATP_3D_SCENEILLUMINATION%3ABTN_LIGHT_2 39 Prema para activar ou desactivar a fonte de luz uniforme.
3c chart2%3AImageButton%3ATP_3D_SCENEILLUMINATION%3ABTN_LIGHT_8 39 Prema para activar ou desactivar a fonte de luz uniforme.
3a chart2%3ACheckbox%3ATP_3D_SCENEAPPEARANCE%3ACB_ROUNDEDEDGE 24 Os bordos están arredondados ao 5%.
3f chart2%3AMetricField%3ATP_3D_SCENEGEOMETRY%3AMTR_FLD_X_ROTATION 5e Define a rotación da gráfica no eixo x. A previsualización responde á nova configuración.
42 chart2%3AImageButton%3ATP_3D_SCENEILLUMINATION%3ABTN_AMBIENT_COLOR 37 Seleccione unha cor utilizando a caixa de diálogo Cor.
3c chart2%3AImageButton%3ATP_3D_SCENEILLUMINATION%3ABTN_LIGHT_3 39 Prema para activar ou desactivar a fonte de luz uniforme.
3c chart2%3AImageButton%3ATP_3D_SCENEILLUMINATION%3ABTN_LIGHT_1 4c Prema para alternar entre o modelo de iluminación dunha esfera ou dun cubo.
3a chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_3D_SCENEAPPEARANCE%3ACB_OBJECTLINES 4d Mostra bordos arredor das áreas configurando o estilo de liña como Sólido.
40 chart2%3AMetricField%3ATP_3D_SCENEGEOMETRY%3AMTR_FLD_PERSPECTIVE bc Mark the Perspective box to view the chart as through a camera lens. Use the spin button to set the percentage. With a high percentage nearer objects look bigger than more distant objects.
3c chart2%3AListBox%3ATP_3D_SCENEILLUMINATION%3ALB_AMBIENTLIGHT 2b Seleccione unha cor para a luz de ambiente.
36 chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_3D_SCENEAPPEARANCE%3ACB_SHADING 5c Aplica o sombreamento Gouraud se está marcado ou o sombreamento plano se non está marcado.
d .uno%3AView3D c6 Abre unha caixa de diálogo para editar as propiedades dunha vista tridimensional das gráficas de columnas, barras, pizza, e de área. Para gráficas de liña e XY (Dispersión) pode ver liñas 3D.
3f chart2%3AMetricField%3ATP_3D_SCENEGEOMETRY%3AMTR_FLD_Z_ROTATION 5e Define a rotación da gráfica no eixo z. A previsualización responde á nova configuración.
3c chart2%3AImageButton%3ATP_3D_SCENEILLUMINATION%3ABTN_LIGHT_5 39 Prema para activar ou desactivar a fonte de luz uniforme.
3c chart2%3AImageButton%3ATP_3D_SCENEILLUMINATION%3ABTN_LIGHT_6 39 Prema para activar ou desactivar a fonte de luz uniforme.
3c chart2%3AImageButton%3ATP_3D_SCENEILLUMINATION%3ABTN_LIGHT_7 39 Prema para activar ou desactivar a fonte de luz uniforme.
39 chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_3D_SCENEGEOMETRY%3ACBX_PERSPECTIVE bc Mark the Perspective box to view the chart as through a camera lens. Use the spin button to set the percentage. With a high percentage nearer objects look bigger than more distant objects.
34 chart2%3AListBox%3ATP_3D_SCENEAPPEARANCE%3ALB_SCHEME 60 Seleccione un esquema da caixa de lista ou prema calquera das seguintes caixas de verificación.
3f chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_3D_SCENEGEOMETRY%3ACBX_RIGHT_ANGLED_AXES 101 If Right-angled axes is enabled, you can rotate the chart contents only in X and Y direction, that is, parallel to the chart borders. Right-angled axes is enabled by default for newly created 3D charts. Pie and Donut charts do not support right-angled axes.
46 chart2%3AImageButton%3ATP_3D_SCENEILLUMINATION%3ABTN_LIGHTSOURCE_COLOR 37 Seleccione unha cor utilizando a caixa de diálogo Cor.
3b chart2%3AListBox%3ATP_3D_SCENEILLUMINATION%3ALB_LIGHTSOURCE 35 Seleccione unha cor para a fonte de luz seleccionada.
1a CHART2_HID_SCH_LEGEND_SHOW 1e Mostra unha lenda na gráfica.
1d CHART2_HID_SCH_LEGEND_POS_TOP 30 Posiciona a lenda na parte superior da gráfica.
20 CHART2_HID_SCH_TITLE_SECONDARY_Y 71 Enter a label for the secondary y-axis. This option is only available for charts that support a secondary y-axis.
17 CHART2_HID_SCH_CB_ZGRID 6e Introducir unha etiqueta para o eixo z. Esta opción só está dispoñíbel para as gráficas tridimensionais.
16 CHART2_HID_SCH_TITLE_Z 6e Introducir unha etiqueta para o eixo z. Esta opción só está dispoñíbel para as gráficas tridimensionais.
1e CHART2_HID_SCH_LEGEND_POS_LEFT 2a Posiciona a lenda á esquerda da gráfica.
17 CHART2_HID_SCH_CB_YGRID 39 Displays grid lines that are perpendicular to the y-axis.
17 CHART2_HID_SCH_CB_XGRID 39 Displays grid lines that are perpendicular to the x-axis.
20 CHART2_HID_SCH_LEGEND_POS_BOTTOM 30 Posiciona a lenda na parte inferior da gráfica.
20 CHART2_HID_SCH_TITLE_SECONDARY_X 71 Enter a label for the secondary x-axis. This option is only available for charts that support a secondary x-axis.
16 CHART2_HID_SCH_TITLE_Y 32 Introducir unha etiqueta para o eixo y (vertical).
1f CHART2_HID_SCH_LEGEND_POS_RIGHT 29 Posiciona a lenda á dereita da gráfica.
16 CHART2_HID_SCH_TITLE_X 34 Introducir unha etiqueta para o eixo x (horizontal).
19 CHART2_HID_SCH_TITLE_MAIN 26 Introducir un título para a gráfica.
18 CHART2_HID_SCH_TITLE_SUB 29 Introducir un subtítulo para a gráfica.
12 .uno%3ADiagramType 2a Abre a caixa de diálogo Tipo de gráfica.
1d CHART2_HID_SCH_WIZARD_ROADMAP 33 Prema para ir á páxina do asistente especificada.
2e chart2%3AListBox%3ATP_CHARTTYPE%3ALB_3D_SCHEME 22 Seleccione o tipo de aparencia 3D.
38 chart2%3ARadioButton%3ATP_CHARTTYPE%3ARB_STACK_Y_PERCENT 36 As series amontoadas mostran valores como porcentaxes.
34 chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_CHARTTYPE%3ACB_XVALUE_SORTING 73 Conecta puntos por valores X ascendentes, mesmo se a orde dos valores é diferente, nun diagrama de dispersión XY.
2d chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_CHARTTYPE%3ACB_SPLINES 21 As liñas móstranse como curvas.
1b CHART2_HID_SCH_NUM_OF_LINES 49 Definir o número de liñas para o tipo de gráfica de Columnas e liñas.
17 CHART2_HID_SCH_CTL_TYPE 27 Seleccione un tipo de gráfica básico.
1e CHART2_HID_SCH_LB_BAR_GEOMETRY 1f Selecciona unha forma da lista.
30 chart2%3ARadioButton%3ATP_CHARTTYPE%3ARB_STACK_Y 3e As series amontoadas mostran os valores uns enriba dos outros.
2d chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_CHARTTYPE%3ACB_STACKED 31 Mostra series amontoadas para gráficas de liña.
1a CHART2_HID_SCH_CTL_VARIANT 32 Seleccione un subtipo do tipo de gráfica básico.
2d chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_CHARTTYPE%3ACB_3D_LOOK 32 Activa unha aparencia 3D para os valores de datos.
35 chart2%3APushButton%3ATP_CHARTTYPE%3APB_SPLINE_DIALOG 41 Abre unha caixa de diálogo para definir as propiedades da curva.
34 chart2%3ARadioButton%3ATP_RANGECHOOSER%3ARB_DATACOLS 100 A serie de datos toma datos das columnas consecutivas no intervalo seleccionado. Para gráficas de dispersión, a primeira columna de datos conterá valores x para todas as seires. As demais columnas de datos utilízanse como valores y, un para cada serie.
2a chart2%3AEdit%3ATP_RANGECHOOSER%3AED_RANGE c5 Introduza o intervalo de datos que desexa incluír na gráfica. Para minimizar esta caixa de diálogo mentres selecciona o intervalo de datos en Calc, prema no botón Seleccionar intervalo de datos
34 chart2%3ARadioButton%3ATP_RANGECHOOSER%3ARB_DATAROWS f7 A serie de datos toma datos das filas consecutivas no intervalo seleccionado. Para gráficas de dispersión, a primeira serie de datos conterá valores x en todas as series. As demais series de datos utilízanse como valores y, un para cada serie.
3b chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_RANGECHOOSER%3ACB_FIRST_ROW_ASLABELS 14c Para series de datos en columnas: A primeira fila do intervalo utilízase como nomes para series de datos. Para series de datos en filas: A primeira fila no intervalo utilízase como categorías. As filas restantes abranguen a serie de datos. Se esta caixa de verificación non está seleccionada, todas as filas son serie de datos.
3e chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_RANGECHOOSER%3ACB_FIRST_COLUMN_ASLABELS 151 Para series de datos en columnas: A primeira columna do intervalo utilízase como nomes para series de datos. Para serie de datos en filas: A primeira columna utilízase como categorías. As columnas restantes abranguen as columnas de datos. Se esta caixa de verificación non está seleccionada, todas as columnas son columnas de datos.
31 chart2%3AImageButton%3ATP_RANGECHOOSER%3AIB_RANGE c5 Introduza o intervalo de datos que desexa incluír na gráfica. Para minimizar esta caixa de diálogo mentres selecciona o intervalo de datos en Calc, prema no botón Seleccionar intervalo de datos
11 .uno%3ADataRanges 5b Abre a caixa de diálogo Intervalos de datos onde pode editar Intervalos e Series de datos.
35 chart2%3AImageButton%3ATP_DATA_SOURCE%3AIMB_RANGE_CAT 144 Shows the source range address of the categories (the texts you can see on the x-axis of a category chart). For an XY-chart, the text box contains the source range of the data labels which are displayed for the data points. To minimize this dialog while you select the data range in Calc, click the Select data range button.
2f chart2%3AEdit%3ATP_DATA_SOURCE%3AEDT_CATEGORIES 144 Shows the source range address of the categories (the texts you can see on the x-axis of a category chart). For an XY-chart, the text box contains the source range of the data labels which are displayed for the data points. To minimize this dialog while you select the data range in Calc, click the Select data range button.
2a chart2%3AEdit%3ATP_DATA_SOURCE%3AEDT_RANGE 123 Mostra o intervalo de orixe desde a segunda columna da caixa de lista Intervalo de datos. Pode modificar o intervalo na caixa de texto ou arrastrar no documento. Para minimizar esta caixa de diálogo ao seleccionar o intervalo de datos en Calc, prema no botón Seleccionar intervalo de datos
2e chart2%3APushButton%3ATP_DATA_SOURCE%3ABTN_ADD 9d Engade unha entrada debaixo da seleccionada na lista Serie de datos. Se hai unha entrada seleccionada, a nova serie de datos obtén o mesmo tipo de gráfica.
2f chart2%3APushButton%3ATP_DATA_SOURCE%3ABTN_DOWN 42 Move cara a abaixo a entrada seleccionada na lista Serie de datos.
1f CHART2_HID_SCH_DATA_RANGES_LIST c4 Mostra todos os intervalos de datos utilizados pola serie de datos seleccionada na caixa de lista Serie de datos. Cada intervalo de datos mostra o nome do papel e o enderezo do intervalo de orixe.
31 chart2%3APushButton%3ATP_DATA_SOURCE%3ABTN_REMOVE 37 Elimina a entrada seleccionada da lista Serie de datos.
36 chart2%3AImageButton%3ATP_DATA_SOURCE%3AIMB_RANGE_MAIN 123 Mostra o intervalo de orixe desde a segunda columna da caixa de lista Intervalo de datos. Pode modificar o intervalo na caixa de texto ou arrastrar no documento. Para minimizar esta caixa de diálogo ao seleccionar o intervalo de datos en Calc, prema no botón Seleccionar intervalo de datos
2d chart2%3APushButton%3ATP_DATA_SOURCE%3ABTN_UP 42 Move cara a arriba a entrada seleccionada na lista Serie de datos.
1a CHART2_HID_SCH_SERIES_LIST ce Mostra unha lista de todas as series de datos na gráfica. Prema nunha entrada para ver e editar esas series de datos. Prema en Engadir para inserir na lista unha nova serie despois da entrada seleccionada.
11 .uno%3ADataInRows 2e Modifica a disposición dos datos da gráfica.
14 .uno%3ADataInColumns 2e Modifica a disposición dos datos da gráfica.
10 .uno%3AScaleText 38 Redimensiona o texto ao modificar o tamaño da gráfica.
15 .uno%3ANewArrangement c3 Move todos os elementos para a súa posición predefinida dentro da gráfica actual. Esta función non altera o tipo de gráfica nin ningún dos outros atributos alén da posición dos elementos.
12 .uno%3AContextType 29 Mostra o nome do tipo de gráfica actual.
19 .uno%3AResetAllDataPoints 3c Restabelece todos os puntos de datos ao formato predefinido.
11 .uno%3ADeleteAxis 1a Borra o eixo seleccionado.
17 .uno%3AFormatDataSeries 19 Formata a serie de datos.
17 .uno%3AFormatYErrorBars 1c Formata as barras de erro Y.
11 .uno%3AFormatAxis 1c Formata o eixo seleccionado.
12 .uno%3AFormatTitle 1f Formata o título seleccionado.
16 .uno%3AInsertMinorGrid 1d Insire unha grade secundaria.
1e .uno%3AFormatTrendlineEquation 21 Formata a ecuación de tendencia.
10 .uno%3ADrawChart 123 Crea unha gráfica no documento actual. Para usar un intervalo regular de celas como orixe de datos para a gráfica, prema dentro do intervalo de celas e logo escolla esta orde. Alternativamente, seleccione algunhas celas e escolla esta orde para crear unha gráfica das celas seleccionadas.
11 .uno%3AInsertAxis 26 Abre un diálogo para inserir un eixo.
12 .uno%3AFormatFloor 1d Formata a planta da gráfica.
16 .uno%3AFormatStockLoss 30 Formata os indicadores de perda de cotizacións.
13 SW_HID_INSERT_CHART 123 Crea unha gráfica no documento actual. Para usar un intervalo regular de celas como orixe de datos para a gráfica, prema dentro do intervalo de celas e logo escolla esta orde. Alternativamente, seleccione algunhas celas e escolla esta orde para crear unha gráfica das celas seleccionadas.
16 .uno%3AStarChartDialog 123 Crea unha gráfica no documento actual. Para usar un intervalo regular de celas como orixe de datos para a gráfica, prema dentro do intervalo de celas e logo escolla esta orde. Alternativamente, seleccione algunhas celas e escolla esta orde para crear unha gráfica das celas seleccionadas.
16 .uno%3AFormatTrendline 1d Formata a liña de tendencia.
16 .uno%3AFormatMeanValue 1f Formata a liña de valor medio.
14 .uno%3AInsertR2Value 32 Insire valor de coeficiente de determinación R².
16 .uno%3AFormatDataPoint 26 Formata o punto de datos seleccionado.
16 .uno%3AFormatMinorGrid 1b Formata a grade secundaria.
15 .uno%3AResetDataPoint 41 Restabelece o punto de datos seleccionado ao formato predefinido.
16 .uno%3ADeleteMeanValue 1f Elimina a liña de valor medio.
16 .uno%3ADeleteMajorGrid 18 Borra a grade principal.
13 .uno%3AFormatLegend 1c Formata a lenda da gráfica.
16 .uno%3ADeleteMinorGrid 14 Borra a grade menor.
16 .uno%3AInsertAxisTitle 31 Abre un diálogo para inserir un título de eixo.
16 .uno%3AFormatChartArea 1c Formata a área da gráfica.
18 .uno%3AInsertObjectChart 123 Crea unha gráfica no documento actual. Para usar un intervalo regular de celas como orixe de datos para a gráfica, prema dentro do intervalo de celas e logo escolla esta orde. Alternativamente, seleccione algunhas celas e escolla esta orde para crear unha gráfica das celas seleccionadas.
16 .uno%3AInsertMajorGrid 1c Insire unha grade principal.
17 .uno%3AInsertRemoveAxes 30 Abre un diálogo para inserir ou eliminar eixos.
17 .uno%3ADeleteDataLabels 22 Borra todas as etiquetas de datos.
13 .uno%3ADeleteLegend 1a Borra a lenda da gráfica.
17 .uno%3AInsertDataLabels 1a Insire etiquetas de datos.
13 .uno%3AInsertTitles 33 Abre un diálogo para inserir títulos de gráfica.
11 .uno%3AFormatWall 1d Formata a parede da gráfica.
16 .uno%3AFormatStockGain 33 Formata os indicadores de ganancia de cotizacións.
16 .uno%3AFormatDataLabel 29 Formata a etiqueta de datos seleccionada.
16 .uno%3ADeleteDataLabel 27 Elimina a etiqueta de datos selecciona.
1e .uno%3ADeleteTrendlineEquation 2a Elimina a ecuación de liña de tendencia.
14 .uno%3ADeleteR2Value 14 Elimina o valor R².
17 .uno%3AFormatDataLabels 1e Formata as etiquetas de datos.
17 .uno%3ADeleteYErrorBars 1c Elimina as barras de erro Y.
16 .uno%3AInsertDataLabel 22 Insire unha soa etiqueta de datos.
23 .uno%3AInsertTrendlineEquationAndR2 52 Insire unha ecuación de liña de tendencia e o coeficiente de determinación R².
16 .uno%3AFormatMajorGrid 1a Formata a grade principal.
1b .uno%3AChartElementSelector dd Seleccionar o elemento da gráfica que quere formatar. O elemento queda seleccionado na previsualización da gráfica. Prema sobre Formatado de selección para abrir o diálogo de propiedades para o elemento seleccionado.